Contents

Nissan Frontier Owner's Manual PDF

1 of 444
1 of 444

Summary of Content for Nissan Frontier Owner's Manual PDF

2013 FRONTIER OWNERS MANUAL

For your safety, read carefully and keep in this vehicle.

2 0 1 3 N

IS S

A N

F R

O N

T IE

R D

4 0

-D

D40-D

Printing : November 2012 (17)

Publication No.: OM1E 0D40U1

Printed in U.S.A.

3 0

Welcome to the growing family of new NISSAN owners. This vehicle is delivered to you with confidence. It was produced using the latest techniques and strict quality control.

This manual was prepared to help you under- stand the operation and maintenance of your vehicle so that you may enjoy many miles (kilome- ters) of driving pleasure. Please read through this manual before operating your vehicle.

A separate Warranty Information Booklet explains details about the warranties cov- ering your vehicle. The NISSAN Service and Maintenance Guide explains details about maintaining and servicing your ve- hicle. Additionally, a separate Customer Care/Lemon Law Booklet (U.S. only) will explain how to resolve any concerns you may have with your vehicle, as well as clarify your rights under your states lemon law.

Your NISSAN dealership knows your vehicle best. When you require any service or have any questions, they will be glad to assist you with the extensive resources available to them.

In addition to factory installed options, your ve- hicle may also be equipped with additional ac- cessories installed by NISSAN or by your NISSAN dealer prior to delivery. It is important that you familiarize yourself with all disclosures,

warnings, cautions and instructions concerning proper use of such accessories prior to operating the vehicle and/or accessory. See a NISSAN dealer for details concerning the particular ac- cessories with which your vehicle is equipped.

Before driving your vehicle, please read this Owners Manual carefully. This will ensure famil- iarity with controls and maintenance require- ments, assisting you in the safe operation of your vehicle.

WARNING

IMPORTANT SAFETY INFORMATION RE- MINDERS FOR SAFETY!

Follow these important driving rules to help ensure a safe and comfortable trip for you and your passengers!

NEVER drive under the influence of al- cohol or drugs.

ALWAYS observe posted speed limits and never drive too fast for conditions.

ALWAYS give your full attention to driving and avoid using vehicle features or taking other actions that could distract you.

ALWAYS use your seat belts and appro- priate child restraint systems. Pre-teen children should be seated in the rear seat.

ALWAYS provide information about the proper use of vehicle safety features to all occupants of the vehicle.

ALWAYS review this Owners Manual for important safety information.

FOREWORD READ FIRSTTHEN DRIVE SAFELY

For descriptions specified for four-wheel drive models, a mark is placed at the begin- ning of the applicable sections/items.

As with other vehicles with features for off-road use, failure to operate four-wheel drive models correctly may result in loss of control or an accident. Be sure to read Driving safety precautions in the Start- ing and driving section of this manual.

ON-PAVEMENT AND OFF-ROAD DRIV- ING

This vehicle will handle and maneuver differently from an ordinary passenger car because it has a higher center of gravity for off-road use. As with other vehicles with features of this type, fail- ure to operate this vehicle correctly may result in loss of control or an accident.

Be sure to read On-pavement and off- road driving precautions, and Avoid- ing collision and rollover, and Driving safety precautions, in the Starting and driving section of this manual.

MODIFICATION OF YOUR VEHICLE

This vehicle should not be modified. Modification could affect its performance, safety or durability, and may even violate governmental regulations. In addition, damage or per- formance problems resulting from modi- fications may not be covered under NISSAN warranties.

This manual includes information for all options available on this model. Therefore, you may find some information that does not apply to your vehicle.

All information, specifications and illustrations in this manual are those in effect at the time of printing. NISSAN reserves the right to change specifications or design without notice and with- out obligation.

IMPORTANT INFORMATION ABOUT THIS MANUAL You will see various symbols in this manual. They are used in the following ways:

WARNING

This is used to indicate the presence of a hazard that could cause death or serious personal injury. To avoid or reduce the risk, the procedures must be followed precisely.

CAUTION

This is used to indicate the presence of a hazard that could cause minor or moder- ate personal injury or damage to your ve- hicle. To avoid or reduce the risk, the pro- cedures must be followed carefully.

WHEN READING THE MANUAL

If you see this symbol, it means Do not do this or Do not let this happen.

If you see a symbol similar to these in an illustra- tion, it means the arrow points to the front of the vehicle.

Arrows in an illustration that are similar to these indicate movement or action.

Arrows in an illustration that are similar to these call attention to an item in the illustration.

CALIFORNIA PROPOSITION 65 WARNING

WARNING

Engine exhaust, some of its constituents, and certain vehicle components contain or emit chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer and birth de- fects or other reproductive harm. In addi- tion, certain fluids contained in vehicles and certain products of component wear contain or emit chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects or other reproductive harm.

CALIFORNIA PERCHLORATE ADVISORY Some vehicle parts, such as lithium batter- ies, may contain perchlorate material. The following advisory is provided: Perchlorate Material special handling may apply, See www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate/.

BLUETOOTH is a trademark owned by Bluetooth SIG, Inc. and licensed to Visteon and Clarion.

SiriusXM Satellite Radio requires subscription, sold separately. Not available in Alaska, Hawaii or Guam. For more information, visit www.siriusxm.com.

2012 NISSAN NORTH AMERICA, INC.

All rights reserved. No part of this Owners Manual may be reproduced or stored in a retrieval system, or transmitted in any form, or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording or otherwise, without the prior written permission of Nissan North America, Inc.

APD1005

NISSAN CARES . . .

Both NISSAN and your NISSAN dealer are dedicated to serving all your automotive needs. Your satisfaction with your vehicle and your NISSAN dealer are our primary concerns. Your NISSAN dealer is always available to assist you with all your automobile sales and service needs.

However, if there is something that your NISSAN dealer cannot assist you with or you would like to provide NISSAN directly with comments or questions, please contact the NISSAN Con- sumer Affairs Department using our toll-free number:

For U.S. customers 1-800-NISSAN-1 (1-800-647-7261)

For Canadian customers 1-800-387-0122

The Consumer Affairs Department will ask for the following information:

Your name, address, and telephone number

Vehicle identification number (attached to the top of the instrument panel on the drivers side)

Date of purchase

Current odometer reading

Your NISSAN dealers name

Your comments or questions

OR

You can write to NISSAN with the information at:

For U.S. customers Nissan North America, Inc. Consumer Affairs Department P.O. Box 685003 Franklin, TN 37068-5003 or via e-mail at: nnaconsumeraffairs@nissan-usa.com

For Canadian customers Nissan Canada Inc. 5290 Orbitor Drive Mississauga, Ontario L4W 4Z5 or via e-mail at: information.centre@nissancanada.com

If you prefer, visit us at: www.nissanusa.com (for U.S. customers) or www.nissan.ca (for Canadian customers)

We appreciate your interest in NISSAN and thank you for buying a quality NISSAN vehicle.

NISSAN CUSTOMER CARE PROGRAM

Table of Contents

Illustrated table of contents

SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

Instruments and controls

Pre-driving checks and adjustments

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Starting and driving

In case of emergency

Appearance and care

Maintenance and do-it-yourself

Technical and consumer information

Index

0

1

2

3

4

5

6

7

8

9

10

0 Illustrated table of contents

Air bags, seat belts and child restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0-2 Exterior front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0-3 Exterior rear. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0-4 Passenger compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0-5

Instrument panel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0-6 Engine compartment check locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0-8 Warning/indicator lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0-10

1. 2nd row seat belts (P. 1-15) 2. Roof-mounted curtain side-impact and

rollover supplemental air bag (P. 1-63) 3. Front seat belts (P. 1-15) 4. Head restraints (P.1-6 ) 5. Supplemental front-impact air bags

(P.1-70) 6. Seats (P. 1-2) 7. Occupant classification sensor

(pressure sensor) (P. 1-70) 8. Seat belt with pretensioners (P. 1-76) 9. Front seat-mounted side-impact

supplemental air bag (P. 1-63) 10. LATCH (Lower Anchors and Tethers for

CHildren) system (P. 1-27) 11. Top tether strap anchor (P. 1-29) See the page number indicated in paren- theses for operating details.

WII0135

AIR BAGS, SEAT BELTS AND CHILD RESTRAINTS

0-2 Illustrated table of contents

1. Engine hood (P. 8-6) 2. Windshield wiper and washer switch

(P. 2-26) 3. Windshield (P. 8-22) 4. Windows (P. 2-47) 5. Door locks, keyfob (if so equipped),

keys (P. 3-3, 3-6, 3-2) 6. Mirrors (P. 3-15) 7. Tire pressure (P. 8-33) 8. Flat tire (P. 6-3) 9. Tire chains (P. 8-40) 10. Headlight and turn signal switch

(P. 2-28); Replacing bulbs (P. 8-29) 11. Fog light switch (if so equipped)

(P. 2-32) See the page number indicated in paren- theses for operating details.

LII0052

EXTERIOR FRONT

Illustrated table of contents 0-3

1. Rear sliding window (if so equipped) (P.2-50)

2. Vehicle loading (P. 9-13) 3. Truck box, tailgate (P. 3-17) 4. Replacing bulbs (P. 8-29) 5. Fuel-filler cap, fuel recommendation

(P. 3-11, P. 9-4) See the page number indicated in paren- theses for operating details.

LII0053

EXTERIOR REAR

0-4 Illustrated table of contents

1. Map lights (if so equipped) (P. 2-53) 2. Sun visors (P. 3-14) 3. Rearview mirror (if so equipped)

(P. 3-15) 4. Vents (P. 4-17) 5. Glove box (P. 2-42) 6. Shift selector (automatic transmission,

if so equipped) (P. 5-13) 7. Cup holders (P. 2-44) 8. Front seats (P. 1-2) 9. Console box (P. 2-41) 10. Rear seats (P. 1-13) 11. Flat tire/Jacking equipment storage

(P. 6-3) See the page number indicated in paren- theses for operating details.

WII0054

PASSENGER COMPARTMENT

Illustrated table of contents 0-5

1. Vents (P. 4-17) 2. Headlight/fog light (if so equipped)/turn

signal switch (P. 2-28) 3. Steering wheel switch for audio control

(if so equipped)/Bluetooth Hands- Free Phone System (if so equipped) (P. 4-75, P. 4-70, 4-71)

4. Driver supplemental air bag/horn P. 1-63, P. 2-32)

5. Meters, gauges and warning/indicator lights (P. 2-3, 2-14)

6. Cruise control main/set switches (if so equipped) (P. 5-21)

7. Windshield wiper/washer switch (P. 2-26)

8. Storage (P. 2-38) 9. Audio system controls (if so equipped)

(P. 4-35) 10. Front passenger supplemental air bag

(P. 1-63) 11. Upper and lower glove box (P. 2-42) 12. Passenger air bag status light (P. 1-72) 13. Power outlet (P. 2-37) 14. Power outlet (P. 2-37)

LIC2471

INSTRUMENT PANEL

0-6 Illustrated table of contents

15. Electronic locking rear differential (E-Lock) system switch (if so equipped) (P.2-35) Heated seat switch (if so equipped) (P. 2-33) Rear sonar switch (if so equipped) (P. 2-37) Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) OFF switch (P. 2-34)

16. Shift selector (P. 5-13, 5-18) 17. 4WD shift switch (if so equipped)

(P. 5-26) 18. Climate controls (P. 4-17, P.4-25) 19. Hazard warning flasher switch (P. 6-3) 20. Ignition switch (P. 5-10) 21. Tilt steering wheel control

(if so equipped) (P. 3-13) 22. Cargo lamp switch (P. 2-32) 23. Clutch interlock (clutch start) switch

(if so equipped) (P. 2-36)/Hill descent control switch (if so equipped) (P. 2-34)

24. Outside mirror controls (if so equipped) (P. 3-17)

Illustrated table of contents 0-7

QR25DE engine

1. Windshield-washer fluid reservoir (P. 8-15)

2. Fuse/fusible link box (P. 8-24) 3. Fuse and relay box (P. 8-24) 4. Air cleaner (P. 8-20) 5. Engine oil filler cap (P. 8-10) 6. Engine oil dipstick (P. 8-10) 7. Brake fluid reservoir/Clutch fluid

reservoir (M/T model) (P. 8-14) 8. Drive belt location (P.8-18) 9. Radiator cap (P. 8-8) 10. Power steering fluid reservoir (P. 8-14) 11. Battery (P. 8-16) 12. Engine coolant reservoir (P. 8-8) See the page number indicated in paren- theses for operating details.

WDI0643

ENGINE COMPARTMENT CHECK LOCATIONS

0-8 Illustrated table of contents

VQ40DE engine

1. Windshield-washer fluid reservoir (P. 8-15)

2. Fuse/fusible link box (P. 8-24) 3. Fuse and relay box (P. 8-24) 4. Engine oil filler cap (P. 8-10) 5. Engine oil dipstick (P. 8-10) 6. Brake fluid reservoir/Clutch fluid

reservoir (M/T model) (P. 8-14) 7. Air cleaner (P. 8-20) 8. Drive belt location (P.8-18) 9. Radiator cap (P. 8-8) 10. Power steering fluid reservoir (P. 8-14) 11. Battery (P. 8-16) 12. Engine coolant reservoir (P. 8-8) *Engine cover removed for clarity.

See the page number indicated in paren- theses for operating details.

LII0167

Illustrated table of contents 0-9

Warning light

Name Page

or

Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) warning light

2-15

Automatic transmis- sion check warning light

2-15

Automatic transmis- sion oil temperature warning light (if so equipped)

2-15

Automatic transmis- sion park warning light ( model)

2-15

or

Brake warning light 2-16

Warning light

Name Page

Charge warning light

2-16

Door open warning light

2-17

Engine oil pressure warning light

2-17

4WD warning light ( model)

2-17

Low fuel warning light

2-18

Low tire pressure warning light

2-18

Low windshield- washer fluid warning light (if so equipped)

2-19

Seat belt warning light and chime

2-19

Warning light

Name Page

Supplemental air bag warning light

2-20

Indicator light

Name Page

Automatic transmis- sion position indica- tor light (if so equipped)

2-20

Cruise main switch indicator light (if so equipped)

2-20

Cruise set switch indicator light (if so equipped)

2-20

WARNING/INDICATOR LIGHTS

0-10 Illustrated table of contents

Indicator light

Name Page

Electronic locking rear differential (E-Lock) system on indicator light (if so equipped)

2-20

4WD shift indicator light ( model)

2-21

Front passenger air bag status light

2-21

High beam indicator light (blue)

2-21

Hill descent control system on indicator light (if so equipped)

2-34

Malfunction Indica- tor Light (MIL)

2-21

Overdrive off indica- tor light (A/T models only)

2-22

Indicator light

Name Page

Security indicator light (if so equipped)

2-22

Slip indicator light for models with ABLS

2-22

Slip indicator light for models with VDC

2-22

Transfer 4LO posi- tion indicator light ( model)

2-22

Turn signal/hazard indicator lights

2-23

Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) OFF indicator light

2-23

Illustrated table of contents 0-11

1 SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2 Front manual seat adjustment (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2 Front power seat adjustment (if so equipped for Crew cab models) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4 Jump seat (King cab) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6 Armrest (if so equipped). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6 Head restraints (1st row only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6 Head restraints (2nd row outboard positions only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-9 Flexible seating. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-11

Seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-15 Precautions on seat belt usage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-15 Pregnant women . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-18 Injured persons. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-18 Three-point type seat belt with retractor . . . . . . . . . . 1-18 Seat belt extenders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-22 Seat belt maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-23

Child safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-23 Infants. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-24 Small children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-24 Larger children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-24

Child restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-25 Precautions on child restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-25

LATCH (Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren) System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-27 Rear-facing child restraint installation using LATCH (Crew cab models only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-30 Rear-facing child restraint installation using LATCH Jump seat (King cab models only). . . . . . 1-32 Rear-facing child restraint installation using the seat belts (Crew cab models only) . . . . . . . . . . . 1-36 Rear-facing child restraint installation using the seat belts jump seat (King cab models only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-39 Forward-facing child restraint installation using LATCH (Crew cab model only) . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-43 Forward-facing child restraint installation using LATCH jump seat (King cab models only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-45 Forward-facing child restraint installation using the seat belts front passenger and rear bench seat (Crew cab models only) . . . . . . . . . 1-48 Foward-facing child restraint installation using the seat belts front passenger and jump seats (King cab models only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-52 Installing top tether strap (Front passenger seat King cab models only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-56

Installing top tether strap (Jump seat King cab models only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-57 Installing top tether strap (Rear bench seat Crew cab models only). . . . . . . 1-57 Booster seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-58

Supplemental restraint system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-63 Precautions on supplemental restraint system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-63 Supplemental air bag warning labels . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-77 Supplemental air bag warning light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-78

WARNING

Do not ride in a moving vehicle when the seatback is reclined. This can be dangerous. The shoulder belt will not be against your body. In an accident, you could be thrown into it and receive neck or other serious injuries. You could also slide under the lap belt and receive serious internal injuries.

For the most effective protection when the vehicle is in motion, the seat should be upright. Always sit well back in the seat with both feet on the floor and adjust the seat properly. See Precau- tions on seat belt usage later in this section.

After adjustment, gently rock in the seat to make sure it is securely locked.

Do not leave children unattended inside the vehicle. They could unknowingly ac- tivate switches or controls. Unattended children could become involved in seri- ous accidents.

The seatback should not be reclined any more than needed for comfort. Seat belts are most effective when the pas- senger sits well back and straight up in the seat. If the seatback is reclined, the risk of sliding under the lap belt and being injured is increased.

CAUTION

When adjusting the seat positions, be sure not to contact any moving parts to avoid possible injuries and/or damage.

FRONT MANUAL SEAT ADJUSTMENT (if so equipped)

ARS1152

SEATS

1-2 SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

Forward and backward Pull the lever up and hold it while you slide the seat forward or backward to the desired position. Release the lever to lock the seat in position.

Reclining To recline the seatback, pull the lever up and lean back. To bring the seatback forward, pull the lever up and lean your body forward. Release the lever to lock the seatback in position.

The reclining feature allows adjustment of the seatback for occupants of different sizes for added comfort and to help obtain proper seat belt fit. See Precautions on seat belt usage later in this section. Also, the seatback can be reclined to allow occupants to rest when the vehicle is stopped and the transmission is in P (Park) or N (Neutral) position with the parking brake fully applied.

Seat lifter (if so equipped for drivers seat) Turn either dial to adjust the angle and height of the seat cushion to the desired position.

WRS0175 WRS0176 WRS0131

SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-3

Lumbar support (if so equipped for drivers seat) The lumbar support feature provides lower back support to the driver. Move the lever forward or backward to adjust the seat lumbar area.

FRONT POWER SEAT ADJUSTMENT (if so equipped for Crew cab models)

Operating tips The power seat motor has an auto-reset

overload protection circuit. If the motor stops during operation, wait 30 seconds, then reactivate the switch.

Do not operate the power seat switch for a long period of time when the engine is off. This will discharge the battery.

Forward and backward

Moving the switch forward or backward will slide the seat forward or backward to the desired position.

Reclining

Move the recline switch backward until the de- sired angle is obtained. To bring the seatback forward again, move the switch forward and move your body forward. The seatback will move forward.

WRS0389 WRS0163

1-4 SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

The reclining feature allows adjustment of the seatback for occupants of different sizes for added comfort and to help obtain proper seat belt fit (see Precautions on seat belt usage later in this section). Also, the seatback can be re- clined to allow occupants to rest when the ve- hicle is stopped and the transmission is in P (Park) or N (Neutral) position with the parking brake fully applied.

Seat lifter (if so equipped for drivers seat) Push the front or rear end of the switch up or down to adjust the angle and height of the seat cushion.

Lumbar support (if so equipped for drivers seat) The lumbar support feature provides lower back support to the driver. Move the lever forward or backward to adjust the seat lumbar area.

WRS0164 WRS0389

SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-5

JUMP SEAT (King cab)

WARNING

Do not use a child restraint in the driv- ers side jump seat. This seating posi- tion is not suitable for child restraint installation. A child restraint can be in- stalled in the passengers side jump seat when the seat extension is un- folded from the seat base.

When folding the jump seat, be careful not to squeeze your finger between the seat cushion and the body side.

ARMREST (if so equipped)

To use the center armrest on the 2nd row bench seat, pull on the tab in the center of the seat and fold it down to the resting position.

HEAD RESTRAINTS (1st row only)

WARNING

Head restraints supplement the other ve- hicle safety systems. They may provide additional protection against injury in cer- tain rear end collisions. Adjust the head restraints properly, as specified in this section. Check the adjustment after someone else uses the seat. Do not attach anything to the head restraint stalks or remove the head restraint. Do not use the seat if the head restraint has been re- moved. If the head restraint was removed, reinstall and properly adjust the head re- straint before an occupant uses the seat- ing position. Failure to follow these in- structions can reduce the effectiveness of the head restraints. This may increase the risk of serious injury or death in a collision.

LRS0556 LRS2089

1-6 SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

The illustration shows the seating positions equipped with head restraints. The first row head restraints are adjustable.

Indicates the seating position is equipped with a head restraint.

Components 1. Head restraint

2. Adjustment notches

3. Lock knob

4. Stalks

Adjustment Adjust the head restraint so the center is level with the center of the seat occupants ears.

LRS2020 LRS0887 WRS0134

SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-7

To raise the head restraint, pull it up. To lower, push and hold the lock knob and push the head restraint down.

Removal Use the following procedure to remove the ad- justable head restraints.

1. Pull the head restraint up to the highest position.

2. Push and hold the lock knob.

3. Remove the head restraint from the seat.

4. Store the head restraint properly so it is not loose in the vehicle.

5. Reinstall and properly adjust the head re- straint before an occupant uses the seating position.

LRS0888 LRS0889 LRS0890

1-8 SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

Install 1. Align the head restraint stalks with the holes

in the seat. Make sure the head restraint is facing the correct direction. The stalk with the adjustment notches 1 must be installed in the hole with the lock knob 2 .

2. Push and hold the lock knob and push the head restraint down.

3. Properly adjust the head restraint before an occupant uses the seating position.

Front-seat Active Head Restraints

The Active Head Restraint moves forward utiliz- ing the force that the seatback receives from the occupant in a rear-end collision. The movement of the head restraint helps support the occu- pants head by reducing its backward movement and helping absorb some of the forces that may lead to whiplash-type injuries.

Active Head Restraints are effective for collisions at low to medium speeds in which it is said that whiplash injury occurs most.

Active Head Restraints operate only in certain rear-end collisions. After the collision, the head restraints return to their original position.

Adjust the Active Head Restraints properly as described in this section.

HEAD RESTRAINTS (2nd row outboard positions only)

WARNING

Head restraints supplement the other ve- hicle safety systems. They may provide additional protection against injury in cer- tain rear end collisions. Adjust the head restraints properly, as specified in this section. Check the adjustment after someone else uses the seat. Do not attach anything to the head restraint stalks or remove the head restraint. Do not use the seat if the head restraint has been re- moved. If the head restraint was removed, reinstall and properly adjust the head re- straint before an occupant uses the seat- ing position. Failure to follow these in- structions can reduce the effectiveness of the head restraints. This may increase the risk of serious injury or death in a collision.

LRS0891 SPA1025

SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-9

The illustration shows the seating positions equipped with head restraints. The second row head restraints are removable but not adjustable.

Indicates the seating position is equipped with a head restraint.

+ Indicates the seating position is not equipped with a head restraint or adjustable headrest.

Components 1. Head restraint

2. Lock knobs

3. Stalks

Removal Use the following procedure to remove the ad- justable head restraints.

1. Adjust the seat or seatback as necessary.

2. Push and hold the lock knobs.

3. Pull the head restraint up until it is removed from the seat.

4. Store the head restraint properly so it is not loose in the vehicle.

5. Reinstall the head restraint and properly ad- just the seat or seatback before an occupant uses the seating position.

LRS2020 LRS2073 LRS2074

1-10 SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

Install

1. Align the head restraint stalks with the holes in the seat. Make sure the head restraint is facing the correct direction.

2. Push the head restraint down until it locks in place.

FLEXIBLE SEATING

WARNING

Never allow anyone to ride in the cargo area or on the rear seats when they are in the fold-down position. In a collision, people riding in these areas without proper restraints are more likely to be seriously injured or killed.

Do not allow people to ride in any area of your vehicle that is not equipped with seats and seat belts. Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and using a seat belt properly.

Do not fold down the rear seats when occupants are in the rear seat area or any luggage is on the rear seats.

Head restraints should be adjusted properly as they may provide significant protection against injury in an accident. Always replace and adjust them prop- erly if they have been removed for any reason.

If the head restraints are removed for any reason, they should be securely stored to prevent them from causing injury to passengers or damage to the vehicle in case of sudden braking or an accident.

When returning the seatbacks to the upright position, be certain they are completely secured in the latched posi- tion. If they are not completely secured, passengers may be injured in an acci- dent or sudden stop.

Properly secure all cargo to help pre- vent it from sliding or shifting. Do not place cargo higher than the seatbacks. In a sudden stop or collision, unsecured cargo could cause personal injury.

LRS2075

SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-11

Folding the front passengers seatback flat (if so equipped) To fold the front passengers seatback flat for extra storage length when transporting long items:

1 Slide the seat to the rearmost position. Lift up on the recline lever, located on the out- side edge of the seat, and fold the seatback forward as far as it will go. Then lift up on the latch located on the upper corner of the seatback to release the back of the seat.

2 Once the seatback is released, it will enable you to fold the front passenger seatback flat over the seat cushion.

3. To return the front passengers seat to a seating position, lift up on the seatback and push it up to an upright position. Then pull up on the recline lever and lean the seatback to a proper seating position. Release the lever to lock the seatback in position.

WARNING

If you fold the front passengers seat- back flat forward to carry longer ob- jects, be sure this cargo is properly se- cured and not near an air bag. In a crash, an inflating air bag might force that object toward a person. This could cause severe injury or even death. Se- cure objects away from the area in which an air bag would inflate. See Precautions on supplemental restraint system later in this section.

Never allow anyone to ride in the cargo area or on the front passengers seat when it is in the fold-down position. Use of these areas by passengers could re- sult in serious injury in an accident or sudden stop.

LRS0608 LRS0609

1-12 SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

Folding the rear bench seat To fold the rear bench seat up:

1 Lift up on the lever, located on the side of the seat, while lifting the front of the seat cushion up.

2 Fold the bottom of the seat cushion toward the back of the vehicle until it locks in place.

3 Repeat this process to raise and secure the seat cushion on the other side of the vehicle for maximum storage capacity.

To return the rear bench seat to a seating posi- tion, reverse the process. Make sure to prop- erly push the seat cushion down into place.

LRS0398 LRS0566 LRS0567

SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-13

WARNING

When the vehicle is being used to carry cargo, properly secure all cargo to help prevent it from sliding or shifting. Do not place cargo higher than the seat- backs. In a sudden stop or collision, unsecured cargo could cause personal injury.

Do not allow people to ride in any area of your vehicle that is not equipped with seats and seat belts. Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and using a seat belt properly. Never ride in the rear seat unless the seat bottom cushions are in place and latched.

When returning the seatbacks to the upright position, be certain they are completely secured in the latched posi- tion. If they are not completely secured, passengers may be injured in an acci- dent or sudden stop.

Folding the rear bench seat down

The rear bench seatback can be tilted forward to access the child restraint anchor point locations or the jacking equipment.

To tilt the seatback forward, pull the strap up 1 and tilt the seatback. The child restraint anchor points 2 can be accessed behind the rear bench seatback. The jacking equipment can be accessed from behind the passengers side seatback.

WARNING

Never allow anyone to ride in the cargo area or on the rear seat when it is in the fold-down position. Use of these areas by passengers without proper restraints could result in serious injury in an acci- dent or sudden stop.

WRS0840

1-14 SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

PRECAUTIONS ON SEAT BELT USAGE If you are wearing your seat belt properly ad- justed and you are sitting upright and well back in your seat with both feet on the floor, your chances of being injured or killed in an accident and/or the severity of injury may be greatly reduced. NISSAN strongly encourages you and all of your passengers to buckle up every time you drive, even if your seating position includes a supple- mental air bag.

Most U.S. states and Canadian provinces or territories specify that seat belts be worn at all times when a vehicle is being driven.

SSS0136

SEAT BELTS

SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-15

WARNING

Every person who drives or rides in this vehicle should use a seat belt at all times. Children should be properly re- strained in the rear seat and, if appro- priate, in a child restraint.

WARNING

The seat belt should be properly ad- justed to a snug fit. Failure to do so may reduce the effectiveness of the entire restraint system and increase the chance or severity of injury in an acci- dent. Serious injury or death can occur if the seat belt is not worn properly.

SSS0134 SSS0016

1-16 SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

WARNING

Always route the shoulder belt over your shoulder and across your chest. Never put the belt behind your back, under your arm or across your neck. The belt should be away from your face and neck, but not falling off your shoulder.

Position the lap belt as low and snug as possible AROUND THE HIPS, NOT THE WAIST. A lap belt worn too high could increase the risk of internal injuries in an accident.

Be sure the seat belt tongue is securely fastened to the proper buckle.

Do not wear the seat belt inside out or twisted. Doing so may reduce its effectiveness.

Do not allow more than one person to use the same seat belt.

Never carry more people in the vehicle than there are seat belts.

If the seat belt warning light glows con- tinuously while the ignition is turned ON with all doors closed and all seat belts fastened, it may indicate a mal- function in the system. Have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer.

No changes should be made to the seat belt system. For example, do not modify the seat belt, add material, or install devices that may change the seat belt routing or tension. Doing so may affect the operation of the seat belt system. Modifying or tampering with the seat belt system may result in serious per- sonal injury.

Once a seat belt pretensioner has acti- vated, it cannot be reused and must be replaced together with the retractor. See your NISSAN dealer.

Removal and installation of preten- sioner system components should be done by a NISSAN dealer.

All seat belt assemblies, including re- tractors and attaching hardware, should be inspected after any collision by a NISSAN dealer. NISSAN recom- mends that all seat belt assemblies in use during a collision be replaced un- less the collision was minor and the belts show no damage and continue to operate properly. Seat belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and replaced if either damage or improper operation is noted.

All child restraints and attaching hard- ware should be inspected after any col- lision. Always follow the restraint manufacturers inspection instructions and replacement recommendations. The child restraints should be replaced if they are damaged.

SSS0014

SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-17

PREGNANT WOMEN

NISSAN recommends that pregnant women use seat belts. The seat belt should be worn snug and always position the lap belt as low as possible around the hips, not the waist. Place the shoulder belt over your shoulder and across your chest. Never run the lap/shoulder belt over your ab- dominal area. Contact your doctor for specific recommendations.

INJURED PERSONS

NISSAN recommends that injured persons use seat belts. Check with your doctor for specific recommendations.

THREE-POINT TYPE SEAT BELT WITH RETRACTOR

WARNING

Every person who drives or rides in this vehicle should use a seat belt at all times.

Do not ride in a moving vehicle when the seatback is reclined. This can be dangerous. The shoulder belt will not be against your body. In an accident, you could be thrown into it and receive neck or other serious injuries. You could also slide under the lap belt and receive serious internal injuries.

For the most effective protection when the vehicle is in motion, the seat should be upright. Always sit well back in the seat with both feet on the floor and adjust the seat belt properly.

Do not allow children to play with the seat belts. Most seating positions are equipped with Automatic Locking Re- tractor (ALR) mode seat belts. If the seat belt becomes wrapped around a childs neck with the ALR mode acti- vated, the child can be seriously injured or killed if the seat belt retracts and becomes tight. This can occur even if the vehicle is parked. Unbuckle the seat belt to release the child. If the seat belt cannot be unbuckled or is already un- buckled, release the child by cutting the seat belt with a suitable tool (such as a knife or scissors) to release the seat belt.

Fastening the seat belts (Front seats all models and rear seats Crew cab models)

1. Adjust the seat. See Seats earlier in this section.

Manual front seat shown WRS0175

1-18 SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

2 Slowly pull the seat belt out of the retractor and insert the tongue into the buckle until you hear and feel the latch engage.

The retractor is designed to lock dur- ing a sudden stop or on impact. A slow pulling motion permits the seat belt to move, and allows you some freedom of movement in the seat.

If the seat belt cannot be pulled from its fully retracted position, firmly pull the belt and release it. Then smoothly pull the belt out of the re- tractor.

3 Position the lap belt portion low and snug on the hips as shown.

4 Pull the shoulder belt portion toward the retractor to take up extra slack. Be sure the shoulder belt is routed over your shoulder and across your chest.

The front passenger seat and the rear seating positions three-point seat belts have two modes of operation:

Emergency Locking Retractor (ELR)

Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR)

The Emergency Locking Retractor (ELR) mode allows the seat belt to extend and retract to allow the driver and passengers some freedom of movement in the seat. The ELR locks the seat belt when the vehicle slows down rapidly or during certain impacts.

The Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) mode (child restraint mode) locks the seat belt for child restraint installation.

When the ALR mode is activated, the seat belt cannot be extended again until the seat belt tongue is detached from the buckle and fully retracted. The seat belt returns to the ELR mode after the seat belt fully retracts. See Child re- straints later in this section for more information.

The ALR mode should be used only for child restraint installation. During normal seat belt use by an occupant, the ALR mode should not be activated. If it is activated it may cause uncomfortable seat belt ten- sion. It can also change the operation of the front passenger air bag. See Front passenger air bag and status light later in this section.

LRS0594 LRS0595

SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-19

WARNING

When fastening the seat belts, be certain that the seatbacks are completely se- cured in the latched position. If they are not completely secured, passengers may be injured in an accident or sudden stop.

Fastening the seat belts (Jump seats King cab models)

1. Open the jump seat. See Seats earlier in this section.

2 Slowly pull the seat belt out of the retractor and insert the tongue into the buckle until you hear and feel the latch engage.

The retractor is designed to lock during a sudden stop or on impact. A slow pulling motion permits the seat belt to move, and allows you some freedom of movement in the seat.

If the seat belt cannot be pulled from its fully retracted position, firmly pull the belt and release it. Then smoothly pull the belt out of the retractor.

LRS0556 LRS0569

1-20 SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

3 Position the lap belt portion low and snug on the hips as shown.

4 Pull the shoulder belt portion toward the retractor to take up extra slack. Be sure the shoulder belt is routed over your shoulder and across your chest.

The jump seat positions three-point seat belts have two modes of operation:

Emergency Locking Retractor (ELR)

Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR)

The Emergency Locking Retractor (ELR) mode allows the seat belt to extend and retract to allow the driver and passengers some freedom of

movement in the seat. The ELR locks the seat belt when the vehicle slows down rapidly or during certain impacts.

The Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) mode (child restraint mode) locks the seat belt for child restraint installation.

When the ALR mode is activated, the seat belt cannot be extended again until the seat belt tongue is detached from the buckle and fully retracted. The seat belt returns to the ELR mode after the seat belt fully retracts. See Child re- straints later in this section for more information.

The ALR mode should be used only for child restraint installation. During normal seat belt use by an occupant, the ALR mode should not be activated. If it is activated it may cause uncomfortable seat belt ten- sion. It can also change the operation of the front passenger air bag. See Front passenger air bag and status light later in this section.

WARNING

When fastening the seat belts, be certain that the seatbacks are completely se- cured in the latched position. If they are not completely secured, passengers may be injured in an accident or sudden stop.

Unfastening the seat belts

1 To unfasten the seat belt, press the button on the buckle. The seat belt automatically re- tracts.

Checking seat belt operation Seat belt retractors are designed to lock seat belt movement by two separate methods:

When the seat belt is pulled quickly from the retractor.

When the vehicle slows down rapidly.

LRS0570 WRS0139

SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-21

To increase your confidence in the seat belts, check the operation as follows:

Grasp the shoulder belt and pull forward quickly. The retractor should lock and re- strict further belt movement.

If the retractor does not lock during this check or if you have any questions about seat belt opera- tion, see a NISSAN dealer.

Shoulder belt height adjustment (front seats)

The shoulder belt anchor height should be ad- justed to the position best for you. See Precau- tions on seat belt usage earlier in this section. To adjust, pull out the adjustment button 1 and move the shoulder belt anchor to the desired position 2 , so the belt passes over the center of the shoulder. The belt should be away from your face and neck, but not falling off your shoulder. Release the adjustment button to lock the shoul- der belt anchor into position.

WARNING

After adjustment, release the adjust- ment button and try to move the shoul- der belt anchor up and down to make sure it is securely fixed in position.

The shoulder belt anchor height should be adjusted to the position best for you. Failure to do so may reduce the effec- tiveness of the entire restraint system and increase the chance or severity of injury in an accident.

SEAT BELT EXTENDERS

If, because of body size or driving position, it is not possible to properly fit the lap/shoulder belt and fasten it, an extender that is compatible with the installed seat belts is available that can be purchased. The extender adds approximately 8 in (200 mm) of length and may be used for either the driver or front passenger seating position. See a NISSAN dealer for assistance with pur- chasing an extender if an extender is required.

WARNING

Only NISSAN seat belt extenders, made by the same company which made the original equipment seat belts, should be used with NISSAN seat belts.

LRS0242

1-22 SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

Adults and children who can use the standard seat belt should not use an extender. Such unnecessary use could result in serious personal injury in the event of an accident.

Never use seat belt extenders to install child restraints. If the child restraint is not secured properly, the child could be seriously injured in a collision or a sud- den stop.

SEAT BELT MAINTENANCE To clean the seat belt webbing, apply a

mild soap solution or any solution recom- mended for cleaning upholstery or carpet. Then wipe with a cloth and allow the seat belts to dry in the shade. Do not allow the seat belts to retract until they are completely dry.

If dirt builds up in the shoulder belt guide of the seat belt anchors, the seat belts may retract slowly. Wipe the shoulder belt guide with a clean, dry cloth.

Periodically check to see that the seat belt and the metal components, such as buckles, tongues, retractors, flexible wires and anchors, work properly. If loose parts, deterioration, cuts or other damage on the webbing is found, the entire seat belt as- sembly should be replaced.

WARNING

Do not allow children to play with the seat belts. Most seating positions are equipped with Automatic Locking Retrac- tor (ALR) mode seat belts. If the seat belt becomes wrapped around a childs neck with the ALR mode activated, the child can be seriously injured or killed if the seat belt retracts and becomes tight. This can occur even if the vehicle is parked. Un- buckle the seat belt to release the child. If the seat belt cannot be unbuckled or is already unbuckled, release the child by cutting the seat belt with a suitable tool (such as a knife or scissors) to release the seat belt.

Children need adults to help protect them. They need to be properly restrained.

In addition to the general information in this manual, child safety information is available from many other sources, including doctors, teachers, government traffic safety offices, and community organizations. Every child is different, so be sure to learn the best way to transport your child.

There are three basic types of child restraint systems:

Rear-facing child restraint

Forward-facing child restraint

Booster seat

The proper restraint depends on the childs size. Generally, infants up to about 1 year and less than 20 lbs (9 kg) should be placed in rear-facing child restraints. Forward-facing child restraints are available for children who outgrow rear- facing child restraints and are at least 1 year old. Booster seats are used to help position a vehicle lap/shoulder belt on a child who can no longer use a forward-facing child restraint.

WARNING

Infants and children need special protec- tion. The vehicles seat belts may not fit them properly. The shoulder belt may come too close to the face or neck. The lap belt may not fit over their small hip bones. In an accident, an improperly fitting seat belt could cause serious or fatal injury. Always use appropriate child restraints.

All U.S. states and Canadian provinces or terri- tories require the use of approved child restraints for infants and small children. See Child re- straints later in this section.

CHILD SAFETY

SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-23

A child restraint may be secured in the vehicle by using either the LATCH (Lower Anchor and Teth- ers for CHildren) system or with the vehicle seat belt. See Child restraints section for more infor- mation.

NISSAN recommends that all pre-teens and children be restrained in the rear seat if available (Crew Cab models). Studies show that children are safer when properly re- strained in the rear seat than in the front seat.

This is especially important because your vehicle has a supplemental restraint sys- tem (Air bag system) for the front passen- ger. See Supplemental restraint system later in this section.

INFANTS Infants up to at least 1 year old should be placed in a rear-facing child restraint. NISSAN recom- mends that infants be placed in child restraints that comply with Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standards or Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standards. You should choose a child restraint that fits your vehicle and always follow the manu- facturers instructions for installation and use.

SMALL CHILDREN

Children that are over 1 year old and weigh at least 20 lbs (9 kg) should remain in a rear-facing child restraint as long as possible up to the height or weight limit of the child restraint. Children who outgrow the height or weight limit of the rear- facing child restraint and are at least 1 year old should be secured in a forward-facing child re- straint with a harness. Refer to the manufactur- ers instructions for minimum and maximum weight and height recommendations. NISSAN recommends that small children be placed in child restraints that comply with Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standards or Canadian Motor Ve- hicle Safety Standards. You should choose a child restraint that fits your vehicle and always follow the manufacturers instructions for instal- lation and use.

LARGER CHILDREN Children should remain in a forward-facing child restraint with a harness until they reach the maxi- mum height or weight limit allowed by the child restraint manufacturer.

Once a child outgrows the height or weight limit of the harness-equipped forward-facing child re- straint, NISSAN recommends that the child be placed in a commercially available booster seat to obtain proper seat belt fit. For a seat belt to fit

properly, the booster seat should raise the child so that the shoulder belt is properly positioned across the chest and the top, middle portion of the shoulder. The shoulder belt should not cross the neck or face and should not fall off the shoul- der. The lap belt should lie snugly across the lower hips or upper thighs, not the abdomen. A booster seat can only be used in seating posi- tions that have a three-point type seat belt. The booster seat should fit the vehicle seat and have a label certifying that it complies with Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standards or Canadian Mo- tor Vehicle Safety Standards. Once the child has grown so the shoulder belt is no longer on or near the face and neck and the lap belt can be posi- tioned properly across the lower hips or upper thighs use the seat belt without the booster seat.

WARNING

Never let a child stand or kneel on any seat and do not allow a child in the cargo area. The child could be seriously injured or killed in a sudden stop or collision.

1-24 SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

PRECAUTIONS ON CHILD RESTRAINTS

WARNING

Failure to follow the warnings and in- structions for proper use and installa- tion of child restraints could result in serious injury or death of a child or other passengers in a sudden stop or collision:

Do not install rear-facing child re- straints in the drivers side rear seat- ing position.

For forward-facing child seats and boosters, DO NOT install if the child restraint base extends past the for- ward edge of the seat cushion.

The child restraint must be used and installed properly. Always follow all of the child restraint manufacturers instructions for installation and use.

Infants and children should never be held on anyones lap. Even the stron- gest adult cannot resist the forces of a collision.

Do not put a seat belt around both a child and another passenger.

NISSAN recommends that all child restraints be installed in the rear seat. Studies show that children are safer when properly restrained in the rear seat than in the front seat. If you must install a forward-facing child restraint in the front seat, see Forward-facing child restraint in- stallation using the seat belts later in this section.

ARS1098 WRS0256

CHILD RESTRAINTS

SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-25

Even with the NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System, never install a rear- facing child restraint in the front seat. An inflating air bag could seri- ously injure or kill a child. A rear- facing child restraint must only be used in the rear seat.

Be sure to purchase a child restraint that will fit the child and vehicle. Some child restraints may not fit properly in your vehicle.

Child restraint anchor points are de- signed to withstand loads from child restraints that are properly fitted.

Never use the anchor points for adult seat belts or harnesses.

A child restraint with a top tether strap should not be used in the front passenger seat (King cab models only).

Keep seatbacks as upright as pos- sible after fitting the child restraint.

Infants and children should always be placed in an appropriate child re- straint while in the vehicle.

When the child restraint is not in use, keep it secured with the LATCH system or a seat belt. In a sudden stop or colli- sion, loose objects can injure occu- pants or damage the vehicle.

CAUTION

A child restraint in a closed vehicle can become very hot. Check the seating sur- face and buckles before placing a child in the child restraint.

This vehicle is equipped with a universal child restraint anchor system, referred to as the LATCH (Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren) sys- tem. Some child restraints include rigid or webbing-mounted attachments that can be con- nected to these anchors. For details, see LATCH (Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren) sys- tem later in this section.

If you do not have a LATCH compatible child restraint, the vehicle seat belts can be used.

Several manufacturers offer child restraints for infants and children of various sizes. When se- lecting any child restraint, keep the following points in mind:

Choose only a restraint with a label certifying that it complies with Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard 213 or Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standard 213.

Check the child restraint in your vehicle to be sure it is compatible with the vehicles seat and seat belt system.

If the child restraint is compatible with your vehicle, place your child in the child restraint and check the various adjustments to be sure the child restraint is compatible with your child. Choose a child restraint that is designed for your childs height and weight. Always follow all recommended procedures.

All U.S. states and Canadian provinces or territories require that infants and small children be restrained in an approved child restraint at all times while the vehicle is being operated. Canadian law requires the top tether strap on forward-facing child restraints be secured to the designated an- chor point on the vehicle.

1-26 SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

LATCH (Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren) SYSTEM

Your vehicle is equipped with special anchor points that are used with LATCH (Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren) system compatible child restraints. This system may also be referred to as the ISOFIX or ISOFIX compatible system. With this system, you do not have to use a vehicle seat belt to secure the child restraint.

The LATCH lower anchor points are provided to install child restraints in the rear outboard seating positions only. Do not attempt to install a child

restraint in the center position using the LATCH lower anchors.

LATCH lower anchor

WARNING

Failure to follow the warnings and instruc- tions for proper use and installation of child restraints could result in serious in- jury or death of a child or other passen- gers in a sudden stop or collision:

Attach LATCH system compatible child restraints only at the locations shown in the illustration.

Do not secure a child restraint in the center rear seating position using the LATCH lower anchors. The child restraint will not be secured properly.

Inspect the lower anchors by insert- ing your fingers into the lower anchor area. Feel to make sure there are no obstructions over the anchors such as seat belt webbing or seat cushion material. The child restraint will not be secured properly if the lower an- chors are obstructed.

LATCH system lower anchor locations (Crew cab models)

LRS0429

LATCH system lower anchor locations (King cab models)

LRS2016

SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-27

LATCH lower anchor location The LATCH lower anchors are located at the rear of the seat cushion near the seatback. A label is attached to the seatback (Crew cab models only) to help you locate the LATCH lower anchors.

Installing child restraint LATCH lower anchor attachments

LATCH compatible child restraints include two rigid or webbing-mounted attachments that can be connected to two anchors located at certain seating positions in your vehicle. With this sys- tem, you do not have to use a vehicle seat belt to secure the child restraint. Check your child re- straint for a label stating that it is compatible with LATCH. This information may also be in the in- structions provided by the child restraint manu- facturer.

LATCH lower anchor location LRS0748

LATCH label locations (Crew cab models only)

LRS0571

LATCH webbing-mounted attachment LRS0661

1-28 SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

When installing a child restraint, carefully read and follow the instructions in this manual and those supplied with the child restraint.

Top tether anchor

WARNING

Do not allow cargo to contact the top tether strap when it is attached to the top tether anchor. Properly secure the cargo so it does not contact the top tether strap. Cargo that is not properly secured or cargo that contacts the top tether strap may damage it during a collision. A child could be seriously injured or killed in a collision if the top tether strap is damaged.

1. Top tether strap

2. Anchor point

Top tether anchor point locations Anchor points are located in the following loca- tions:

On the back of the front passenger seat (King cab only) as shown.

LATCH rigid-mounted attachment LRS0662

Front passenger seat (King cab models only)

LRS0572

SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-29

Under the rear window behind the rear bench seat (Crew cab only) as shown. On the floor between the jump seat belt

buckles in the center of the vehicle (King cab only) as shown.

The anchor point 3 is located on the floor be- tween the jump seat belt buckles in the center of the vehicle. The routing bracket 2 is located behind the cover plate 1 under the rear window above the jump seat.

REAR-FACING CHILD RESTRAINT INSTALLATION USING LATCH (Crew cab models only) Refer to all Warnings and Cautions in the Child Safety and Child Restraint sections before in- stalling a child restraint.

Follow these steps to install a rear-facing child restraint in the 2nd row seats using the LATCH system:

1. Position the child restraint on the seat. Al- ways follow the child restraint manufactur- ers instructions.

Rear bench seat (Crew cab models only) LRS0393

Jump seats (King cab models - passenger side shown)

LRS2101

1-30 SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

2. Secure the child restraint anchor attach- ments to the LATCH lower anchors. Check to make sure the LATCH attachment is prop- erly attached to the lower anchors.

3. For child restraints that are equipped with webbing-mounted attachments, remove any additional slack from the anchor attach- ments. Press downward and rearward firmly in the center of the child restraint with your hand to compress the vehicle seat cushion and seatback while tightening the webbing of the anchor attachments.

Rear-facing web-mounted step 2 WRS0801

Rear-facing rigid-mounted step 2 WRS0802

Rear-facing step 3 LRS0673

SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-31

4. After attaching the child restraint, test it be- fore you place the child in it. Push it from side to side while holding the child restraint near the LATCH attachment path. The child re- straint should not move more than 1 inch (25 mm), from side to side. Try to tug it forward and check to see if the LATCH at- tachment holds the restraint in place. If the restraint is not secure, tighten the LATCH attachment as necessary, or put the restraint in another seat and test it again. You may need to try a different child restraint or try installing by using the vehicle seat belt (if applicable). Not all child restraints fit in all types of vehicles.

5. Check to make sure the child restraint is properly secured prior to each use. If the child restraint is loose, repeat steps 2 through 4.

REAR-FACING CHILD RESTRAINT INSTALLATION USING LATCH JUMP SEAT (King cab models only)

Rear-facing step 4 LRS0674 LRS0597

1-32 SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

WARNING

The three-point seat belt with Auto- matic Locking Retractor (ALR) must be used when installing a child restraint. Failure to use the ALR mode will result in the child restraint not being properly secured. The restraint could tip over or be loose and cause injury to a child in a sudden stop or collision. Also, it can change the operation of the front pas- senger air bag. See Front passenger air bag and status light later in this section.

A child restraint system will not be in- stalled properly and the child could be seriously injured or killed in a sudden stop or collision.

Never install a child restraint system on the drivers side jump seat.

Do not install a child restraint system on the passengers side jump seat without unfolding the seat extender.

WARNING

To install a rear-facing child restraint on the passengers side jump seat, it will be necessary to move the front passen- gers seat fully forward and place the front seatback upright or tilt it forward. Failure to do so may cause the child restraint to not be installed properly and cause serious injury or death in a sudden stop or collision.

The front seat cannot be used when a rear-facing child restraint is installed on the jump seat. Attempting to do so could cause serious injury in a sud- den stop or collision.

LRS0549

SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-33

Refer to all Warnings and Cautions in the Child Safety and Child Restraint sections before in- stalling a child restraint.

Follow these steps to install a child restraint on the jump seat.

1. To access the jump seat extension (passen- gers side only) 1 on the jump seat, pull up 2 on the extension to unfold it to the open position. Then unfold the two support legs 3 and lower the jump seat to the full open 4 seating position.

2 Move the front passengers seat into the FULL FORWARD position. Then move the front seatback to the upright or tilted forward position. Position the child restraint on the jump seat. The direction of the child restraint depends on the type of the child restraint and the size of the child. Always follow the restraint manufacturers instructions.

3. Position the child restraint on the seat. Al- ways follow the child restraint manufactur- ers instructions.

LRS0559 LRS0537 Rear-facing step 2

LRS0544

1-34 SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

4. Secure the child restraint anchor attach- ments to the LATCH lower anchors. Check to make sure the LATCH attachment is prop- erly attached to the lower anchors.

5. For child restraints that are equipped with webbing-mounted attachments, remove any additional slack from the anchor attach- ments. Press downward and rearward firmly in the center of the child restraint with your hand to compress the vehicle seat cushion and seatback while tightening the webbing of the anchor attachments.

Rear-facing web-mounted step 4 WRS0801

Rear-facing rigid-mounted step 4 WRS0802

Rear-facing step 5 LRS0673

SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-35

6. After attaching the child restraint, test it be- fore you place the child in it. Push it from side to side while holding the child restraint near the LATCH attachment path. The child re- straint should not move more than 1 inch (25 mm), from side to side. Try to tug it forward and check to see if the LATCH at- tachment holds the restraint in place. If the restraint is not secure, tighten the LATCH attachment as necessary, or put the restraint in another seat and test it again. You may need to try a different child restraint or try installing by using the vehicle seat belt (if applicable). Not all child restraints fit in all types of vehicles.

7. Check to make sure the child restraint is properly secured prior to each use. If the child restraint is loose, repeat steps 1 through 6.

REAR-FACING CHILD RESTRAINT INSTALLATION USING THE SEAT BELTS (Crew cab models only)

Rear-facing step 6 LRS0674 WRS0256

1-36 SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

WARNING

The three-point seat belt with Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) must be used when installing a child restraint. Failure to use the ALR mode will result in the child restraint not being properly secured. The restraint could tip over or be loose and cause injury to a child in a sudden stop or collision. Also, it can change the opera- tion of the front passenger air bag. See Front passenger air bag and status light later in this section.

Refer to all Warnings and Cautions in the Child Safety and Child Restraint sections before in- stalling a child restraint.

Follow these steps to install a rear-facing child restraint using the vehicle seat belts in the rear seats:

1. Child restraints for infants must be used in the rear-facing direction and therefore must not be used in the front seat. Position the child restraint on the seat. Always follow the restraint manufacturers instructions.

2. Route the seat belt tongue through the child restraint and insert it into the buckle until you hear and feel the latch engage. Be sure to follow the child restraint manufacturers in- structions for belt routing.

Rear-facing step 1 WRS0256

Rear-facing step 2 WRS0761

SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-37

3. Pull the shoulder belt until the belt is fully extended. At this time, the seat belt retractor is in the Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) mode (child restraint mode). It reverts to the Emergency Locking Retractor (ELR) mode when the seat belt is fully retracted.

4. Allow the seat belt to retract. Pull up on the shoulder belt to remove any slack in the belt.

5. Remove any additional slack from the seat belt; press downward and rearward firmly in the center of the child restraint to compress the vehicle seat cushion and seatback while pulling up on the seat belt.

Rear-facing step 3 LRS0669

Rear-facing step 4 LRS0670

Rear-facing step 5 WRS0762

1-38 SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

6. After attaching the child restraint, test it be- fore you place the child in it. Push it from side to side while holding the child restraint near the seat belt path. The child restraint should not move more than 1 inch (25 mm), from side to side. Try to tug it forward and check to see if the belt holds the restraint in place. If the restraint is not secure, tighten the seat belt as necessary, or put the restraint in another seat and test it again. You may need to try a different child restraint. Not all child restraints fit in all types of vehicles.

7. Check to make sure that the child restraint is properly secured prior to each use. If the seat belt is not locked, repeat steps 3 through 6.

After the child restraint is removed and the seat belt fully retracted, the ALR mode (child restraint mode) is canceled.

REAR-FACING CHILD RESTRAINT INSTALLATION USING THE SEAT BELTS JUMP SEAT (King cab models only)

Rear-facing step 6 WRS0763 LRS0597

SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-39

WARNING

The three-point seat belt with Auto- matic Locking Retractor (ALR) must be used when installing a child restraint. Failure to use the ALR mode will result in the child restraint not being properly secured. The restraint could tip over or be loose and cause injury to a child in a sudden stop or collision. Also, it can change the operation of the front pas- senger air bag. See Front passenger air bag and status light later in this section.

A child restraint system will not be in- stalled properly and the child could be seriously injured or killed in a sudden stop or collision.

Never install a rear-facing child re- straint system on the drivers side jump seat.

Do not install a child restraint system on the passengers side jump seat without unfolding the seat extender.

WARNING

To install a rear-facing child restraint on the passengers side jump seat, it will be necessary to move the front passen- gers seat fully forward and place the front seatback upright or tilt it forward. Failure to do so may cause the child restraint to not be installed properly and cause serious injury or death in a sudden stop or collision.

The front seat cannot be used when a rear-facing child restraint is installed on the jump seat. Attempting to do so could cause serious injury in a sud- den stop or collision.

LRS0549

1-40 SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

Refer to all Warnings and Cautions in the Child Safety and Child Restraint sections before in- stalling a child restraint.

Follow these steps to install a child restraint on the passengers side jump seat.

1. To access the jump seat extension 1 on the passengers side jump seat, pull up 2 on the extension to unfold it to the open posi- tion. Then unfold the two support legs 3 and lower the jump seat to the full open 4 seating position.

2 Move the front passengers seat into the FULL FORWARD position. Then move the front seatback to the upright or tilted forward position. Position the child restraint on the jump seat. The direction of the child restraint depends on the type of the child restraint and the size of the child. Always follow the restraint manufacturers instructions.

LRS0559 LRS0537 Rear-facing step 2

LRS0544

SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-41

3 Route the seat belt tongue through the child restraint and insert it into the buckle until you hear and feel the latch engage.

Be sure to follow the child restraint manu- facturers instructions for belt routing.

4 Pull the shoulder belt until the belt is fully extended. At this time, the seat belt retractor is in the Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) mode (child restraint mode). It reverts to the Emergency Locking Retractor (ELR) mode when the seat belt is fully retracted.

5 Allow the seat belt to retract. Pull up on the shoulder belt to remove any slack in the belt.

Rear-facing step 3 LRS0545

Rear-facing step 4 LRS0546

Rear-facing step 5 LRS0547

1-42 SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

6. Remove any additional slack from the seat belt; press downward and rearward firmly in the center of the child restraint to compress the vehicle seat cushion and seatback while pulling up on the seat belt.

7. After attaching the child restraint, test it be- fore you place the child in it. Push it from side to side while holding the seat near the seat belt path. The child restraint should not move more than 1 inch (25 mm), from side to side. Try to tug it forward and check to see if the seat belt holds the restraint in place. If the restraint is not secure, tighten the seat belt as necessary, or put the restraint in another seat and test it again. You may need to try a different child restraint. Not all child restraints fit in all types of vehicles.

8. Check to make sure that the child restraint is properly secured prior to each use. If the seat belt is not locked, repeat steps 3 through 7.

After the child restraint is removed and the seat belt fully retracted, the ALR mode (child restraint mode) is canceled.

FORWARD-FACING CHILD RESTRAINT INSTALLATION USING LATCH (Crew cab model only) Refer to all Warnings and Cautions in the Child Safety and Child Restraint sections before in- stalling a child restraint.

Follow these steps to install a forward-facing child restraint in the 2nd row seats using the LATCH system:

1. Position the child restraint on the seat. Al- ways follow the child restraint manufactur- ers instructions.

Rear-facing step 6 WRS0762

Rear-facing step 7 WRS0918

SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-43

2. Secure the child restraint anchor attach- ments to the LATCH lower anchors. Check to make sure the LATCH attachment is prop- erly attached to the lower anchors.

If the child restraint is equipped with a top tether strap, route the top tether strap and secure the tether strap to the tether anchor point. See Installing top tether strap in this section. Do not install child restraints that require the use of a top tether strap in seat- ing positions that do not have a top tether anchor.

3. The back of the child restraint should be secured against the vehicle seatback.

If necessary, adjust or remove the head re- straint to obtain the correct child restraint fit. If the head restraint is removed, store it in a secure place. Be sure to reinstall the head restraint when the child restraint is re- moved. See Head restraints in this section for head restraint adjustment information.

If the seating position does not have an adjustable head restraint and it is interfering with the proper child restraint fit, try another seating position or a different child restraint.

4. For child restraints that are equipped with webbing-mounted attachments, remove any additional slack from the anchor attach- ments. Press downward and rearward firmly in the center of the child restraint with your knee to compress the vehicle seat cushion and seatback while tightening the webbing of the anchor attachments.

5. Tighten the tether strap according to the manufacturers instructions to remove any slack.

Forward-facing web-mounted step 2 WRS0799

Forward-facing rigid-mounted step 2 WRS0800

Forward-facing step 4 LRS0671

1-44 SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

6. After attaching the child restraint, test it be- fore you place the child in it. Push it from side to side while holding the child restraint near the LATCH attachment path. The child re- straint should not move more than 1 inch (25 mm), from side to side. Try to tug it forward and check to see if the LATCH at- tachment holds the restraint in place. If the restraint is not secure, tighten the LATCH attachment as necessary, or put the restraint in another seat and test it again. You may need to try a different child restraint. Not all child restraints fit in all types of vehicles.

7. Check to make sure the child restraint is properly secured prior to each use. If the child restraint is loose, repeat steps 3 through 6.

FORWARD-FACING CHILD RESTRAINT INSTALLATION USING LATCH JUMP SEAT (King cab models only)

WARNING

A child restraint system will not be in- stalled properly and the child could be seriously injured or killed in a sudden stop or collision.

Do not install a child restraint system on the passengers side jump seat without unfolding the seat extender.

Forward-facing step 6 WRS0697 LRS0598

SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-45

For forward-facing child seats and boosters, DO NOT install if the child restraint base extends past the for- ward edge of the drivers side seat cushion.

Refer to all Warnings and Cautions in the Child Safety and Child Restraint sections before in- stalling a child restraint.

Follow these steps to install a child restraint on the jump seat.

1. To access the jump seat extension (passen- gers side only) 1 on the jump seat, pull up 2 on the extension to unfold it to the open position. Then unfold the two support legs 3 and lower the jump seat to the full open 4 seating position.

WRS0699 LRS0559

1-46 SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

2. Position the child restraint on the seat. Al- ways follow the child restraint manufactur- ers instructions.

3. Secure the child restraint anchor attach- ments to the LATCH lower anchors. Check to make sure the LATCH attachment is prop- erly attached to the lower anchors.

If the child restraint is equipped with a top tether strap, route the top tether strap and secure the tether strap to the tether anchor point. See Installing top tether strap in this section. Do not install child restraints that require the use of a top tether strap in seat- ing positions that do not have a top tether anchor.

4. The back of the child restraint should be secured against the vehicle seatback.

If necessary, adjust or remove the head re- straint to obtain the correct child restraint fit. If the head restraint is removed, store it in a secure place. Be sure to reinstall the head restraint when the child restraint is re- moved. See Head restraints in this section for head restraint adjustment information.

If the seating position does not have an adjustable head restraint and it is interfering with the proper child restraint fit, try another seating position or a different child restraint.

LRS0537 Forward-facing web-mounted step 3

WRS0799

Forward-facing rigid-mounted step 3 WRS0800

SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-47

5. For child restraints that are equipped with webbing-mounted attachments, remove any additional slack from the anchor attach- ments. Press downward and rearward firmly in the center of the child restraint with your knee to compress the vehicle seat cushion and seatback while tightening the webbing of the anchor attachments.

6. Tighten the tether strap according to the manufacturers instructions to remove any slack.

7. After attaching the child restraint, test it be- fore you place the child in it. Push it from side to side while holding the child restraint near the LATCH attachment path. The child re- straint should not move more than 1 inch (25 mm), from side to side. Try to tug it forward and check to see if the LATCH at- tachment holds the restraint in place. If the restraint is not secure, tighten the LATCH attachment as necessary, or put the restraint in another seat and test it again. You may need to try a different child restraint. Not all child restraints fit in all types of vehicles.

8. Check to make sure the child restraint is properly secured prior to each use. If the child restraint is loose, repeat steps 1 through 7.

FORWARD-FACING CHILD RESTRAINT INSTALLATION USING THE SEAT BELTS FRONT PASSENGER AND REAR BENCH SEAT (Crew cab models only)

WARNING

The three-point seat belt with Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) must be used when installing a child restraint. Failure to use the ALR mode will result in the child restraint not being properly secured. The restraint could tip over or be loose and cause injury to a child in a sudden stop or collision. Also, it can change the opera- tion of the front passenger air bag. See Front passenger air bag and status light later in this section.

Forward-facing step 5 LRS0671

Forward-facing step 7 WRS0697

1-48 SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

Refer to all Warnings and Cautions in the Child Safety and Child Restraint sections before in- stalling a child restraint.

Follow these steps to install a forward-facing child restraint using the vehicle seat belt in the rear seats (Crew cab models only) or in the front passenger seat:

1. If you must install a child restraint in the front seat, it should be placed in a forward-facing direction only. Move the seat to the rearmost position. Child restraints for infants must be used in

the rear-facing direction and therefore must not be used in the front seat.

2. Position the child restraint on the seat. Al- ways follow the child restraint manufactur- ers instructions.

The back of the child restraint should be secured against the vehicle seatback.

If necessary, adjust or remove the head re- straint to obtain the correct child restraint fit. If the head restraint is removed, store it in a secure place. Be sure to reinstall the head restraint when the child restraint is removed. See Head restraints in this section for head restraint adjustment, re- moval and installation information.

If the seating position does not have an adjustable head restraint and it is interfering with the proper child restraint fit, try another seating position or a different child restraint.

3. Route the seat belt tongue through the child restraint and insert it into the buckle until you hear and feel the latch engage. Be sure to follow the child restraint manufacturers in- structions for belt routing.

If the child restraint is equipped with a top tether strap, route the top tether strap and secure the tether strap to the tether anchor point (rear seat installation only). See In- stalling top tether strap in this section. Do not install child restraints that require the use of a top tether strap in seating positions that do not have a top tether anchor.

Forward-facing (front passenger seat) step 1

WRS0699

Forward-facing step 3 WRS0680

SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-49

4. Pull the shoulder belt until the belt is fully extended. At this time, the seat belt retractor is in the Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) mode (child restraint mode). It reverts to Emergency Locking Retractor (ELR) mode when the seat belt is fully retracted.

5. Allow the seat belt to retract. Pull up on the shoulder belt to remove any slack in the belt.

6. Remove any additional slack from the seat belt; press downward and rearward firmly in the center of the child restraint with your knee to compress the vehicle seat cushion and seatback while pulling up on the seat belt.

7. Tighten the tether strap according to the manufacturers instructions to remove any slack.

Forward-facing step 4 LRS0667

Forward-facing step 5 LRS0668

Forward-facing step 6 WRS0681

1-50 SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

8. After attaching the child restraint, test it be- fore you place the child in it. Push it from side to side while holding the child restraint near the seat belt path. The child restraint should not move more than 1 inch (25 mm), from side to side. Try to tug it forward and check to see if the seat belt holds the restraint in place. If the restraint is not secure, tighten the seat belt as necessary, or put the re- straint in another seat and test it again. You may need to try a different child restraint. Not all child restraints fit in all types of vehicles.

9. Check to make sure the child restraint is properly secured prior to each use. If the seat belt is not locked, repeat steps 3 through 8.

10. If the child restraint is installed in the front passenger seat, place the ignition switch in the ON position. The front passenger air bag status light should illuminate. If this light is not illuminated, see Front passenger air bag and status light in this section. Move the child restraint to another seating position. Have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer.

After the child restraint is removed and the seat belt is fully retracted, the ALR mode (child re- straint mode) is canceled.

Forward-facing step 8 WRS0698

Forward-facing step 10 WRS0475

SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-51

FOWARD-FACING CHILD RESTRAINT INSTALLATION USING THE SEAT BELTS FRONT PASSENGER AND JUMP SEATS (King cab models only)

WARNING

The three-point seat belt with Auto- matic Locking Retractor (ALR) must be used when installing a child restraint. Failure to use the ALR mode will result in the child restraint not being properly secured. The restraint could tip over or be loose and cause injury to a child in a sudden stop or collision. Also, it can change the operation of the front pas- senger air bag. See Front passenger air bag and status light later in this section.

A child restraint system will not be in- stalled properly and the child could be seriously injured or killed in a sudden stop or collision.

Do not install a child restraint system on the passengers side jump seat without unfolding the seat extender.

For forward-facing child seats and boosters, DO NOT install if the child restraint system base extends past the forward edge of the drivers side seat cushion.

LRS0598 Foward-facing (front passenger seat)

step 1

WRS0699

1-52 SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

Refer to all Warnings and Cautions in the Child Safety and Child Restraint sections before in- stalling a child restraint.

Follow these steps to install a forward-facing child restraint using the vehicle seat belt in the passengers side jump seat (King cab models only) or in the front passenger seat:

1. If you must install a child restraint in the front seat, it should be placed in a forward-facing direction only. Move the seat to the rearmost position. Child restraints for infants must be used in the rear-facing direction and therefore must not be used in the front seat.

2. To access the jump seat extension (passen- gers side only) 1 on the jump seat, pull up 2 on the extension to unfold it to the open position. Then unfold the two support legs 3 and lower the jump seat to the full open 4 seating position.

3. Position the child restraint on the seat. Al- ways follow the child restraint manufactur- ers instructions.

The back of the child restraint should be secured against the vehicle seat back.

If necessary, adjust or remove the head re- straint to obtain the correct child restraint fit. If the head restraint is removed, store it in a secure place. Be sure to reinstall the head restraint when the child restraint is removed. See Head restraints in this section for head restraint adjustment, re- moval and installation information.

LRS0559 LRS0537

Forward-facing step 3 WRS0919

SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-53

If the seating position does not have an adjustable head restraint and it is interfering with the proper child restraint fit, try another seating position or a different child restraint.

4. Route the seat belt tongue through the child restraint and insert it into the buckle until you hear and feel the latch engage. Be sure to follow the child restraint manufacturers in- structions for belt routing.

If the child restraint is equipped with a top tether strap, route the top tether strap and secure the tether strap to the tether anchor point. See Installing top tether strap in this section. Do not install child restraints that require the use of a top tether strap to seat- ing positions that do not have a top tether anchor.

5. Pull the shoulder belt until the belt is fully extended. At this time, the seat belt retractor is in the Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) mode (child restraint mode). It reverts to the Emergency Locking Retractor (ELR) mode when the seat belt is fully retracted.

Forward-facing step 4 WRS0680

Forward-facing step 5 LRS0667

1-54 SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

6. Allow the seat belt to retract. Pull up on the shoulder belt to remove any slack in the belt.

7. Remove any additional slack from the seat belt; press downward and rearward firmly in the center of the child restraint with your knee to compress the vehicle seat cushion and seatback while pulling up on the seat belt.

8. Tighten the tether strap according to the manufacturers instructions to remove any slack.

9. After attaching the child restraint, test it be- fore you place the child in it. Push it from side to side while holding the seat near the seat belt path. The child restraint should not move more than 1 inch (25 mm) from side to side. Try to tug it forward and check to see if the belt holds the restraint in place. If the restraint is not secure, tighten the belt as necessary, or put the restraint in another seat and test it again. You may need to try a different child restraint. Not all child re- straints fit in all types of vehicles.

Forward-facing step 6 LRS0668

Forward-facing step 7 WRS0681

Forward-facing step 9 WRS0698

SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-55

10. Check to make sure that the child restraint is properly secured prior to each use. If the seat belt is not locked, repeat steps 3 through 9.

After the child restraint is removed and the seat belt is fully retracted, the ALR mode (child re- straint mode) is canceled.

INSTALLING TOP TETHER STRAP (Front passenger seat King cab models only)

Before securing the child restraint with the seat belt,

1. If necessary, raise or remove the head re- straint to position the top tether strap 1 over the top of the seatback. If the head restraint is removed, store it in a secure place. Be sure to reinstall the head restraint when the child restraint is removed. See Head restraints in this section for

head restraint adjustment, removal and installation information.

2. Route the top tether strap 1 between the head restraint and the top of the seatback.

3. Secure the tether strap to the tether anchor point 2 on the seatback.

4. Refer back to child restraint installation steps before tightening the tether strap.

If you have any questions when installing a top tether strap, consult your NISSAN dealer for details.

Front passenger seat (King cab models only)

LRS0572

1-56 SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

INSTALLING TOP TETHER STRAP (Jump seat King cab models only)

WARNING

Do not secure the top tether strap to the routing bracket. If the child restraint is not anchored properly, the risk of a child be- ing injured or killed in a collision or a sudden stop greatly increases.

First, secure the child restraint with the seat belt.

1. Pull the cover plate off to access the top tether strap routing bracket for the jump seat.

2. Route the top tether strap 1 through the routing bracket 2 .

3. Secure the top tether strap to the tether anchor point (3) located between the seat belt buckles in the center of the vehicle.

4. Refer back to child restraint installation steps before tightening the tether strap.

If you have any questions when installing a top tether strap, consult your NISSAN dealer for details.

INSTALLING TOP TETHER STRAP (Rear bench seat Crew cab models only) To access the anchor points 2 behind the rear bench seat, tilt the rear seatback forward by lifting up on the pull strap 1 behind the seat- back.

Jump seat (King cab models only) LRS0561

Anchor point access LRS0392

SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-57

Before securing the child restraint with the LATCH lower anchors (rear outboard seating po- sitions only [crew cab models only] ) or the seat belt, as applicable, follow these steps.

1. If necessary, raise or remove the head re- straint to position the top tether strap 1 over the top of the seatback. If the head restraint is removed, store it in a secure place. Be sure to reinstall the head restraint when the child restraint is removed. See Head restraint in this section for head restraint adjustment, removal and installation information.

2. Position the top tether strap over the top of the seatback and under the head restraint.

3. Secure the tether strap 2 to the tether anchor point 3 on the seat directly behind the child restraint.

4. Return the seatback to the locked position.

5. Refer back to child restraint installation steps before tightening the tether strap.

If you have any questions when installing a top tether strap, consult your NISSAN dealer for details.

BOOSTER SEATS

Precautions on booster seats

WARNING

If a booster seat and seat belt are not used properly, the risk of a child being injured in a sudden stop or collision greatly increases:

Make sure the shoulder portion of the belt is away from the childs face and neck and the lap portion of the belt does not cross the stomach.

Make sure the shoulder belt is not behind the child or under the childs arm.

A booster seat must only be installed in a seating position that has a lap/shoulder belt.

Rear bench seat (Crew cab models only) LRS0576

1-58 SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

Booster seats of various sizes are offered by several manufacturers. When selecting any booster seat, keep the following points in mind:

Choose only a booster seat with a label certifying that it complies with Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard 213 or Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standard 213.

Check the booster seat in your vehicle to be sure it is compatible with the vehicles seat and seat belt system.

LRS0455 LRS0453 LRS0464

SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-59

Make sure the childs head will be properly supported by the booster seat or vehicle seat. The seatback must be at or above the center of the childs ears. For example, if a low back booster seat 1 is chosen, the vehicle seatback must be at or above the center of the childs ears. If the seatback is lower than the center of the childs ears, a high back booster seat 2 should be used.

If the booster seat is compatible with your vehicle, place the child in the booster seat and check the various adjustments to be sure the booster seat is compatible with the child. Always follow all recommended pro- cedures.

All U.S. states and Canadian provinces or territories require that infants and small children be restrained in an approved child restraint at all times while the vehicle is being operated.

The instructions in this section apply to booster seat installation in the rear seats or the front passenger seat.

Booster seat installation on front passenger seat and rear seat (Crew cab models only)

CAUTION

Do not use the lap/shoulder belt in the Automatic Locking Retractor mode when using a booster seat with the seat belts.

Refer to all Warnings and Cautions in the Child Safety, Child Restraint and Booster Seats sections before installing a child restraint.

Follow these steps to install a booster seat in the rear seat or in the front passenger seat:

1. If you must install a booster seat in the front seat, move the seat to the rear- most position.

2. Position the booster seat on the seat. Only place it in a front-facing direction. Always follow the booster seat manufacturers in- structions.

WRS0699

1-60 SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

3. The booster seat should be positioned on the vehicle seat so that it is stable.

If necessary, adjust or remove the head re- straint to obtain the correct booster seat fit. If the head restraint is removed, store it in a secure place. Be sure to reinstall the head restraint when the booster seat is removed. See Head restraints in this sec- tion for head restraint adjustment, removal and installation information.

If the seating position does not have an adjustable head restraint and it is interfering with the proper booster seat fit, try another seating position or a different booster seat.

4. Position the lap portion of the seat belt low and snug on the childs hips. Be sure to follow the booster seat manufacturers in- structions for adjusting the seat belt routing.

5. Pull the shoulder belt portion of the seat belt toward the retractor to take up extra slack. Be sure the shoulder belt is positioned across the top, middle portion of the childs shoulder. Be sure to follow the booster seat manufacturers instructions for adjusting the seat belt routing.

6. Follow the warnings, cautions and instruc- tions for properly fastening a seat belt shown in Three-point type seat belt with retractor earlier in this section. 7. If the booster seat is installed in the front

passenger seat, place the ignition switch in the ON position. The front passenger air bag status light may or may not illuminate, depending on the size of the child and the type of booster seat being used. See Front passenger air bag and status light later in this section.

Front passenger position LRS0454 WRS0475

SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-61

Booster seat installation jump seats (King cab models only)

WARNING

A child restraint system will not be in- stalled properly and the child could be seriously injured or killed in a sudden stop or collision.

For boosters, DO NOT install if the child restraint system base extends past the forward edge of the seat cushion.

Do not install a child restraint system on the passengers side jump seat without unfolding the seat extender.

CAUTION

Do not use the lap/shoulder belt in the Automatic Locking Retractor mode when using a booster seat with the seat belts.

Refer to all Warnings and Cautions in the Child Safety, Child Restraint and Booster Seats sections before installing a child restraint.

Follow these steps to install a booster seat in the jump seats:

1. To access the jump seat extension (passen- gers side only) 1 on the jump seat, pull up 2 on the extension to unfold it to the open position. Then unfold the two support legs 3 and lower the jump seat to the full open 4 seating position.

LRS0559 LRS0537

1-62 SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

2. Position the booster seat on the seat. Only place it in a front-facing direction. Always follow the booster seat manufacturers in- structions.

3. The booster seat should be positioned on the vehicle seat so that it is stable.

If necessary, adjust or remove the head re- straint to obtain the correct booster seat fit. If the head restraint is removed, store it in a secure place. Be sure to reinstall the head restraint when the booster seat is removed. See Head restraint in this sec- tion for head restraint adjustment, removal and installation information.

If the seating position does not have an adjustable head restraint and it is interfering with the proper booster seat fit, try another seating position or a different booster seat.

4. Position the lap portion of the seat belt low and snug on the childs hips. Be sure to follow the booster seat manufacturers in- structions for adjusting the seat belt routing.

5. Pull the shoulder belt portion of the seat belt toward the retractor to take up extra slack. Be sure the shoulder belt is positioned across the top, middle portion of the childs shoulder. Be sure to follow the booster seat manufacturers instructions for adjusting the seat belt routing.

6. Follow the warnings, cautions and instruc- tions for properly fastening a seat belt shown in Three-point type seat belt with retractor earlier in this section.

PRECAUTIONS ON SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM This Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) sec- tion contains important information concerning the following systems:

Driver and passenger supplemental front- impact air bag (NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System)

Front seat-mounted side-impact supple- mental air bag

Roof-mounted curtain side-impact and roll- over supplemental air bag

Seat belt with pretensioner

Supplemental front-impact air bag system- :The NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System can help cushion the impact force to the head and chest of the driver and front passenger in certain frontal collisions.

Front seat-mounted side-impact supple- mental air bag system: This system can help cushion the impact force to the chest area of the driver and front passenger in certain side impact collisions. The side air bags are designed to inflate on the side where the vehicle is impacted.

LRS0539

SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM

SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-63

Roof-mounted curtain side-impact and rollover supplemental air bag system: This system can help cushion the impact force to the head of occupants in front and rear outboard seating positions in certain side impact or rollover collisions. In a side impact, the curtain and roll- over air bags are designed to inflate on the side where the vehicle is impacted. In a rollover, both curtain and rollover air bags are designed to inflate and remain inflated for a short time.

These supplemental restraint systems are de- signed to supplement the crash protection pro- vided by the seat belts and are not a substitute for them. Seat belts should always be correctly worn and the occupant seated a suitable dis- tance away from the steering wheel, instrument panel and door finishers. See Seat belts earlier in this section for instructions and precautions on seat belt usage.

The supplemental air bags operate only when the ignition switch is in the ON or START position.

After placing the ignition switch in the ON position, the supplemental air bag warning light illuminates. The supplemental air bag warning light will turn off after about 7 sec- onds if the system is operational.

WARNING

The front air bags ordinarily will not inflate in the event of a side impact, rear impact, rollover, or lower severity fron- tal collision. Always wear your seat belts to help reduce the risk or severity of injury in various kinds of accidents.

The front passenger air bag will not inflate if the passenger air bag status light is lit or if the front passenger seat is unoccupied. See Front passenger air bag and status light later in this section.

The seat belts and the front air bags are most effective when you are sitting well back and upright in the seat. The front air bags inflate with great force. Even with the NISSAN Advanced Air Bag Sys- tem, if you are unrestrained, leaning forward, sitting sideways or out of posi- tion in any way, you are at greater risk of injury or death in a crash. You may also receive serious or fatal injuries from the front air bag if you are up against it when it inflates. Always sit back against the seatback and as far away as practi- cal from the steering wheel or instru- ment panel. Always use the seat belts.

WRS0031

1-64 SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

The driver and front passenger seat belt buckles are equipped with sensors that detect if the seat belts are fastened. The Advanced Air Bag System monitors the severity of a collision and seat belt us- age then inflates the air bags as needed. Failure to properly wear seat belts can increase the risk or severity of injury in an accident.

The front passenger seat is equipped with an occupant classification sensor (pressure sensor) that turns the front passenger air bag OFF under some conditions. This sensor is only used in this seat. Failure to be properly seated and wearing the seat belt can increase the risk or severity of injury in an acci- dent. See Front passenger air bag and status light later in this section.

Keep hands on the outside of the steer- ing wheel. Placing them inside the steering wheel rim could increase the risk that they are injured when the front air bag inflates.

ARS1133

SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-65

WARNING

Never let children ride unrestrained or extend their hands or face out of the window. Do not attempt to hold them in your lap or arms. Some examples of dangerous riding positions are shown in the illustrations.

WARNING

Children may be severely injured or killed when the front air bags, side air bags or curtain and rollover air bags inflate if they are not properly re- strained. Pre-teens and children should be properly restrained in the rear seat, if possible.

ARS1041 ARS1042 ARS1043

1-66 SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

WARNING

Even with the NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System, never install a rear-facing child restraint in the front seat. An in- flating front air bag could seriously in- jure or kill your child. See Child re- straints earlier in this section for details.

ARS1044 ARS1045 WRS0256

SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-67

WARNING

Front seat-mounted side-impact supple- mental air bags and roof-mounted curtain side-impact and rollover supplemental air bags:

The side air bags and curtain and roll- over air bags ordinarily will not inflate in the event of a frontal impact, rear im- pact, or lower severity side collision. Always wear your seat belts to help reduce the risk or severity of injury in various kinds of accidents.

Do not lean against the door. WRS0431

Do not lean against doors or windows. LRS0396

Do not lean against doors or windows. SSS0162

1-68 SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

WARNING

The seat belts, the side air bags and curtain and rollover air bags are most effective when you are sitting well back and upright in the seat. The side air bag and curtain and rollover air bag inflate with great force. Do not allow anyone to place their hand, leg or face near the side air bag on the side of the seatback of the front seat or near the side roof rails. Do not allow anyone sitting in the front seats or rear outboard seats to extend their hand out of the window or lean against the door. Some examples of dangerous riding positions are shown in the previous illustrations. WARNING

When sitting in the rear seat, do not hold onto the seatback of the front seat. If the side air bag inflates, you may be seriously injured. Be especially careful with children, who should always be properly restrained. Some examples of dangerous riding positions are shown in the illustrations.

Do not use seat covers on the front seatbacks. They may interfere with side air bag inflation.

LRS0421 SSS0159

SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-69

1. Roof-mounted curtain side-impact and rollover supplemental air bags

2. Roof-mounted curtain side-impact and rollover supplemental air bag inflators

3. Air bag Control Unit (ACU) 4. Supplemental front-impact air bag

modules 5. Crash zone sensor 6. Occupant classification system control

unit 7. Occupant classification sensor

(pressure sensor) 8. Satellite sensors 9. Seat belt buckle switches 10. Seat belt with pretensioner 11. Front seat-mounted side-impact

supplemental air bag module

NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System (front seats)

This vehicle is equipped with the NISSAN Ad- vanced Air Bag System for the driver and front passenger seats. This system is designed to meet certification requirements under U.S. regu- lations. It is also permitted in Canada. However, all of the information, cautions and warn- ings in this manual still apply and must be followed.LRS0565

1-70 SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

The driver supplemental front-impact air bag is located in the center of the steering wheel. The passenger supplemental front-impact air bag is mounted in the dashboard above the glove box. The front air bags are designed to inflate in higher severity frontal collisions, although they may in- flate if the forces in another type of collision are similar to those of a higher severity frontal impact. They may not inflate in certain frontal collisions. Vehicle damage (or lack of it) is not always an indication of proper front air bag system opera- tion.

The NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System has dual stage inflators. It also monitors information from the crash zone sensor, the Air bag Control Unit (ACU), seat belt buckle sensors, occupant clas- sification sensor (pressure sensor) and passen- ger seat belt tension sensor. Inflator operation is based on the severity of a collision and seat belt usage for the driver. For the front passenger, it additionally monitors the weight of an occupant or object on the seat and seat belt tension. Based on information from the sensors, only one front air bag may inflate in a crash, depending on the crash severity and whether the front occupants are belted or unbelted. Additionally, the front passenger air bag may be automatically turned OFF under some conditions, depending on the weight detected on the passenger seat and how the seat belt is used. If the front passenger air bag

is OFF, the passenger air bag status light will be illuminated (if the seat is unoccupied, the light will not be illuminated, but the air bag will be off). See Front passenger air bag and status light later in this section for further details. One front air bag inflating does not indicate improper performance of the system.

If you have any questions about your air bag system, please contact NISSAN or your NISSAN dealer. If you are considering modification of your vehicle due to a disability, you may also contact NISSAN. Contact information is contained in the front of this Owners Manual.

When a front air bag inflates, a fairly loud noise may be heard, followed by the release of smoke. This smoke is not harmful and does not indicate a fire. Care should be taken to not inhale it, as it may cause irritation and choking. Those with a history of a breathing condition should get fresh air promptly.

Front air bags, along with the use of seat belts, help to cushion the impact force on the face and chest of the front occupants. They can help save lives and reduce serious injuries. However, an inflating front air bag may cause facial abrasions or other injuries. Front air bags do not provide restraint to the lower body.

Even with NISSAN advanced air bags, seat belts should be correctly worn and the driver and pas- senger seated upright as far as practical away from the steering wheel or instrument panel. The front air bags inflate quickly in order to help protect the front occupants. Because of this, the force of the front air bag inflating can increase the risk of injury if the occupant is too close to, or is against, the front air bag module during inflation.

The front air bags deflate quickly after a collision.

The front air bags operate only when the ignition switch is in the ON or START posi- tion.

After placing the ignition switch in the ON position, the supplemental air bag warning light illuminates. The supplemental air bag warning light will turn off after about 7 sec- onds if the system is operational.

SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-71

Front passenger air bag and status light

WARNING

The front passenger air bag is designed to automatically turn OFF under some con- ditions. Read this section carefully to learn how it operates. Proper use of the seat, seat belt and child restraints is nec- essary for most effective protection. Fail- ure to follow all instructions in this manual concerning the use of seats, seat belts and child restraints can increase the risk or severity of injury in an accident.

Status light

The front passenger air bag status light is located near the climate controls. After the igni- tion switch is placed in the ON position, the front passenger air bag status light on the instru- ment panel illuminates for about 7 seconds and then turns off or remains illuminated depending on the front passenger seat occupied status. The light operates as follows:

Unoccupied passengers seat: The is OFF and the front passenger air bag is OFF and will not inflate in a crash.

Passengers seat occupied by a small adult, child or child restraint as outlined in this section: The illuminates to indicate that the front passenger air bag is OFF and will not inflate in a crash.

Occupied passenger seat and the passen- ger meet the conditions outlined in this sec- tion: The light is OFF to indicate that the front passenger air bag is operational.

Front passenger air bag

The front passenger air bag is designed to auto- matically turn OFF when the vehicle is operated under some conditions as described below in accordance with U.S. regulations. If the front passenger air bag is OFF, it will not inflate in a

crash. The driver air bag and other air bags in your vehicle are not part of this system.

The purpose of the regulation is to help reduce the risk of injury or death from an inflating air bag to certain front passenger seat occupants, such as children, by requiring the air bag to be auto- matically turned OFF. Certain sensors are used to meet the requirements.

One sensor used is the occupant classification sensor (pressure sensor). It is in the bottom of the front passenger seat cushion and is designed to detect an occupant and objects on the seat by weight. It works together with seat belt sensors described later. For example, if a child is in the front passenger seat, the Advanced Air Bag Sys- tem is designed to turn the passenger air bag OFF in accordance with the regulations. Also, if a child restraint of the type specified in the regula- tions is on the seat, its weight and the childs weight can be detected and cause the air bag to turn OFF. Occupant classification sensor opera- tion can vary depending on the front passenger seat belt sensors.

The front passenger seat belt sensors are de- signed to detect if the seat belt is buckled and the amount of tension on the seat belt, such as when it is in the Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) mode (child restraint mode). Based on the weight on the seat detected by the occupant

WRS0475

1-72 SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

classification sensor and the belt tension de- tected on the seat belt, the Advanced Air Bag System determines whether the front passenger air bag should be automatically turned OFF as required by the regulations.

Front passenger seat adult occupants who are properly seated and using the seat belt as out- lined in this manual should not cause the passen- ger air bag to be automatically turned OFF. For small adults it may be turned OFF, however if the occupant takes his/her weight off the seat cush- ion (for example, by not sitting upright, by sitting on an edge of the seat, or by otherwise being out of position), this could cause the sensor to turn the air bag OFF. In addition, if the occupant improperly uses the seat belt in the ALR mode, this could cause the air bag to be turned OFF. Always be sure to be seated and wearing the seat belt properly for the most effective protection by the seat belt and supplemental air bag.

NISSAN recommends that pre-teens and chil- dren be properly restrained in a rear seat. NISSAN also recommends that appropriate child restraints and booster seats be properly installed in a rear seat. If this is not possible, the occupant classification sensor and seat belt sensors are designed to operate as described above to turn the front passenger air bag OFF for specified child restraints as required by the regulations. Failing to properly secure child restraints and to

use the ALR mode may allow the restraint to tip or move in an accident or sudden stop. This can also result in the passenger air bag inflating in a crash instead of being OFF. See Child re- straints earlier in this section for proper use and installation.

If the front passenger seat is not occupied, the passenger air bag is designed not to inflate in a crash. However, heavy objects placed on the seat could result in air bag inflation, because of the objects weight detected by the occupant classification sensor. Other conditions could also result in air bag inflation, such as if a child is standing on the seat, or if two children are on the seat, contrary to the instructions in this manual. Always be sure that you and all vehicle occupants are seated and restrained properly.

Using the passenger air bag status light, you can monitor when the front passenger air bag is au- tomatically turned OFF with the seat occupied. The light will not illuminate when the front pas- senger seat is unoccupied.

If an adult occupant is in the seat but the passen- ger air bag status light is illuminated (indicating that the air bag is OFF), it could be that the person is a small adult, or is not sitting on the seat properly or not using the seat belt properly.

If a child restraint must be used in the front seat, the passenger air bag status light may or may not

be illuminated, depending on the size of the child and the type of child restraint being used. If the air bag status light is not illuminated (indicating that the air bag might inflate in a crash), it could be that the child restraint or seat belt is not being used properly. Make sure that the child restraint is installed properly, the seat belt is used properly and the occupant is positioned properly. If the air bag status light is not illuminated, reposition the occupant or child restraint in a rear seat.

If the passenger air bag status light will not illu- minate even though you believe that the child restraint, the seat belts and the occupant are properly positioned, the system may be sensing an unoccupied seat (in which case the air bag is OFF). Your NISSAN dealer can check that the system is OFF by using a special tool. However, until you have confirmed with your dealer that your air bag is working properly, reposition the occupant or child restraint in a rear seat.

The air bag system and passenger air bag status light will take a few seconds to register a change in the passenger seat status. For example, if a large adult who is sitting in the front passenger seat exits the vehicle, the passenger air bag status light will go from OFF to ON for a few seconds and then to OFF. This is normal system operation and does not indicate a malfunction.

SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-73

If a malfunction occurs in the front passenger air bag system, the supplemental air bag warning light , located in the meter and gauges area of the instrument panel, will blink. Have the sys- tem checked by a NISSAN dealer.

Other supplemental front-impact air bag precautions

WARNING

Do not place any objects on the steer- ing wheel pad or on the instrument panel. Also, do not place any objects between any occupant and the steering wheel or instrument panel. Such ob- jects may become dangerous projec- tiles and cause injury if the front air bags inflate.

Immediately after inflation, several front air bag system components will be hot. Do not touch them; you may se- verely burn yourself.

No unauthorized changes should be made to any components or wiring of the supplemental air bag system. This is to prevent accidental inflation of the supplemental air bag or damage to the supplemental air bag system.

Do not make unauthorized changes to your vehicles electrical system, sus- pension system or front end structure. This could affect proper operation of the front air bag system.

Tampering with the front air bag system may result in serious personal injury. Tampering includes changes to the steering wheel and the instrument panel assembly by placing material over the steering wheel pad and above the instrument panel or by installing additional trim material around the air bag system.

Modifying or tampering with the front passenger seat may result in serious personal injury. For example, do not change the front seats by placing mate- rial on the seat cushion or by installing additional trim material, such as seat covers, on the seat that are not specifi- cally designed to assure proper air bag operation. Additionally, do not stow any objects under the front passenger seat or the seat cushion and seatback. Such objects may interfere with the proper operation of the occupant classifica- tion sensor (pressure sensor).

No unauthorized changes should be made to any components or wiring of the seat belt system. This may affect the front air bag system. Tampering with the seat belt system may result in seri- ous personal injury.

Work on and around the front air bag system should be done by a NISSAN dealer. Installation of electrical equip- ment should also be done by a NISSAN dealer. The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) wiring harnesses* should not be modified or disconnected. Unau- thorized electrical test equipment and probing devices should not be used on the air bag system.

A cracked windshield should be re- placed immediately by a qualified re- pair facility. A cracked windshield could affect the function of the supplemental air bag system.

*The SRS wiring harness connectors are yellow and orange for easy identification.

When selling your vehicle, we request that you inform the buyer about the front air bag system and guide the buyer to the appropriate sections in this Owners Manual.

1-74 SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

Front seat-mounted side-impact supplemental air bag and roof- mounted curtain side-impact and rollover supplemental air bag systems

The side air bags are located in the outside of the seatback of the front seats. The curtain and roll- over air bags are located in the side roof rails. These systems are designed to meet voluntary guidelines to help reduce the risk of injury to out-of-position occupants. However, all of the information, cautions and warnings in this manual still apply and must be followed. The side air bags and curtain and rollover air bags are designed to inflate in higher severity side

collisions, although they may inflate if the forces in another type of collision are similar to those of a higher severity side impact. They are designed to inflate on the side where the vehicle is im- pacted. They may not inflate in certain side colli- sions.

Curtain and rollover air bags are also designed to inflate in certain types of rollover collisions or near rollovers. As a result, certain vehicle movements (for example, during severe off roading) may cause the curtain and rollover air bags to inflate.

Vehicle damage (or lack of it) is not always an indication of proper side air bag and curtain and rollover air bag operation.

When the side air bags and curtain and rollover air bags inflate, a fairly loud noise may be heard, followed by release of smoke. This smoke is not harmful and does not indicate a fire. Care should be taken not to inhale it, as it may cause irritation and choking. Those with a history of a breathing condition should get fresh air promptly.

Side air bags, along with the use of seat belts, help to cushion the impact force on the chest of the front occupants. Curtain and rollover air bags help to cushion the impact force to the head of occupants in the front and rear outboard seating positions. They can help save lives and reduce serious injuries. However, an inflating side air bag or curtain and rollover air bag may cause abra-

sions or other injuries. Side air bags and curtain and rollover air bags do not provide restraint to the lower body.

The seat belts should be correctly worn and the driver and passenger seated upright as far as practical away from the side air bag. Rear seat passengers should be seated as far away as practical from the door finishers and side roof rails. The side air bags and curtain and rollover air bags inflate quickly in order to help protect the occupants. Because of this, the force of the side air bag and curtain and rollover air bag inflating can increase the risk of injury if the occupant is too close to, or is against, these air bag modules during inflation. The side air bag will deflate quickly after the collision is over.

The curtain and rollover air bags will remain in- flated for a short time.

The side air bags and curtain and rollover air bags operate only when the ignition switch is in the ON or START position.

After placing the ignition switch in the ON position, the supplemental air bag warning light illuminates. The supplemental air bag warning light will turn off after about 7 sec- onds if the system is operational.

WRS0422

SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-75

WARNING

Do not place any objects near the seat- back of the front seats. Also, do not place any objects (an umbrella, bag, etc.) between the front door finisher and the front seat. Such objects may become dangerous projectiles and cause injury if a side air bag inflates.

Right after inflation, several side air bag and curtain and rollover air bag system components will be hot. Do not touch them; you may severely burn yourself.

No unauthorized changes should be made to any components or wiring of the side air bag and curtain and rollover air bag systems. This is to prevent dam- age to or accidental inflation of the side air bag and curtain and rollover air bag systems.

Do not make unauthorized changes to your vehicles electrical system, sus- pension system or side panel. This could affect proper operation of the curtain and rollover air bag systems.

Tampering with the side air bag system may result in serious personal injury. For example, do not change the front seats by placing material near the seat- backs or by installing additional trim material, such as seat covers, around the side air bag.

Work around and on the side air bag and curtain and rollover air bag systems should be done by a NISSAN dealer. Installation of electrical equipment should also be done by a NISSAN dealer. The SRS wiring harnesses* should not be modified or discon- nected. Unauthorized electrical test equipment and probing devices should not be used on the side air bag or cur- tain and rollover air bag systems.

* The SRS wiring harness or connectors are yellow or orange for easy identification.

When selling your vehicle, we request that you inform the buyer about the side air bag and curtain and rollover air bag systems and guide the buyer to the appropriate sections in this Owners Manual.

Seat belts with pretensioners (Front seats)

WARNING

The pretensioners cannot be reused af- ter activation. They must be replaced together with the retractor and buckle as a unit.

If the vehicle becomes involved in a collision but a pretensioner is not acti- vated, be sure to have the pretensioner system checked and, if necessary, re- placed by your NISSAN dealer.

No unauthorized changes should be made to any components or wiring of the pretensioner system. This is to pre- vent damage to or accidental activation of the pretensioners. Tampering with the pretensioner system may result in serious personal injury.

Work around and on the pretensioner system should be done by a NISSAN dealer. Installation of electrical equip- ment should also be done by a NISSAN dealer. Unauthorized electrical test equipment and probing devices should not be used on the pretensioner system.

1-76 SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

If you need to dispose of a pretensioner or scrap the vehicle, contact a NISSAN dealer. Incorrect disposal procedures could cause personal injury.

The pretensioner system may activate with the supplemental air bag system in certain types of collisions. Working with the seat belt retractor, the pretensioner helps tighten the seat belt when the vehicle becomes involved in certain types of collisions, helping to restrain front seat occu- pants.

The pretensioner is encased with the seat belt retractor. These seat belts are used the same way as conventional seat belts.

When a pretensioner activates, smoke is re- leased and a loud noise may be heard. This smoke is not harmful and does not indicate a fire. Care should be taken not to inhale it, as it may cause irritation and choking. Those with a history of a breathing condition should get fresh air promptly.

After pretensioner activation, load limiters allow the seat belt to release webbing (if necessary) to reduce forces against the chest.

The supplemental air bag warning light is used to indicate malfunctions in the pretensioner system. (See SUPPLEMENTAL AIR BAG WARNING LIGHT in this section for more de-

tails.) If the operation of the supplemental air bag warning light indicates there is a malfunction, have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer.

When selling your vehicle, we request that you inform the buyer about the pretensioner system and guide the buyer to the appropriate sections in this Owners Manual.

1. SRS Air Bag Warning Labels

The warning labels are located on the sur- face of the sun visor.

SUPPLEMENTAL AIR BAG WARNING LABELS Warning labels about the supplemental front- impact air bag system are placed in the vehicle as shown in the illustration.

WRS0885

SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-77

SUPPLEMENTAL AIR BAG WARNING LIGHT

The supplemental air bag warning light, displaying in the instrument panel, moni- tors the circuits for the air bag systems, preten- sioners and all related wiring.

When the ignition switch is placed in the ON or START position, the supplemental air bag warn- ing light illuminates for about 7 seconds and then turns off. This means the system is operational.

If any of the following conditions occur, the front air bag, side air bag, curtain and rollover air bag and pretensioner systems need servicing:

The supplemental air bag warning light re- mains on after approximately 7 seconds.

The supplemental air bag warning light flashes intermittently.

The supplemental air bag warning light does not come on at all.

Under these conditions, the front air bag, side air bag, curtain and rollover air bag or pretensioner systems may not operate properly. They must be checked and repaired. Take your vehicle to the nearest NISSAN dealer.

WARNING

If the supplemental air bag warning light is on, it could mean that the front air bag, side air bag, curtain and rollover air bag and/or pretensioner systems will not operate in an accident. To help avoid injury to yourself or others, have your vehicle checked by a NISSAN dealer as soon as possible.

Repair and replacement procedure The front air bags, side air bags, curtain and rollover air bags and pretensioners are designed to inflate on a one-time-only basis. As a reminder, unless it is damaged, the supplemental air bag warning light remains illuminated after inflation has occurred. Repair and replacement of these supplemental air bag systems should be done only by a NISSAN dealer.

When maintenance work is required on the ve- hicle, the front air bags, side air bags, curtain and rollover air bags, pretensioners and related parts should be pointed out to the person performing the maintenance. The ignition switch should al- ways be in the LOCK position when working under the hood or inside the vehicle.

WARNING

Once a front air bag, side air bag, or curtain and rollover air bag has inflated, the air bag module will not function again and must be replaced. Addition- ally, the activated pretensioners must also be replaced. The air bag module and pretensioner should be replaced by a NISSAN dealer. The air bag module and pretensioner cannot be repaired.

The front air bag, side air bag, curtain and rollover air bag systems and the pretensioner system should be in- spected by a NISSAN dealer if there is any damage to the front end or side portion of the vehicle.

If you need to dispose of a supplemen- tal air bag or pretensioner or scrap the vehicle, contact a NISSAN dealer. Incor- rect disposal procedures could cause personal injury.

LRS0100

1-78 SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system

MEMO

SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-79

2 Instruments and controls

Instrument panel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2 Meters and gauges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3

Speedometer and odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4 Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6 Engine coolant temperature gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6 Fuel gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7 Engine oil pressure gauge (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . 2-8 Voltmeter (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8 Trip computer (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9

Compass and outside temperature display (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10

Outside temperature display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10 Compass display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-11

Warning/indicator lights and audible reminders . . . . . . 2-14 Checking bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-15 Warning lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-15 Indicator lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-20 Audible reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-24

Security systems (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-24 Vehicle security system (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . 2-24 NISSAN vehicle immobilizer system (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-25

Windshield wiper and washer switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-26

Switch operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-26 Rear window and outside mirror defroster switch (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-27 Headlight and turn signal switch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-28

Headlight control switch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-28 Daytime running light system (Canada only) . . . . . . 2-30 Instrument brightness control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-31 Turn signal switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-31 Fog light switch (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-32

Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-32 Cargo lamp switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-32 Heated seats (if so equipped). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-33 Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) off switch. . . . . . . . . . . 2-34 Hill descent control switch (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . 2-34 Electronic locking rear differential (E-Lock) system switch (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-35 Clutch interlock (clutch start) switch (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-36 Rear sonar system off switch (if so equipped). . . . . . . . 2-37 Power outlet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-37 Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-38

Storage trays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-38 Under-seat storage bins. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-40 Console box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-41

Glove box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-42 Sunglasses holder (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-42 Map pockets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-43 Seat pocket (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-44 Cup holders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-44 Roof rack (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-46

Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-47 Power windows (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-47 Manual windows (if so equipped). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-49 Rear sliding window (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-50

Moonroof (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-50 Interior lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-53

Map lights (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-53 HomeLink universal transceiver (if so equipped) . . . .2-54

Programming HomeLink . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-54 Programming HomeLink for Canadian customers and gate openers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-56 Operating the HomeLink universal transceiver. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-56 Programming trouble-diagnosis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-56 Clearing the programmed information . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-57 Reprogramming a single HomeLink button. . . . . . 2-57 If your vehicle is stolen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-57

1. Vents (P. 4-17) 2. Headlight/fog light (if so equipped)/turn

signal switch (P. 2-28) 3. Steering wheel switch for audio control

(if so equipped)/Bluetooth Hands- Free Phone System (if so equipped) (P. 4-75, P. 4-70, 4-71)

4. Driver supplemental air bag/horn (P. 1-63, P. 2-32)

5. Meters, gauges and warning/indicator lights (P. 2-3, 2-14)

6. Cruise control main/set switches (if so equipped) (P. 5-21)

7. Windshield wiper/washer switch P. 2-26)

8. Storage (P. 2-38) 9. Audio system controls (if so equipped)

(P. 4-35) 10. Front passenger supplemental air bag

(P. 1-63) 11. Upper and lower glove box (P. 2-42) 12. Passenger air bag status light (P. 1-72) 13. Power outlet (P. 2-37) 14. Power outlet (P. 2-37)

LIC2471

INSTRUMENT PANEL

2-2 Instruments and controls

15. Electronic locking rear differential (E-Lock) system switch (if so equipped) (P.2-35) Heated seat switch (if so equipped) (P. 2-33) Rear sonar switch (if so equipped) (P. 2-37) Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) OFF switch (P. 2-34)

16. Shift selector (P. 5-13, 5-18) 17. 4WD shift switch (if so equipped)

(P. 5-26) 18. Climate controls (P. 4-17, P.4-25) 19. Hazard warning flasher switch (P. 6-3) 20. Ignition switch (P. 5-10) 21. Tilt steering wheel control (if so

equipped) (P. 3-13) 22. Cargo lamp switch (P. 2-32) 23. Clutch interlock (clutch start) switch

(if so equipped) (P. 2-36)/Hill descent control switch (if so equipped) (P. 2-34)

24. Outside mirror controls (if so equipped) (P. 3-17)

1. Warning/indicator lights 2. Tachometer 3. Speedometer 4. Fuel gauge 5. Voltmeter (if so equipped)

6. Odometer/Twin trip odometer/Trip computer (if so equipped)

7. Engine oil pressure gauge (if so equipped)

8. Engine coolant temperature gauge

LIC2028

METERS AND GAUGES

Instruments and controls 2-3

1. Speedometer 2. Odometer/Twin trip odometer 3. Change/Loose fuel cap warning mes-

sage reset/Check tire pressure warning message reset button

SPEEDOMETER AND ODOMETER

Speedometer

The speedometer indicates vehicle speed.

Odometer/Twin trip odometer

The odometer/twin trip odometer is displayed when the ignition switch is placed in the ON position.

The odometer records the total distance the ve- hicle has been driven.

The twin trip odometer records the distance of individual trips.

Changing the display:

For vehicles equipped with twin trip odometer, pressing the change button changes the display as follows:

Trip Trip Trip

LIC2029 With twin trip odometer

LIC0780

2-4 Instruments and controls

For vehicles equipped with trip computer, press- ing the change button changes the display as follows:

Trip Trip Distance to Empty Average speed Average fuel consumption Journey time Trip

For additional information, refer to Trip com- puter later in this section.

Resetting the trip odometer:

Pushing the change button for more than 1 sec- ond resets the currently displayed trip odometer to zero.

Loose fuel cap warning message Press the reset button A for more than 1 second to reset the LOOSE FUEL CAP warning mes- sage after the fuel cap has been tightened. For additional information see Fuel-filler cap in the Pre-driving checks and adjustments section.

Check tire pressure warning message

The CHECK TIRE PRES (pressure) warning message is displayed when the low tire pressure warning light is illuminated and low tire pressure is detected. Check and adjust the tire pressure to the recommended COLD tire pressure shown on the Tire and Loading Information label. The CHECK TIRE PRES warning message turns off when the low tire pressure warning light turns off.

The low tire pressure warning light remains illu- minated until the tires are inflated to the recom- mended COLD tire pressure. The CHECK TIRE PRES warning message is displayed each time the ignition switch is placed in the ON position as

With trip computer LIC0781 LRS2004 LIC2017

Instruments and controls 2-5

long as the low tire pressure warning light re- mains illuminated. For more information see Low tire pressure warning light in the Instruments and controls section, Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) in the Starting and driving and Wheels and tires section in the Maintenance and do-it-yourself section of this Owners Manual.

TACHOMETER The tachometer indicates engine speed in revo- lutions per minute (rpm). Do not rev the engine into the red zone 1 .

CAUTION

When engine speed approaches the red zone, shift to a higher gear or reduce en- gine speed. Operating the engine in the red zone may cause serious engine damage.

ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE GAUGE

The gauge indicates the engine coolant tempera- ture. The engine coolant temperature is within the normal range 1 when the gauge needle points within the zone shown in the illustration.

The engine coolant temperature varies with the outside air temperature and driving conditions.

LIC0738 LIC0739

2-6 Instruments and controls

CAUTION

If the gauge indicates coolant tempera- ture near the hot (H) end of the normal range, reduce vehicle speed to decrease temperature. If the gauge is over the nor- mal range, stop the vehicle as soon as safely possible. If the engine is over- heated, continued operation of the ve- hicle may seriously damage the engine. See If your vehicle overheats in the In case of emergencysection for immediate action required.

FUEL GAUGE

The gauge indicates the approximate fuel level in the tank.

The gauge may move slightly during braking, turning, acceleration, or going up or down hills.

The gauge needle returns to E (Empty) after the ignition key is turned to OFF.

The low fuel warning light comes on when the amount of fuel in the tank is getting low.

Refill the fuel tank before the gauge regis- ters E (Empty).

The indicates that the fuel-filler door is located on the drivers side of the vehicle.

CAUTION

If the vehicle runs out of fuel, the Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) may come on. Refuel as soon as possible. After a few driving trips. the light should turn off. If the light remains on after a few driving trips, have the ve- hicle inspected by a NISSAN dealer.

For additional information, see Mal- function Indicator Light (MIL) later in this section.LIC0740

Instruments and controls 2-7

ENGINE OIL PRESSURE GAUGE (if so equipped) The gauge indicates the engine lubrication sys- tem oil pressure while the engine is running. The needle should be in the middle of the gauge when the engine is running.

CAUTION

This gauge is not designed to indicate low engine oil level. Use the dipstick to check the oil level. (See Engine oil in the Maintenance and do-it-yourself section.)

If the gauge needle does not move with the proper amount of engine oil, have the vehicle checked by a NISSAN dealer. Continued vehicle operation in such a condition could cause serious damage to the engine.

VOLTMETER (if so equipped) When the ignition switch is placed in the ON position, the voltmeter indicates the battery volt- age. When the engine is running, it indicates the generator voltage.

While cranking the engine, the volts drop below the normal range. If the needle is not in the normal range (11 - 15 volts) 1 while the engine is running, it may indicate that the charging system is not functioning properly. Have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer.

LIC0741 WIC1299

2-8 Instruments and controls

TRIP COMPUTER (if so equipped)

The display of the trip computer is situated in the speedometer display. When the ignition switch is placed in the ON position, the display scrolls all the modes of the trip computer and then shows the mode chosen before the ignition switch was placed in the OFF position.

When the ignition switch is placed in the ON position, modes of the trip computer can be selected by pushing the trip computer change button. The following modes can be selected:

Distance to empty (dtemile or km)

The distance to empty (dte) mode provides you with an estimation of the distance that can be driven before refueling. The dte is constantly be- ing calculated, based on the amount of fuel in the fuel tank and the actual fuel consumption.

The display is updated every 30 seconds.

The dte mode includes a low range warning feature: when the fuel level is low, the dte mode is automatically selected and the digits blink in or- der to draw the drivers attention. Press the change button if you wish to return to the mode that was selected before the warning occurred. The dte mark (dte) will remain blinking until the vehicle is refueled.

When the fuel level drops even lower, the dte display will change to (----).

NOTE:

If the amount of fuel added while the ignition switch is OFF is small, the dis- play just before the ignition switch is turned OFF may continue to be dis- played.

When driving uphill or rounding curves, the fuel in the tank shifts, which may momentarily change the display.

Average fuel consumption (Mpg or l/100km)

The average fuel consumption mode shows the average fuel consumption since the last reset. Resetting is done by pressing the change button for more than approximately 1 second. The dis- play is updated every 30 seconds. At about the first 1/3 miles (500 m) after a reset, the display shows (----).

Journey time

The journey time mode shows the time since the last reset. The displayed time can be reset by pressing the change button for more than ap- proximately 1 second.

Average speed (MPH or km/h) The average speed mode shows the average vehicle speed since last reset. Resetting is done by pressing the change button for more than approximately 1 second. The display is updated every 30 seconds. The first 30 seconds after a reset, the display shows (----).

Trip computer reset Pushing the change button for more than 3 sec- onds will reset all modes except Trip A and dis- tance to empty (dte).

Instruments and controls 2-9

This unit has the following functions:

Measures terrestrial magnetism and indi- cates heading direction of vehicle

Indicates outside air temperature (if so equipped)

With the ignition switch in the ON position, press

the or button as described in the charts below to activate various features of the automatic anti-glare rearview mirror. Type A

Push and hold

the button for about:

Feature: (Push button again for about 1 sec- ond to change settings)

1 second Compass display toggles on/off

8 seconds Automatic anti-glare/indicator light toggles on/off

11 seconds Compass zone can be changed to correct false compass readings

13 seconds Compass enters calibration mode

Type B

Push and hold

the button for about:

Feature: (Push button again for about 1 sec- ond to change settings)

1 second Compass display toggles on/off

8 seconds Compass zone can be changed to correct false compass readings

10 seconds Compass enters calibration mode

For information about the automatic anti-glare feature, refer to Automatic anti-glare rearview mirror in the Pre-driving checks and adjust- ments section.

OUTSIDE TEMPERATURE DISPLAY

Push the or button for about 1 sec- ond when the ignition key is in the ON position to toggle the outside temperature and compass direction display 1 on or off.

To change from F to C, push and hold the button for about 5 seconds or the button for about 3 seconds until the display begins to flash. Press the button again to toggle between C and F.

Type A WIC0904

COMPASS AND OUTSIDE TEMPERATURE DISPLAY (if so equipped)

2-10 Instruments and controls

When the outside temperature is between 140F (60C) and 194F (90C), the display will read 140F (60C). When the tempera- ture is above 194F (90C), the display will read SC.

When the outside temperature is between than -40F (-40C) and -60F (-51C), the display will read -40F (-40C). When the temperature is below -60F (-51C), the dis- play will read OC.

The outside temperature sensor is located in front of the radiator. The sensor may be affected by road or engine heat, wind direc- tion and other driving conditions. The display may differ from the actual outside tempera- ture or the temperature displayed on various signs or billboards.

COMPASS DISPLAY

Push the or button for about 1 sec- ond when the ignition switch is placed in the ON position to toggle the outside temperature and compass direction display 1 on or off. The dis- play will indicate the direction that the vehicle is heading.

N: North E: East S: South W: West

If the display reads C, calibrate the compass by driving the vehicle in three complete circles at less than 5 MPH (8 km/h).

You can also calibrate the compass by driving your vehicle on your everyday route. The com- pass will be calibrated once it has tracked three complete circles.

Type B LIC0583

Instruments and controls 2-11

Zone variation change procedure

The difference between magnetic north and geo- graphical north is known as variance. In some areas, this difference can sometimes be great enough to cause false compass readings. Follow these instructions to set the variance for your particular location if this happens:

1. Press and hold the button for about 11 seconds or the button for about 8 seconds. The current zone number will appear in the display. Release the button.

2. Find your current location on the zone map. Refer to the illustration.

3. Press the or the button repeat- edly to toggle through the zone numbers until the desired number appears in the dis- play. Once you have selected a zone num- ber, the display will show a compass direc- tion within a few seconds.

NOTE:

Use zone number 5 for Hawaii.

Inaccurate compass direction:

The compass display is equipped with automatic correction function. If the correct direction is not shown, follow this procedure.WIC0355

2-12 Instruments and controls

1. With the display turned on, press and hold the button for about 13 seconds or the for about 10 seconds. The C icon in the compass display will illuminate.

2. Calibrate the compass by driving the vehicle in three complete circles at a maximum speed of 5 MPH (8 km/h).

3. After completing the circles, the display should return to normal.

CAUTION

Do not install a ski rack, antenna, etc., which are attached to the vehicle by means of a magnet. They affect the op- eration of the compass.

When cleaning the mirror, use a paper towel or similar material dampened with glass cleaner. Do not spray glass cleaner directly on the mirror as it may cause the liquid cleaner to enter the mirror housing.

Instruments and controls 2-13

or Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) warning light

Low tire pressure warning light High beam indicator light (blue)

Automatic Transmission check warning light Low windshield-washer fluid warning light (if so equipped)

Hill descent control system on indicator light (if so equipped)

Automatic transmission oil temperature warning light (if so equipped)

Seat belt warning light and chime Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL)

Automatic transmission park warning light ( model)

Supplemental air bag warning light Overdrive off indicator light (A/T models only)

or Brake warning light Automatic transmission position indicator light (if so equipped)

Security indicator light (if so equipped)

Charge warning light Cruise main switch indicator light (if so equipped)

Slip indicator light for models with ABLS

Door open warning light Cruise set switch indicator light (if so equipped) Slip indicator light for models with VDC

Engine oil pressure warning light Electronic locking rear differential (E-Lock) system on indicator light (if so equipped)

Transfer 4LO position indicator light ( model)

4WD warning light ( model) 4WD shift indicator light ( model) Turn signal/hazard indicator lights

Low fuel warning light Front passenger air bag status light Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) OFF indicator light

WARNING/INDICATOR LIGHTS AND AUDIBLE REMINDERS

2-14 Instruments and controls

CHECKING BULBS

With all doors closed, apply the parking brake and turn the ignition key to the ON position without starting the engine. The following lights will come on:

, or , , , ,

The following lights come on briefly and then go off:

or , , , , , ,

, ,

If any light fails to come on, it may indicate an open circuit in the electrical system. Have the system repaired promptly.

WARNING LIGHTS

or Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) warning light

When the ignition switch is placed in the ON position, the Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) warning light illuminates and then turns off. This indicates the ABS is operational.

If the ABS warning light illuminates while the engine is running, or while driving, it may indicate the ABS is not functioning properly. Have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer.

If an ABS malfunction occurs, the anti-lock func- tion is turned off. The brake system then operates normally, but without anti-lock assistance. See Brake system in the Starting and driving sec- tion.

Automatic Transmission check warning light

When the ignition switch is placed in the ON position, the light comes on for about 2 seconds. If the light comes on at any other time, it may indicate the automatic transmission system is not functioning properly. Have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer.

Automatic transmission oil temperature warning light (if so equipped)

This light comes on when the automatic transmis- sion oil temperature is too high. If the light comes on while driving, reduce the vehicle speed as soon as safely possible until the light turns off.

CAUTION

Continued vehicle operation when the A/T oil temperature warning light is on may damage the automatic transmission.

Automatic transmission park warning light ( model)

WARNING

If the ATP light is ON, this indicates that the automatic transmission P (Park) po- sition will not function and the transfer case is in neutral.

When parking, always make sure that the 4WD shift indicator light illuminates and the parking brake is set. Failure to engage the transfer position in 2WD, 4H or 4LO could result in the vehicle mov- ing unexpectedly, resulting in serious personal injury or property damage.

Instruments and controls 2-15

Shift the 4WD switch into the 2WD, 4H or 4LO position again to turn off the ATP warning light when the shift selector is in the P position and the ATP warning light is ON. (Before shifting the 4WD switch into the 4LO position, move the shift selector into the N position once, shift the shift selector into P again and make sure the ATP warning light is OFF.)

This light indicates that the automatic transmis- sion parking function is not engaged. If the trans- fer control is not secured in any drive position while the shift selector is in the P (Park) position, the transmission will disengage and the drive wheels will not lock.

or Brake warning light

This light functions for both the parking brake and the foot brake systems.

Parking brake indicator

When the ignition switch is placed in the ON position, the light comes on when the parking brake is applied.

Low brake fluid warning light

When the ignition switch is placed in the ON position, the light warns of a low brake fluid level. If the light comes on while the engine is running with the parking brake not applied, stop the ve- hicle and perform the following:

1. Check the brake fluid level. Add brake fluid as necessary. See Brake fluid in the Main- tenance and do-it-yourself section of this manual.

2. If the brake fluid level is correct, have the warning system checked by a NISSAN dealer.

WARNING

Your brake system may not be working properly if the warning light is on. Driv- ing could be dangerous. If you judge it to be safe, drive carefully to the nearest service station for repairs. Otherwise, have your vehicle towed because driv- ing it could be dangerous.

Pressing the brake pedal with the en- gine stopped and/or a low brake fluid level may increase your stopping dis- tance and braking will require greater pedal effort as well as pedal travel.

If the brake fluid level is below the MINIMUM or MIN mark on the brake fluid reservoir, do not drive until the brake system has been checked at a NISSAN dealer.

Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) warning indicator

When the parking brake is released and the brake fluid level is sufficient, if both the brake warning light and the Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) warning light illuminate, it may indicate the ABS is not functioning properly. Have the brake system checked, and if necessary, repaired by a NISSAN dealer promptly. Avoid high-speed driv- ing and abrupt braking. (See Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) warning light in this section.)

Charge warning light

If this light comes on while the engine is running, it may indicate the charging system is not func- tioning properly. Turn the engine off and check the generator belt. If the belt is loose, broken, missing, or if the light remains on, see a NISSAN dealer immediately.

2-16 Instruments and controls

CAUTION

Do not ground electrical accessories directly to the battery terminal. Doing so will bypass the variable control sys- tem and the vehicle battery may not charge completely. Refer to Variable voltage control system (if so equipped) in the Maintenance and do-it- yourself section later in this manual.

Do not continue driving if the generator belt is loose, broken or missing.

Door open warning light

This light comes on when any of the doors are not closed securely while the ignition switch is in the ON position.

Engine oil pressure warning light

This light warns of low engine oil pressure. If the light flickers or comes on during normal driving, pull off the road in a safe area, stop the engine immediately and call a NISSAN dealer or other authorized repair shop.

The engine oil pressure warning light is not designed to indicate a low oil level. Use the dipstick to check the oil level. See Engine oil in the Maintenance and do-it-yourself section of this manual.

CAUTION

Running the engine with the engine oil pressure warning light on could cause se- rious damage to the engine almost imme- diately. Such damage is not covered by warranty. Turn off the engine as soon as it is safe to do so.

4WD warning light ( model)

The 4WD warning light comes on when the igni- tion switch is turned to ON. It turns off soon after the engine is started.

If the engine or vehicle is not functioning properly, the warning light will either remain illuminated or blink. See 4WD warning light in the Starting and driving section.

CAUTION

If the warning light comes on or blinks during operation, have your vehicle checked by a NISSAN dealer as soon as possible.

Do not drive on dry hard surface roads in the 4H or 4LO position. If the 4WD warning light turns on when you are driving on dry hard surface roads:

in the 4H position, shift the 4WD shift switch to 2WD.

in the 4LO position for automatic transmission models, stop the ve- hicle and shift the shift selector to the N (Neutral) position with the brake pedal depressed and shift the 4WD shift switch to 2WD.

in the 4LO position for manual trans- mission models, stop the vehicle and shift the shift selector to the N (Neu- tral) position with the clutch pedal depressed and shift the 4WD shift switch to 2WD,

If the warning light is still on after the above operation, have your vehicle checked by a NISSAN dealer as soon as possible.

Instruments and controls 2-17

Low fuel warning light

This light comes on when the fuel level in the fuel tank is getting low. Refuel as soon as it is conve- nient, preferably before the fuel gauge reaches E (Empty). There will be a small reserve of fuel in the tank when the fuel gauge needle reaches E (Empty).

Low tire pressure warning light

Your vehicle is equipped with a Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) that monitors the tire pressure of all tires except the spare.

The low tire pressure warning light warns of low tire pressure or indicates that the TPMS is not functioning properly.

After the ignition switch is placed in the ON position, this light illuminates for about 1 second and turns off.

Low tire pressure warning:

If the vehicle is being driven with low tire pressure, the warning light will illuminate. A CHECK TIRE PRES (pressure) warning message is also displayed in the odometer.

When the low tire pressure warning light illuminates, you should stop and adjust the tire pressure of all 4 tires to the recom- mended COLD tire pressure shown on the Tire and Loading Information label located in the drivers door opening. The low tire pressure warning light does not automati- cally turn off when the tire pressure is ad- justed. After the tire is inflated to the rec- ommended pressure, the vehicle must be driven at speeds above 16 MPH (25 km/h) to activate the TPMS and turn off the low tire pressure warning light. Use a tire pres- sure gauge to check the tire pressure.

The low tire pressure warning light remains illu- minated until the tires are inflated to the recom- mended COLD tire pressure. The CHECK TIRE PRES warning message is displayed each time the ignition switch is placed in the ON position as long as the low tire pressure warning light re- mains illuminated.

For additional information, see Check tire pres- sure warning message in the Instruments and controls section and Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) in the Starting and driving section and in the In case of emergency sec- tion.

TPMS malfunction:

If the TPMS is not functioning properly, the low tire pressure warning light will flash for approxi- mately 1 minute when the ignition switch is placed in the ON position. The light will remain on after the 1 minute. Have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer. The CHECK TIRE PRES warn- ing message is not displayed if the low tire pres- sure warning light illuminates to indicate a TPMS malfunction.

For additional information, see Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) in the Starting and driving section and Tire pressure in the Main- tenance and do-it-yourself section.

2-18 Instruments and controls

WARNING

If the light does not illuminate with the ignition switch placed in the ON posi- tion, have the vehicle checked by a NISSAN dealer as soon as possible.

If the light illuminates while driving, avoid sudden steering maneuvers or abrupt braking, reduce vehicle speed, pull off the road to a safe location and stop the vehicle as soon as possible. Driving with under-inflated tires may permanently damage the tires and in- crease the likelihood of tire failure. Se- rious vehicle damage could occur and may lead to an accident and could re- sult in serious personal injury. Check the tire pressure for all four tires. Adjust the tire pressure to the recommended COLD tire pressure shown on the Tire and Loading Information label located in the drivers door opening to turn the low tire pressure warning light OFF. If the light still comes on while driving after adjusting the tire pressure, a tire may be flat. If you have a flat tire, re- place it with a spare tire as soon as possible.

When a spare tire is mounted or a wheel is replaced the TPMS will not function and the low tire pressure warning light will flash for approximately 1 minute. The light will remain on after 1 minute. The CHECK TIRE PRES warning mes- sage is not displayed if the low tire pressure warning light illuminates to indicate a TPMS malfunction. Contact your NISSAN dealer as soon as pos- sible for tire replacement and/or sys- tem resetting.

Replacing tires with those not originally specified by NISSAN could affect the proper operation of the TPMS.

CAUTION

The TPMS is not a substitute for the regular tire pressure check. Be sure to check the tire pressure regularly.

If the vehicle is being driven at speeds of less than 16 MPH (25 km/h), the TPMS may not operate correctly.

Be sure to install the specified size of tires to the 4 wheels correctly.

Low windshield-washer fluid warning light (if so equipped)

This light comes on when the windshield-washer fluid is at a low level. Add windshield-washer fluid as necessary. See Windshield-washer fluid in the Maintenance and do-it-yourself section of this manual.

Seat belt warning light and chime

The light and chime remind you to fasten your seat belts. The light illuminates whenever the ignition switch is placed in the ON or START position and remains illuminated until the drivers seat belt is fastened. At the same time, the chime sounds for about 6 seconds unless the drivers seat belt is securely fastened.

The seat belt warning light may also illuminate if the front passengers seat belt is not fastened when the front passengers seat is occupied . For 7 seconds after the ignition switch is placed in the ON position, the system does not activate the warning light for the front passenger.

Refer to Seat belts in the SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system section for precautions on seat belt usage.

Instruments and controls 2-19

Supplemental air bag warning light

When the ignition switch is in the ON or START position, the supplemental air bag warning light illuminates for about 7 seconds and then turns off. This means the system is operational.

If any of the following conditions occur, the front air bag, side air bag, curtain and rollover air bag, and pretensioner systems need servicing and your vehicle must be taken to a NISSAN dealer:

The supplemental air bag warning light re- mains on after approximately 7 seconds.

The supplemental air bag warning light flashes intermittently.

The supplemental air bag warning light does not come on at all.

Unless checked and repaired, the supplemental restraint system (air bag system) and/or the pre- tensioners may not function properly. For addi- tional details see Supplemental restraint sys- tem in the SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system section of this manual.

WARNING

If the supplemental air bag warning light is on, it could mean that the front air bag, side air bag, curtain and rollover air bag systems, and/or pretensioner systems will not operate in an accident. To help avoid injury to yourself or others, have your ve- hicle checked by a NISSAN dealer as soon as possible.

INDICATOR LIGHTS

Automatic transmission position indicator light (if so equipped)

See Driving the vehicle in the Starting and driving section of this manual.

Cruise main switch indicator light (if so equipped)

The light comes on when the cruise control main switch is pushed. The light goes out when the main switch is pushed again. When the cruise main switch indicator light comes on, the cruise control system is operational.

Cruise set switch indicator light (if so equipped)

The light comes on while the vehicle speed is controlled by the cruise control system. If the light blinks while the engine is running, it may indicate the cruise control system is not functioning prop- erly. Have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer.

Electronic locking rear differential (E-Lock) system on indicator light (if so equipped)

This light comes on when the electronic locking rear differential (E-Lock) system clutch is fully engaged.

The indicator light flashes when the system is first turned on. When the system fully engages, the light remains on. If the switch is on and the indicator light continues to flash, the system is not engaged.

For additional information, see Electronic lock- ing rear differential (E-Lock) system switch later in this section and Electronic locking rear differ- ential (E-Lock) system in the Starting and driv- ing section of this manual.

2-20 Instruments and controls

4WD shift indicator light ( model)

The light should turn off within 1 second after placing the ignition switch in the ON position.

While the engine is running, the 4WD shift indi- cator light will illuminate the position selected by the 4WD shift switch.

The 4WD shift indicator light may blink while shifting from one drive mode to the other.

Front passenger air bag status light

The front passenger air bag status light ( ) will be lit and the passenger front air bag will be OFF depending on how the front passenger seat is being used.

For front passenger air bag status light operation, see Front passenger air bag and status light in the Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system section of this manual.

High beam indicator light (blue)

This blue light comes on when the headlight high beams are on and goes out when the low beams are selected.

The high beam indicator light also comes on when the passing signal is activated.

Hill descent control system on indicator light (if so equipped)

When the ignition switch is placed in the ON position, this light comes on briefly and then turns off.

The light comes on when the hill descent control system is activated.

If the hill descent control switch is on and the indicator light blinks, the system is not engaged.

If the indicator light does not come on or blink when the hill descent switch is on, the system may not be functioning properly. Have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer.

For additional information, see Hill descent con- trol switch later in this section and Hill descent control system in the Starting and driving sec- tion of this manual.

Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL)

If this indicator light comes on steady or blinks while the engine is running, it may indicate a potential emission control malfunction.

The Malfunction Indicator Light may also come on steady if the fuel-filler cap is loose or missing, or if the vehicle runs out of fuel. Check to make sure the fuel-filler cap is installed and closed tightly, and that the vehicle has at least 3 gallons (11.4 liters) of fuel in the fuel tank.

After a few driving trips, the light should turn off if no other potential emission control system malfunction exists.

If this indicator light comes on steady for 20 sec- onds and then blinks for 10 seconds when the engine is not running, it indicates that the vehicle is not ready for an emission control system inspection/maintenance test. See Readiness for inspection/maintenance (I/M) test in the Tech- nical and consumer information section of this manual.

Instruments and controls 2-21

Operation

The Malfunction Indicator Light will come on in one of two ways:

Malfunction Indicator Light on steady An emission control system malfunction has been detected. Check the fuel-filler cap if the LOOSE FUEL CAP warning message is displayed in the odometer. If the fuel-filler cap is loose or missing, tighten or install the cap and continue to drive the vehicle. The light should turn off after a few driving trips. If the light does not turn off after a few driving trips, have the vehicle inspected by a NISSAN dealer. You do not need to have your vehicle towed to the dealer.

Malfunction Indicator Light blinking An engine misfire has been detected which may damage the emission control system. To re- duce or avoid emission control system dam- age:

do not drive at speeds above 45 MPH (72 km/h).

avoid hard acceleration or deceleration.

avoid steep uphill grades.

if possible, reduce the amount of cargo being hauled or towed.

The Malfunction Indicator Light may stop blinking and come on steady. Have the vehicle inspected by a NISSAN dealer. You do not need to have your vehicle towed to the dealer.

CAUTION

Continued vehicle operation without hav- ing the emission control system checked and repaired as necessary could lead to poor driveability, reduced fuel economy, and possible damage to the emission con- trol system.

Overdrive OFF indicator light (A/T models only)

This light comes on when the overdrive function is OFF.

The automatic transmission overdrive function is controlled by the overdrive switch.

See Driving the vehicle in the Starting and driving section of this manual.

Security indicator light (if so equipped)

This light blinks when the ignition switch is in the OFF, LOCK or ACC position. The blinking secu- rity indicator light indicates that the security sys- tems equipped on the vehicle are operational.

For additional information, see Security sys- tems later in this section.

Slip indicator light for models with ABLS

This indicator light comes on if the active brake limited slip is activated. If activated, the system will apply braking to the slipping drive wheel(s), giving the non-slipping wheel(s) more traction.

Slip indicator light for models with VDC

This indicator will blink when the VDC system or the traction control system is operating, thus alerting that the vehicle is nearing its traction limits. The road surface may be slippery.

Transfer 4LO position indicator light ( model)

The light should turn off within 1 second after turning the ignition switch to ON.

This light comes on when the 4WD shift switch is set in the 4LO position with the ignition switch in the ON position.

The transfer case may be damaged if you shift the switch while driving.

2-22 Instruments and controls

Make sure the transfer 4LO position indicator light turns on when you shift the 4WD shift switch to 4LO.

The indicator light may blink while shifting from one drive mode to the other.

The 4LO indicator light must stop blinking and remain illuminated or turn off before shifting the transmission into gear. If the shift selector is shifted from the N (Neutral) position to any other gear when the 4LO indicator light is blinking, the vehicle may move unexpectedly.

When you shift between 4H and 4LO, follow the instructions below:

For automatic transmission models, stop the vehicle and shift the shift selector to the N (Neutral) position with the brake pedal de- pressed, then depress and turn the 4WD shift switch to 4LO or 4H.

For manual transmission models, stop the vehicle and shift the shift selector to the N (Neutral) position with the clutch pedal de- pressed, then depress and turn the 4WD shift switch to 4LO or 4H.

You cannot move the transfer 4WD shift switch between 4H and 4LO unless you stop the vehicle and shift the shift selector to the N position with the brake pedal (A/T models) or clutch pedal (M/T models) depressed.

Turn signal/hazard indicator lights

The appropriate light flashes when the turn signal switch is activated.

Both lights flash when the hazard switch is turned on.

Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) OFF indicator light

This indicator light comes on when the Vehicle Dynamic Control off switch is pushed to OFF, the transfer case is in the 4LO position ( model), or when the Vehicle Dynamic Control system is not functioning properly. This indicates the Vehicle Dynamic Control system is not oper- ating.

Push the Vehicle Dynamic Control off switch again or restart the engine and the system will operate normally. See Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system in the Starting and driving sec- tion of this manual.

The Vehicle Dynamic Control light also comes on when you turn the ignition key to the ON position. The light will turn off after about 2 seconds if the system is operational. If the light stays on or comes on along with the SLIP indicator light

while you are driving, have the Vehicle Dynamic Control system checked by a NISSAN dealer.

If the battery is removed or discharged, the Ve- hicle Dynamic Control system is disabled and the VDC indicator light will not turn off after 2 sec- onds when the ignition switch is turned to the ON position. To reset the system, you must perform the reset procedure. Refer to Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system in the Starting and driv- ing section of this manual.

If the light does not go off after performing the reset procedure, have the traction control system checked by a NISSAN dealer.

While the Vehicle Dynamic Control system is operating, you might feel slight vibration or hear the system working when starting the vehicle or accelerating, but this is normal.

The VDC system will be disabled and the VDC light will illuminate when the electronic locking rear differential (E-lock) system switch (if so equipped) is turned on and the E-lock system is engaged. If the E-lock system disengages or the switch is turned off, the VDC system will be enabled and the VDC light will turn off.

Instruments and controls 2-23

AUDIBLE REMINDERS Brake pad wear warning The disc brake pads have audible wear warnings. When a disc brake pad requires replacement, it makes a high pitched scraping sound when the vehicle is in motion, whether or not the brake pedal is depressed. Have the brakes checked as soon as possible if the warning sound is heard.

Key reminder chime A chime sounds if the drivers door is opened while the key is left in the ignition switch. Remove the key and take it with you when leaving the vehicle.

Light reminder chime With the ignition switch placed in the OFF posi- tion, a chime sounds when the drivers door is opened if the headlights or parking lights are on.

Turn the headlight control switch off before leav- ing the vehicle.

Your vehicle may have two types of security sys- tems:

Vehicle security system (if so equipped)

NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System (if so equipped)

VEHICLE SECURITY SYSTEM (if so equipped)

The vehicle security system provides visual and audible alarm signals if someone opens the doors when the system is armed. It is not, however, a motion detection-type system that activates when a vehicle is moved or when a vibration occurs.

The system helps deter vehicle theft but cannot prevent it, nor can it prevent the theft of interior or exterior vehicle components in all situations. Al- ways secure your vehicle even if parking for a brief period. Never leave your keys in the ignition, and always lock the vehicle when unattended. Be aware of your surroundings, and park in secure, well-lit areas whenever possible.

Many devices offering additional protection, such as component locks, identification markers, and tracking systems, are available at auto supply stores and specialty shops. Your NISSAN dealer may also offer such equipment. Check with your insurance company to see if you may be eligible for discounts for various theft protection features.

How to arm the vehicle security system

1. Close all windows. (The system can be armed even if the windows are open.)

2. Remove the key from the ignition switch.

3. Close all doors. Lock all doors. The doors can be locked with the key, power door lock switch (if the door is opened, locked and then closed), or with the keyfob.

LIC0359

SECURITY SYSTEMS (if so equipped)

2-24 Instruments and controls

Keyfob operation:

Push the button on the keyfob. All doors lock. The hazard lights flash twice and the horn beeps once to indicate all doors are locked.

When the button is pushed with all doors locked, the hazard lights flash twice and the horn beeps once as a re- minder that the doors are already locked.

The horn may or may not beep. Refer to Silencing the horn beep feature in the Pre-driving checks and adjustments sec- tion later in this manual.

4. Confirm that the indicator light comes on. The light stays on for about 30 seconds. The vehicle security system is now pre-armed. After about 30 seconds the vehicle security system automatically shifts into the armed phase. The light begins to flash once every 3 seconds. If, during the 30-second pre-arm time period, the drivers door is unlocked by the key or the keyfob, or the ignition switch is placed in ACC or ON position, the system will not arm.

If the key is turned slowly when locking the drivers door, the system may not arm. Furthermore, if the key is turned beyond the vertical position toward the unlock position to remove the key, the system may be disarmed when the key is removed. If the indicator light fails to glow for a period of time, unlock the door once and lock it again.

Even when the driver and/or passen- gers are in the vehicle, the system will arm with all doors closed and locked with the ignition switch placed in the OFF position.

Vehicle security system activation The vehicle security system will give the following alarm:

The headlights blink and the horn sounds intermittently.

The alarm automatically turns off after a pe- riod of time. However, the alarm reactivates if the vehicle is tampered with again. The alarm can be shut off by unlocking the drivers door with the key or by pressing the button on the keyfob.

The alarm is activated by:

opening a door without using the key or keyfob (even if the door is unlocked by using the inside lock knob or the power door lock switch).

How to stop an activated alarm

The alarm stops only by unlocking the drivers door with the key or by pressing the button on the keyfob.

NISSAN VEHICLE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM (if so equipped)

The NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System will not allow the engine to start without the use of a registered key.

If the engine fails to start using a registered key (for example, when interference is caused by another registered key, an automated toll road device or automatic payment device on the key ring), restart the engine using the following pro- cedures:

1. Leave the ignition switch in the ON position for approximately 5 seconds.

2. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF or LOCK position, and wait approximately 10 sec- onds.

Instruments and controls 2-25

3. Repeat steps 1 and 2.

4. Restart the engine while holding the device (which may have caused the interference) separate from the registered key.

If the no start condition re-occurs, NISSAN rec- ommends placing the registered key on a sepa- rate key ring to avoid interference from other devices.

Statement related to Section 15 of FCC Rules for NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer Sys- tem (CONT ASSY IMMOBILIZER, ANT ASSY IMMOBILIZER)

This device complies with part 15 of the FCC Rules and RSS-210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the follow- ing two conditions;

(1) This device may not cause harmful in- terference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including inter- ference that may cause undesired opera- tion of the device.

CHANGES OR MODIFICATIONS NOT EX- PRESSLY APPROVED BY THE PARTY RE- SPONSIBLE FOR COMPLIANCE COULD VOID THE USERS AUTHORITY TO OPER- ATE THE EQUIPMENT.

Security indicator light

The security indicator light blinks whenever the ignition switch is placed in the LOCK, OFF or ACC position. This function indicates the NISSAN Ve- hicle Immobilizer System is operational.

If the NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System is mal- functioning, the light will remain on while the ignition switch is placed in the ON position.

If the light still remains on and/or the en- gine will not start, see a NISSAN dealer for NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System ser- vice as soon as possible. Please bring all registered keys that you have when visiting your NISSAN dealer for service.

SWITCH OPERATION

The windshield wiper and washer operates when the ignition switch is placed in the ON position.

Push the lever down to operate the wiper at the following speed:

1 Intermittent (INT) intermittent operation can be adjusted by turning the knob toward A (Slower) or B (Faster).

2 Low (LO) continuous low speed operation

3 High (HI) continuous high speed opera- tion

LIC0474 WIC0854

WINDSHIELD WIPER AND WASHER SWITCH

2-26 Instruments and controls

Push the lever up 4 to have one sweep opera- tion (MIST) of the wiper.

Pull the lever toward you 5 to operate the washer. The wiper will also operate several times.

WARNING

In freezing temperatures the washer solu- tion may freeze on the windshield and obscure your vision which may lead to an accident. Warm the windshield with the defroster before you wash the windshield.

CAUTION

Do not operate the washer continu- ously for more than 30 seconds.

Do not operate the washer if the windshield-washer fluid reservoir is empty.

Do not fill the windshield-washer fluid reservoir with windshield-washer fluid concentrates at full strength. Some methyl alcohol based windshield- washer fluid concentrates may perma- nently stain the grille if spilled while filling the windshield-washer fluid reservoir.

Pre-mix windshield-washer fluid con- centrates with water to the manufactur- ers recommended levels before pour- ing the fluid into the windshield-washer fluid reservoir. Do not use the windshield-washer fluid reservoir to mix the windshield-washer fluid con- centrate and water.

To defrost the rear window glass and outside mirrors (if so equipped), start the engine and push the rear window defroster switch on. The rear window defroster indicator light on the switch comes on. Push the switch again to turn the defroster off.

The rear window defroster automatically turns off after approximately 15 minutes.

CAUTION

When cleaning the inner side of the rear window, be careful not to scratch or dam- age the rear window defroster.

Type A LIC0783

REAR WINDOW AND OUTSIDE MIRROR DEFROSTER SWITCH (if so equipped)

Instruments and controls 2-27

HEADLIGHT CONTROL SWITCH

Lighting

1 When turning the switch to the posi- tion, the front parking, tail, license plate and instrument panel lights come on.

2 When turning the switch to the posi- tion, the headlights come on and all the other lights remain on.

CAUTION

Use the headlights with the engine run- ning to avoid discharging the vehicle battery.

Type B LIC1419

Type A WIC1424

Type B WIC1452

HEADLIGHT AND TURN SIGNAL SWITCH

2-28 Instruments and controls

Autolight system (if so equipped) The autolight system allows the headlights to be set so they turn on and off automatically. The autolight system can:

Turn on the headlights, front parking, tail, license plate and instrument panel lights au- tomatically when it is dark.

Turn off all the lights when it is light.

Keep all the lights on for a period of time after you turn the key to OFF and all doors are closed.

To turn on the autolight system:

1. Turn the headlight switch to the AUTO posi- tion 1 .

2. Turn the ignition switch to ON.

3. The autolight system automatically turns the headlights on and off.

Initially, if the ignition switch is turned OFF and a door is opened and left open, the headlights remain ON for a period of time. If another door is opened while the headlights are on, then the timer is reset.

To turn the autolight system off, turn the switch to

the OFF, , or position.Type C WIC1426 WIC1453

Instruments and controls 2-29

Be sure you do not put anything on top of the autolight sensor 1 located in the top side of the instrument panel. The autolight sensor controls the autolight; if it is cov- ered, the autolight sensor reacts as if it is dark out and the headlights will illuminate. If this occurs while parked with the engine off and the switch in the ON position, your vehicles battery could become discharged.

Headlight beam select

1 To select the high beam function, push the lever forward. The high beam lights come on and the light illuminates.

2 Pull the lever back to select the low beam.

3 Pulling and releasing the lever flashes the headlight high beams on and off.

Battery saver system If the ignition switch is placed in the OFF position while the headlight switch is in the or position, the headlights will turn off after a period of time.

After the headlights automatically turn off with the

headlight switch in the or position, the headlights will illuminate again if the headlight switch is moved to the OFF position and then

turned to the or position.

CAUTION

Even though the battery saver feature au- tomatically turns off the headlights after a period of time, you should turn the head- light switch to the OFF position when the engine is not running to avoid discharging the vehicle battery.

DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT SYSTEM (Canada only) The headlights automatically illuminate at a re- duced intensity when the engine is started with the parking brake released. The daytime running lights operate with the headlight switch in the OFF position or in the position. Turn the headlight switch to the position for full illumination when driving at night.

LIC0835 WIC1427

2-30 Instruments and controls

If the parking brake is applied before the engine is started, the daytime running lights do not illumi- nate. The daytime running lights illuminate when the parking brake is released. The daytime run- ning lights will remain on until the ignition switch is placed in the OFF position.

WARNING

When the daytime running light system is active, tail lights on your vehicle are not on. It is necessary at dusk to turn on your headlights. Failure to do so could cause an accident injuring yourself and others.

INSTRUMENT BRIGHTNESS CONTROL The instrument brightness control operates when the headlight control switch is in the AUTO (if so

equipped), or position.

Turn the control A to adjust the brightness of the instrument panel lights when driving at night.

TURN SIGNAL SWITCH

Turn signal

1 Move the lever up or down to signal the turning direction. When the turn is com- pleted, the turn signals cancel automatically.

Lane change signal

2 To signal a lane change, move the lever up or down to the point where the indicator light begins to flash, but the lever does not latch.

The turn signal will flash three times automati- cally.

WIC0917 WIC1428

Instruments and controls 2-31

FOG LIGHT SWITCH (if so equipped)

To turn the fog lights on, turn the headlight switch to the position, then turn the fog light switch to the position. To turn the fog lights on with the headlight switch in the AUTO position (if so equipped), the head- lights must be on, then turn the fog light switch to the position. To turn the fog lights off, turn the fog light switch to the OFF position. The headlights must be on and the low beams selected for the fog lights to operate. The fog lights automatically turn off when the high beam headlights are selected.

To sound the horn, push the area between the horn icons on the steering wheel.

WARNING

Do not disassemble the horn. Doing so could affect proper operation of the supplemental front air bag system. Tam- pering with the supplemental front air bag system may result in serious personal injury.

To turn on the cargo lamp, push the switch down to the ON position.

CAUTION

Be sure to turn the light switch to the OFF position when you leave the vehicle for extended periods of time, otherwise the battery will go dead.

LIC0393 WIC1449 LIC0616

HORN CARGO LAMP SWITCH

2-32 Instruments and controls

The front seats are warmed by built-in heaters.

1. Start the engine.

2. Push the LO or HI position of the switch, as desired, depending on the temperature. The indicator light in the switch will illuminate.

The heater is controlled by a thermostat, automatically turning the heater on and off. The indicator light will remain on as long as the switch is on.

3. When the seat is warmed or before you leave the vehicle, be sure to turn the switch off.

WARNING

Do not use or allow occupants to use the seat heater if you or the occupants cannot monitor elevated seat temperatures or have an inability to feel pain in body parts that contact the seat. Use of the seat heater by such people could result in se- rious injury.

CAUTION

Do not use the seat heater for extended periods or when no one is using the seat.

Do not put anything on the seat which insulates heat, such as a blanket, cush- ion, seat cover, etc. Otherwise, the seat may become overheated.

Do not place anything hard or heavy on the seat or pierce it with a pin or similar object. This may result in damage to the heater.

Any liquid spilled on the heated seat should be removed immediately with a dry cloth.

When cleaning the seat, never use gasoline, benzine, thinner, or any simi- lar materials.

If any malfunctions are found or the heated seat does not operate, turn the switch off and have the system checked by your NISSAN dealer.

The battery could run down if the seat heater is operated while the engine is not running.

LIC1041

HEATED SEATS (if so equipped)

Instruments and controls 2-33

The vehicle should be driven with the Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system on for most driv- ing conditions.

If the vehicle is stuck in mud or snow, the VDC system reduces the engine output to reduce wheel spin. The engine speed will be reduced even if the accelerator is depressed to the floor. If maximum engine power is needed to free a stuck vehicle, turn the VDC system off.

To turn off the VDC system, push the VDC OFF switch. The indicator will come on. Push the VDC OFF switch again or restart the engine to turn on the system. See Vehicle Dy- namic Control (VDC) system in the Starting and driving section.

WARNING

Never rely solely on the hill descent control system to control vehicle speed when driving on steep downhill grades. Always drive carefully when using the hill descent control system and decel- erate the vehicle speed by depressing the brake pedal if necessary. Be espe- cially careful when driving on frozen, muddy or extremely steep downhill roads. Failure to control vehicle speed may result in a loss of control of the vehicle and possible serious injury or death.

The hill descent control may not control the vehicle speed on a hill under all load or road conditions. Always be prepared to depress the brake pedal to control vehicle speed. Failure to do so may re- sult in a collision or serious personal injury.

CAUTION

When the hill descent control system op- erates continuously for a long time, the temperature of the brake pads may in- crease and the hill descent control system may be temporarily disabled (the indicator light will blink). If the indicator light does not come on continuously after blinking, stop using the system.

The hill descent control system is designed to reduce driver workload when going down steep hills. The hill descent control system helps to control vehicle speed so the driver can concen- trate on steering the vehicle.

To activate the hill descent control system:

the 4WD switch must be in the 4L position and the vehicle speed must be under 15 MPH (25 km/h) or

LIC1548 LIC0743

VEHICLE DYNAMIC CONTROL (VDC) OFF SWITCH

HILL DESCENT CONTROL SWITCH (if so equipped)

2-34 Instruments and controls

the 4WD switch must be in the 4H position and the vehicle speed must be under 21 MPH (35 km/h), and

the hill descent control system switch must be ON.

The hill descent control system on indicator light will come on when the system is activated. Also, the stop/tail lights illuminate while the hill descent control system applies the brakes to control ve- hicle speed.

If the accelerator or brake pedal is depressed while the hill descent control system is on, the system will stop operating temporarily. As soon as the accelerator or brake pedal is released, the hill descent control system begins to function again if the hill descent control operating condi- tions are fulfilled.

The hill descent control system on indicator light blinks if the switch is on and all conditions for system activation are not met or if the system becomes disengaged for any reason.

To turn off the hill descent control system, push the switch to the OFF position.

For additional information, see Hill descent con- trol system on indicator light earlier in this sec- tion and Hill descent control system in the Starting and driving section of this manual.

The Electronic Locking Rear Differential (E-Lock) system can help provide added traction if the vehicle is stuck or becoming stuck.

To activate the E-Lock system:

the 4WD switch must be in the 4LO position (4-wheel drive vehicles),

the vehicle must be stopped or moving at 4 MPH (7 km/h) or less, and

the E-Lock system switch must be turned ON.

When the E-Lock switch is turned ON, the indi- cator light will flash until the system engages. However, if all operation conditions listed above are not met or the system becomes disengaged, the indicator light will continue to flash.

The Anti-Lock Brake (ABS) system is disabled and the ABS light illuminates when the E-Lock system is ON. Also, the Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system is disabled and the VDC light illuminates when the E-Lock system is ON.

See Electronic locking rear differential (E-Lock) system in the Starting and Driving section for further explanation and system limitations.

WARNING

Never leave the E-Lock system ON when driving on paved or hard-surfaced roads. Turning the vehicle may result in the rear wheels slipping and result in an accident and personal injury. After us- ing the E-Lock system to free the ve- hicle, turn the system OFF.

LIC0729

ELECTRONIC LOCKING REAR DIFFERENTIAL (E-Lock) SYSTEM SWITCH (if so equipped)

Instruments and controls 2-35

Use the E-Lock system only when free- ing a stuck vehicle. Try the 4LO position before using the E-Lock system. Never use the E-Lock system on a slippery road surface such as snow or ice sur- face. Using the E-Lock system when driving in these road conditions may cause unexpected movement of the ve- hicle during engine braking, accelerat- ing or turning, which may result in an accident and serious personal injury.

CAUTION

After using the E-Lock system, turn the switch OFF to prevent possible damage to driveline components from extended use.

Do not drive over 12 MPH (20 km/h) when the system is engaged. Doing so could result in possible damage to the driveline.

Do not turn on the E-lock system while the tires are spinning. Doing so could damage drivetrain components.

WARNING

Pay special attention to your surround- ings when using the clutch interlock switch. The vehicle will move forward or backward according to the gear selected.

The clutch interlock (clutch start) switch allows for starting the engine without depressing the clutch pedal. This feature helps you restart the engine if it stops under difficult conditions. (For example, the engine stops on a steep hill and a slight movement forward or backward might be dangerous.)

To use the clutch interlock switch:

1. Set the parking brake.

2. Depress the brake pedal with your right foot.

3. Place your left foot on the brake pedal and release the parking brake.

4. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.

5. Press and release the clutch interlock switch. The CANCEL light on the switch will illuminate.

6. Turn the ignition to the START position to start the engine and, at the same time, de- press the accelerator pedal with your right foot. As the vehicle begins to move, take your left foot off the brake. Once the engine has started, the clutch interlock switch CANCEL light shuts off. Do not use the interlock switch to start the engine under normal driving conditions.

WIC0817

CLUTCH INTERLOCK (clutch start) SWITCH (if so equipped)

2-36 Instruments and controls

WARNING

The rear sonar system is a convenience but it is not a substitute for proper back- ing. Always turn and check that it is safe to do so before backing up. Always back up slowly.

The rear sonar system (if so equipped) is active when the ignition switch is placed in the ON position and the shift selector is in R (Reverse).

When sensors detect obstacles within 6 ft (1.8 m) of the rear bumper, a beeping tone is emitted.

The rear sonar system can be disabled by push- ing the OFF switch. When the system is disabled, the indicator light on the switch will illuminate.

The system will automatically reset the next time the ignition switch is placed in the ON position.

See Rear sonar system (if so equipped) in the Starting and driving section.

The power outlets are for powering electrical accessories such as cellular telephones. They are rated at 12 volt, 120W (10A) maximum.

The power outlets are powered only when the ignition switch is in the ACC or ON position.

Open the cap to use a power outlet.

LIC0471 Front row

LIC1430

REAR SONAR SYSTEM OFF SWITCH (if so equipped)

POWER OUTLET

Instruments and controls 2-37

CAUTION

The outlet and plug may be hot during or immediately after use.

Only certain power outlets are designed for use with a cigarette lighter unit. Do not use any other power outlet for an accessory lighter. See your NISSAN dealer for additional information.

Do not use with accessories that ex- ceed a 12 volt, 120W (10A) power draw.

Do not use double adapters or more than one electrical accessory.

Use power outlets with the engine run- ning to avoid discharging the vehicle battery.

Avoid using power outlets when the air conditioner, headlights or rear window defroster is on.

Before inserting or disconnecting a plug, be sure the electrical accessory being used is turned OFF.

Push the plug in as far as it will go. If good contact is not made, the plug may overheat or the internal temperature fuse may open.

When not in use, be sure to close the cap. Do not allow water or any other liquids to contact the outlet.

STORAGE TRAYS

WARNING

Do not place sharp objects in the trays to help prevent injury in an accident or sud- den stop.

Center console LIC0761

Top center tray LIC1539

STORAGE

2-38 Instruments and controls

A/T model LIC0818

M/T model Type A (if so equipped) WIC1431

M/T model Type B (if so equipped) WIC1432

Instruments and controls 2-39

UNDER-SEAT STORAGE BINS

WARNING

Properly secure all cargo with ropes or straps to help prevent it from sliding or shifting. In a sudden stop or collision, unsecured cargo could cause personal injury.

The cargo restrained in the under-seat storage bins must not exceed the weight limits listed below or the bins may not stay secured. In a sudden stop or collision, the unsecured bins could cause personal inury. King cab model: 16 lb (7.25 kg) Crew cab model

Drivers side: 16 lb (7.25 kg) Passengers side: 25 lb (11.33 kg)

If the under-seat storage bins are re- moved for any reason, they should be securely stored to prevent them from causing injury to passengers or damage to the vehicle in case of sudden braking or an accident.

2nd row under-seat storage bin (King cab model)

LIC0821

2nd row under-seat storage bin (Crew cab model)

LIC0820

2-40 Instruments and controls

Do not place sharp objects in the under- seat storage bins. Such objects may become dangerous projectiles and cause injury when the vehicle is moving or if the vehicle is involved in a collision.

To access the under-seat storage bins:

For King cab model, lift up the jump seat. Refer to Jump seat (King cab) in the SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system section earlier in this manual.

For Crew cab model, lift up the rear bench seat. Refer to Folding the rear bench seat down in the SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system section earlier in this manual. To remove the under-seat storage bins:

1. Remove the storage net.

2. Remove the tray by lifting it out of the stor- age bin (King cab model).

3. Turn the knobs to the UNLOCK position 2 .

To install the under-seat storage bins:

1. Position the under-seat storage bin so the holes line up with the holes in the floorboard.

2. Insert the knobs and turn them to the LOCK position 1 .

CONSOLE BOX Pull up on the lever 1 to open the console box lid 2 .

LIC0822 LIC0766

Instruments and controls 2-41

GLOVE BOX To open the top portion of the glove box, push the latch A up and raise the lid.

To open the lower portion of the glove box, pull the handle B down and lower the lid.

WARNING

Keep glove box lid closed while driving to help prevent injury in an accident or a sudden stop.

SUNGLASSES HOLDER (if so equipped) To open the sunglasses holder, push and release.

WARNING

Keep the sunglasses holder closed while driving to prevent an accident.

CAUTION

Do not leave sunglasses in the sun- glasses holder while parking in direct sunlight. The heat may damage the sunglasses.

Do not use for anything other than sunglasses.

LIC0768 WIC0673

2-42 Instruments and controls

MAP POCKETS WIC0824

King cab model LIC0826

Crew cab model LIC0825

Instruments and controls 2-43

SEAT POCKET (if so equipped) A pocket is located on the back of the drivers seat.

CUP HOLDERS

The front cup holders have adapters that can be removed to accommodate larger cups.

WARNING

The cup holder should not be used while driving so full attention may be given to vehicle operation.

CAUTION

Avoid abrupt starting and braking when the cup holder is being used to prevent spilling the drink. If the liquid is hot, it can scald you or your passenger.

Use only soft cups in the cup holder. Hard objects can injure you in an accident.

LIC0575 Front

WIC0827

2-44 Instruments and controls

To open the 2nd row cup holders (rear of the front console), lower the lid. To close, raise the lid. If stepped on, the cup holder is designed to snap loose from the console. To re-install, close the cup holder assembly and push it back into the console opening.

To fold the 2nd row bench seat back, first close the cup holder.

CAUTION

Do not use bottle holder for any other objects that could be thrown about in the vehicle and possibly injure people during sudden braking or an accident.

Do not use bottle holder for open liquid containers.

2nd row (rear of front console) WIC0771

Bottle holder (front row) LIC0784

Bottle holder (2nd row, Crew cab) WIC0828

Instruments and controls 2-45

ROOF RACK (if so equipped)

WARNING

Drive extra carefully when the vehicle is loaded at or near the cargo carrying capacity, especially if the significant portion of that load is carried on the roof rack.

Heavy loading of the roof rack has the potential to affect the vehicle stability and handling during sudden or abnor- mal handling maneuvers.

Roof rack load should be evenly distributed.

Do not exceed maximum roof rack load weight capacity.

Properly secure all cargo with ropes or straps to help prevent it from sliding or shifting. In a sudden stop or collision, unsecured cargo could cause personal injury.

CAUTION

Use care when placing or removing items from the roof rack. If you cannot comfort- ably lift the items onto the roof rack from the ground, use a ladder or stool.

WIC0857

2-46 Instruments and controls

Always evenly distribute the cargo on the tubular roof rack. The maximum total load is 125 lb (56 kg) evenly distributed. Be careful that your vehicle does not exceed the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) or the Gross Axle Weight Ratings (GAWR front and rear). The GVWR and GAWR are located on the F.M.V.S.S. label (located on the drivers side door jamb pillar). For more information regarding GVWR and GAWR, refer to Vehicle loading information in the Technical and consumer information sec- tion later in this manual.

The front crossbar can be adjusted or removed. Use the Torxdriver provided in the tool kit to loosen both crossbar adjusting screws.

To adjust:

1. Loosen the adjusting screws with the Torx- driver 1 by turning counterclockwise A .

2. When the clamp is loosened, move the crossbar so the cargo can be positioned on the crossbar B .

3. Tighten the crossbar adjusting screws with the Torxdriver by turning clockwise.

4. Secure the cargo with rope.

5. Always check the tightness of the crossbar adjusting screws.

To remove:

1. Loosen the adjusting screws with the Torx- driver 1 by turning counterclockwise A .

2. Rotate the clamps C .

3. Remove the crossbar.

4. Reverse to install.

5. Always check the tightness of the crossbar adjusting screws.

If you hear wind noise coming from the roof rack while driving, adjust the roof rack crossbar to the neutral position, rearward of on the side rails.

POWER WINDOWS (if so equipped)

WARNING

Make sure that all passengers have their hands, etc. inside the vehicle while it is in motion and before closing the windows. Use the window lock switch to prevent unexpected use of the power windows.

Do not leave children unattended inside the vehicle. They could unknowingly ac- tivate switches or controls and become trapped in a window. Unattended chil- dren could become involved in serious accidents.

The power windows operate when the ignition switch is placed in the ON position, or for a period of time after the ignition switch is placed in the OFF position. If the drivers or passengers door is opened during this period of time, the power to the windows is canceled.

WINDOWS

Instruments and controls 2-47

1. Window lock button 2. Power door lock switch 3. Front passenger side window switch 4. Right rear passenger window switch

(Crew Cab models only) 5. Left rear passenger window switch

(Crew Cab models only) 6. Drivers side automatic switch

Drivers side power window switch The drivers side control panel is equipped with switches to open or close the front and rear passenger windows.

To open a window, push the switch and hold it down. To close a window, pull the switch and hold it up. To stop the opening or closing function at any time, simply release the switch.

Front passengers power window switch The passengers window switch operates only the corresponding passengers window. To open the window, push the switch and hold it down 1 . To close the window, pull the switch up 2 .

LIC1329 LIC0786

2-48 Instruments and controls

Rear power window switch (Crew Cab models only) The rear power window switches open or close only the corresponding passenger window. To open the window, push the switch and hold it down 1 . To close the window, push the switch up 2 .

Locking passengers windows When the window lock button is depressed, only the drivers side window can be opened or closed. Push it again to cancel the window lock function.

Automatic operation To fully open a window equipped with automatic operation, press the window switch down to the second detent and release it; it need not be held. The window automatically opens all the way. To stop the window, lift the switch up while the window is opening.

MANUAL WINDOWS (if so equipped) The side windows can be opened or closed by turning the hand crank on each door.

LIC0787 LIC0410 WIC0263

Instruments and controls 2-49

REAR SLIDING WINDOW (if so equipped) Squeeze the handles of the lever 1 , then slide the window open 2 .

Sliding the moonroof

To fully open the moonroof, push the switch to- ward DOWN/OPEN 1 .

To fully close the moonroof, push the switch toward UP/CLOSE 2 .

To open or close the moonroof part way, push the switch in any direction while the moonroof is sliding to stop it in the desired position.

Tilting the moonroof

Close the moonroof by pushing the switch to- ward UP/CLOSE 2 . Release the switch, then push the UP/CLOSE switch again to tilt the moonroof up.

To tilt the moonroof down, push the switch to- ward DOWN/OPEN 1 .

Restarting the moonroof sliding switch

The sliding switch will become inoperable after the battery terminal is disconnected, the electri- cal supply interrupted and/or some abnormality detected. Use the following reset procedure to return moonroof operation to normal.

1. If the moonroof lid is open, push the tilting switch repeatedly toward the DOWN/OPEN 1 position to fully close the lid.

2. Push and hold the tilting switch for more than 2 seconds toward the DOWN/OPEN 1 position to reestablish the lids home position.

The moonroof should now operate normally.

WIC0856 WIC0882

MOONROOF (if so equipped)

2-50 Instruments and controls

Auto-reverse function (when closing or tilting down the moonroof)

The auto-reverse function can be activated when the moonroof is closed or tilted down by auto- matic operation when the ignition switch is placed in the ON position or for a period of time after the ignition switch is placed in the OFF position.

Depending on the environment or driving conditions, the auto-reverse function may be activated if an impact or load similar to something being caught in the moonroof occurs.

WARNING

There are some small distances immedi- ately before the closed position which cannot be detected. Make sure that all passengers have their hands, etc., inside the vehicle before closing the moonroof.

When closing:

If the control unit detects something caught in the moonroof as it moves to the front, the moonroof will immediately open backward.

When tilting down:

If the control unit detects something caught in the moonroof as it tilts down, the moonroof will im- mediately tilt up.

If the auto-reverse function malfunctions and re- peats opening or tilting up the moonroof, keep pushing the tilt down switch within 5 seconds after it happens; the moonroof will fully close gradually. Make sure nothing is caught in the moonroof.

WARNING

In an accident you could be thrown from the vehicle through an open moonroof. Always use seat belts and child restraints.

Do not allow anyone to stand up or extend any portion of their body out of the moonroof opening while the vehicle is in motion or while the moonroof is closing.

CAUTION

Remove water drops, snow, ice or sand from the moonroof before opening.

Do not place heavy objects on the moonroof or surrounding area.

Sunshade Open and close the sunshade by sliding it for- ward or backward.

If the moonroof does not close Have your NISSAN dealer check and repair the moonroof.

Instruments and controls 2-51

Type A LIC0789

Type B LIC0792

Type C LIC0630

2-52 Instruments and controls

The interior lights have a three-position switch and operate regardless of ignition switch posi- tion.

When the switch is in the ON position 1 , the interior lights illuminate, regardless of door posi- tion. The lights will go off after a period of time unless the ignition switch is in the ON position.

When the switch is in the O (DOOR) position 2 , the interior lights will stay on for a period of time when:

The doors are unlocked by the keyfob, a key or the power door lock switch while all doors are closed and the ignition switch is in the OFF position.

The drivers door is opened and then closed while the key is removed from the ignition switch.

The key is removed from the ignition switch while all doors are closed.

The lights will turn off while the timer is activated when:

The drivers door is locked by the keyfob, a key, or the power door lock switch.

The ignition switch is turned ON.

The lights will turn off automatically after a period of time while doors are open to prevent the bat- tery from becoming discharged.

When the switch is in the OFF position 3 , the interior lights do not illuminate, regardless of door position.

CAUTION

Do not use for extended periods of time with the engine stopped. This could result in a discharged battery.

To turn the map lights on, press the lenses. To turn them off, press the lenses of the lights again.

CAUTION

Do not use for extended periods of time with the engine stopped. This could result in a discharged battery.

LIC0791

INTERIOR LIGHTS MAP LIGHTS (if so equipped)

Instruments and controls 2-53

The HomeLink Universal Transceiver provides a convenient way to consolidate the functions of up to three individual hand-held transmitters into one built-in device.

HomeLink Universal Transceiver:

Will operate most Radio Frequency (RF) devices such as garage doors, gates, home and office lighting, entry door locks and se- curity systems.

Is powered by your vehicles battery. No separate batteries are required. If the vehi- cles battery is discharged or is discon- nected, HomeLink will retain all program- ming.

When the HomeLink Universal Trans- ceiver is programmed, retain the original transmitter for future programming proce- dures (Example: new vehicle purchases). Upon sale of the vehicle, the programmed HomeLink Universal Transceiver buttons should be erased for security purposes. For additional information, refer to Program- ming HomeLink later in this section.

WARNING

Do not use the HomeLink Universal Transceiver with any garage door opener that lacks safety stop and re- verse features as required by federal safety standards. (These standards be- came effective for opener models manufactured after April 1, 1982). A ga- rage door opener which cannot detect an object in the path of a closing garage door and then automatically stop and reverse, does not meet current federal safety standards. Using a garage door opener without these features in- creases the risk of serious injury or death.

During the programming procedure your garage door or security gate will open and close (if the transmitter is within range). Make sure that people or objects are clear of the garage door, gate, etc. that you are programming.

Your vehicles engine should be turned off while programming the HomeLink Universal Transceiver.

PROGRAMMING HOMELINK If you have any questions or are having difficulty programming your HomeLink buttons, refer to the HomeLink web site at: www.homelink.com or call 1-800-355-3515.

NOTE:

Place the ignition switch in the ACC posi- tion when programming HomeLink. It is also recommended that a new battery be placed in the hand-held transmitter of the device being programmed to HomeLink for quicker programming and accurate transmission of the radio-frequency.

1. Position the end of your hand-held transmit- ter 13 inches (28 cm) away from the HomeLink surface, keeping the HomeLink indicator light 1 in view.

HOMELINK UNIVERSAL TRANSCEIVER (if so equipped)

2-54 Instruments and controls

2. Using both hands, simultaneously press and hold the desired HomeLink button and handheld transmitter button. DO NOT re- lease until the HomeLink indicator light 1 flashes slowly and then rapidly. When the indicator light flashes rapidly, both buttons may be released. (The rapid flashing indi- cates successful programming.)

NOTE:

Some devices may require you to replace Step 2 with the cycling procedure noted in the Programing HomeLink for Canadian customers and gate openers section.

3. Press and hold the programmed HomeLink button and observe the indica- tor light.

If the indicator light 1 is solid/continuous, programming is complete and your device should acti- vate when the HomeLink button is pressed and released.

If the indicator light 1 blinks rapidly for two seconds and then turns to a solid/continuous light, continue with Steps 4-6 for a rolling code device. A second person may make the following steps easier. Use a ladder or other device.

Do not stand on your vehicle to perform the next steps.

4. At the receiver located on the garage door opener motor in the garage, locate the learnor smartbutton (the name and color of the button may vary by manufacturer but it is usually located near where the hanging antenna wire is attached to the unit). If there is difficulty locating the button, reference the garage door openers manual.

5. Press and release the learn or smart but- ton.

6. Return to the vehicle and firmly press and hold the trained HomeLink button for two seconds and release. Repeat the press/hold/release sequence up to 3 times to complete the training process. HomeLink should now activate your rolling code equipped device.

7. If you have any questions or are having diffi- culty programming your HomeLink but- tons, refer to the HomeLink web site at: www.homelink.com or call 1-800-355- 3515.

LIC2365 LIC2366

Instruments and controls 2-55

PROGRAMMING HOMELINK FOR CANADIAN CUSTOMERS AND GATE OPENERS

Canadian radio-frequency laws require transmit- ter signals to time-out (or quit) after several seconds of transmission which may not be long enough for HomeLink to pick up the signal during training. Similar to this Canadian law, some U.S. gate operators are designed to tim- eout in the same manner.

If you live in Canada or you are having difficulties training a gate operator or garage door opener by using the Training procedures, replace Programming HomeLink Step 2 with the fol- lowing:

NOTE:

When programming a garage door opener, etc., unplug the device during the cycling process to prevent possible damage to the garage door opener components.

1. See Programing HomeLinkstep 1 earlier in this section.

2. Using both hands, simultaneously press and hold the desired HomeLink button and the hand-held transmitter button. During train- ing, your hand-held transmitter may auto- matically stop transmitting. Continue to

press and hold the desired HomeLink but- ton while you press and re-press (cycle) your hand-held transmitter every two sec- onds until the frequency signal has been learned. The HomeLink indicator light will flash slowly and then rapidly after several seconds upon successful training. DO NOT release until the HomeLink indicator light flashes slowly and then rapidly. When the indicator light flashes rapidly, both buttons may be released. The rapid flashing indi- cates successful training. Proceed with Programming HomeLink step 3 to complete. If the device was unplugged during the pro- gramming procedure, remember to plug it back in when programming is completed.

OPERATING THE HOMELINK UNIVERSAL TRANSCEIVER The HomeLink Universal Transceiver, after it is programmed, can be used to activate the pro- grammed device. To operate, simply press and release the appropriate programmed HomeLink Universal Transceiver button. The amber indicator light will illuminate while the sig- nal is being transmitted.

For convenience, the hand-held transmitter of the device may also be used at any time.

PROGRAMMING TROUBLE- DIAGNOSIS If the HomeLink does not quickly learn the hand-held transmitter information:

replace the hand-held transmitter batteries with new batteries.

position the hand-held transmitter with its battery area facing away from the HomeLink surface.

press and hold both the HomeLink and hand-held transmitter buttons without inter- ruption.

position the hand-held transmitter 1 - 3 inches (26 - 76 mm) away from the HomeLink surface. Hold the transmitter in that position for up to 15 seconds. If HomeLink is not programmed within that time, try holding the transmitter in another position keeping the indicator light in view at all times.

If you have any questions or are having difficulty programming your HomeLink buttons, refer to the HomeLink web site at: www.homelink.com or call 1-800-355-3515.

2-56 Instruments and controls

CLEARING THE PROGRAMMED INFORMATION The following procedure clears the programmed information from both buttons. Individual buttons cannot be cleared. However, individual buttons can be reprogrammed, see Reprogramming a single HomeLink button in this section.

To clear all programming:

1. Press and hold the two outer HomeLink buttons until the indicator light begins to flash in approximately 10 seconds. Do not hold for longer than 20 seconds.

2. Release both buttons.

HomeLink is now in the programming mode and can be programmed at any time beginning with Programming HomeLink - Step 1.

REPROGRAMMING A SINGLE HOMELINK BUTTON To reprogram a HomeLink Universal Trans- ceiver button, complete the following:

1. Press and hold the desired HomeLink but- ton. DO NOT release the button.

2. The indicator light will begin to flash after 20 seconds. Without releasing the HomeLink button, proceed with Pro- gramming HomeLink - Step 1.

For questions or comments, contact HomeLink at: www.homelink.com or 18003553515.

The HomeLink Universal Transceiver button has now been reprogrammed. The new device can be activated by pushing the HomeLink button that was just programmed. This procedure will not affect any other programmed HomeLink buttons.

IF YOUR VEHICLE IS STOLEN If your vehicle is stolen, you should change the codes of any non-rolling code device that has been programmed into HomeLink. Consult the Owners Manual of each device or call the manu- facturer or dealer of those devices for additional information.

When your vehicle is recovered, you will need to reprogram the HomeLink Univer- sal Transceiver with your new transmitter information.

FCC Notice:

For USA:

This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the fol- lowing two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference re- ceived, including interference that may cause undesired operation. Note: Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the users authority to operate the equipment.

For Canada:

This device complies with RSS-210 of In- dustry Canada. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference, in- cluding interference that may cause unde- sired operation of the device.

Instruments and controls 2-57

MEMO

2-58 Instruments and controls

3 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2 NISSAN vehicle immobilizer system keys (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2

Doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3 Locking with key. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3 Locking with inside lock knob . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4 Locking with power door lock switch (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4 Rear doors (King Cab models) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-5 Automatic door locks (if so equipped). . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-5 Child safety rear door lock (Crew Cab models only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6

Remote keyless entry system (if so equipped). . . . . . . . . 3-6 How to use remote keyless entry system . . . . . . . . . . 3-7

Hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10

Fuel-filler door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11 Fuel-filler cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11

Steering wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-13 Tilt operation (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-13

Sun visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-14 Vanity mirrors (if so equipped). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-14

Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-15 Rearview mirror (if so equipped). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-15 Automatic anti-glare rearview mirror (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-15 Outside mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16

Truck box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-17 Tailgate. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-17 Bed Extender (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-21 Tie down hooks (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-22

1. Two master keys (black) with transponder chip and chrome NISSAN brand symbol on one side.

2. Transponder chip

3. Key number plate

A key number plate is supplied with your keys. Record the key number and keep the plate in a safe place (such as your wallet), not in the ve- hicle. If you lose your keys, see a NISSAN dealer for duplicates by using the key number. NISSAN does not record key numbers so it is very impor- tant to keep track of your key number plate.

A key number is only necessary when you have lost all keys and do not have one to duplicate from. If you still have a key, your NISSAN dealer can duplicate it.

NISSAN VEHICLE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM KEYS (if so equipped)

You can only drive your vehicle using the master key which is registered to the NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System components in your vehicle. This key has a transponder chip in the key head.

The master key can be used for all the locks.

Never leave these keys in the vehicle.

Additional or replacement keys:

If you still have a key, the key number is not necessary when you need extra NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System keys. Your dealer can dupli- cate your existing key. As many as five NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System keys can be used with one vehicle. You should bring all NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System keys that you have to your NISSAN dealer for registration. This is be- cause the registration process will erase the memory of all key codes previously registered into the NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System. After the registration process, these components will only recognize keys coded into the NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System during registration.

Any key that is not given to your dealer at the time of registration will no longer be able to start your vehicle.

CAUTION

Do not allow the immobilizer system key, which contains an electrical transponder, to come into contact with water or salt water. This could affect system function.

LPD0348

KEYS

3-2 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

When the doors are locked using one of the following methods, the doors can not be opened using the inside or outside door handles. The doors must be unlocked to open the doors.

WARNING

Always have the doors locked while driving. Along with the use of seat belts, this provides greater safety in the event of an accident by helping to prevent persons from being thrown from the vehicle. This also helps keep children and others from unintentionally open- ing the doors, and will help keep out intruders.

Before opening any door, always look for and avoid oncoming traffic.

Do not leave children unattended inside the vehicle. They could unknowingly ac- tivate switches or controls. Unattended children could become involved in seri- ous accidents.

LOCKING WITH KEY

Manual (if so equipped) To lock a door, turn the key toward the front of the vehicle 1 . To unlock, turn the key toward the rear 2 .

Power (if so equipped) The power door lock system allows you to lock or unlock all doors at the same time.

Turning the key toward the front 1 of the vehicle locks all doors.

Turning the key one time toward the rear 2 of the vehicle unlocks that door. From that position, returning the key to neutral 3 (where the key can only be removed and inserted) and turning it toward the rear again within 5 seconds unlocks all doors 4 .

Drivers side and Passenger side (if so equipped)

WPD0311 LPD0240

DOORS

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-3

LOCKING WITH INSIDE LOCK KNOB To lock the door without the key, move the inside lock knob to the lock position 1 , then close the door.

To unlock the door without the key, move the inside lock knob to the unlock position 2 .

LOCKING WITH POWER DOOR LOCK SWITCH (if so equipped)

To lock all the doors without a key, push the door lock switch (drivers or front passengers side) to the lock position 1 . When locking the door this way, be certain not to leave the key inside the vehicle.

To unlock all the doors without a key, push the door lock switch (drivers or front passengers side) to the unlock position 2 .

Lockout protection When the power door lock switch (drivers or front passengers side) is moved to the lock position with the key in the ignition switch and any door open, all doors will lock and then unlock automatically. This helps to prevent the keys from being accidently locked inside the vehicle.

Inside lock LPD0298

Door lock switch WPD0381

3-4 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

REAR DOORS (King Cab models) 1. Open the drivers or passengers door.

2. From the outside, pull the door handle A toward you.

3. Open the door to the desired position.

AUTOMATIC DOOR LOCKS (if so equipped)

All doors lock automatically when the vehicle speed reaches 15 MPH (24 km/h).

For automatic transmission models: All doors unlock automatically when the trans- mission is placed in the P (Park) position.

For manual transmission models: All doors unlock automatically when the key is re- moved from the ignition switch.

LPD0278 LPD0312 WPD0313

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-5

The automatic unlock function can be de- activated or activated.To deactivate or acti- vate the automatic door unlock system, perform the following procedure:

1. Close all doors.

2. Place the ignition switch in the ON position.

3. Within 20 seconds of performing Step 2, push and hold the power door lock switch to the position (UNLOCK) for more than 5 seconds.

4. When activated, the hazard indicator will flash twice. When deactivated, the hazard indicator will flash once.

5. The ignition switch must be placed in the OFF and ON position again between each setting change.

When the automatic door unlock system is deac- tivated, the doors do not unlock when the ignition switch is placed in the OFF position for manual transmission models or the transmission is placed in the P (Park) position for automatic transmission models. To unlock the door manu- ally, use the inside lock knob or the power door lock switch (drivers or front passengers side).

CHILD SAFETY REAR DOOR LOCK (Crew Cab models only) Child safety locks help prevent the rear doors from being opened accidentally, especially when small children are in the vehicle.

The child safety lock levers are located on the edge of the rear doors.

When the lever is in the LOCK position, the door can be opened only from the outside.

WARNING

Radio waves could adversely affect electric medical equipment. Those who use a pacemaker should contact the electric medical equipment manufac- turer for the possible influences before use.

The remote keyless entry keyfob trans- mits radio waves when the buttons are pushed. The FAA advises radio waves may affect aircraft navigation and com- munication systems. Do not operate the remote keyless entry keyfob while on an airplane. Make sure the buttons are not operated unintentionally when the unit is stored for a flight

It is possible to lock/unlock all doors, turn the interior lights on, and activate the panic alarm by using the keyfob from outside the vehicle.

Be sure to remove the key from the vehicle before locking the doors.

The keyfob can operate at a distance of approxi- mately 33 ft (10 m) from the vehicle. The effective distance depends on the conditions around the vehicle.

WPD0314

REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY SYSTEM (if so equipped)

3-6 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

As many as 5 keyfobs can be used with one vehicle. For information concerning the purchase and use of additional keyfobs, contact a NISSAN dealer.

The keyfob will not function when:

the battery is discharged

the distance between the vehicle and the keyfob is over 33 ft (10 m)

The panic alarm will not activate when the key is in the ignition switch.

CAUTION

Listed below are conditions or occur- rences which will damage the keyfob:

Do not allow the keyfob, which contains electrical components, to come into contact with water or salt water. This could affect the system function.

Do not drop the keyfob.

Do not strike the keyfob sharply against another object.

Do not change or modify the keyfob.

Wetting may damage the keyfob. If the keyfob gets wet, immediately wipe until it is completely dry.

Do not place the keyfob for an extended period in an area where temperatures exceed 140F (60C).

Do not attach the keyfob with a key holder that contains a magnet.

Do not place the keyfob near equip- ment that produces a magnetic field, such as a TV, audio equipment and per- sonal computers.

If a keyfob is lost or stolen, NISSAN rec- ommends erasing the ID code of that key- fob. This will prevent the keyfob from un- authorized use to unlock the vehicle. For information regarding the erasing proce- dure, please contact a NISSAN dealer. HOW TO USE REMOTE KEYLESS

ENTRY SYSTEM

Locking doors

1. Close all windows.

2. Remove the key from the ignition switch.

3. Close the hood and all doors.

4. Press the button on the keyfob. All the doors lock. The hazard warning lights flash twice and the horn beeps once to indicate all doors are locked.

LPD0209

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-7

When the button is pressed with all doors locked, the hazard warning lights flash twice and the horn beeps once as a reminder that the doors are already locked.

If a door is open and you press the button, the doors will lock but the horn will not beep and the hazard lights will not flash.

The horn may or may not beep. Refer to Silenc- ing the horn beep feature in this section for details.

Unlocking doors

Press the button on the keyfob once.

Only the drivers door unlocks.

The hazard warning lights flash once if all doors are completely closed with the ignition switch in any position except the ON posi- tion.

The interior lights illuminate for a period of time when the interior light switch is in the normal operation position.

Press the button on the keyfob again within 5 seconds.

All doors unlock.

The hazard warning lights flash once if all doors are completely closed.

The interior lights can be turned off without wait- ing by inserting the key into the ignition switch and placing the ignition switch in the ON or START position, locking the doors with the key- fob or pushing the interior light switch to the OFF position.

Auto relock

When the button on the keyfob is pressed, all doors will lock automatically within 1 minute unless one of the following operations is per- formed:

Any door is opened.

A key is inserted into the ignition switch and the switch is cycled from OFF to ON.

LPD0210

3-8 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

Opening windows (if so equipped) The keyfob allows you to open windows equipped with automatic operation.

To open the windows, press the but- ton on the keyfob for longer than 3 sec- onds after all doors are unlocked.

The door windows will open while pressing the button on the keyfob.

The door windows cannot be closed by using the keyfob.

Using the panic alarm If you are near your vehicle and feel threatened, you may activate the panic alarm to call attention by pressing and holding the button on the keyfob for longer than 0.5 seconds.

The panic alarm and headlights will stay on for a period of time.

The panic alarm stops when:

it has run for a period of time, or

any button is pressed on the keyfob.

Using the interior lights

Press the button on the keyfob once to turn on the interior lights.

For additional information, refer to Interior lights in the Instruments and controls section in this manual.

LPD0211

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-9

Silencing the horn beep feature

If desired, the horn beep feature can be deacti- vated using the keyfob.

To deactivate: Press and hold the and buttons for at least 2 seconds.

The hazard warning lights will flash three times to confirm that the horn beep feature has been deactivated.

To activate: Press and hold the and buttons for at least 2 seconds once more.

The hazard warning lights will flash once and the horn will sound once to confirm that the horn beep feature has been reactivated.

Deactivating the horn beep feature does not si- lence the horn if the alarm is triggered.

1 Pull the hood lock release handle located below the drivers side instrument panel. The hood will spring up slightly.

2 Push the lever at the front of the hood to the side as illustrated with your fingertips and raise the hood.

3 Insert the support rod into the slot on the underside of the hood.

When closing the hood, return the hood rod to its original position. Lower the hood approximately 12 in (30 cm) above the latch and release it. This allows proper engagement of the hood latch.

LPD0262 LPD0302

HOOD

3-10 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

WARNING

Make sure the hood is completely closed and latched before driving. Fail- ure to do so could cause the hood to fly open and result in an accident.

If you see steam or smoke coming from the engine compartment, to avoid injury do not open the hood.

FUEL-FILLER CAP

WARNING

Gasoline is extremely flammable and highly explosive under certain condi- tions. You could be burned or seriously injured if it is misused or mishandled. Always stop the engine and do not smoke or allow open flames or sparks near the vehicle when refueling.

Do not attempt to top off the fuel tank after the fuel pump nozzle shuts off automatically. Continued refueling may cause fuel overflow, resulting in fuel spray and possibly a fire.

Use only an original equipment type fuel-filler cap as a replacement. It has a built-in safety valve needed for proper operation of the fuel system and emis- sion control system. An incorrect cap can result in a serious malfunction and possible injury. It could also cause the Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) to come on.

Never pour fuel into the throttle body to attempt to start your vehicle.

Do not fill a portable fuel container in the vehicle or trailer. Static electricity can cause an explosion of flammable liquid, vapor or gas in any vehicle or trailer. To reduce the risk of serious injury or death when filling portable fuel containers:

Always place the container on the ground when filling.

Do not use electronic devices when filling.

LPD0263

FUEL-FILLER DOOR

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-11

Keep the pump nozzle in contact with the container while you are fill- ing it.

Use only approved portable fuel con- tainers for flammable liquid.

CAUTION

Do not use E-15 or E-85 fuel in your vehicle. For further information see the Fuel Recommendation in the Techni- cal and consumer information section of this manual.

The LOOSE FUEL CAP warning mes- sage will be displayed if the fuel-filler cap is not properly tightened. It may take a few driving trips for the message to be displayed. Failure to tighten the fuel-filler cap properly after the LOOSE FUEL CAP warning message is dis- played may cause the Malfunc- tion Indicator Light (MIL) to illuminate.

Failure to tighten the fuel-filler cap properly may cause the Malfunc- tion Indicator Light (MIL) to illuminate. If the light illuminates because the fuel-filler cap is loose or missing, tighten or install the cap and continue to drive the vehicle. The light should turn off after a few driving trips. If the light does not turn off after a few driving trips, have the vehicle in- spected by a NISSAN dealer.

For additional information, see the Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) in the Instruments and Controls section in this manual.

If fuel is spilled on the vehicle body, flush it away with water to avoid paint damage.

To remove the fuel-filler cap:

1. Turn the fuel-filler cap counterclockwise to remove.

2. Loop the tether strap around the hook 1 while refueling.

To install the fuel-filler cap:

1. Insert the fuel-filler cap straight into the fuel- filler tube.

2. Turn the fuel-filler cap clockwise until a single click is heard.

LPD0325

3-12 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

Loose Fuel Cap warning message The LOOSE FUEL CAP warning message dis- plays in the odometer when the fuel-filler cap is not tightened correctly after the vehicle has been refueled. It may take a few driving trips for the message to be displayed. To turn off the warning message, perform the following:

1. Remove and install the fuel-filler cap as de- scribed above as soon as possible.

2. Tighten the fuel-filler cap until it clicks.

3. Press the loose fuel cap warning reset but- ton A in the meter for about 1 second to turn off the LOOSE FUEL CAP warning message after tightening the fuel-filler cap.

For additional information, see Meters and gauges in the Instruments and Controls sec- tion in this manual.

TILT OPERATION (if so equipped) Pull the lock lever forward and hold it to adjust the steering wheel up or down to the desired posi- tion.

Release the lock lever to lock the steering wheel in place.

WARNING

Do not adjust the steering wheel while driving. You could lose control of your vehicle and cause an accident.

LRS2004 LPD0304

STEERING WHEEL

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-13

1 To block glare from the front, swing down the main sun visor.

2 To block glare from the side, remove the main sun visor from the center mount and swing the visor to the side.

3 To extend the sun visor, slide in or out as needed.

CAUTION

Do not store the sun visor before return- ing the extension to its original position.

Do not pull the extension sun visor forcedly downward. VANITY MIRRORS (if so equipped)

To access the vanity mirror, pull the sun visor down and flip open the mirror cover. Some vanity mirrors are illuminated and turn on when the mirror cover is open.

WPD0344

WPD0307

SUN VISORS

3-14 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

REARVIEW MIRROR (if so equipped) The night position 1 reduces glare from the headlights of vehicles behind you at night.

Use the day position 2 when driving in daylight hours.

WARNING

Use the night position only when neces- sary, because it reduces rear view clarity.

AUTOMATIC ANTI-GLARE REARVIEW MIRROR (if so equipped) The inside mirror is designed so that it automati- cally dims during night time conditions and ac- cording to the intensity of the headlights of the vehicle following you. The automatic anti-glare feature is activated when the ignition switch is in the ON position.

The indicator light will illuminate when the auto- matic anti-glare feature is operating.

NOTE:

Do not hang any objects over the sensors 1 or apply glass cleaner to the sensors. Doing so will reduce the sensitivity of the sensors, resulting in improper operation. Type A and Type B

The indicator light will illuminate when the auto- matic anti-glare feature is operating.

With the ignition switch in the ON position, press the button as described:

To turn off the anti-glare feature, press the button. The indicator light will turn off.

To turn on the anti-glare feature, press the button again. The indicator light will turn on.

WPD0126 Type A

LPD0446

MIRRORS

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-15

For information on HomeLink Universal Trans- ceiver (if so equipped) operation, see the HomeLink Universal Transceiver in the In- struments and controls section of this manual.

For more information about the compass 2 and compass features (if so equipped), refer to Compass display in the Instruments and con- trols section of this manual.

OUTSIDE MIRRORS

WARNING

Objects viewed in the outside mirror on the passenger side are closer than they appear. Be careful when moving to the right. Using only this mirror could cause an accident. Use the inside mirror or glance over your shoulder to properly judge distances to other objects.

Manual control type (if so equipped) The outside mirror can be moved in any direction for a better rear view.

Type B LPD0470 WPD0170

3-16 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

Electric control type (if so equipped) The outside mirror remote control will operate only when the ignition switch is placed in the ACC or ON position.

Move the small switch 1 to select the right or left mirror. Adjust each mirror to the desired position using the large switch 2 .

Heated mirrors (if so equipped) Some outside mirrors can be heated to defrost, defog, or de-ice for improved visibility. For addi- tional information, see Rear window and outside mirror defroster switch in the Instruments and controls section of this manual.

Foldable outside mirrors Pull the outside mirror toward the door to fold it.

TAILGATE

Opening the tailgate

Pull the tailgate handle upward and lower the tailgate. The support cables hold the tailgate open.

When closing the tailgate, make sure the latches are securely locked.

Do not drive the vehicle with the tailgate down, unless equipped with NISSANs Bed Extender (accessory) or equivalent in the extended position.

LPD0237 LPD0259 LPD0270

TRUCK BOX

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-17

For proper truck box loading see Vehicle loading information in the Technical and consumer in- formation section of this manual.

WARNING

It is extremely dangerous to ride in a cargo area inside a vehicle. In a colli- sion, people riding in these areas are more likely to be seriously injured or killed.

Do not allow people to ride in any area of your vehicle that is not equipped with seats and seat belts.

Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and using a seat belt properly. Disconnecting the rear camera (if so

equipped) Before removing the tailgate disconnect the rear camera by performing the following:

1. Open the tailgate to access the rear camera connector bracket 1 located on the rear sill.

2. Remove the connector bracket 2 from the sill by pressing the locking tab inward, in the direction shown, while pulling the bracket apart.

3. Disconnect the chassis wiring harness 3 by pressing inward on the locking tab, in the direction shown, while pulling the connec- tors apart. Hold the connector firmly to pre- vent the connector in the chassis harness from falling into the sill.

4. Take the chassis plug and bracket from the glove box and connect them to the chassis wiring harness to avoid contamination to the terminals which will lead to malfunction of the rear camera.

5. Insert the bracket back into the sill.

LPD2097

3-18 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

6. Take the tailgate plug from the glove box and connect it to the tailgate wiring harness to avoid contamination which will lead to mal- function of the rear camera.

7. Remove the tailgate. See Removing the tailgate in this section.

Removing the tailgate

1. Release the tailgate support cables.

CAUTION

The tailgate is heavy. Two people should remove or install it. Be careful not to drop it during removal.

After releasing the support cables, do not let the tailgate rest on the bumper.

2. Hold the tailgate at a 45 degree angle.

3. Pull the tailgate out from the right side hinge.

4. Slide the tailgate out of the left side hinge.

Installing the tailgate 1. Insert the tailgate into the left side hinge.

2. Hold the tailgate at a 45 degree angle and insert into the right side hinge.

3. Continue to hold the tailgate at a 45 degree angle and attach the tailgate support cables.

4. Close the tailgate securely.

LPD0271

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-19

Connecting the rear camera (if so equipped)

Before closing the tailgate reconnect the rear camera by performing the following:

1. After attaching the rear tailgate to the truck, keep the tailgate open and check that the tailgate harness is not hanging below the tailgate.

2. Remove the connector bracket 2 from the sill by pressing the locking tab inward, in the direction shown, while pulling the bracket apart.

3. Disconnect the chassis plug and bracket from the chassis wiring harness 3 . Keep the connector and bracket in a safe place such as the glove box.

4. Disconnect the tailgate plug from the tail- gate wiring harness. Keep the tailgate plug in a safe place such as the glove box.

5. Connect the tailgate wiring harness to the chassis wiring harness.

6. Securely fix the rear camera connector bracket 1 to the rear sill.

7. Close the tailgate securely.

Locking the tailgate To lock the tailgate, turn the key toward the pas- senger side of the vehicle 1 . To unlock, turn the key toward the driver side 2 .

LPD2097 LPD0272

3-20 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

BED EXTENDER (if so equipped)

CAUTION

Do not overload the bed extender. Maximum load on the open tailgate is 890N (200 lbs).

Evenly distribute and properly secure all cargo.

Do not use the bed extender or tailgate to secure cargo.

Positioning the bed extender

To use the bed extender in the inward position perform the following:

1. Rotate the bed extender 1 toward the cab of the truck.

2. If necessary, remove tethers from the tailgate latch.

3. Tighten the knobs to secure the extender into the desired position.

4. Close the tailgate.

5. Place cargo inside the bed extender in the truck bed.

6. Properly secure the cargo.

To use the bed extender in the outward position perform the following:

1. Open the tailgate.

2. Rotate the bed extender 2 away from the cab of the truck until the extender sits on the tailgate.

3. Lock the buckles 3 into the tailgate latch on both sides.

The bed extender can be adjusted in the outward position by moving the extender along the rail.

LPD0480 LPD0479

Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-21

NOTE:

Use care when rotating extender, buckles may come in contact with the truck bed railing.

Removing and installing the bed extender To remove or install the bed extender perform the following:

1. Open the tailgate.

2. Rotate the bed extender into a vertical posi- tion and lift straight up (to remove) or lower straight down (to install).

To store the bed extender in the front of the truck when not in use perform the following:

1. Position the sliding brackets past the center of the wheel well.

2. Re-install the extender into the brackets (see above).

3. Rotate the extender to the inward position.

4. Push the brackets forward until the extender comes in contact with the front wall of the truck box.

TIE DOWN HOOKS (if so equipped)

For your convenience, tie down hooks are placed at each corner of the truck box. These may be used to help secure cargo loaded into the truck box.

The weight of the cargo load must be evenly distributed over both the front and the rear axles.

All cargo should be securely fastened with ropes or straps to prevent it from shifting or sliding within the vehicle.

WARNING

Properly secure all cargo with ropes or straps to help prevent it from sliding or shifting. In a sudden stop or collision, unsecured cargo could cause personal injury.

LTI0102

3-22 Pre-driving checks and adjustments

4 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Control panel buttons color screen with Navigation System (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-4

How to use the touch screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5 How to use the BACK button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-7 How to use the MENU button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-7

button. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11 RearView Monitor (if so equipped). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11

How to read the displayed lines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12 Difference between predicted and actual distances . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13 Adjusting the screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-15 Operating tips. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-16

Vents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-17 Heater and air conditioner (manual) (Type A) (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-17

Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-18 Heater operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-19 Air conditioner operation (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . 4-20 Air flow charts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-22

Heater and air conditioner (manual) (Type B) (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-25

Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-25 Heater operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-26 Air conditioner operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-28 Air flow charts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-29

Heater and air conditioner (automatic) (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-33

Automatic operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-33 Manual operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-34 Operating tips. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-34

Servicing air conditioner (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-35 Audio system (if so equipped). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-35

Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-35 FM radio reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-36 AM radio reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-36 Satellite radio reception (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . 4-36 Audio operation precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-37 FM/AM radio with compact disc (CD) player (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-45 FM/AM/SAT radio with compact disc (CD) player (Type A) (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-49 FM/AM/SAT radio with compact disc (CD) player (Type B) (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-54

USB interface (models without Navigation System) (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-61 USB interface (models with Navigation System) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-62 iPod* player operation without Navigation System (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-64 iPod* player operation with Navigation System (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-66 Bluetooth streaming audio without Navigation System (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-70 Bluetooth streaming audio with Navigation System (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-71 Pandora audio (United States only) (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-72 CD care and cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-74 Steering wheel switch for audio control (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-75 Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-76

Car phone or CB radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-77 Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System without Navigation System (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-77

Regulatory Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-79 Using the system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-79 Control buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-81

Getting started . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-82 List of voice commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-84 Voice Adaptation (VA) mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-88 Manual control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-89 Troubleshooting guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-90

Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System with Navigation System (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-91

Regulatory Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-92 Voice commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-93 Connecting procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-93 Vehicle phonebook . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-94 Making a call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-95 Receiving a call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-96 During a call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-96 Ending a call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-96 Text messaging. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-97 Bluetooth settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-98 Phone settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-100

NISSAN Voice Recognition System (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-101

Using the system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-101 System features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-102 Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System voice commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-103

Navigation System voice commands . . . . . . . . . . . .4-104 Audio system voice commands. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-104 Information voice commands. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-105

Help voice commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-105 Troubleshooting guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-106

WARNING

Positioning of the heating or air condi- tioning controls and display controls should not be done while driving in or- der that full attention may be given to the driving operation.

Do not disassemble or modify this sys- tem. If you do, it may result in accidents, fire, or electrical shock.

Do not use this system if you notice any abnormality, such as a frozen screen or lack of sound. Continued use of the system may result in accident, fire or electric shock.

In case you notice any foreign object in the system hardware, spill liquid on it, or notice smoke or smell coming from it, stop using the system immediately and contact your nearest NISSAN dealer. Ignoring such conditions may lead to accidents, fire or electrical shock.

1. Display screen

2. button**

3. MAP button*

4. NAV button*

5. MENU button

6. BACK button

7. TUNE knob / AUDIO button

8. (brightness control) button

LHA2516

CONTROL PANEL BUTTONS COLOR SCREEN WITH NAVIGATION SYSTEM (if so equipped)

4-4 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

9. Power button/VOL (volume) control knob

10. CAMERA button

* For information regarding the Navigation system control buttons, refer to the separate Navigation System Owners Manual.

** For information regarding the Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System control button, see Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System in this section.

When you use this system, make sure the engine is running.

If you use the system with the engine not running (ignition ON or ACC) for a long time, it will discharge the battery, and the engine will not start.

Reference symbols:

Example Words marked in quotes refer to a key shown only on the display. These keys can be selected by touching the screen.

HOW TO USE THE TOUCH SCREEN

CAUTION

The glass display screen may break if it is hit with a hard or sharp object. If the glass screen breaks, do not touch it. Doing so could result in an injury.

To clean the display, never use a rough cloth, alcohol, benzine, thinner or any kind of solvent or paper towel with a chemical cleaning agent. They will scratch or deteriorate the panel.

Do not splash any liquid such as water or car fragrance on the display. Contact with liquid will cause the system to malfunction.

To help ensure safe driving, some functions can- not be operated while driving.

The on-screen functions that are not available while driving will be grayed out or muted.

Park the vehicle in a safe location and then oper- ate the navigation system.

WARNING

ALWAYS give your full attention to driving.

Avoid using vehicle features that could distract you. If distracted, you could lose control of your vehicle and cause an accident.

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-5

Touch screen operation Selecting the item:

Touch an item to select. For example, to select the Audio key, touch the Audio key 1 on the screen.

Adjusting the item:

For screens where an item can be adjusted incre- mentally, such as when adjusting the bass and treble for the audio system, touch the + key 1 or the key 2 to adjust the settings of an item.

When there are more items than can be dis- played on one screen, touch the up arrow 3 to scroll up the page or touch the down arrow 4 to scroll down the page.

Other items are adjusted by selecting one of a set number of conditions. For example, the Display Mode can be set to Automatic, Day or Night. To adjust this type of item, touch the item 1 . The item will cycle through the available settings and the red indicator lights to the left of the setting condition 2 will come on or turn off accordingly.

LHA2245 LHA2246 LHA1478

4-6 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Inputting characters:

Touch the letter key 1 .

There are some options available when inputting characters.

123 / ABC: Changes the available character set to num- bers.

Space: Inserts a space.

Delete: Deletes the last inputted character with one touch. Touch and hold the Delete key to delete all of the characters.

OK: Completes the character input.

Touch screen maintenance If you clean the display screen, use a dry, soft cloth. If additional cleaning is necessary, use a small amount of neutral detergent with a soft cloth. Never spray the screen with water or de- tergent. Dampen the cloth first and then wipe the screen.

HOW TO USE THE BACK BUTTON Press the BACK button to return to the previous screen.

HOW TO USE THE MENU BUTTON

For more information about the POIs Powered by Google, Google Send-To-Car, Traffic Information and Weather features, see the separate Navigation System Owners Manual.

For more information about the Voice Com- mands key, see NISSAN Voice Recognition System in this section.

To select and/or adjust several functions, fea- tures and modes that are available for your ve- hicle:

1. Press the MENU button.

2. Select the Settings key.

LHA2247 LHA2253

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-7

3. Select the desired item.

Audio

For audio setup, refer to Audio system in this section.

Navigation

Refer to the separate Navigation System Own- ers Manual for information regarding this item.

Phone & Bluetooth

For information regarding the Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System, see Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System in this section.

For information regarding Bluetooth audio, see Bluetooth streaming audio with Navigation System in this section.

System Select the System key to select and/or adjust various functions of the system. A screen with additional options will appear.

LHA2248 LHA2249

4-8 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Display:

Select the Display key to adjust the appearance of the display. The following settings can be adjusted:

Brightness The brightness of the display can be set to Very Bright, Bright, Default, Dark or Very Dark. Touch the Brightness key to cycle through the options.

Display Mode The display can be adjusted to fit the level of lighting in the vehicle. Touch the Display Mode key to cycle through the options. Day and Night modes are suited for the respective times of day, while Automatic controls the display automatically.

Scroll Direction The direction that menus scroll can be adjusted. Choose either up or down.

Clock Settings:

Select the Clock Settings key to adjust the time and the appearance of the clock on the display. The following settings can be adjusted:

Time Format The clock can be set to 12 hours or 24 hours.

Date Format Select from five possible formats of displaying the day, month and year.

LHA1482 LHA2250

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-9

Clock Mode Select the mode for the clock. Auto uses the systems GPS to automatically maintain the time. Manual allows you to set the clock using the Set Clock Manually key. Time Zone maintains the time based upon the zone selected when selecting the Time Zone key.

Set Clock Manually When this setting is activated, the clock can be set manually. Touch the + or - keys to adjust the hours, minutes, day, month and year up or down. Clock Mode must be set to Manual for this option to be available.

Daylight Savings Time When this setting is activated, daylight savings time is on. Touch the Daylight Savings Time key to toggle the setting on or off.

Time Zone Choose the applicable time zone from the list.

Language:

Select the Language key to adjust the language used by the system. The language can be set to English, Franais or Espaol.

Touchscreen click:

Select the Touchscreen Click key to toggle the touchscreen click feature on or off. When acti- vated, a click sound will be heard every time a key on the screen is touched.

LHA2251 LHA2252

4-10 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

System Beeps:

Select the System Beeps key to toggle the system beep tones feature on or off. When acti- vated, a beep sound will be heard when a pop-up message appears on the screen or a button on the unit (such as the button) is pressed and held for two seconds.

Reset all settings/memory:

Select the Reset All Settings/Memory key to return all settings to default and to clear the memory.

Info

For information about the Info key, see the separate Navigation System Owners Manual.

XM

For XM setup, refer to Audio system in this section.

BUTTON

To change the display brightness, press the button. Pressing the button again will change the display to the day or the night display.

If no operation is performed within 5 seconds, the display will return to the previous display.

Press and hold the button for more than two seconds to turn the display off. Press the button again to turn the display on.

When the shift selector is shifted into the R (Reverse) position, the monitor display shows a rearward view from the vehicle.

WARNING

The system is designed as an aid to the driver in detecting large stationary ob- jects to help avoid damaging the ve- hicle. The system will not detect small objects below the bumper, and may not detect objects close to the bumper or on the ground.

The RearView Monitor is a convenience but it is not a substitute for proper back- ing. Always turn and check that it is safe to do so before backing up. Always back up slowly.

Objects viewed in the RearView Moni- tor differ from actual distance because a wide-angle lens is used.

Do not put anything on the rearview camera. The rearview camera is in- stalled beside the license plate light.

REARVIEW MONITOR (if so equipped)

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-11

When washing the vehicle with high- pressure water, be sure not to spray it around the camera. Otherwise, water may enter the camera unit causing wa- ter condensation on the lens, a mal- function, fire or an electric shock.

Do not strike the camera. It is a preci- sion instrument. Otherwise, it may mal- function or cause damage resulting in a fire or an electric shock.

CAUTION

There is a plastic cover over the camera. Do not scratch the cover when cleaning dirt or snow from the cover. HOW TO READ THE DISPLAYED

LINES Guiding lines which indicate the vehicle width and distances to objects with reference to the vehicle body line A are displayed on the monitor.

Distance guide lines:

Indicate distances from the vehicle body.

Red line 1 : approx. 1.5 ft (0.5 m)

Yellow line 2 : approx. 3 ft (1 m)

Green line 3 : approx. 7 ft (2 m)

Green line 4 : approx. 10 ft (3 m)

The on-screen guidelines can be set to on or off.

With the shift selector in the R (Reverse) position:

Press the CAMERA button to toggle the feature on and off.

With the shift selector in any position other than the R (Reverse) position:

1. Press the CAMERA button.

2. Select the Show Guidelines key to toggle the feature on or off.

LHA0437 LHA2278

4-12 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

DIFFERENCE BETWEEN PREDICTED AND ACTUAL DISTANCES The distance guide line and the vehicle width guide line should be used as a reference only when the vehicle is on a level, paved surface. The distance viewed on the monitor is for reference only and may be different than the actual distance between the vehicle and displayed objects.

Backing up on a steep uphill When backing up the vehicle up a hill, the dis- tance guide lines and the vehicle width guide lines are shown closer than the actual distance. For example, the display shows 3 ft (1.0 m) to the place A , but the actual 3 ft (1.0 m) distance on the hill is the place B . Note that any object on the hill is further than it appears on the monitor.

LHA2326

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-13

Backing up on a steep downhill

When backing up the vehicle down a hill, the distance guide lines and the vehicle width guide lines are shown farther than the actual distance. For example, the display shows 3 ft (1.0 m) to the place A , but the actual 3 ft (1.0 m) distance on

the hill is the place B . Note that any object on the hill is closer than it appears on the monitor.

Backing up behind a projecting object The position C is shown farther than the position B in the display. However, the position C is actually at the same distance as the position A . The vehicle may hit the object when backing up to the position A if the object projects over the actual backing up course.

LHA2327 LHA2328

4-14 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

ADJUSTING THE SCREEN

The procedure for adjusting the quality of the screen differs depending on the type of screen present on the vehicle.

For vehicles without Navigation System:

1. Press the ENTER/SETTING button.

2. Turn the TUNE-SCROLL knob to highlight the Brightness or Contrast key.

3. Press the ENTER/SETTING button.

4. Adjust the level using the TUNE-SCROLL knob and then press the ENTER/SETTING button to apply the adjustment.

Do not adjust the Brightness or Contrast of the RearView Monitor while the vehicle is moving.

For vehicles with Navigation System:

1. Press the MENU button.

2. Select the Settings key.

3. Select the System key.

4. Select the Display key.

5. Touch the Brightness key and adjust the level to the desired setting.

Do not adjust the display of the RearView Monitor while the vehicle is moving.

Without Navigation System LHA2254

With Navigation System LHA1482

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-15

OPERATING TIPS

CAUTION

Do not use alcohol, benzine or thinner to clean the camera. This will cause discoloration. To clean the camera, wipe with a cloth dampened with a di- luted mild cleaning agent and then wipe with a dry cloth.

Do not damage the camera as the moni- tor screen may be adversely affected.

When the shift selector is shifted to R (Re- verse), the monitor screen automatically changes to the RearView Monitor mode. However, the radio can be heard.

It may take some time until the RearView Monitor is displayed after the shift selector has been shifted to R (Reverse). Objects may be distorted momentarily until the Rear- View Monitor screen is displayed com- pletely. When the shift selector is returned to a position other than R (Reverse), it may take some time until the screen changes. Objects on the screen may be distorted until they are completely displayed.

When the temperature is extremely high or low, the screen may not clearly display ob- jects. This is not a malfunction.

When strong light directly enters the cam- era, objects may not be displayed clearly.

Vertical lines may be seen in objects on the screen. This is due to strong reflected light from the bumper. This is not a malfunction.

The screen may flicker under fluorescent light. This is not a malfunction.

The colors of objects on the RearView Moni- tor may differ somewhat from those of the actual object.

When the contrast of objects is low at night, pressing the SETTING button or MENU but- ton may not change the brightness.

Objects on the monitor may not be clear in a dark place or at night.

If dirt, rain or snow attaches to the camera, the RearView Monitor may not display ob- jects. Clean the camera.

Do not use body wax on the camera window. If body wax does get on the camera window, wipe off the wax with a clean cloth damp- ened with mild detergent diluted with water.

4-16 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Adjust air flow direction for the drivers and pas- sengers side windows 1 , driver and passenger 2 , or center 3 vent by moving the vent slide and/or vent assemblies.

WARNING

The air conditioner cooling function op- erates only when the engine is running.

Do not leave children or adults who would normally require the assistance of others alone in your vehicle. Pets should also not be left alone. They could accidentally injure themselves or others through inadvertent operation of the vehicle. Also, on hot, sunny days, temperatures in a closed vehicle could quickly become high enough to cause severe or possibly fatal injuries to people or animals.

Do not use the recirculation mode for long periods as it may cause the interior air to become stale and the windows to fog up.

LHA0534

VENTS HEATER AND AIR CONDITIONER (manual) (Type A) (if so equipped)

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-17

1. Fan control dial 2. Temperature control dial 3. Air flow control dial 4. Air conditioner button (if so equipped) 5. Air recirculation button

CONTROLS

Fan control dial

The fan control dial turns the fan on and off, and controls fan speed.

Air flow control dial

The air flow control dial allows you to select the air flow outlets.

MAX A/C

Air flows from center and side vents with maximum cooling (air conditioning).

Air flows from center and side vents.

Air flows from center and side vents and the front and rear floor outlets.

Air flows mainly from the front and rear floor outlets.

Air flows from defroster outlets and the front and rear floor outlets.

Air flows mainly from defroster outlets.

Temperature control dial

The temperature control dial allows you to adjust the temperature of the outlet air. To lower the temperature, turn the dial to the left. To increase the temperature, turn the dial to the right.

Air recirculation button

ON position: Push the air recirculation button to recir- culate air inside the vehicle. The indicator light on the button will come on.

Push the button to the on position:

when driving on a dusty road.

to prevent traffic fumes from entering pas- senger compartment.

for maximum cooling when using the air con- ditioner.

Type A WHA1384

4-18 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

OFF position: Push the air recirculation button again to turn air recirculation off. The indicator light on the button will turn off. Outside air is drawn into the passenger compartment and distributed through the selected outlet.

Use the off position for normal heater or air con- ditioner operation.

Air conditioner button (if so equipped)

The button is provided only on vehicles equipped with an air conditioner.

Start the engine, turn the fan control dial to the desired (1 - 4) position and push the button to turn on the air conditioner. The indicator light comes on when the air conditioner is oper- ating. To turn off the air conditioner, push the button again.

The air conditioner cooling function oper- ates only when the engine is running.

HEATER OPERATION Heating

This mode is used to direct heated air to the foot outlets. Some air also flows from the defrost outlets.

1. Push the button to the OFF position for normal heating. The indicator light on the button will go off.

2. Turn the air flow control dial to the position.

3. Turn the fan control dial to the desired posi- tion.

4. Turn the temperature control dial to the de- sired position between the middle and the hot position.

Ventilation

This mode directs outside air to the side and center vent.

1. Push the button to the OFF position. The indicator light on the button will go off.

2. Turn the air flow control dial to the position.

3. Turn the fan control dial to the desired posi- tion.

4. Turn the temperature control dial to the de- sired position.

Defrosting or defogging

This mode directs the air to the defrost outlets to defrost/defog the windows.

1. Turn the air flow control dial to the position.

2. Turn the fan control dial to the desired posi- tion.

3. Turn the temperature control dial to the de- sired position between the middle and the hot position.

To quickly remove ice or fog from the win- dows, turn the fan control dial to 4 and the temperature control lever to the full HOT position.

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-19

When the position is selected, the air conditioner automatically turns on (however, the indicator light will not illuminate) if the outside temperature is more than 36F (2C). If the air flow control dial is in the position for more than one minute, the air conditioning system will continue to operate until the fan control dial is turned to OFF or the vehicle is shut off, even if the air flow control dial is turned to a position other than the position. This dehumidifies the air which helps defog the windshield. The mode automatically turns off, al- lowing outside air to be drawn into the pas- senger compartment to further improve the defogging performance.

Bi-level heating

This mode directs cooler air from the side and center vents and warmer air from the floor outlets. When the temperature control dial is moved to the full hot or full cool position, the air between the vents and the floor outlets is the same tem- perature.

1. Push the button to the off position.

2. Turn the air flow control dial to the position.

3. Turn the fan control dial to the desired posi- tion.

4. Turn the temperature control dial to the de- sired position.

Heating and defogging

This mode heats the interior and defogs the wind- shield.

1. Turn the air flow control dial to the position.

2. Turn the fan control dial to the desired posi- tion.

3. Turn the temperature control dial to the de- sired position between the middle and the hot position.

When the position is selected, the air conditioner automatically turns on (however, the indicator light on the button will not come on) if the outside temperature is more than 36F (2C). If the air flow control dial is in the position for more than one minute, the air conditioning system will continue to operate until the fan control dial is turned to OFF or the vehicle is shut off, even if the air flow control dial is turned to a position other than the position. This dehumidifies the air which helps defog the windshield. The mode automatically turns off, allowing outside air to be drawn into the passenger compartment to further improve the defogging performance.

Operating tips Clear snow and ice from the wiper blades and air inlet in front of the windshield. This improves heater operation.

AIR CONDITIONER OPERATION (if so equipped) Start the engine, turn the fan control dial to the desired position, and press the button to activate the air conditioner. When the air condi- tioner is on, cooling and dehumidifying functions are added to the heater operation.

4-20 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

The air conditioner cooling function oper- ates only when the engine is running.

Cooling

This mode is used to cool and dehumidify the air.

1. Push the button to the off position.

2. Turn the air flow control dial to the position.

3. Turn the fan control dial to the desired posi- tion.

4. Push the button. The indicator light comes on.

5. Turn the temperature control dial to the de- sired position.

For quick cooling when the outside tem- perature is high, push the button to the on position (indicator light on). Be sure to return the button to the off position for normal cooling.

Dehumidified heating This mode is used to heat and dehumidify the air.

1. Push the button to the off position.

2. Turn the air flow control dial to the position.

3. Turn the fan control dial to the desired posi- tion.

4. Push the button. The indicator light comes on.

5. Turn the temperature control dial to the de- sired position.

Dehumidified defogging This mode is used to defog the windows and dehumidify the air.

1. Turn the air flow control dial to the position.

2. Turn the fan control dial to the desired posi- tion.

3. Push the button. The indicator light comes on.

When the air flow control dial is in the or position, the air conditioner automati- cally turns on (however, the indicator light will not illuminate) if the outside temperature is more than 36F (2C). If one of these positions is selected for more than one minute, the air conditioning system will continue to operate until the fan con- trol dial is turned to OFF or the vehicle is shut off, even if the air flow control dial is turned to a position other than these positions. This dehu- midifies the air which helps defog the windshield.

The mode automatically turns off, allowing outside air to be drawn into the passenger com- partment to further improve the defogging perfor- mance.

4. Turn the temperature control dial to the de- sired position.

Operating tips

Keep the windows and moonroof (if so equipped) closed while the air conditioner is in operation.

After parking in the sun, drive for two or three minutes with the windows open to vent hot air from the passenger compartment. Then, close the windows. This allows the air con- ditioner to cool the interior more quickly.

The air conditioning system should be operated for approximately 10 minutes at least once a month. This helps pre- vent damage to the system due to lack of lubrication.

A visible mist may be seen coming from the vents in hot, humid conditions as the air is cooled rapidly. This does not indicate a mal- function.

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-21

If the engine coolant temperature gauge indicates engine coolant tem- perature over the normal range, turn the air conditioner off. See If your vehicle overheats in the In case of emergency section of this manual.

AIR FLOW CHARTS The following charts show the button and dial positions for MAXIMUM AND QUICK heating, cooling or defrosting. For additional information on heating and cooling, see Heater and air con- ditioner (manual) in this section. The air recir- culation ( ) button should always be in the OFF position for heating and defrost- ing.

WHA1385

4-22 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

WHA1386 WHA1387

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-23

WHA1388 WHA1389

4-24 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

WARNING

The air conditioner cooling function op- erates only when the engine is running.

Do not leave children or adults who would normally require the assistance of others alone in your vehicle. Pets should also not be left alone. They could accidentally injure themselves or others through inadvertent operation of the vehicle. Also, on hot, sunny days, temperatures in a closed vehicle could quickly become high enough to cause severe or possibly fatal injuries to people or animals.

Do not use the recirculation mode for long periods as it may cause the interior air to become stale and the windows to fog up.

1. Fan speed control dial 2. Front window defroster button 3. Rear window defroster switch (if so

equipped) 4. Air recirculation button 5. Temperature control dial 6. Max A/C button 7. Air flow control buttons 8. Air conditioner ON/OFF button

CONTROLS

Fan control dial

The fan control dial turns the fan on and off, and controls fan speed.

Air flow control buttons

The air flow control buttons allow you to select the air flow outlets.

MAX A/C

Air flows from center and side vents with maximum cooling (air conditioning).

Type B WHA1406

HEATER AND AIR CONDITIONER (manual) (Type B) (if so equipped)

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-25

Air flows from center and side vents.

Air flows from center and side vents and foot outlets.

Air flows mainly from foot outlets. Air flows from defroster outlets

and foot outlets. Air flows mainly from defroster

outlets.

Temperature control dial

The temperature control dial allows you to adjust the temperature of the outlet air. To lower the temperature, turn the dial to the left. To increase the temperature, turn the dial to the right.

Air recirculation button

ON position (Indicator light on): Interior air is recirculated inside the vehicle.

Press the button to the on position when:

driving on a dusty road.

to prevent traffic fumes from entering pas- senger compartment.

for maximum cooling when using the air con- ditioner.

OFF position (Indicator light off): Outside air is drawn into the passenger compart- ment and distributed through the selected outlet.

Use the off position for normal heater or air con- ditioner operation.

Air conditioner button

Start the engine, turn the fan control dial to the desired position and press the button to turn on the air conditioner. The indicator light comes on when the air conditioner is operating. To turn off the air conditioner, press the button again.

The air conditioner cooling function oper- ates only when the engine is running.

Rear window and outside mirror defroster switch (if so equipped) For more information about the rear window de- froster switch, see Rear window and outside mirror defroster switch in the Instruments and controls section of this manual.

HEATER OPERATION Heating

This mode is used to direct heated air to the foot outlets. Some air also flows from the defrost outlets.

1. Press the button to the OFF position for normal heating. The indicator light on the button will go off.

2. Press the air flow control button.

3. Turn the fan control dial to the desired posi- tion.

4. Turn the temperature control dial to the de- sired position between the middle and the hot position.

Ventilation

This mode directs outside air to the side and center vents.

1. Press the button to the OFF position. The indicator light on the button will go off.

2. Press the air flow control button.

3. Turn the fan control dial to the desired posi- tion.

4-26 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

4. Turn the temperature control dial to the de- sired position.

Defrosting or defogging This mode directs the air to the defrost outlets to defrost/defog the windows.

1. Press the defrost/defog button .

2. Turn the fan control dial to the desired posi- tion.

3. Turn the temperature control dial to the de- sired position between the middle and the hot position.

To quickly remove ice or fog from the win- dows, turn the fan control dial to the highest setting and the temperature control to the full HOT position.

When the position is selected, the air conditioner automatically turns on (the indi- cator light on the button will come on) if the outside temperature is more than 36F (2C). This dehumidifies the air which helps defog the windshield. The mode au- tomatically turns off, allowing outside air to be drawn into the passenger compartment to further improve the defogging perfor- mance.

Bi-level heating

The bi-level mode directs warmed air to the side and center vents and to the front and rear floor outlets.

1. Press the button to the OFF position. The indicator light on the button will go off.

2. Press the air flow control button.

3. Turn the fan control dial to the desired posi- tion.

4. Turn the temperature control dial to the de- sired position.

Heating and defogging

This mode heats the interior and defogs the wind- shield.

1. Press the air flow control button.

2. Turn the fan control dial to the desired posi- tion.

3. Turn the temperature control dial to the de- sired position between the middle and the hot position.

When the position is selected, the air conditioner automatically turns on (however, the indicator light on the button will not come on) if the outside temperature is more than 36F (2C). If the air flow control button is selected for more than one minute, the air conditioning system will con- tinue to operate until the fan control dial is turned to OFF, the vehicle is shut off, or the A/C button is used to turn off the compres- sor even if the air flow control dial is turned to a position other than the position. This dehumidifies the air which helps defog the windshield. The mode automati- cally turns off, allowing outside air to be drawn into the passenger compartment to further improve the defogging performance.

Operating tips

Clear snow and ice from the wiper blades and air inlet in front of the windshield. This improves heater operation.

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-27

AIR CONDITIONER OPERATION

Start the engine, turn the fan control dial to the desired position, and press the button to activate the air conditioner. When the air condi- tioner is on, cooling and dehumidifying functions are added to the heater operation.

The air conditioner cooling function oper- ates only when the engine is running.

Cooling

This mode is used to cool and dehumidify the air.

1. Press the button to the OFF position.

2. Press the air flow control button.

3. Turn the fan control dial to the desired posi- tion.

4. Press the button. The indicator light on the button will come on.

5. Turn the temperature control dial to the de- sired position.

For quick cooling when the outside tem- perature is high, push the button to the ON position. The indicator light on the button will come on. Be sure to return the to the OFF position for nor- mal cooling. The indicator light on the button will go off. You may also select MAX A/C for quick cooling.

Dehumidified heating This mode is used to heat and dehumidify the air.

1. Press the button to the OFF position. The indicator light on the button will go off.

2. Press the air flow control button.

3. Turn the fan control dial to the desired posi- tion.

4. Press the button on. The indicator light on the button will come on.

5. Turn the temperature control dial to the de- sired position.

Dehumidified defogging

This mode is used to defog the windows and dehumidify the air.

1. Press the air flow control button.

2. Turn the fan control dial to the desired posi- tion.

3. Press the button. The indicator light comes on.

When the or positions are se- lected, the air conditioner automatically turns on (however, the indicator light will not illuminate) if the outside temperature is more than 36F (2C). The air conditioning system will continue to op- erate until the fan control dial is turned to OFF, the air conditioner is turned OFF, or the vehicle is shut off, even if a position other than the air flow control button is selected. This dehumidifies the air which helps defog the windshield. The mode automatically turns off, allowing outside air to be drawn into the passenger com- partment to further improve the defogging perfor- mance.

4. Turn the temperature control dial to the de- sired position.

4-28 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Operating tips Keep the windows closed while the air con-

ditioner is in operation.

After parking in the sun, drive for 2 or 3 min- utes with the windows open to vent hot air from the passenger compartment. Then, close the windows. This allows the air con- ditioner to cool the interior more quickly.

The air conditioning system should be operated for approximately 10 minutes at least once a month. This helps pre- vent damage to the system due to lack of lubrication.

A visible mist may be seen coming from the ventilators in hot, humid conditions as the air is cooled rapidly. This does not indicate a malfunction.

If the engine coolant temperature gauge indicates engine coolant tem- perature over the normal range, turn the air conditioner off. See If your vehicle overheats in the In case of emergency section of this manual.

AIR FLOW CHARTS The following charts show the button and dial positions for MAXIMUM AND QUICK heating, cooling or defrosting. For additional information on heating and cooling, see Heater and air con- ditioner (manual) in this section. The air recir- culation ( ) button should always be in the OFF position for heating and defrost- ing.

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-29

LHA2059 LHA2060

4-30 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

LHA2061 LHA2062

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-31

WHA1362

4-32 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

1. Driver temperature control dial 2. A/C ON/OFF button 3. Front window defroster button 4. Fan speed control dial 5. (System OFF) button 6. Rear window defroster button 7. Air recirculation button 8. Passenger temperature control dial 9. DUAL button 10. Air flow control buttons 11. AUTO button

WARNING

The air conditioner cooling function op- erates only when the engine is running.

Do not leave children or adults who would normally require the assistance of others alone in your vehicle. Pets should also not be left alone. They could accidentally injure themselves or others through inadvertent operation of the vehicle. Also, on hot, sunny days, temperatures in a closed vehicle could quickly become high enough to cause severe or possibly fatal injuries to people or animals.

Do not use the recirculation mode for long periods as it may cause the interior air to become stale and the windows to fog up.

Start the engine and operate the controls to activate the air conditioner.

AUTOMATIC OPERATION

Cooling or heating (auto)

This mode may be normally used all year round as the system automatically works to keep a con- stant temperature. Air flow distribution and fan speed are also controlled automatically.

1. Press the AUTO button on.

2. Turn the temperature dial to the left or right to set the desired temperature. Driver and passenger temperatures can be set inde- pendently. Press DUAL to activate dual cli- mate control functions. Turn the passengers side temperature control dial to the left or right to set the desired passengers tem- perature.

Adjust the temperature dial to about 75F (24C) for normal operation.

LHA2611

HEATER AND AIR CONDITIONER (automatic) (if so equipped)

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-33

The temperature of the passenger compart- ment will be maintained automatically. Air flow distribution, fan speed and A/C on/off are also controlled automatically.

A visible mist may be seen coming from the vents in hot, humid conditions as the air is cooled rapidly. This does not indicate a mal- function.

Dehumidified defrosting or defogging

1. Press the defroster control button to turn the system on. The indicator light in the button will illuminate.

2. Turn the temperature dial to the left or right to set the desired temperature.

To quickly remove ice from the outside of the windows, turn the manual fan control to the maximum position.

As soon as possible after the windshield is clean, press the AUTO button to return to the auto mode.

When the control is activated, the air conditioner will automatically be turned on at outside temperatures above 36F (2C). If in defrost mode for more than one minute, the air conditioning system will continue to op- erate until the fan control is turned OFF, the vehicle is shut off or the A/C button is used to turn off the compressor even if an air flow button other than is selected. This dehumidifies the air which helps defog the windshield. The air recirculation mode auto- matically turns off, allowing outside air to be drawn into the passenger compartment to further improve the defogging performance.

MANUAL OPERATION

Fan speed control dial

Turn the fan speed control dial left or right to manually control the fan speed or turn the system on or off.

Press the AUTO button to return to automatic control of the fan speed.

Air recirculation

Push the air recirculation button to recir- culate interior air inside the vehicle. Push the AUTO button to return to automatic mode.

The air recirculation button will not be activated when the air conditioner is in DEF, floor, or floor/defrost mode.

Air flow control Press the air flow control buttons to manually control air flow and select the air outlet:

Air flows from center and side vents.

Air flows from center and side vents and foot outlets.

Air flows mainly from foot outlets. Air flows from defroster and foot

outlets. Air flows from defroster outlets.

To turn system off

Press the /OFF button.

OPERATING TIPS When the engine coolant temperature and

outside air temperature are low, the air flow from the foot outlets may not operate for a maximum of 150 seconds. However, this is not a malfunction. After the coolant tempera- ture warms up, air flow from the foot outlets will operate normally.

4-34 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

The sunload sensor 1 , located on the top center of the instrument panel, helps the system main- tain a constant temperature. Do not put anything on or around this sensor.

The air conditioner system in your NISSAN ve- hicle is charged with a refrigerant designed with the environment in mind.

This refrigerant does not harm the earths ozone layer.

Special charging equipment and lubricant is re- quired when servicing your NISSAN air condi- tioner. Using improper refrigerants or lubricants will cause severe damage to your air conditioner system. See Air conditioner system refrigerant and oil recommendations in the Technical and consumer information section of this manual.

A NISSAN dealer is able to service your environ- mentally friendly air conditioning system.

WARNING

The air conditioner system contains re- frigerant under high pressure. To avoid personal injury, any air conditioner ser- vice should be done only by an experi- enced technician with proper equipment.

RADIO

With the ignition placed in the ACC or ON posi- tion, press the PWR (power)/VOL (volume) knob to turn the radio on. If you listen to the radio with the engine not running, the ignition should be placed in the ACC position.

Radio reception is affected by station signal strength, distance from radio transmitter, build- ings, bridges, mountains and other external influ- ences. Intermittent changes in reception quality normally are caused by these external influences.

Using a cellular phone in or near the ve- hicle may influence radio reception quality.

Radio reception

Your NISSAN radio system is equipped with state-of-the-art electronic circuits to enhance ra- dio reception. These circuits are designed to extend reception range, and to enhance the qual- ity of that reception.

However, there are some general characteristics of both FM and AM radio signals that can affect radio reception quality in a moving vehicle, even when the finest equipment is used. These char- acteristics are completely normal in a given re- ception area and do not indicate any malfunction in your NISSAN radio system.

LIC0515

SERVICING AIR CONDITIONER (if so equipped)

AUDIO SYSTEM (if so equipped)

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-35

Reception conditions will constantly change be- cause of vehicle movement. Buildings, terrain, signal distance and interference from other ve- hicles can work against ideal reception. De- scribed below are some of the factors that can affect your radio reception.

Some cellular phones or other devices may cause interference or a buzzing noise to come from the audio system speakers. Storing the de- vice in a different location may reduce or elimi- nate the noise.

FM RADIO RECEPTION Range: FM range is normally limited to 25 30 mi (40 48 km), with monaural (single channel) FM having slightly more range than stereo FM. Exter- nal influences may sometimes interfere with FM station reception even if the FM station is within 25 mi (40 km). The strength of the FM signal is directly related to the distance between the transmitter and receiver. FM signals follow a line- of-sight path, exhibiting many of the same char- acteristics as light. For example, they will reflect off objects.

Fade and drift: As your vehicle moves away from a station transmitter, the signals will tend to fade and/or drift.

Static and flutter: During signal interference from buildings, large hills or due to antenna position (usually in conjunction with increased distance from the station transmitter), static or flutter can be heard. This can be reduced by adjusting the treble control to reduce treble response.

Multipath reception: Because of the reflective characteristics of FM signals, direct and reflected signals reach the receiver at the same time. The signals may cancel each other, resulting in mo- mentary flutter or loss of sound.

AM RADIO RECEPTION AM signals, because of their low frequency, can bend around objects and skip along the ground. In addition, the signals can be bounced off the ionosphere and bent back to earth. Because of these characteristics, AM signals are also sub- ject to interference as they travel from transmitter to receiver.

Fading: Occurs while the vehicle is passing through freeway underpasses or in areas with many tall buildings. It can also occur for several seconds during ionospheric turbulence even in areas where no obstacles exist.

Static: Caused by thunderstorms, electrical power lines, electric signs and even traffic lights.

SATELLITE RADIO RECEPTION (if so equipped) When the satellite radio is used for the first time or the battery has been replaced, the satellite radio may not work properly. This is not a mal- function. Wait more than 10 minutes with satellite radio ON and the vehicle outside of any metal or large building for satellite radio to receive all of the necessary data.

No satellite radio reception is available and NO SAT is displayed when the SAT band option is selected unless optional satellite receiver and antenna are installed and a SiriusXM Satellite Radio service subscription is active. Satellite ra- dio is not available in Alaska, Hawaii and Guam.

Satellite radio performance may be affected if cargo carried on the roof blocks the satellite radio signal.

If possible, do not put cargo over the satellite antenna.

A build up of ice on the satellite radio antenna can affect satellite radio performance. Remove the ice to restore satellite radio reception.

4-36 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

AUDIO OPERATION PRECAUTIONS

Compact disc (CD) player

CAUTION

Do not force a compact disc into the CD insert slot. This could damage the CD and/or CD player.

Trying to load a CD with the CD door closed could damage the CD and/or CD player.

Only one CD can be loaded into the CD player at a time.

Only use high quality 4.7 in (12 cm) round discs that have the COMPACT disc DIGITAL AUDIO logo on the disc or packaging.

During cold weather or rainy days, the player may malfunction due to the hu- midity. If this occurs, remove the CD and dehumidify or ventilate the player completely.

The player may skip while driving on rough roads.

The CD player sometimes cannot func- tion when the compartment tempera- ture is extremely high or low. Decrease/increase the temperature before use.

Do not expose the CD to direct sun- light.

CDs that are in poor condition or are dirty, scratched or covered with finger- prints may not work properly.

The following CDs may not work prop- erly:

Copy control compact discs (CCCD)

Recordable compact discs (CD-R)

Rewritable compact discs (CD-RW)

Do not use the following CDs as they may cause the CD player to malfunc- tion:

3.1 in (8 cm) discs with an adapter

CDs that are not round

CDs with a paper label

CDs that are warped, scratched, or have abnormal edges

This audio system can only play pre- recorded CDs. It has no capability to record or burn CDs.

If the CD cannot be played, one of the following messages will be displayed.

LHA0099

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-37

CHECK DISC:

Confirm that the CD is inserted cor- rectly (the label side is facing up, etc.).

Confirm that the CD is not bent or warped and it is free of scratches.

PRESS EJECT:

This is an error due to excessive tem- perature inside the player. Remove the CD by pressing the EJECT button. After a short time, reinsert the CD. The CD can be played when the temperature of the player returns to normal.

UNPLAYABLE:

The file is unplayable in this audio sys- tem (only MP3 or WMA (if so equipped) CD).

Compact disc with MP3 or WMA (if so equipped)

Terms:

MP3 MP3 is short for Moving Pictures Experts Group Audio Layer 3. MP3 is the most well-known compressed digital audio file format. This format allows for near CD quality sound, but at a fraction of the size of normal audio files. MP3 conversion of an audio track from CD-ROM can reduce the file size by approximately a 10:1 ratio with virtually no perceptible loss in quality. MP3 compression removes the redundant and irrelevant parts of a sound signal that the human ear doesnt hear.

WMA Windows Media Audio (WMA)* is a compressed audio format created by Micro- soft as an alternative to MP3. The WMA codec offers greater file compression than the MP3 codec, enabling storage of more digital audio tracks in the same amount of space when compared to MP3s at the same level of quality.

Bit rate Bit rate denotes the number of bits per second used by a digital music file. The size and quality of a compressed digital audio file is determined by the bit rate used when encoding the file.

Sampling frequency Sampling frequency is the rate at which the samples of a signal are converted from analog to digital (A/D conversion) per second.

Multisession Multisession is one of the methods for writing data to media. Writing data once to the media is called a single session, and writing more than once is called a multisession.

ID3/WMA Tag The ID3/WMA tag is the part of the encoded MP3 or WMA file that contains information about the digital music file such as song title, artist, encoding bit rate, track time duration, etc. ID3 tag infor- mation is displayed on the Artist/song title line on the display.

* Windows and Windows Media are regis- tered trademarks and trademarks in the United States of America and other countries of Micro- soft Corporation of the USA.

4-38 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Playback order:

Music playback order of a CD with MP3 or WMA files is as illustrated.

The names of folders not containing MP3 or WMA files are not shown in the display.

If there is a file in the top level of the disc, Root Folder is displayed.

The playback order is the order in which the files were written by the writing software. Therefore, the files might not play in the desired order.

Playback order chart WHA1078

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-39

Specification chart:

Supported media CD, CD-R, CD-RW Supported file systems ISO9660 LEVEL1, ISO9660 LEVEL2, Apple ISO, Romeo, Joliet * ISO9660 Level 3 (packet writing) is not supported.

Supported versions*1

MP3 Version MPEG1, MPEG2, MPEG2.5 Sampling frequency 8 kHz - 48 kHz Bit rate 8 kbps - 320 kbps, VBR

WMA Version WMA7, WMA8, WMA9 Sampling frequency 32 kHz - 48 kHz Bit rate 48 kbps - 192 kbps, VBR

Tag information ID3 tag VER1.0, VER1.1, VER2.2, VER2.3 (MP3 only) Folder levels Folder levels: 8, Max folders: 255 (including root folder), Files: 512 (Max. 255 files for one folder) Text character number limitation 128 characters

Displayable character codes*2 01: ASCII, 02: ISO-8859-1, 03: UNICODE (UTF-16 BOM Big Endian), 04: UNICODE (UTF-16 Non-BOM Big Endian), 05: UNICODE (UTF-8), 06: UNICODE (Non-UTF-16 BOM Little Endian)

*1 Files created with a combination of 48 kHz sampling frequency and 64 kbps bit rate cannot be played.

*2 Available codes depend on what kind of media, versions and information are going to be displayed.

4-40 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Troubleshooting guide:

Symptom Cause and Countermeasure

Cannot play

Check if the disc was inserted correctly. Check if the disc is scratched or dirty. Check if there is condensation inside the player. If there is, wait until the condensation is gone (about 1 hour) before using the player. If there is a temperature increase error, the CD player will play correctly after it returns to the normal temperature. If there is a mixture of music CD files (CD-DA data) and MP3/WMA files on a CD, only the music CD files (CD-DA data) will be played. Files with extensions other than .MP3,.WMA, .mp3 or .wma cannot be played. In addition, the character codes and number of characters for folder names and file names should be in compliance with the specifications. Check if the finalization process, such as session close and disc close, is done for the disc. Check if the disc is protected by copyright.

Poor sound quality Check if the disc is scratched or dirty. Bit rate may be too low.

It takes a relatively long time before the music starts playing.

If there are many folders or file levels on the MP3/WMA disc, or if it is a multisession disc, some time may be required before the music starts playing.

Music cuts off or skips The writing software and hardware combination might not match, or the writing speed, writing depth, writing width, etc., might not match the specifications. Try using the slowest writing speed.

Skipping with high bit rate files

Skipping may occur with large quantities of data, such as for high bit rate data.

Moves immediately to the next song when playing

When a non-MP3/WMA file has been given an extension of .MP3, .WMA, .mp3or .wma, or when play is prohibited by copyright protection, there will be approximately 5 seconds of no sound and then the player will skip to the next song.

Songs do not play back in the desired order

The playback order is the order in which the files were written by the writing software. Therefore, the files might not play in the desired order.

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-41

USB (Universal Serial Bus) memory (if so equipped)

WARNING

Do not connect or disconnect the USB device while driving. Doing so can be a distraction. If distracted you could lose control of your vehicle and cause an acci- dent or serious injury.

CAUTION

Do not force the USB device into the USB port. Inserting the USB device tilted or up-side-down into the port may damage the USB device and the port. Make sure that the USB device is con- nected correctly into the USB port.

Do not grab the USB port cover (if so equipped) when pulling the USB device out of the port. This could damage the port and the cover.

Do not leave the USB cable in a place where it can be pulled unintentionally. Pulling the cable may break the wire, USB device or the port.

To avoid damage and loss of function when using a USB device, note the fol- lowing precautions.

Do not bend the cable excessively (1.6 in [40 mm]) radius minimum.

Do not twist the cable excessively (more than 180 degrees).

Do not pull or drop the cable.

Do not hit or press the USB port or USB device with hands, feet, or objects.

Do not store objects with sharp edges in the storage area where the cable is stored.

Do not leave the USB device and attached devices in the vehicle com- partment. When not in use for ex- tended periods of time, store the cable and USB device in a clean, dust free environment at room tempera- ture and without direct sun exposure.

Do not use the cable for any other purposes than its intended use in the vehicle.

The vehicle is not equipped with a USB device. USB devices should be purchased separately as necessary.

This system cannot be used to format USB devices. To format a USB device, use a personal computer.

In some states/area, the USB device for the front seats plays only sound without images for regulatory reasons, even when the vehicle is parked.

This system supports various USB memory devices, USB hard drives and iPod players. Some USB devices may not be supported by this system.

Partitioned USB devices may not play correctly.

Some characters used in other lan- guages (Chinese, Japanese, etc.) may not appear properly in the display. Us- ing English language characters with a USB device is recommended.

General notes for USB use:

The USB device may not function when the passenger compartment tempera- ture is extremely high. Lower the tem- perature before use.

4-42 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

During cold weather or rainy days, the player may malfunction due to humid- ity. If this occurs, remove the USB de- vice and dehumidify or ventilate the USB player completely.

Do not connect a USB device if a con- nector, cable or USB port is wet. Allow the connector, cable, and USB port to dry completely before connecting the USB device. (Wait for 24 hours or more until it is dry.) If the connector and USB port are exposed to fluids other than water, evaporative residue may cause a short circuit between the connector pins and USB port. In this case, replace the cable and USB port. Otherwise damage to the USB device and a loss of function may occur.

If the cable is damaged (insulation cut, connectors cracked, contamination such as liquids, dust, dirt, etc. in the connectors), do not use the cable. Re- place the cable with a new one.

Do not put a USB device in a location where static electricity occurs, electri- cal noise is generated or hot air from the air conditioner blows directly on it. Doing so may cause the data stored on the USB device to be corrupted.

Notes for iPod use:

iPod is a trademark of Apple Inc., regis- tered in the U.S. and other countries.

Improperly plugging in the iPod may cause a checkmark to be displayed on and off (flickering). Always make sure that the iPod is connected properly.

An iPod nano (1st Generation) may remain in fast forward or rewind mode if it is connected during a seek operation. In this case, please manually reset the iPod.

An iPod nano (2nd Generation) will continue to fast-forward or rewind if it is disconnected during a seek operation.

An incorrect song title may appear when the Play Mode is changed while using an iPod nano (2nd Generation).

Audiobooks may not play in the same order as they appear on an iPod.

Large video files cause slow responses in an iPod. The vehicle center display may momentarily black out, but will soon recover.

If an iPod automatically selects large video files while in the shuffle mode, the vehicle center display may momen- tarily black out, but will soon recover.

Bluetooth streaming audio (if so equipped)

Some Bluetooth audio devices may not be recognized by the in-vehicle audio system.

It is necessary to set up the wireless con- nection between a compatible Bluetooth audio device and the in-vehicle Bluetooth module before using the Bluetooth audio.

Operating procedure of the Bluetooth au- dio will vary depending on the devices. Make sure how to operate your audio device be- fore using it with this system.

The Bluetooth audio may be stopped un- der the following conditions:

Receiving a call on the Hands-Free Phone System.

Checking the connection to the hands- free phone.

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-43

Do not place the Bluetooth audio device in an area surrounded by metal or far away from the in-vehicle Bluetooth module to prevent tone quality degradation and wireless con- nection disruption.

While an audio device is connected through the Bluetooth wireless connection, the battery power of the device may discharge quicker than usual.

This system supports the Bluetooth Audio Distribution Profile (A2DP, AVRCP).

BLUETOOTH is a trademark owned by Bluetooth SIG, Inc. and licensed to Visteon and Bosch.

1. PRESET ABC button 2. CD eject button 3. MENU button 4. CD insert slot 5. CD button 6. FMAM button

7. TUNE buttons 8. RPT button 9. PWR button/VOL control knob 10. RDM button 11. Station select (1 - 6) buttons 12. SEEK buttons

WHA1075

4-44 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

FM/AM RADIO WITH COMPACT DISC (CD) PLAYER (if so equipped)

For all operation precautions, see Audio opera- tion precautions in this section.

Audio main operation

Power button and VOL control knob

Place the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position, then press the PWR (power) button. If you listen to the radio with the engine not running, place the ignition switch in the ACC position. The mode (radio or CD) that was playing immediately before the system was turned off resumes play- ing.

When no CD is loaded, the radio comes on. Pressing the PWR button again turns the system off.

Turn the VOL control knob to the right to increase volume or to the left to decrease volume.

MENU button (BASS, TREBLE, FADE, BALANCE and CLOCK):

Press the MENU button to change the mode as follows:

BAS TRE FAD BAL CLOCK Audio BAS

To adjust Bass, Treble, Fade and Balance, press the MENU button until the desired mode appears in the display. Press the SEEK button to adjust Bass and Treble to the desired level. You can also use the SEEK button to adjust Fade and Balance modes. Fade adjusts the sound level between the front and rear speakers and Balance adjusts the sound between the right and left speakers.

Once you have adjusted the sound quality to the desired level, press the MENU button repeatedly until the radio or CD display reappears. Other- wise, the radio or CD display will automatically reappear after about 10 seconds.

NOTE:

If the clock is enabled, pressing the MENU button will change the mode as follows: BAS TRE FAD BAL CLOCK Hour adjustment Minute adjustment Audio BAS

For more information on setting the clock, see Clock set later in this section.

Clock operation

Press the MENU button until CLOCK is dis- played; use the SEEK button to turn the clock display on (CLK ON) or off (CLK OFF).

Clock set

If the clock is not displayed with the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position, you need to select the CLK ON mode. Press the MENU but- ton repeatedly until CLOCK is displayed. Use the SEEK button to enable CLK ON mode.

1. Press the MENU button repeatedly until CLOCK mode appears; press the SEEK button until CLK ON appears.

2. Press the MENU button again; the hours will start flashing.

3. Press the SEEK button or to adjust the hour.

4. Press the MENU button again; the display will switch to the minute adjustment mode.

5. The minutes will start flashing. Press SEEK

button or to adjust the minutes.

6. Press the MENU button again to exit the clock set mode.

The display will return to the regular clock display after 10 seconds, or press the MENU button again to return to the regular clock display.

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-45

Resetting the time

Hold the MENU button down and then press the TUNE or SEEK button; the time will reset as follows:

If the displayed minutes before the reset are in the range of :00 - :29, the hour displayed before the reset will stay the same and the minutes will be reset to :00.

If the displayed minutes before the reset are in the range of :30 - :59, the hour displayed before the reset will advance by one hour and the minutes will be reset to :00.

For example, if the MENU button and the TUNE or SEEK button are pressed while the time dis- played is between 8:00 and 8:29, the display will be reset to 8:00. If the buttons were pressed while the time was between 8:30 and 8:59, the display will be reset to 9:00. At the same time the display will return to the audio.

FM/AM radio operation FMAM button:

Press the FMAM button to change from AM FM reception.

The FM stereo indicator, ST, illuminates during FM stereo reception. When the stereo broadcast signal is weak, the radio automatically changes from stereo to monaural reception.

TUNE buttons:

Manual tuning

Press the TUNE or button for less than 0.5 seconds for manual tuning.

To move quickly through the channels, press and

hold either TUNE or button down for more than 1.5 seconds.

SEEK buttons:

SEEK tuning

Press the SEEK or button to seek through the frequencies. Seek tuning begins from low to high frequencies, or high to low frequencies, depending on which button is pressed, and stops at the next broadcasting sta- tion. Once the highest broadcasting station is reached, the radio continues in the seek mode at the lowest broadcasting station.

Station memory operations:

18 stations can be set for the FM and AM radio to the A, B and C preset button in any combination of AM or FM stations.

1. Press the PRESET ABC button to change between storage banks. The radio displays the icon A, B or C to indicate which set of presets are active.

2. Tune to the desired station using manual TUNE or SEEK tuning. Press and hold any of the desired station memory buttons (1 6) until a beep sound is heard. (The radio mutes when the select button is pressed.)

3. The channel indicator will then come on and the sound will resume. Programming is now complete.

4. Other buttons can be set in the same man- ner.

If the battery cable is disconnected, or if the fuse opens, the radio memory will be canceled. In that case, reset the desired stations.

Compact disc (CD) player operation

If the radio is already operating, it automatically turns off and the compact disc begins to play.

CD button:

When the CD button is pressed with a compact disc loaded and the radio playing, the radio turns off and the last used compact disc starts to play.

4-46 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

TUNE (rewind and fast

forward) buttons:

When the TUNE or button is pressed while the compact disc is playing, the compact disc plays at an increased speed while rewinding or fast forwarding. When the button is released, the compact disc returns to normal play speed.

SEEK buttons:

When is pressed while the compact disc is playing, the next track following the present one starts to play from the beginning. Press several times to skip several tracks. Each time the button is pressed, the CD ad- vances 1 additional track. The track number ap- pears in the display window. (When the last track on the compact disc is skipped, the first track is played.)

When is pressed, the track being played returns to the beginning. Press several times to skip back several tracks. Each time the button is pressed, the CD moves back one track.

SEEK (Scan CDs) button:

Press and hold the SEEK button for more than 1.5 seconds to scan through the first 10 seconds of a track on the compact disc. The SCAN icon is flashed during scan mode.

The scan mode is canceled once it scans through all the tracks on the disc, or if the SEEK or button is pressed during the scan mode.

RPT button:

When the RPT button is pressed while the com- pact disc is being played, the play pattern can be changed as follows:

1 Normal

1: The track that is currently playing will be re- peated.

RDM button:

When the RDM button is pressed while the com- pact disc is being played, the play pattern can be changed as follows:

RDM Normal

RDM: Tracks from the disc that is currently play- ing will be played randomly.

CD EJECT button:

When the button is pressed with a com- pact disc loaded, the compact disc will be ejected.

When the button is pressed while the compact disc is being played, the compact disc will eject and the system will turn off.

CD IN indicator:

CD IN indicator appears on the display when the CD is loaded with the system on.

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-47

1. CD eject button 2. XM button* 3. CD insert slot 4. Display screen 5. SEEK button 6. SCAN button

7. CAT button 8. BACK button 9. iPod MENU button 10.TUNE/SCROLL knob, ENTER/SETTING

button 11.AUX IN jack

12.Station select (1 - 6) buttons 13.RDM button 14.RPT button 15.DISP button 16.VOL (volume) knob / PWR (power)

button 17.CDAUX button 18.FMAM button

*No satellite radio reception is available when the XM button is pressed to access satellite radio stations unless optional satellite receiver and antenna are installed and an SiriusXM Satellite Radio service subscription is active. Satellite radio is not available in Alaska, Hawaii and Guam.

LHA2501

4-48 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

FM/AM/SAT RADIO WITH COMPACT DISC (CD) PLAYER (Type A) (if so equipped) For all operation precautions, see Audio opera- tion precautions in this section.

Audio main operation VOL (volume) knob / ON-OFF button:

Place the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position and press the VOL (volume) knob / ON-OFF button while the system is off to call up the mode that was playing immediately before the system was turned off.

To turn the system off, press the VOL (volume) knob / ON-OFF button.

Turn the VOL (volume) knob / ON-OFF button to adjust the volume.

SETTING button:

Press the SETTING button to show the Settings screen on the display. Turn the TUNE/SCROLL knob to navigate the options and then press the ENTER button to make a selection.

Bass, Treble, Balance and Fade

Increase or decrease the level of bass, treble, balance or fade. Balance controls the level of sound between the left and right speakers. Fade controls the level of sound between the front and rear speakers.

Speed Sens Vol. (Speed Sensitive Volume)

Speed Sensitive Volume adjusts the volume of the audio system as the vehicles driving speed changes. The feature can be turned off or set to a level of 1 to 5. Level 5 represents the highest degree of volume adjustment.

AUX Vol.

Choose a setting from 0 to +3 to control the boost of the incoming auxiliary device volume. A setting of 0 provides no additional boost in vol- ume. A setting of +3 provides the greatest boost in volume.

LHA2257 LHA2258

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-49

Brightness and Contrast

Adjust the brightness or contrast to adjust the appearance of the display screen.

Clock Adjust

Press the ENTER button to highlight the hours or minutes and then use the TUNE/SCROLL knob to adjust the value. Press the ENTER button again to set the value.

On-Screen Clock

Select ON or OFF to control whether or not the clock is shown in the upper right corner of the display screen.

RDS Display

Select ON or OFF to control whether or not RDS information is displayed on the screen while the radio is playing.

Language Select

Select the desired language for the system. Eng- lish, Spanish and French are the available lan- guages.

iPod MENU button

This button can only be used for iPod opera- tions. See iPod player operation without Navi- gation System later in this section for details about the function of this button.

FM/AM/SAT radio operation

FMAM button:

Press the FMAM button to change the band as follows:

AM FM1 FM2 AM

If another audio source is playing when the FMAM button is pressed, the audio source play- ing will automatically be turned off and the last radio station played will begin playing.

The FM stereo indicator (STEREO) is shown on the screen during FM stereo reception. When the stereo broadcast signal is weak, the radio auto- matically changes from stereo to monaural re- ception.

LHA2259

4-50 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

XM band select:

Press the XM button to change the band as follows:

XM1* XM2* XM3* XM1 (satellite, if so equipped)

When the XM button is pressed while the ignition switch is in the ACC or ON position, the radio will come on at the station last played.

The last station played will also come on when the VOL/ONOFF control knob is pressed ON.

*When the XM button is pressed, the satellite radio reception will not be available unless an optional satellite receiver and antenna are in- stalled and a SiriusXM Satellite Radio service subscription is active. Satellite radio is not avail- able in Alaska, Hawaii and Guam.

If a compact disc is playing when the XM button is pressed, the compact disc will automatically be turned off and the last radio station played will come on.

TUNE/SCROLL knob (Tuning):

Turn the TUNE/SCROLL knob to the left or right for manual tuning.

SEEK tuning:

Press the SEEKCAT button or to tune from low to high or high to low frequencies and to stop at the next broadcasting station.

SCAN tuning:

Press the SCAN button to stop at each broad- casting station for 5 seconds. SCAN will appear on the screen while the radio is scan tuning.

Pressing the button again during this 5 second period will stop SCAN tuning and the radio will remain tuned to that station. If the SCAN button is not pressed within 5 seconds, SCAN tuning moves to the next station.

1 to 6 Station memory operations:

Six stations can be set for the AM band. Twelve stations can be set for the FM band (6 for FM1, 6 for FM2). Eighteen channels can be set for the satellite radio (6 for XM1, 6 for XM2, 6 for XM3).

1. Choose the radio band AM, FM1 or FM2 using the FMAM select button, or choose the satellite band XM1, XM2 or XM3 using the XM button.

2. Tune to the desired station using manual, SEEK or SCAN tuning. Press and hold any of the desired station memory buttons (1

6) until the preset number is updated on the display and the sound is briefly muted.

3. The channel indicator will then come on and the sound will resume. Programming is now complete.

4. Other buttons can be set in the same man- ner.

If the battery cable is disconnected, or if the fuse opens, the radio memory will be canceled. In that case, reset the desired stations.

Compact disc (CD) player operation If the radio is already operating, it automatically turns off and the compact disc begins to play.

CDAUX button:

With a CD loaded, press the CDAUX button until the CD mode is displayed on the screen.

CD/MP3 display mode:

While listening to an MP3/WMA CD, certain text may be displayed on the screen if the CD has been encoded with text information. Depending on how the MP3/WMA CD is encoded, informa- tion such as Artist, Song and Folder will be dis- played.

The track number and the total number of tracks in the current folder or on the current disc are displayed on the screen as well.

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-51

SEEK/CAT (Reverse or

Fast Forward) button:

Press and hold the SEEK/CAT button or for 1.5 seconds while the compact disc is playing to reverse or fast forward the track being played. The compact disc plays at an in- creased speed while reversing or fast forwarding. When the button is released, the compact disc returns to normal play speed.

SEEK/CAT button:

Press the SEEK/CAT button while a CD or MP3/WMA CD is playing to return to the begin- ning of the current track. Press the SEEK/CAT button several times to skip backward sev- eral tracks.

Press the SEEK/CAT button while a CD or MP3/WMA CD is playing to advance one track. Press the SEEK/CAT button several times to skip forward several tracks. If the last track on a CD is skipped, the first track on the disc is played. If the last track in a folder of an MP3/WMA CD is skipped, the first track of the next folder is played.

TUNE/SCROLL knob (MP3/WMA CD only):

If an MP3/WMA CD with multiple folders is play- ing, turn the TUNE/SCROLL knob to change folders. Turn the knob to the left to skip back a folder. Turn the knob to the right to skip ahead a folder.

RPT button:

When the RPT button is pressed while a com- pact disc is playing, the play pattern can be changed as follows:

CD:

1 Track Repeat OFF

CD with MP3 or WMA:

1 Folder Repeat 1 Track Repeat OFF

1 Track Repeat: the current track will be repeated.

1 Folder Repeat: the current folder will be re- peated.

OFF: No repeat play pattern is applied. The indi- cator on the display will turn off.

The current play pattern of the CD is displayed on the screen unless no pattern is applied.

RDM button:

When the RDM button is pressed while a com- pact disc is playing, the play pattern can be changed as follows:

CD:

1 Disc Random OFF

CD with MP3 or WMA:

1 Disc Random 1 Folder Random OFF

1 Disc Random: all tracks on the disc will be played randomly.

1 Folder Random: all tracks in the current folder will be played randomly.

OFF: No random play pattern is applied. The indicator on the display will turn off.

The current play pattern of the CD is displayed on the screen unless no pattern is applied.

CDAUX button:

The AUX IN jack is located on the CD player. The AUX IN audio input jack accepts any standard analog audio input such as from a portable cas- sette tape/CD player, MP3 player or a laptop computer.

4-52 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Press the CDAUX button to play a compatible device plugged into the AUX IN jack. The CDAUX button is also used to switch the audio system to a source plugged into the USB input jack in the center console. When a device is plugged into the AUX IN jack while another de- vice is plugged into the USB input jack, the CDAUX button is used to toggle between the two functions.

For more information about the USB input jack, see USB interface (models without Navigation System) in this section.

EJECT button:

When the button is pressed with a com- pact disc loaded, the compact disc will eject and the last source will be played.

When the button is pressed twice with a compact disc loaded, the compact disc will be ejected further for easier CD removal. If the disc is not removed within 20 seconds, the disc will reload.

Additional features For more information about the iPod player available with this system, see iPod player operation without Navigation System in this sec- tion.

For more information about the USB interface available with this system, see USB interface (models without Navigation System) in this sec- tion.

For more information about the Bluetooth audio interface available with this system, see Bluetooth streaming audio without Navigation System in this section.

For more information about the Pandora audio feature available with this system, see Pan- dora audio in this section.

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-53

1. CD eject button 2. FM-AM button 3. AUX button 4. CD insert slot 5. BACK button

6. TUNE knob / AUDIO button 7. Display screen 8. ON-OFF button / VOL (volume) 9. Backward seek button and

Forward seek button

10.CD button 11.XM button*

*No satellite radio reception is available when the XM button is pressed to access satellite radio stations unless optional satellite receiver and antenna are installed and an SiriusXM Satellite Radio service subscription is active. Satellite radio is not available in Alaska, Hawaii and Guam.

FM/AM/SAT RADIO WITH COMPACT DISC (CD) PLAYER (Type B) (if so equipped)

For all operation precautions, see Audio opera- tion precautions in this section.

Audio main operation

VOL (volume) / ON-OFF button:

Place the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position and press the ON-OFF button while the system is off to call up the mode (radio, CD, AUX, Bluetooth audio USB or iPod) that was play- ing immediately before the system was turned off.

To turn the system off, press the ON-OFF button.

Turn the VOL (volume) control knob to adjust the volume.

Type B LHA2500

4-54 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

This vehicle may be equipped with Speed Sen- sitive Volume. When this feature is active, the audio volume changes as the driving speed changes.

Audio settings:

1. Press the MENU button.

2. Select the Settings key.

3. Select the Audio key.

Use the touchscreen to adjust the following items to the desired setting:

Bass, Treble, Balance and Fade: Controls the sound of the audio system. Balance adjusts the sound between the left and right speakers. Fade adjusts the sound between the front and rear speakers.

Speed Sensitive Vol.: Controls the level to which the volume is adjusted as the vehicles driving speed changes. Choose a setting or choose 0 to disable the feature en- tirely.

AUX Volume Level: Controls the volume level of incoming sound when an auxiliary device is connected to the system. Available options are Low, Medium and High.

LHA2261 LHA2262

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-55

XM settings:

To view the XM settings:

1. Press the MENU button.

2. Select the Settings key.

3. Select the XM key.

The signal strength, activation status and other information are displayed on the screen.

FM/AM/SAT radio operation

FMAM button:

Press the FMAM button to change the band as follows:

AM FM1 FM2 AM

If another audio source is playing when the FMAM button is pressed, the audio source play- ing will automatically be turned off and the last radio station played will begin playing.

The FM stereo indicator (ST) is shown on the screen during FM stereo reception. When the stereo broadcast signal is weak, the radio auto- matically changes from stereo to monaural re- ception.

XM band select:

Pressing the XM button will change the band as follows:

XM1* XM2* XM3* XM1* (satellite, if so equipped)

When the XM button is pressed while the ignition switch is in the ACC or ON position, the radio will come on at the last station played.

The last station played will also come on when the VOL/ON-OFF control knob is pressed to turn the radio on.

*When the XM button is pressed, the satellite radio mode will be skipped unless an optional satellite receiver and antenna are installed and a SiriusXM Satellite Radio service subscription is active. Satellite radio is not available in Alaska, Hawaii and Guam.

If a compact disc is playing when the XM button is pressed, the compact disc will automatically be turned off and the last radio station played will come on.

LHA2303

4-56 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

While the radio is in XM mode, the operation can be controlled through the touchscreen. Touch the Channels key to display a list of channels. Touch a channel displayed on the list to change to that channel. Touch the Categories key to display a list of categories. Touch a category displayed on the list to display options within that category.

Tuning with the touchscreen:

When in AM or FM mode, the radio can be tuned using the touchscreen. To bring up the visual tuner, touch the Tune key on the lower right corner of the screen. A screen appears with a bar running from low frequencies on the left to high frequencies on the right. Touch the screen at the location of the frequency you wish to tune and the station will change to that frequency. To return to the regular radio display screen, touch the OK key.

Tuning with the TUNE knob:

The radio can also be manually tuned using the TUNE knob. When in FM or AM mode, turn the TUNE knob to the left for lower frequencies or to the right for higher frequencies. When in XM mode, turn the TUNE knob to change the chan- nel.

SEEK tuning:

When in FM or AM mode, press the seek

buttons or to tune from low to high or high to low frequencies and to stop at the next broadcasting station.

When in XM mode, press the seek buttons or to change the category.

LHA1492 LHA1489

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-57

1 to 6 Station memory operations:

Twelve stations can be set for the FM band (6 for FM1, 6 for FM2) and six stations can be set for the AM band. Eighteen stations can be set for the XM band (6 for XM1, 6 for XM2, 6 for XM3).

1. Choose the radio band AM, FM1 or FM2 using the FMAM select button or choose the radio band XM1, XM2 or XM3 using the XM button.

2. Tune to the desired station using manual or seek tuning. Press and hold any of the de- sired station memory buttons (1 6) until a beep sound is heard.

3. The channel indicator will then come on and the sound will resume. Programming is now complete.

4. Other buttons can be set in the same man- ner.

If the battery cable is disconnected or if the fuse opens, the radio memory will be canceled. In that case, reset the desired stations.

Presets can also be selected by touching the desired preset number on the screen.

Compact disc (CD) player operation If the radio is already operating, it automatically turns off and the compact disc begins to play.

CD button:

When the CD button is pressed with the system off and the compact disc loaded, the system will turn on and the compact disc will start to play.

When the CD button is pressed with a compact disc loaded and the radio playing, the radio will automatically be turned off and the compact disc will start to play.

CD/MP3 display mode

While listening to a CD or an MP3/WMA CD, certain text may be displayed (when a CD en- coded with text is being used). Depending on how the CD or MP3/WMA CD is encoded, the text is displayed listing the artist, album and song title.

There are other keys displayed on the screen when a CD is playing:

LHA2263 LHA1488

4-58 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Random: Touch the Random key to apply a random play pattern to the CD. When the random mode is active, the icon will be displayed to the left of the song title. If an MP3 CD is playing, touch- ing Random alternates between randomly play- ing songs within the current folder and songs from the CD as a whole. The icon is dis- played to the left of the song title or folder name to denote which pattern is applied. To cancel Random mode, touch the Random key until no icon is displayed.

Repeat: Touch the Repeat key to apply a repeat play pattern to the CD. When the repeat mode is active, the icon will be displayed to the left of the song title. If an MP3 CD is playing, touch- ing Repeat alternates between repeating the current song and repeating the current folder. The icon is displayed to the left of the song title or folder name to denote which pattern is applied. To cancel Repeat mode, touch the Re- peat key until no icon is displayed.

Browse: Touch the Browse key to display the titles on the CD in list format. Touch the title of a song in the list to begin playing that song. If an MP3 CD is

playing, touching the Browse key will also list the folders on the disc. Follow the procedure for selecting a song with the touchscreen to choose a folder.

SEEK (Reverse or Fast

Forward) buttons:

Press and hold the seek buttons or for 1.5 seconds while the compact disc is playing to reverse or fast forward the track being played. The compact disc plays at an increased speed while reversing or fast forwarding. When the but- ton is released, the compact disc returns to nor- mal play speed.

SEEK buttons:

Press the seek button while a CD or MP3/WMA CD is playing to return to the begin- ning of the current track. Press the seek button several times to skip backward sev- eral tracks.

Press the seek button while a CD or MP3/WMA CD is playing to advance one track. Press the seek button several times to skip forward several tracks. If the last track on a CD is skipped, the first track on the disc is played. If the last track in a folder of an MP3/WMA CD is skipped, the first track of the next folder is played.

LHA1490 LHA1491

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-59

AUX button:

The AUX IN audio input jack is located in the center console 1 and accepts any standard analog audio input such as from a portable cas- sette tape/CD player, MP3 player or a laptop computer.

Press the AUX button to play a compatible device plugged into the AUX IN jack.

EJECT button:

When the button is pressed with a com- pact disc loaded, the compact disc will eject and the last source will be played.

When the button is pressed twice with a compact disc loaded, the compact disc will be ejected further for easier CD removal. If the disc is not removed within 10 seconds, the disc will reload.

Additional features For more information about the iPod player available with this system, see iPod player operation with Navigation System in this section.

For more information about the USB interface available with this system, see USB interface (models with Navigation System) in this section.

For more information about the Bluetooth audio interface available with this system, see Bluetooth streaming audio with Navigation System in this section.

For more information about the Pandora audio feature available with this system, see Pan- dora audio in this section.

LHA2578 LHA1493

4-60 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

USB INTERFACE (models without Navigation System) (if so equipped)

Connecting a device to the USB input jack

CAUTION

Depending on size and shape of USB device, the console lid may not fully close. Do not force console lid closed as this may damage USB device.

Do not force the USB device into the USB port. Inserting the USB device tilted or up-side-down into the port may damage the USB device and the port. Make sure that the USB device is con- nected correctly into the USB port. (Some USB devices come with a mark as a guide. Make sure that the mark is facing the correct direction be- fore inserting the device.)

Do not locate objects near the USB de- vice to prevent the objects from leaning on the USB device and the port. Pres- sure from the objects may damage the USB device and the port.

The USB input jack is located inside the center console 1 . Insert the USB device into the jack.

When a compatible storage device is plugged into the jack, compatible audio files on the stor- age device can be played through the vehicles audio system.

Audio file operation

CDAUX button:

Place the ignition switch in the ON or ACC position and press the CDAUX button to switch to the USB input mode. If a CD is playing or another audio source is plugged in through the

AUX IN jack on the radio, the CDAUX button toggles between the three sources.

Play information

Information about the audio files being played can be displayed on the display screen of the vehicles audio system. Depending on how the audio files are encoded, information such as Folder, Song and Artist will be displayed.

The track number and number of total tracks in the folder are displayed on the screen as well.

SEEK/CAT (Reverse or

Fast Forward) buttons:

Press and hold the SEEK/CAT buttons or for 1.5 seconds while an audio file on the USB device is playing to reverse or fast forward the track being played. The track plays at an increased speed while reversing or fast for- warding. When the button is released, the audio file returns to normal play speed.

SEEK/CAT buttons:

Press the SEEK/CAT button while an au- dio file on the USB device is playing to return to the beginning of the current track. Press the SEEK/CAT button several times to skip backward several tracks.

LHA2577

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-61

Press the SEEK/CAT button while an au- dio file on the USB device is playing to advance one track. Press the SEEK/CAT button several times to skip forward several tracks. If the last track in a folder on the USB device is skipped, the first track of the next folder is played.

RDM button:

When the RDM button is pressed while an audio file on the USB device is playing, the play pattern can be changed as follows:

All Random 1 Folder Random OFF

All Random: all tracks on the USB device will be played randomly.

1 Folder Random: all tracks in the current folder will be played randomly.

OFF: No random play pattern is applied. The indicator on the display will turn off.

The current play pattern of the USB device is displayed on the screen unless no pattern is applied.

RPT button:

When the RPT button is pressed while an audio file on the USB device is playing, the play pattern can be changed as follows:

1 Folder Repeat 1 Track Repeat OFF

1 Track Repeat: the current track will be re- peated.

1 Folder Repeat: the current folder will be re- peated.

OFF: No repeat play pattern is applied. The indi- cator on the display will turn off.

The current play pattern of the USB device is displayed on the screen unless no pattern is applied.

TUNE/SCROLL knob:

If there are multiple folders with audio files on the USB device, turn the TUNE/SCROLL knob to change folders. Turn the knob to the left to skip back a folder. Turn the knob to the right to skip ahead a folder. If there is only one folder of audio files on the USB device, turning the TUNE/SCROLL knob in either direction will re- turn to the first track on the USB device.

USB INTERFACE (models with Navigation System)

Connecting a device to the USB input jack

CAUTION

Depending on size and shape of USB device, the console lid may not fully close. Do not force console lid closed as this may damage USB device.

LHA2577

4-62 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Do not force the USB device into the USB port. Inserting the USB device tilted or up-side-down into the port may damage the USB device and the port. Make sure that the USB device is con- nected correctly into the USB port. (Some USB devices come with a mark as a guide. Make sure that the mark is facing the correct direction be- fore inserting the device.)

Do not locate objects near the USB de- vice to prevent the objects from leaning on the USB device and the port. Pres- sure from the objects may damage the USB device and the port.

The USB input jack is located inside the center console 1 . Insert the USB device into the jack.

When a compatible storage device is plugged into the jack, compatible audio files on the stor- age device can be played through the vehicles audio system.

Audio file operation AUX button:

Place the ignition switch in the ON or ACC position and press the AUX button to switch to the USB input mode. If another audio source is playing and a USB memory device is inserted, press the AUX button repeatedly until the center display changes to the USB memory mode.

If the system has been turned off while the USB memory was playing, push the ON-OFF/VOL control knob to restart the USB memory.

Play information:

Information about the audio files being played is shown on the display screen of the vehicles audio system. Touch Browse to display the list of folders and files on the USB device. Touch the name of a song on the screen to begin playing that song.

Seeking buttons:

Press the button while an audio file on the USB device is playing to return to the beginning of the current track. Press the button sev- eral times to skip backward several tracks.

LHA1496

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-63

Press the button while an audio file on the USB device is playing to advance one track. Press the button several times to skip for- ward several tracks. If the last track in a folder on the USB device is skipped, the first track of the next folder is played.

Random and repeat play mode:

While files on a USB device are playing, the play pattern can be altered so that songs are repeated or played randomly.

Random: Touch the Random key to apply a random play pattern to the USB device. When the random mode is active, the icon is displayed to the left of the song title or album name to denote which random pattern is applied. To cancel Ran- dom mode, touch the Random key until no icon is displayed.

Repeat: Touch the Repeat key to apply a repeat play pattern to the USB device. When the repeat mode is active, the icon is displayed to the left of the song title or album name to denote which repeat pattern is applied. To cancel Repeat mode, touch the Repeat key until no icon is displayed.

iPod* PLAYER OPERATION WITHOUT NAVIGATION SYSTEM (if so equipped)

Connecting iPod

CAUTION

Depending on size and shape of the iPod and iPod cable, the console lid may not fully close. Do not force con- sole lid closed as this may damage the iPod and iPod cable.

Do not force the iPod cable into the USB port. Inserting the USB device tilted or up-side-down into the port may damage the iPod cable and the port. Make sure that the iPod cable is con- nected correctly into the USB port. (Some iPod cables come with a mark as a guide. Make sure that the mark is facing the correct direction be- fore inserting the iPod cable.)

Do not locate objects near the iPod cable to prevent the objects from lean- ing on the iPod cable and the port. Pressure from the objects may damage the iPod cable and the port.

To connect an iPod to the vehicle so that the iPod can be controlled with the audio system controls and display screen, use the USB jack located in the center console 1 . Connect the iPod-specific end of the cable to the iPod and the USB end of the cable to the USB jack on the vehicle. If your iPod supports charging via a USB connection, its battery will be charged while connected to the vehicle with the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position.

While connected to the vehicle, the iPod can only be operated by the vehicle audio controls.

LHA2577

4-64 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

To disconnect the iPod from the vehicle, re- move the USB end of the cable from the USB jack on the vehicle, then remove the cable from the iPod.

* iPod is a trademark of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries.

Compatibility

The following models are compatible:

iPod 5th Generation (firmware version 1.3 or later)

iPod Classic (80GB) (firmware version 1.1.2PC or later)

iPod Classic (120GB) (firmware version 2.0.1PC or later)

iPod Nano - 1st generation (firmware ver- sion 1.3.1 or later)

iPod Nano - 2nd generation (firmware ver- sion 1.1.3 or later)

iPod Nano - 3rd generation (firmware ver- sion 1.1.3PC or later)

iPod Nano - 4th generation (firmware ver- sion 1.0PC or later)

iPod Nano - 5th generation (8GB) (firm- ware version 1.0.2PC or later)

iPod Nano - 5th generation (16GB) (firm- ware version 1.0.1PC or later)

iPod Nano - 6th generation (8GB) (firm- ware version 1.2PC or later)

iPod Nano - 6th generation (8GB) (firm- ware version 1.1PC or later)

iPod Touch - 1st generation (firmware ver- sion 2.2.1 or later)

iPod Touch - 2nd generation (firmware version 2.2.1 or later)

iPod Touch - 3rd generation (firmware ver- sion 3.1.3 or later)

iPod Touch - 4th generation (firmware ver- sion 4.3.5 or later)

iPhone 3G (firmware version 4.1 or later)

iPhone 3GS (firmware version 4.3 or later)

iPhone 4 (firmware version 5.0 or later)

iPhone 4S (firmware version 5.1 or later)

iPad (firmware version 4.3.2 or later)

iPad 2 (firmware version 4.3.3 or later)

Make sure that your iPod firmware is updated to the version indicated above.

Audio main operation Place the ignition switch to the ACC or ON position. Then, press the CDAUX or iPod MENU button repeatedly to switch to the iPod mode.

If the audio system is turned off while the iPod is playing, the iPod plays when the audio system is turned back on.

If the audio system is off, pressing the CDAUX or iPod MENU button turns the audio system on and plays the iPod.

If the audio system is on, the audio system auto- matically begins playing tracks from the iPod when it is plugged into the jack.

iPod MENU button:

Press the iPod MENU button while the iPod is connected to show the iPod operation menu on the audio display. Scroll through the menu list using the TUNESCROLL control dial. Press EN- TER to select a menu item. Items in the iPod menu appear on the display in the following or- der:

Now playing

Playlists

Artists

Albums

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-65

Songs

Podcasts

Genres

Composers

Audiobooks

Shuffle songs

For more information about each item, see the iPod Owners Manual.

SEEK/CAT buttons:

Press the SEEK/CAT buttons or to skip backward or forward one track.

Press and hold the SEEK/CAT buttons or for 1.5 seconds while a track is playing to reverse or fast forward the track being played. The track plays at an increased speed while reversing or fast forwarding. When the button is released, the track returns to normal play speed.

REPEAT (RPT):

When the RPT button is pressed while a track is being played, the play pattern can be changed as follows:

Repeat Off 1 Track Repeat All Repeat Repeat Off

1 Track Repeat: the current track will be re- peated.

All Repeat: all songs in the current list are re- peated.

Repeat Off: no repeat play pattern is applied.

RANDOM (RDM):

When the RDM button is pressed while a track is being played, the play pattern can be changed as follows:

Shuffle Off Track Shuffle Album Shuffle Shuffle Off

Track Shuffle: the tracks in the current list will be played randomly.

Album Shuffle: the albums in the current list will be played randomly.

Shuffle Off: no random play pattern is applied.

BACK button:

When the BACK button is pressed, it returns to the previous menu.

iPod* PLAYER OPERATION WITH NAVIGATION SYSTEM (if so equipped)

Connecting iPod

CAUTION

Depending on size and shape of the iPod and iPod cable, the console lid may not fully close. Do not force con- sole lid closed as this may damage the iPod and iPod cable.

LHA2577

4-66 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Do not force the iPod cable into the USB port. Inserting the USB device tilted or up-side-down into the port may damage the iPod cable and the port. Make sure that the iPod cable is con- nected correctly into the USB port. (Some iPod cables come with a mark as a guide. Make sure that the mark is facing the correct direction be- fore inserting the iPod cable.)

Do not locate objects near the iPod cable to prevent the objects from lean- ing on the iPod cable and the port. Pressure from the objects may damage the iPod cable and the port.

To connect an iPod to the vehicle so that the iPod can be controlled with the audio system controls and display screen, use the USB jack located in the center console 1 . Connect the iPod-specific end of the cable to the iPod and the USB end of the cable to the USB jack on the vehicle. If your iPod supports charging via a USB connection, its battery will be charged while connected to the vehicle with the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position.

While connected to the vehicle, the iPod can only be operated by the vehicle audio controls.

To disconnect the iPod from the vehicle, re- move the USB end of the cable from the USB jack on the vehicle, then remove the cable from the iPod.

* iPod is a trademark of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries.

Compatibility

The following models are compatible:

iPod 5th Generation (firmware version 1.2.3 or later)

iPod Classic (firmware version 1.1.1 or later)

iPod Touch (firmware version 2.0.0 or later)*

iPod Nano - 1st generation (firmware ver- sion 1.3.1 or later)

iPod Nano - 2nd generation (firmware ver- sion 1.1.3 or later)

iPod Nano - 3rd generation (firmware ver- sion 1.1.3 or later)

iPod Nano - 4th generation (firmware ver- sion 1.0.4 or later)

iPod Nano - 5th generation (firmware ver- sion 1.0.1 or later)

* Some features of this iPod may not be fully functional.

Make sure that your iPod firmware is updated to the version indicated above.

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-67

Audio main operation Place the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position. Press the AUX button repeatedly to switch to the iPod mode.

If the system has been turned off while the iPod was playing, pressing the VOL/ONOFF control knob will start the iPod.

AUX button:

When the AUX button is pressed with the system off and the iPod connected, the system will turn on. If another audio source is playing and the iPod is connected, press the AUX button re- peatedly until the center display changes to the iPod mode.

Interface:

The interface for iPod operation shown on the vehicles audio system display screen is similar to the iPod interface. Use the touchscreen, BACK button or the scrolling knob to navigate the menus on the screen.

When the iPod is playing, touch the Menu key to bring up the iPod interface.

Depending on the iPod model, the following items may be available on the menu list screen. For further information about each item, see the iPod Owners Manual.

LHA1494 LHA1495

4-68 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Playlists

Artists

Albums

Genres

Songs

Composers

Audiobooks

Podcasts

Random and repeat play mode:

While the iPod is playing, the play pattern can be altered so that songs are repeated or played randomly.

Random: Touch the Random key to apply a random play pattern to the iPod. When the random mode is active, the icon is displayed to the left of the song title or album name to denote which random pattern is applied. To cancel Random mode, touch the Random key until no icon is displayed.

Repeat: Touch the Repeat key to apply a repeat play pattern to the iPod. When the repeat mode is active, the icon is displayed to the left of the song title or album name to denote which repeat pattern is applied. To cancel Repeat mode, touch the Repeat key until no icon is displayed.

Seek buttons:

Press the seek button or to skip backward or forward one track.

Press and hold the seek button or for 1.5 seconds while a track is playing to reverse or fast forward the track being played. The track plays at an increased speed while reversing or fast forwarding. When the button is released, the track returns to normal play speed.

Scrolling menus:

While navigating long lists of artists, albums or songs in the music menu, it is possible to scroll the list by the first character in the name. To activate character indexing, touch and hold the A-Z key in the upper right corner of the screen. Turn the TUNE knob to choose the number or letter to jump to in the list and then press the ENTER button.

If no character is selected after two seconds, the display returns to normal.

LHA2279

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-69

BLUETOOTH STREAMING AUDIO WITHOUT NAVIGATION SYSTEM (if so equipped) If you have a compatible Bluetooth audio de- vice that is capable of playing audio files, the device can be connected to the vehicles audio system so that the audio files on the device play through the vehicles speakers.

Connecting Bluetooth audio To connect your Bluetooth audio device to the vehicle, follow the procedure below:

1. Press the SETTING button.

2. Select the Bluetooth key.

3. Select the Add Telephone or Device key. This same screen can be accessed to re- move, replace or select a different Bluetooth device.

4. The system acknowledges the command and asks you to initiate connecting from the phone handset. The connecting procedure of the cellular phone varies according to each cellular phone model. See the cellular phone Owners Manual for details. You can also visit www.nissanusa.com/bluetooth for instructions on connecting NISSAN recom- mended cellular phones.

LHA2257 LHA2274

4-70 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Audio main operation To switch to the Bluetooth audio mode, press the CDAUX button repeatedly until the Bluetooth audio mode is displayed on the screen.

The controls for the Bluetooth audio are dis- played on the screen. Use the Preset 3 button for play and the Preset 4 button for pause.

BLUETOOTH STREAMING AUDIO WITH NAVIGATION SYSTEM (if so equipped) If you have a compatible Bluetooth audio de- vice that is capable of playing audio files, the device can be connected to the vehicles audio system so that the audio files on the device play through the vehicles speakers.

Connecting Bluetooth audio To connect your Bluetooth audio device to the vehicle, follow the procedure below:

1. Press the MENU button.

2. Select the Settings key.

LHA2292 LHA2253

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-71

3. Select the Phone & Bluetooth key. 4. Select the Connect New Device key.

5. The system acknowledges the command and asks you to initiate connecting from the phone handset. The connecting procedure of the cellular phone varies according to each cellular phone model. See the cellular phone Owners Manual for details. You can also visit www.nissanusa.com/bluetooth for instructions on connecting NISSAN recom- mended cellular phones.

Audio main operation

To switch to the Bluetooth audio mode, press the AUX button repeatedly until the Bluetooth audio mode is displayed on the screen.

The controls for the Bluetooth audio are dis- played on the screen.

PANDORA AUDIO (United States only) (if so equipped)

The vehicles audio system is capable of playing audio streaming through a compatible, USB- connected audio device using the Pandora mu- sic service.

Connecting a device for use with Pandora audio

Devices capable of streaming Pandora audio can be connected to the vehicles audio system via the USB input jack. The USB input jack is located on the center console beneath the heater and air conditioner controls.

Launch the Pandora application on the phone and then connect with the USB jack. Once con- nected, the Pandora controls will be displayed on the control panel display screen.

LHA2248 LHA2265

4-72 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Compatibility The following iPhone models are compatible with the system:

iPhone 3GS

iPhone 4

iPhone 4S

The latest Pandora application should be in- stalled on the phone.

Audio main operation

Models without Navigation System:

To switch to the Pandora audio mode, press the CD-AUX button repeatedly until the Pan- dora audio mode is displayed on the screen.

The controls for the Pandora audio are dis- played on the screen. Press the audio preset 3 button to pause or play the music.

Press the audio preset 5 button to select (thumbs up). Press the audio preset 4 button to select (thumbs down).

NOTE:

There is a limit of six skips per station per hour. If a (thumbs down) is given after the skip limit has been reached, the current track will continue to play but the feedback will be saved.

Models with Navigation System:

To switch to the Pandora audio mode, press the AUX button repeatedly until the Pandora audio mode is displayed on the screen.

Models without Navigation System LHA2283

Models with Navigation System: LHA2269

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-73

The controls for the Pandora audio are dis- played on the screen. Touch the keys on the screen to play or pause the audio. Touch the key to select thumbs up or the key to select thumbs down.

NOTE:

There is a limit of six skips per station per hour. If a (thumbs down) is given after the skip limit has been reached, the current track will continue to play but the feedback will be saved.

Pandora audio settings (models with Navigation System only) To adjust the Pandora audio settings, select the Menu key.

Station List Select to display a list of available Pandora stations.

Bookmark Select to bookmark the current station.

Delete Station Select to remove the current station.

CD CARE AND CLEANING

Handle a CD by its edges. Do not bend the disc. Never touch the surface of the disc.

Always place the discs in the storage case when they are not being used.

To clean a disc, wipe the surface from the center to the outer edge using a clean, soft cloth. Do not wipe the disc using a circular motion.

Do not use a conventional record cleaner or alcohol intended for industrial use.

LHA2270 LHA0049

4-74 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

A new disc may be rough on the inner and outer edges. Remove the rough edges by rubbing the inner and outer edges with the side of a pen or pencil as illustrated.

1. Volume control switch 2. MODE select switch 3. Tuning switch

STEERING WHEEL SWITCH FOR AUDIO CONTROL (if so equipped)

The audio system can be operated using the controls on the steering wheel.

MODE select switch

Push the mode select switch to change the mode in the following sequence:

AM FM1 FM2 XM1 (satellite radio, if so equipped) XM2 (satellite radio, if so equipped)

XM3 (satellite radio, if so equipped) CD* USB/iPod* (if so equipped) Bluetooth Au- dio* AUX* AM.

* These modes are only available when compat- ible media storage is inserted into the device or connected to the system.

Volume control switch Push the volume control switch to increase or decrease the volume.

Tuning switch

While the display is showing a map or audio screen, tilt the Menu Control switch upward or downward to select a station, track, CD or folder. For most audio sources, tilting the switch up/down for more than 1.5 seconds provides a different function than a tilting up/down for less than 1.5 seconds.

AM and FM:

Tilt up/down for less than 1.5 seconds to increase or decrease the preset station.

Tilt up/down for more than 1.5 seconds to seek up or down to the next station.

Press the ENTER button to show the list of preset stations.

LHA2559

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-75

XM (if so equipped):

Tilt up/down for less than 1.5 seconds to increase or decrease the preset station.

Tilt up/down for more than 1.5 seconds to go to the next or previous category.

Press the ENTER button to show the XM Menu.

iPod (if so equipped):

Tilt up/down for less than 1.5 seconds to increase or decrease the track number.

Press the ENTER button to show the iPod Menu.

CD:

Tilt up/down for less than 1.5 seconds to increase or decrease the track number.

Tilt up/down for more than 1.5 seconds to increase or decrease the folder number (if playing compressed audio files).

Press the ENTER button to show the CD Menu.

USB (if so equipped):

Tilt up/down for less than 1.5 seconds to increase or decrease the track number.

Tilt up/down for more than 1.5 seconds to increase or decrease the folder number.

Press the ENTER button to show the USB Menu.

Bluetooth Audio:

Tilt up/down for less than 1.5 seconds to skip ahead or back to the next song.

Tilt up/down for more than 1.5 seconds to reverse or fast forward the current song.

Pandora Audio (if so equipped):

Tilt up for less than 1.5 seconds to input thumbs up for the current song.

Tilt down for less than 1.5 seconds to input thumbs down for the current song.

Tilt up for more than 1.5 seconds to skip to the next song (if the maximum of six skips per station per hour has not been exceeded).

ANTENNA The antenna cannot be shortened, but can be removed. When you need to remove the antenna, turn the antenna rod counterclockwise.

To install the antenna rod, turn the antenna clock- wise. Tighten the antenna rod to specification using a suitable tool such as an open-end wrench. The antenna rod tightening specification is 3.4 3.6 Nm (30 32 in-lb). Do not use pliers to tighten the antenna as they can leave marks on the antenna surface. The antenna rod cannot be hand tightened to the proper specification.

CAUTION

Always properly tighten the antenna rod during installation or the antenna rod may break during vehicle operation.

4-76 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

When installing a CB, ham radio or car phone in your vehicle, be sure to observe the following precautions; otherwise, the new equipment may adversely affect the engine control system and other electronic parts.

WARNING

A cellular phone should not be used for any purpose while driving so full atten- tion may be given to vehicle operation. Some jurisdictions prohibit the use of cellular phones while driving.

If you must make a call while your ve- hicle is in motion, the hands free cellu- lar phone operational mode (if so equipped) is highly recommended. Ex- ercise extreme caution at all times so full attention may be given to vehicle operation.

If you are unable to devote full attention to vehicle operation while talking on the phone, pull off the road to a safe location and stop your vehicle.

CAUTION

Keep the antenna as far away as pos- sible from the electronic control modules.

Keep the antenna wire more than 8 in (20 cm) away from the electronic con- trol system harnesses. Do not route the antenna wire next to any harness.

Adjust the antenna standing-wave ratio as recommended by the manufacturer.

Connect the ground wire from the CB radio chassis to the body.

For details, consult a NISSAN dealer.

WARNING

Use a phone after stopping your vehicle in a safe location. If you have to use a phone while driving, exercise extreme caution at all times so full attention may be given to vehicle operation.

If you are unable to devote full attention to vehicle operation while talking on the phone, pull off the road to a safe location and stop your vehicle.

CAUTION

To avoid discharging the vehicle battery, use a phone after starting the engine.

CAR PHONE OR CB RADIO BLUETOOTH HANDS-FREE PHONE SYSTEM WITHOUT NAVIGATION SYSTEM (if so equipped)

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-77

Your NISSAN is equipped with the Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System. If you have a com- patible Bluetooth enabled cellular phone, you can set up the wireless connection between your cellular phone and the in-vehicle phone module. With Bluetooth wireless technology, you can

make or receive a hands-free telephone call with your cellular phone in the vehicle.

Once your cellular phone is connected to the in-vehicle phone module, no other phone con- necting procedure is required. Your phone is automatically connected with the in-vehicle

phone module when the ignition switch is placed in the ON position with the previously connected cellular phone turned on and carried in the ve- hicle.

NOTE:

Some devices require the user to accept connections to other Bluetooth devices. If your phone does not connect automati- cally to the system, consult the phones Owners Manual for details on device op- eration.

You can connect up to 5 different Bluetooth cellular phones to the in-vehicle phone module. However, you can talk on only one cellular phone at a time.

Before using the Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System, refer to the following notes.

Set up the wireless connection between a compatible cellular phone and the in-vehicle phone module before using the hands-free phone system.

Some Bluetooth enabled cellular phones may not be recognized or work properly. Please visit www.nissanusa.com/bluetooth for a recommended phone list and connect- ing instructions.

LHA2560

4-78 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

You will not be able to use a hands-free phone under the following conditions:

Your vehicle is outside of the cellular ser- vice area.

Your vehicle is in an area where it is difficult to receive a cellular signal; such as in a tunnel, in an underground parking garage, near a tall building or in a moun- tainous area.

Your cellular phone is locked to prevent it from being dialed.

When the radio wave condition is not ideal or ambient sound is too loud, it may be difficult to hear the other persons voice dur- ing a call.

Do not place the cellular phone in an area surrounded by metal or far away from the in-vehicle phone module to prevent tone quality degradation and wireless connection disruption.

While a cellular phone is connected through the Bluetooth wireless connection, the battery power of the cellular phone may dis- charge quicker than usual. The Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System cannot charge cellular phones.

If the hands-free phone system seems to be malfunctioning, see Troubleshooting guide in this section. You can also visit www.nissanusa.com/bluetooth for trouble- shooting help.

Some cellular phones or other devices may cause interference or a buzzing noise to come from the audio system speakers. Stor- ing the device in a different location may reduce or eliminate the noise.

Refer to the cellular phone Owners Manual regarding the telephone charges, cellular phone antenna and body, etc.

REGULATORY INFORMATION FCC Regulatory information

CAUTION: To maintain compliance with FCCs RF exposure guidelines, use only the supplied antenna. Unauthorized antenna, modification, or attachments could damage the transmitter and may violate FCC regula- tions.

Operation is subject to the following two con- ditions:

1. This device may not cause interference and

2. this device must accept any interference, including interference that may cause unde- sired operation of the device.

IC Regulatory information

Operation is subject to the following two con- ditions: (1) this device may not cause interfer- ence, and (2) this device must accept any interference, including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device.

This Class B digital apparatus meets all re- quirements of the Canadian Interference- Causing Equipment Regulations.

BLUETOOTH is a trademark owned by Bluetooth SIG, Inc. and licensed to Visteon.

USING THE SYSTEM The NISSAN Voice Recognition system allows hands-free operation of the Bluetooth Phone System.

If the vehicle is in motion, some commands may not be available so full attention may be given to vehicle operation.

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-79

Initialization When the ignition switch is placed in the ON position, NISSAN Voice Recognition is initialized, which takes a few seconds. If the button is pressed before the initialization completes, the system will announce Hands-free phone system not ready and will not react to voice commands.

Operating tips To get the best performance out of the NISSAN Voice Recognition system, observe the following:

Keep the interior of the vehicle as quiet as possible. Close the windows to eliminate surrounding noises (traffic noises, vibration sounds, etc.), which may prevent the system from recognizing voice commands correctly.

Wait until the tone sounds before speaking a command. Otherwise, the command will not be received properly.

Start speaking a command within 5 seconds after the tone sounds.

Speak in a natural voice without pausing between words.

Giving voice commands

To operate NISSAN Voice Recognition, press and release the button located on the steering wheel. After the tone sounds, speak a command.

The command given is picked up by the micro- phone, and voice feedback is given when the command is accepted.

If you need to hear the available commands for the current menu again, say Help and the system will repeat them.

If a command is not recognized, the system announces, Command not recognized. Please try again.Make sure the command is said exactly as prompted by the system and repeat the command in a clear voice.

If you want to go back to the previous com- mand, you can say Go back or Correc- tion any time the system is waiting for a response.

You can cancel a command when the sys- tem is waiting for a response by saying, Cancel or Quit. The system announces Cancel and ends the VR session. You can also press and hold the button on the steering wheel for 5 seconds at any time to end the VR session. Whenever the VR ses- sion is cancelled, a double beep is played to indicate you have exited the system.

If you want to adjust the volume of the voice feedback, press the volume control switches (+ or -) on the steering wheel while being provided with feedback. You can also use the radio volume control knob.

In most cases you can interrupt the voice feedback to speak the next command by pressing the button on the steering wheel.

To use the system faster, you may speak the second level commands with the main menu command on the main menu. For example, press the button and after the tone say, Call Redial.

How to say numbers

NISSAN Voice Recognition requires a certain way to speak numbers in voice commands. Refer to the following rules and examples.

4-80 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Either zero or oh can be used for 0.

Example: 1-800-662-6200

One eight oh oh six six two six two oh oh, or

One eight zero zero six six two six two oh oh

Words can be used for the first 4 digits places only.

Example: 1-800-662-6200

One eight hundred six six two six two oh oh,

NOT One eight hundred six six two sixty two hundred, and

NOT One eight oh oh six six two sixty two hundred

Numbers can be spoken in small groups. The system will prompt you to continue en- tering digits, if desired.

Example: 1-800-662-6200

One eight zero zero

The system repeats the numbers and prompts you to enter more.

six six two

The system repeats the numbers and prompts you to enter more.

six two zero zero

Say pound for #. Say star for * (avail- able when using the Special Number com- mand and the Send command during a call).

See List of voice commands and Special number in this section for more information.

Example: 1-555-1212 *123

One five five five one two one two star one two three

Say plus for + (available only when using the Special Number command).

Say pause for a 2-second pause (available only when storing a phone book number).

NOTE:

For best results, say phone numbers as single digits.

The voice command Help is available at any time. Please use the Help command to get information on how to use the system.

CONTROL BUTTONS

The control buttons for the Bluetooth Hands- Free Phone System are located on the steering wheel.

PHONE/SEND

Press the button to initiate a VR session or answer an incom- ing call.

LHA2561

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-81

You can also use the button to interrupt the system feedback and give a command at once. See List of voice commands and During a call in this section for more information.

PHONE/END While the Voice Recognition sys- tem is active, press and hold the button for 5 seconds to quit the Voice Recognition system at any time.

ENTER button / tuning switch While using the Voice Recogni- tion system, tilt the tuning switch up or down to manually control the phone system. Press the EN- TER button to select an option on the display screen.

GETTING STARTED

The following procedures will help you get started using the Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System with NISSAN Voice Recognition. For ad- ditional command options, refer to List of voice commands in this section.

Choosing a language

You can interact with the Bluetooth Hands- Free Phone System using English, Spanish or French.

To change the language, perform the following.

1. Press and hold the button for more than 5 seconds.

2. The system announces: Press the PHONE/SEND ( ) button for the hands-free phone system to enter the voice adaptation mode or press the PHONE/END ( ) button to select a different lan- guage.

3. Press the button.

For information on voice adaptation, see Voice Adaptation (VA) mode in this sec- tion.

4. The system announces the current language and gives you the option to change the lan-

guage to Spanish (in Spanish) or French (in French). To select the current language, press the PHONE/SEND ( ) button. To select a different language, tilt the tuning

switch ( or ) up or down.

NOTE:

You must press the button within 5 seconds to change the language.

5. If you decide not to change the language, do not press either button. After 5 seconds, the VR session will end, and the language will not be changed.

Connecting procedure

NOTE:

The connecting procedure must be per- formed when the vehicle is stationary. If the vehicle starts moving during the procedure, the procedure will be cancelled.

Main Menu

Connect phone A

Add phone B

Initiate from handset C

Name phone D

4-82 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

1. Press the button on the steering wheel. The system announces the available commands.

2. Say: Connect phone A . The system ac- knowledges the command and announces the next set of available commands.

3. Say: Add phone B . The system acknowl- edges the command and asks you to initiate connecting from the phone handset C .

The connecting procedure of the cellular phone varies according to each cellular phone model. See the cellular phone Own- ers Manual for details. You can also visit www.nissanusa.com/bluetooth for instruc- tions on connecting NISSAN recommended cellular phones.

When prompted for a Passkey code, enter 1234 from the handset. The Passkey code 1234 has been assigned by NISSAN and cannot be changed.

4. The system asks you to say a name for the phone D .

If the name is too long or too short, the system tells you, then prompts you for a name again.

Also, if more than one phone is connected and the name sounds too much like a name

already used, the system tells you, then prompts you for a name again.

Making a call by entering a phone number

Main Menu

Call A

Phone Number B

Speak the digits C

Dial D

1. Press the button on the steering wheel. A tone will sound.

2. Say: Call A . The system acknowledges the command and announces the next set of available commands.

3. Say Phone Number B . The system ac- knowledges the command and announces the next set of available commands.

Say: Special Number to dial more than 10 digits or any special characters.

4. Say the number you wish to call starting with the area code in single digit format C . If the system has trouble recognizing the correct phone number, try entering the number in the following groups: 3-digit area code, 3-digit prefix and the last 4-digits. For ex-

ample, 555-121-3354 can be said as five five five as the 1st group, then one two one as the 2nd group, and three three five four as the 3rd group. For dialing more than 10 digits or any special characters, say Special Number. See How to say num- bers in this section for more information.

5. When you have finished speaking the phone number, the system repeats it back and an- nounces the available commands.

6. Say: Dial D . The system acknowledges the command and makes the call.

For additional command options, see List of voice commands in this section.

Receiving a call

When you hear the ring tone, press the button on the steering wheel.

Once the call has ended, press the button on the steering wheel.

NOTE:

If you do not wish to take the call when you hear the ring tone, press the button on the steering wheel.

For additional command options, see List of voice commands later in this section.

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-83

LIST OF VOICE COMMANDS

Main Menu

Call

Phonebook

Recent Calls

Connect Phone

Help

When you press and release the button on the steering wheel, you can choose from the commands on the Main Menu. The following pages describe these commands and the com- mands in each sub-menu.

Remember to wait for the tone before speaking.

After the main menu, you can say Help to hear the list of commands currently available any time the system is waiting for a response.

If you want to end an action without completing it, you can say Cancel or Quit at any time the system is waiting for a response. The system will end the VR session. Whenever the VR session is cancelled, a double beep is played to indicate you have exited the system.

If you want to go back to the previous command, you can say Go back or Correction any time the system is waiting for a response.

Call

Main Menu

Call

(Speak name) A

Phone Number

(Speak Digits) B

Special Number C

Redial D

Call Back E

(Speak name) A

If you have stored entries in the phonebook, you can dial a number associated with a name and location.

See Phonebook in this section to learn how to store entries.

When prompted by the system, say the name of the phone book entry you wish to call. The system acknowledges the name.

If there are multiple locations associated with the name, the system asks you to choose the loca- tion.

Once you have confirmed the name and location, the system begins the call.

(Speak Digits) B

When prompted by the system, say the number you wish to call. Refer to How to say numbers and Making a call by entering a phone number in this section for more details.

Special Number C

For dialing more than 10 digits or any special characters, say Special Number. When the system acknowledges the command, the system will prompt you to speak the number.

Redial D

Use the Redial command to call the last number that was dialed.

The system acknowledges the command, re- peats the number and begins dialing.

If a redial number does not exist, the system announces, There is no number to redial and ends the VR session.

Call Back E

Use the Call Back command to dial the number of the last incoming call within the vehicle.

The system acknowledges the command, re- peats the number and begins dialing.

If a call back number does not exist, the system announces, There is no number to call backand ends the VR session.

4-84 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

During a call

During a call there are several command options available. Press the button on the steering wheel to mute the receiving voice and enter com- mands.

Help The system announces the avail- able commands.

Go back/Correction The system an- nounces Go back, ends the VR session and returns to the call.

Cancel/Quit The system announces Cancel, ends the VR session and returns to the call.

Send/Enter/Call/Dial Use the Send command to enter numbers, * or # during a call. For example, if you were directed to dial an extension by an automated system:

Say: Send one two three four.

The system acknowledges the command and sends the tones associated with the numbers. The system then ends the VR ses- sion and returns to the call. Say star for *, Say pound for #.

Transfer call Use the Transfer Call com- mand to transfer the call from the Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System to the cellular phone when privacy is desired.

The system announces, Transfer call. Call transferred to privacy mode. The system then ends the VR session.

To reconnect the call from the cellular phone to the Bluetooth Hands-Free System, press the button.

Mute Use the Mute command to mute your voice so the other party cannot hear it. Use the mute command again to unmute your voice.

NOTE:

If a call is ended or the cellular phone network connection is lost while the Mute feature is on, the Mute feature will be reset to off for the next call so the other party can hear your voice.

Phonebook (phones without automatic phonebook download function)

NOTE:

The Transfer Entry command is not avail- able when the vehicle is moving.

Main Menu

Phonebook

Transfer Entry A

Delete Entry B

List Names C

For phones that do not support automatic down- load of the phonebook (PBAP Bluetooth pro- file), the Phonebookcommand is used to manu- ally add entries to the vehicle phonebook.

The phonebook stores up to 40 names for each phone connected to the system.

NOTE:

Each phone has its own separate phone- book. You cannot access Phone As phone- book if you are currently connected with Phone B.

Transfer Entry A

Use the Transfer Entry command to store a new name in the system.

When prompted by the system, say the name you would like to give the new entry.

For example, say: Mary. If the name is too long or too short, the system tells you, then prompts you for a name again.

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-85

Also, if the name sounds too much like a name already stored, the system tells you, then prompts you for a name again.

The system will ask you to transfer a phone number stored in the cellular phones memory.

Enter a phone number by voice command:

For example, say: five five five one two one two. See How to say numbers in this section for more information.

To transfer a phone number stored in the cellular phones memory:

Say Transfer entry. The system acknowledges the command and asks you to initiate the transfer from the phone handset. The new contact phone number will be transferred from the cellular phone via the Bluetooth communication link.

The transfer procedure varies according to each cellular phone. See the cellular phone Owners Manual for details. You can also visit www.nissanusa.com/bluetooth for instructions on transferring phone numbers from NISSAN recommended cellular phones.

The system repeats the number and prompts you for the next command. When you have finished entering numbers or transferring an entry, choose Store.

The system confirms the name, location and number.

Delete Entry B

Use the Delete Entry command to erase one entry from the phonebook. After the system rec- ognizes the command, speak the name to delete or say List Names to choose an entry.

List Names C

Use the List Names command to hear all the names in the phonebook.

The system recites the phonebook entries but does not include the actual phone numbers. When the playback of the list is complete, the system goes back to the main menu.

You can stop the playback of the list at any time by pressing the button on the steering wheel. The system ends the VR session.

Phonebook (phones with automatic phonebook download function)

NOTE:

The Transfer Entry command is not avail- able when the vehicle is moving.

Main Menu

Phonebook

Say a Name

List Names A

Record Name B

For phones that support automatic download of the phonebook (PBAP Bluetooth profile), the Phonebook command is used to manage en- tries in the vehicle phonebook. You can say the name of an entry at this menu to initiate dialing of that entry.

The phonebook stores up to 1000 names for each phone connected to the system.

When a phone is connected to the system, the phonebook is automatically downloaded to the vehicle. This feature allows you to access your phonebook from the Bluetooth system and call contacts by name. You can record a custom voice tag for contact names that the system has difficulty recognizing. For more information see Record name in this section.

4-86 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

NOTE:

Each phone has its own separate phone- book. You cannot access Phone As phone- book if you are currently connected with Phone B.

List Names A

Use the List Names command to hear all the names and locations in the phone book.

The system recites the phone book entries but does not include the actual phone numbers. When the playback of the list is complete, the system goes back to the main menu.

You can stop the playback of the list at any time by pressing the button on the steering wheel. The system ends the VR session. See the Record name command in this section for infor- mation about recording custom voice tags for list entries that the system has difficulty pronounc- ing.

Record Name B

The system allows you to record custom voice tags for contact names in the phonebook that the vehicle has difficulty recognizing. This feature can also be used to record voice tags to directly dial an entry with multiple numbers. Up to 40 voice tags can be recorded to the system.

Recent Calls

Main Menu

Recent Calls

Outgoing A

Incoming B

Missed C

Call Back D

Redial E

Use the Recent Calls command to access out- going, incoming or missed calls or dial numbers for the last incoming or outgoing calls.

Outgoing A

Use the Outgoing command to list the outgoing calls made from the vehicle.

Incoming B

Use the Incoming command to list the incoming calls made to the vehicle.

Missed C

Use the Missed command to list the calls made to the vehicle that were not answered.

Call Back D

Use the Call Back command to dial the number of the last incoming call to the vehicle.

Redial E

Use the Redial command to dial the number of the last outgoing call from the vehicle.

Connect Phone

NOTE:

The Add Phone command is not available when the vehicle is moving.

Main Menu

Connect Phone

Add Phone A

Select Phone B

Delete Phone C

Replace Phone D

Bluetooth OFF E

Use the Connect Phone commands to manage the phones connecting to the vehicle or to enable the Bluetooth function on the vehicle.

Add Phone A

Use the Add Phone command to add a phone to the vehicle. See Connecting procedure in this section for more information.

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-87

Select Phone B

Use the Select Phone command to select from a list of phones connected to the vehicle. The sys- tem will list the names assigned to each phone and then prompt you for the phone you wish to select. Only one phone can be active at a time.

Delete Phone C

Use the Delete Phone command to delete a phone that is connected to the vehicle. The sys- tem will list the names assigned to each phone and then prompt you for the phone you wish to delete. Deleting a phone from the vehicle will also delete that phonebook for that phone.

Replace Phone D

Use the Replace Phone command to replace an existing phone pairing with a new phone. The system will keep all voice tags assigned to your phonebook.

Bluetooth OFF E

Use the Bluetooth OFF command to prevent a wireless connection to your phone.

VOICE ADAPTATION (VA) MODE Voice Adaptation allows up to two out-of-dialect users to train the system to improve recognition accuracy. By repeating a number of commands, the users can create a voice model of their own voice that is stored in the system. The system is capable of storing a different voice adaptation model for each connected phone.

Training procedure The procedure for training a voice is as follows.

1. Position the vehicle in a reasonably quiet outdoor location.

2. Sit in the drivers seat with the engine run- ning, the parking brake on, and the transmis- sion in P (Park).

3. Press and hold the button for more than 5 seconds.

4. The system announces: Press the PHONE/SEND ( ) button for the hands-free phone system to enter the voice adaptation mode or press the PHONE/END ( ) button to select a different lan- guage.

5. Press the button.

For information on selecting a different lan- guage, see Choosing a language in this section.

6. Voice memory A or memory B is selected automatically. If both memory locations are already in use, the system will prompt you to overwrite one. Follow the instructions pro- vided by the system.

7. When preparation is complete and you are ready to begin, press the button.

8. The VA mode will be explained. Follow the instructions provided by the system.

9. When training is finished, the system will tell you an adequate number of phrases have been recorded.

10. The system will announce that voice adap- tation has been completed and the system is ready.

The VA mode will stop if:

The button is pressed for more than 5 seconds in VA mode.

The vehicle begins moving during VA mode.

The ignition switch is placed in the OFF or LOCK position.

4-88 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Training phrases

During the VA mode, the system instructs the trainer to say the following phrases. (The system will prompt you for each phrase.)

phonebook transfer entry

dial three oh four two nine

delete call back number

incoming

transfer entry

eight pause nine three two pause seven

delete all entries

call seven two four zero nine

phonebook delete entry

next entry

dial star two one seven oh

yes

no

select

missed

dial eight five six nine two

Bluetooth on

outgoing

call three one nine oh two

nine seven pause pause three oh eight

cancel

call back number

call star two zero nine five

delete phone

dial eight three zero five one

record name

four three pause two nine pause zero

delete redial number

phonebook list names

call eight oh five four one

correction

connect phone

dial seven four oh one eight

previous entry

delete

dial nine seven two six six

call seven six three oh one

go back

call five six two eight zero

dial six six four three seven

MANUAL CONTROL

While using the Voice Recognition system, it is possible to select menu options by using the steering wheel controls instead of speaking voice commands. The manual control mode does not allow dialing a phone number by digits. The user may select an entry from the Phonebook or Re- cent Calls lists. To re-activate voice recognition, exit the manual control mode by pressing and holding the PHONE/END ( ) button. At that time, pressing the PHONE/SEND ( ) button will start the Hands- Free Phone System.

Operating tips To enter manual control mode, start the

Voice Recognition system and tilt the tuning ( ) switch up or down. The system will speak Showing Manual Options when manual controls are initially activated.

To browse the menu options, tilt the tuning ( ) switch up or down. The system will always speak the current menu option. De- pending on the audio display, it will also show the current menu option.

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-89

To select the current menu option, press the PHONE/SEND ( ) button.

To go back to the previous menu, press the PHONE/END ( ) button. If the current menu is the Main Menu, pressing the PHONE/END ( ) button will exit the Phone system.

To exit the manual control mode, press and hold the PHONE/END ( ) button for 5 seconds.

TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE

The system should respond correctly to all voice commands without difficulty. If problems are en- countered, try the following solutions.

Where the solutions are listed by number, try each solution in turn, starting with number 1, until the problem is resolved.

Symptom Solution

System fails to interpret the command correctly.

1. Ensure that the command is valid. See List of voice commands in this section. 2. Ensure that the command is spoken after the tone. 3. Speak clearly without pausing between words and at a level appropriate to the ambient noise level in the vehicle. 4. Ensure that the ambient noise level is not excessive (for example, windows open or defroster on). NOTE: If it is too noisy to use the phone, it is likely that the voice commands will not be recognized. 5. If more than one command was said at a time, try saying the commands separately. 6. If the system consistently fails to recognize commands, the voice training procedure should be carried out to im- prove the recognition response for the speaker. See Voice Adaptation (VA) mode in this section.

The system consistently selects the wrong entry from the phone book.

1. Ensure that the phone book entry name requested matches what was originally stored. This can be confirmed by using the List Names command. See Phonebook in this section. 2. Replace one of the names being confused with a new name.

4-90 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

WARNING

Use a phone after stopping your vehicle in a safe location. If you have to use a phone while driving, exercise extreme caution at all times so full attention may be given to vehicle operation.

If you are unable to devote full attention to vehicle operation while talking on the phone, pull off the road to a safe location and stop your vehicle.

CAUTION

To avoid discharging the vehicle battery, use a phone after starting the engine.

Your NISSAN is equipped with the Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System. If you have a com- patible Bluetooth enabled cellular phone, you can set up the wireless connection between your cellular phone and the in-vehicle phone module. With Bluetooth wireless technology, you can

make or receive a hands-free telephone call with your cellular phone in the vehicle.

Once your cellular phone is connected to the in-vehicle phone module, no other phone con- necting procedure is required. Your phone is automatically connected with the in-vehicle

LHA2560

BLUETOOTH HANDS-FREE PHONE SYSTEM WITH NAVIGATION SYSTEM (if so equipped)

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-91

phone module when the ignition switch is placed in the ON position with the connected cellular phone turned on and carried in the vehicle.

You can register up to 5 different Bluetooth cellular phones to the in-vehicle phone module. However, you can talk on only one cellular phone at a time.

NISSAN Voice Recognition system supports the phone commands, so dialing a phone number using your voice is possible. For more details, see NISSAN Voice Recognition System in this sec- tion.

Before using the Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System, refer to the following notes.

Set up the wireless connection between a cellular phone and the in-vehicle phone module before using the hands-free phone system.

Some Bluetooth enabled cellular phones may not be recognized by the in-vehicle phone module. Please visit www.nissanusa.com/bluetooth for a recom- mended phone list and connecting.

You will not be able to use a hands-free phone under the following conditions:

Your vehicle is outside of the cellular ser- vice area.

Your vehicle is in an area where it is difficult to receive cellular signal; such as in a tunnel, in an underground parking garage, near a tall building or in a moun- tainous area.

Your cellular phone is locked to prevent it from being dialed.

When the radio wave condition is not ideal or ambient sound is too loud, it may be difficult to hear the other persons voice dur- ing a call.

Immediately after the ignition switch is placed in the ON position, it may be impos- sible to receive a call for a short period of time.

Do not place the cellular phone in an area surrounded by metal or far away from the in-vehicle phone module to prevent tone quality degradation and wireless connection disruption.

While a cellular phone is connected through the Bluetooth wireless connection, the battery power of the cellular phone may dis- charge quicker than usual. The Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System cannot charge cellular phones.

If the hands-free phone system seems to be malfunctioning, see Troubleshooting guide in this section. You can also visit www.nissanusa.com/bluetooth for trouble- shooting help.

Some cellular phones or other devices may cause interference or a buzzing noise to come from the audio system speakers. Stor- ing the device in a different location may reduce or eliminate the noise.

Refer to the cellular phone owners manual regarding the telephone charges, cellular phone antenna and body, etc.

The signal strength display on the monitor will not coincide with the signal strength display of some cellular phones.

REGULATORY INFORMATION FCC Regulatory information

CAUTION: To maintain compliance with FCCs RF exposure guidelines, use only the supplied antenna. Unauthorized antenna, modification, or attachments could damage the transmitter and may violate FCC regula- tions.

Operation is subject to the following two con- ditions:

1. This device may not cause interference and

4-92 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

2. this device must accept any interference, including interference that may cause unde- sired operation of the device.

IC Regulatory information

Operation is subject to the following two con- ditions: (1) this device may not cause interfer- ence, and (2) this device must accept any interference, including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device.

This Class B digital apparatus meets all re- quirements of the Canadian Interference- Causing Equipment Regulations.

BLUETOOTH is a trademark owned by Bluetooth SIG, Inc. and licensed to Bosch.

VOICE COMMANDS You can use voice commands to operate various Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System features using the NISSAN Voice Recognition system. For more details, see NISSAN Voice Recognition System in this section.

CONNECTING PROCEDURE 1. Press the MENU button on the control

panel.

2. Select the Settings key. LHA2253

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-93

3. Select the Phone & Bluetooth key. 4. Select the Connect New Device key.

5. Initiate the connecting process from the handset. The system will display the mes- sage: Is PIN XXXXXX displayed on your Bluetooth device?. If the PIN is displayed on your Bluetooth device, select Yes to complete the connecting process.

For more information, see the Bluetooth de- vices Owners Manual.

VEHICLE PHONEBOOK To access the vehicle phonebook:

1. Press the button on the control panel.

2. Select the Phonebook key.

LHA2248 LHA2265 LHA2297

4-94 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

3. Choose the desired entry from the displayed list.

NOTE:

To scroll quickly through the list, touch the A-Z key in the upper right corner of the screen. Turn the TUNE/SCROLL knob to choose a letter or number and then press ENTER. The list will move to the first entry that begins with that number or letter.

4. The number of the entry will be displayed on the screen. Touch the number to initiate di- aling.

MAKING A CALL

To make a call, follow the procedure below:

1. Press the button on the instrument panel. The Phonescreen will appear on the display.

2. Select one of the following options to make a call:

Phonebook: Select the name from an entry stored in the vehicle phonebook.

Call Lists: Select the name from the in- coming, outgoing or missed call history.

Redial: Dial the last outgoing call from the vehicle.

: Input the phone number manually using a keypad displayed on the screen. For information on how to use the touchscreen, see How to use the touchscreen in this section.

LHA2279 LHA2297

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-95

RECEIVING A CALL When a call is placed to the connected phone, the display will change to phone mode.

To accept the incoming call, either:

Press the button on the steering wheel, or

Touch the green phone icon on the screen.

To reject the incoming call, either:

Press the button on the steering wheel, or

Touch the red phone icon on the screen.

DURING A CALL While a call is active, the following options are available on the screen:

Handset Select this option to switch control of the phone call over to the handset.

Mute Mic. Select this option to mute the microphone. Select again to unmute the microphone.

Red phone ( ) icon Select to end the phone call.

ENDING A CALL

To end a phone call, select the red phone ( ) icon on the screen or press the button on the steering wheel.

LHA2298 LHA2299

4-96 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

TEXT MESSAGING

WARNING

Use the text messaging feature after stopping your vehicle in a safe location. If you have to use the feature while driving, exercise extreme caution at all times so full attention may be given to vehicle operation.

If you are unable to devote full attention to vehicle operation while using the text messaging feature, pull off the road to a safe location and stop your vehicle.

The system allows for the sending and receiving of text messages through the vehicle interface.

Sending a text message:

1. Press the button.

2. Say Send Text.

3. The system will provide a list of available commands in order to determine the recipi- ent of the text message. Choose from the following:

(a name)

Number

Incoming Calls

Outgoing Calls

Missed Calls

For more information about these options, see Voice commands in this section.

4. Once a recipient is chosen, the system prompts for which message to send. Five predefined messages are available as well as three custom messages. To choose one of the predefined messages, speak one of the following:

Driving, cant text

Call me

On my way

Running late

Okay

To send one of the custom messages, say Custom Messages. If more than one cus- tom message is stored, the system will prompt for the number of the desired cus- tom message. For more information on set- ting and managing custom text messages, see Bluetooth settings in this section.

LHA2300

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-97

Reading a received text message:

1. Press the button.

2. Say Read Text.

The text message, sender and delivery time are shown on the screen. Use the tuning switch to scroll through all text messages if more than one are available. Press the button to exit the text message screen. Press the button to access the following options for replying to the text message:

Call Back Speak this command to call the sender of the text message using the Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System.

Send Text Speak this command to send a text message response to the sender of the text message.

Read Text Speak this command to read the text mes- sage again.

Previous Text Speak this command to move to the previ- ous text message (if available).

Next Text Speak this command to move to the next text message (if available).

NOTE:

Text messages are only displayed if the vehicle speed is less than 5 mph.

BLUETOOTH SETTINGS To access the phone settings:

1. Press the MENU button.

2. Select the Settings key.

LHA2301 LHA2253

4-98 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

3. Select the Phone & Bluetooth key. Phone Settings See Phone settings in this section for more information.

Connect New Device Select to connect a new Bluetooth device to the Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone Sys- tem.

Select Connected Device Select to choose a Bluetooth device from a list of those devices connected to the Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System.

Replace Connected Device Select to replace a Bluetooth device from a list of those devices connected to the Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System.

Delete Connected Device Select to delete a Bluetooth device from a list of those devices connected to the Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System.

Bluetooth Select to toggle the Bluetooth on and off.

LHA2248 LHA2265

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-99

PHONE SETTINGS

To access the phone settings:

1. Press the MENU button.

2. Select the Settings key.

3. Select the Phone & Bluetooth key.

4. Select the Phone Settings key and adjust the following settings as desired:

Sort Phonebook By: Select First Name or Last Name to choose how phonebook entries are alpha- betically displayed on the screen.

Use Phonebook From: Select Handset to use the phones phone- book. Select SIM to use the phonebook on the SIM card. Select Both to use both sources.

Download Phonebook Now Select to download the phonebook to the vehicle from the chosen source.

Phone Notifications for Select Driver to have phone notifications shown in the vehicle information display. Se- lect Both to have phone notifications shown in both the vehicle information display and the center display screen.

Record Name for Phonebook Entry Select to record a name for a phonebook entry for use with the NISSAN Voice Recog- nition System.

Text Message Service Select to toggle the text message function- ality on or off.

Show Incoming Text for Select Driver to have text message notifi- cations shown in the vehicle information dis- play. Select Both to have text message notifications shown in both the vehicle infor- mation display and the center display screen. Select None to have text message notifications not displayed.

SMS Auto Reply Function Select to toggle the SMS auto reply func- tionality on or off.

SMS Auto Reply Message Select to choose a message that is sent when the auto reply function is activated.

Add Vehicles Signature Select to toggle on or off the addition of the vehicle signature to outgoing messages.

Predefined SMS Messages Select the predefined SMS messages that are used by the system.

LHA2302

4-100 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

The NISSAN Voice Recognition system allows hands-free operation of the systems equipped on this vehicle, such as the phone and navigation systems.

To operate NISSAN Voice Recognition, press the button located on the steering wheel. When prompted, speak the command for the system you wish to activate. The command given is picked up by the microphone and performed when it is properly recognized. NISSAN Voice Recognition will provide a voice response as well as a message in the center display to inform you of the command results.

USING THE SYSTEM

Initialization When the ignition switch is in the ON position, NISSAN Voice Recognition is initialized, which takes a few seconds. When completed, the sys- tem is ready to accept voice commands. If the button is pressed before the initializa- tion completes, the system will announce: Voice Recognition System not ready. Please wait.

Giving voice commands

1. Press the button.

2. The system announces: Please say a com- mand. A list of available commands is spo- ken by the system.

3. After the tone sounds and the face icon on the display changes, speak a command. Available commands are discussed later in this section.

4. Voice and display feedback are provided when the command is accepted.

If the command is not recognized, the sys- tem announces: Command not recog- nized.Repeat the command in a clear voice.

If you want to cancel the command or go back to the previous menu of commands, press the button. The system will an- nounce: Voice recognition canceled or Go back depending on the current menu level.

Press the button to move back through the menus displayed on the screen.

If you want to adjust the volume of the voice feedback, use the volume control switches on the steering wheel or the volume knob on the control panel.

LHA2589

NISSAN VOICE RECOGNITION SYSTEM (if so equipped)

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-101

The voice command screen can also be accessed using the control panel display:

1. Press the MENU button.

2. Select the Voice Commands key.

Operating tips To get the best performance out of NISSAN Voice Recognition, observe the following:

Keep the interior of the vehicle as quiet as possible. Close the windows to eliminate the surrounding noises (traffic noises, vibration sounds, etc.), which may prevent the system from recognizing the voice commands cor- rectly.

Wait until a tone sounds before speaking a command. Otherwise, the command will not be received properly.

Start speaking a command within 3.5 sec- onds after the tone sounds.

Speak in a natural voice without pausing between words.

SYSTEM FEATURES

NISSAN Voice Recognition can activate the fol- lowing systems:

Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System

Navigation

Audio

Information

For additional information on the navigation sys- tem, see the separate Navigation System Own- ers Manual.

LHA2253 LHA2281

4-102 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

How to say numbers NISSAN Voice Recognition requires a certain way to speak numbers in voice commands. Refer to the following examples.

General rule: Either zero or oh can be used for 0.

Phone numbers

Speak phone numbers according to the following example. For 1-800-662-6200, say dial number and then speak the phone number in any of the following formats:

one eight oh oh six six two six two oh oh

one eight hundred six six two six two oh oh

one eight zero zero six six two six two oh oh

For the best voice recognition phone dialing re- sults, say phone numbers as single digits. Also, full numbers can only be spoken for 800. For example, you cannot say 555-6000 as five five five six thousand.

BLUETOOTH HANDS-FREE PHONE SYSTEM VOICE COMMANDS To access the Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System voice commands:

1. Press the button.

2. Say Call and then a name in the vehicle phonebook to call that entry. Otherwise, say Phone to access various phone com- mands.

If the Bluetooth has been set to Off, the system announces: Bluetooth is off. Would you like to turn Bluetooth on?

If no phone is connected to the system and the vehicle is stationary, the system announces: There is no phone connected. Would you like to connect a phone now? Say Yes to connect a phone. All further Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System voice commands are only available if a phone is connected.

If a phone is connected and Bluetooth is set to On, the following voice commands are available:

Dial Number

Allows for up to 24 digits to be dialed. After the number is entered, say Dial to initiate dialing. Say Correction to correct the num- ber entered. Say Go Back to return to the main menu.

List Phonebook

Starting with the first alphabetical entry in the vehicle phonebook, the system prompts for an additional command. Say Dial to call the number of the phonebook entry. Say Send Text to send a text message to the number of the phonebook entry. Say Next Entry to skip to the next alphabetical entry in the vehicle phonebook, where the same op- tions will then be available.

Recent Calls

The system prompts for an additional com- mand. Say Missed Calls, Incoming Calls or Outgoing Calls to display a list of such calls on the screen.

Speak the number of the entry displayed on the screen to dial that number or say Next Page to view entries on the next page (if available).

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-103

Redial

Redials the last called number.

Read Text

Reads an incoming text message. For more information about text messaging with the Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System, see Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System with Navigation System in this section.

Send Text

Sends a text message. For more information about text messaging with the Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System, see Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System with Navigation System in this section.

Select Phone

The system replies Please use manual con- trols to continue. Use manual controls to change the active phone from among the listed phones connected to the vehicle.

For more information about the Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System, see Bluetooth Hands-Free Phone System with Navigation Sys- tem in this section.

NAVIGATION SYSTEM VOICE COMMANDS The following voice commands are available for the Navigation System:

Places

Street Address

Address Book

Home

Previous Destination

For more information about these commands, see the separate Navigation System Owners Manual.

AUDIO SYSTEM VOICE COMMANDS To access the audio system voice commands:

1. Press the button.

2. Say Audio

3. Speak a command from the following avail- able commands:

FM

Switches the audio system to the FM mode.

AM

Switches the audio system to the AM mode.

XM (satellite radio, if so equipped)

Switches the audio system to the SiriusXM Satellite Radio mode.

CD

Switches the audio system to the CD mode. A CD must be inserted for this command to be functional.

iPod

Switches the audio system to the iPod mode. An iPod must be connected for this command to be available and functional.

The following sub-commands are available for iPod:

Now Playing

Menu

Playlists

Artists

Albums

Genres

Songs

Shuffle Songs*

4-104 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

Composers*

Audiobooks*

Podcasts*

* Say Next Page to access these com- mands. Say Previous Page to return to the first page of commands.

USB

Switches the audio system to the USB mode. A USB device must be inserted for this command to be available and functional.

Pandora

Switches the audio system to the Pandora audio mode. A compatible Bluetooth au- dio device with a Pandora application must be connected to the system for this command to be functional.

Bluetooth

Switches the audio system to the Bluetooth audio mode. A compatible Bluetooth audio device must be con- nected to the system for this command to be functional.

AUX

Switches the audio system to the AUX mode. An AUX device must be connected for this command to be functional.

For more information about the audio system, see Audio system in this section.

INFORMATION VOICE COMMANDS The following voice commands are available for the information functions of the Navigation Sys- tem:

Traffic

Current Weather

Weather Forecast

Google Send-To-Car

POIs Powered by Google

For more information about these commands, see the separate Navigation System Owners Manual.

HELP VOICE COMMANDS The following voice commands can be spoken to have the system provide instructions and tips for using the NISSAN Voice Recognition system.

List Commands

What Can I Say?

General Help

Quit

Exit

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-105

TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE The system should respond correctly to all voice commands without difficulty. If problems are en- countered, follow the solutions given in this guide for the appropriate error. Where the solutions are listed by number, try each solution in turn, starting with number one, until the problem is resolved.

Symptom/error message Solution The system responds Command Not Recognized or the system fails to rec- ognize the command correctly.

1. Ensure that the command format is valid. Use the List Commands or What Can I Say? command under the Help menu. 2. Speak clearly without pausing between words and at a level appropriate to the ambient noise level. 3. Ensure that the ambient noise level is not excessive (for example, with the windows open or the defroster on).

NOTE:

If it is too noisy to use the phone, it is likely that voice commands will not be recognized. 4. If optional words of the command have been omitted, then the command should be tried with these in place.

4-106 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems

MEMO

Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-107

5 Starting and driving

Precautions when starting and driving. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2 Exhaust gas (carbon monoxide) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2 Three-way catalyst. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3 Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS). . . . . . . . . . 5-3 On-pavement and off-road driving precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6 Avoiding collision and rollover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6 Off-road recovery. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6 Rapid air pressure loss . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-7 Drinking alcohol/drugs and driving. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-7 Driving safety precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-8

Ignition switch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10 Automatic transmission (if so equipped). . . . . . . . . . 5-10 Manual transmission (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-11 Key positions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-11 NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-12

Before starting the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-12 Starting the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-12 Driving the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-13

Automatic transmission (if so equipped). . . . . . . . . . 5-13 Manual transmission (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-18

Parking brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-20

Cruise control (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-21 Precautions on cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-21 Cruise control operations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-21

Break-in schedule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-22 Fuel efficient driving tips. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-23 Increasing fuel economy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-24

Using four wheel drive (4WD) (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-24

Transfer case shifting procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-26 Electronic locking rear differential (E-Lock) system (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-31 Parking/parking on hills. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-33 Power steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-34 Brake system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-34

Brake precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-34 Anti-lock Braking System (ABS). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-35

Active brake limited slip (ABLS) system . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-36 Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-37 Hill descent control system (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . 5-38 Hill start assist system (if so equipped). . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-39 Rear sonar system (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-40 Cold weather driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-41

Freeing a frozen door lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-41

Anti-freeze. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-41 Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-41 Draining of coolant water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-41 Tire equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-41

Special winter equipment. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-41 Driving on snow or ice . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-41 Engine block heater (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-42

WARNING

Do not leave children or adults who would normally require the assistance of others alone in your vehicle. Pets should also not be left alone. They could accidentally injure themselves or others through inadvertent operation of the vehicle. Also, on hot, sunny days, temperatures in a closed vehicle could quickly become high enough to cause severe or possibly fatal injuries to people or animals.

Properly secure all cargo with ropes or straps to help prevent it from sliding or shifting. Do not place cargo higher than the seatbacks. In a sudden stop or col- lision, unsecured cargo could cause personal injury.

EXHAUST GAS (carbon monoxide)

WARNING

Do not breathe exhaust gases; they contain colorless and odorless carbon monoxide. Carbon monoxide is danger- ous. It can cause unconsciousness or death.

If you suspect that exhaust fumes are entering the vehicle, drive with all win- dows fully open, and have the vehicle inspected immediately.

Do not run the engine in closed spaces such as a garage.

Do not park the vehicle with the engine running for any extended length of time.

Keep the rear vent windows, lift gates, doors and trunk lids (if so equipped) closed while driving, otherwise exhaust gases could be drawn into the passen- ger compartment. If you must drive with one of these open, follow these precautions:

1. Open all the windows.

2. Set the air recirculation but- ton to off and the fan control dial to high to circulate the air.

If electrical wiring or other cable con- nections must pass to a trailer through the seal on the lift gate or the body, follow the manufacturers recommen- dation to prevent carbon monoxide en- try into the vehicle.

The exhaust system and body should be inspected by a qualified mechanic whenever:

a. The vehicle is raised for service.

b. You suspect that exhaust fumes are entering into the passenger compartment.

c. You notice a change in the sound of the exhaust system.

d. You have had an accident involving damage to the exhaust system, un- derbody, or rear of the vehicle.

If a special body, camper, or other equipment is added for recreational or other usage, follow the manufacturers recommendation to prevent carbon monoxide entry into the vehicle. Do not occupy these areas while the engine is running even if the vehicle is parked. Some recreational vehicle appliances such as stoves, refrigerators, heaters, etc. may also generate carbon monoxide.

PRECAUTIONS WHEN STARTING AND DRIVING

5-2 Starting and driving

THREE-WAY CATALYST

The three-way catalyst is an emission control device installed in the exhaust system. Exhaust gases in the three-way catalyst are burned at high temperatures to help reduce pollutants.

WARNING

The exhaust gas and the exhaust sys- tem are very hot. Keep people, animals or flammable materials away from the exhaust system components.

Do not stop or park the vehicle over flammable materials such as dry grass, waste paper or rags. They may ignite and cause a fire.

CAUTION

Do not use leaded gasoline. Deposits from leaded gasoline will seriously re- duce the three-way catalysts ability to help reduce exhaust pollutants.

Keep your engine tuned up. Malfunc- tions in the ignition, fuel injection, or electrical systems can cause overrich fuel flow into the three-way catalyst, causing it to overheat. Do not keep driv- ing if the engine misfires, or if notice- able loss of performance or other un- usual operating conditions are detected. Have the vehicle inspected promptly by a NISSAN dealer.

Avoid driving with an extremely low fuel level. Running out of fuel could cause the engine to misfire, damaging the three-way catalyst.

Do not race the engine while warming it up.

Do not push or tow your vehicle to start the engine.

TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM (TPMS)

Each tire, including the spare (if provided), should be checked monthly when cold and in- flated to the inflation pressure recommended by the vehicle manufacturer on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label. (If your vehicle has tires of a different size than the size indicated on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label,

you should determine the proper tire inflation pressure for those tires.)

As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been equipped with a Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pressure telltale when one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated. Accordingly, when the low tire pressure telltale illuminates, you should stop and check your tires as soon as possible, and inflate them to the proper pressure. Driving on a signifi- cantly under-inflated tire causes the tire to over- heat and can lead to tire failure. Under-inflation also reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicles handling and stopping ability.

Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire maintenance, and it is the drivers responsibility to maintain correct tire pressure, even if under-inflation has not reached the level to trigger illumination of the TPMS low tire pressure telltale.

Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS malfunction indicator to indicate when the system is not operating properly. The TPMS mal- function indicator is combined with the low tire pressure telltale. When the system detects a malfunction, the telltale will flash for approxi- mately one minute and then remain continuously illuminated. This sequence will continue upon

Starting and driving 5-3

subsequent vehicle start-ups as long as the mal- function exists. When the malfunction indicator is illuminated, the system may not be able to detect or signal low tire pressure as intended. TPMS malfunctions may occur for a variety of reasons, including the installation of replacement or alter- nate tires or wheels on the vehicle that prevent the TPMS from functioning properly. Always check the TPMS malfunction telltale after replac- ing one or more tires or wheels on your vehicle to ensure that the replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow the TPMS to continue to function properly.

Additional information:

The TPMS does not monitor the tire pressure of the spare tire.

The TPMS will activate only when the vehicle is driven at speeds above 16 MPH (25 km/h). Also, this system may not detect a sudden drop in tire pressure (for example a flat tire while driving).

The low tire pressure warning light does not automatically turn off when the tire pressure of your tires are adjusted. After the tires are inflated to the recommended pressure, the vehicle must be driven at speeds above 16 MPH (25 km/h) to activate the TPMS and turn off the low tire pressure warning light. Use a tire pressure gauge to check the tire pressure.

The CHECK TIRE PRES (pressure) warning message is displayed in the odometer when the low tire pressure warning light is illumi- nated and low tire pressure is detected. The CHECK TIRE PRES warning message turns off when the low tire pressure warning light turns off. The low tire pressure warning light remains illuminated until the tires are inflated to the recommended COLD tire pressure. The CHECK TIRE PRES warning message is displayed each time the ignition switch is placed in the ON position as long as the low tire pressure warning light remains illumi- nated. See Check tire pressure warning message in the Instruments and controls section.

The CHECK TIRE PRES warning is not dis- played if the low tire pressure warning light illuminates to indicate a TPMS malfunction.

Tire pressure rises and falls depending on the heat caused by the vehicles operation and the outside temperature. Low outside temperature can lower the temperature of the air inside the tire which can cause a lower tire inflation pressure. This may cause the low tire pressure warning light to illumi- nate. If the warning light illuminates in low ambient temperature, check the tire pres- sure for all four tires.

The Tire and Loading Information label (also referred to as the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label) is located in the drivers door opening.

For additional information, see Low tire pressure warning light in the Instruments and controls section and Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) in the In case of emergency section.

5-4 Starting and driving

WARNING

If the low tire pressure warning light illuminates while driving, avoid sudden steering maneuvers or abrupt braking, reduce vehicle speed, pull off the road to a safe location and stop the vehicle as soon as possible. Driving with under- inflated tires may permanently damage the tires and increase the likelihood of tire failure. Serious vehicle damage could occur and may lead to an acci- dent and could result in serious per- sonal injury. Check the tire pressure for all four tires. Adjust the tire pressure to the recommended COLD tire pressure shown on the Tire and Loading Informa- tion label to turn the low tire pressure warning light OFF. If you have a flat tire, replace it with a spare tire as soon as possible. (See Flat tire in the In case of emergency section for changing a flat tire.)

When a spare tire is mounted or a wheel is replaced, the TPMS will not function and the low tire pressure warning light will flash for approximately 1 minute. The light will remain on after 1 minute. Contact your NISSAN dealer as soon as possible for tire replacement and/or system resetting.

Replacing tires with those not originally specified by NISSAN could affect the proper operation of the TPMS.

Do not inject any tire liquid or aerosol tire sealant into the tires, as this may cause a malfunction of the tire pressure sensors.

CAUTION

Do not place metalized film or any metal parts (antenna, etc.) on the windows. This may cause poor reception of the signals from the tire pressure sensors, and the TPMS will not function properly.

Some devices and transmitters may temporarily interfere with the operation of the TPMS and cause the low tire pressure warning light to illu- minate.

Some examples are:

Facilities or electric devices using similar radio frequencies are near the vehicle.

If a transmitter set to similar frequencies is being used in or near the vehicle.

If a computer (or similar equipment) or a DC/AC converter is being used in or near the vehicle.

FCC Notice:

For USA:

This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the fol- lowing two conditions:

1. This device may not cause harmful in- terference, and

2. This device must accept any interfer- ence received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. Note: Changes or modification not ex- pressly approved by the party respon- sible for compliance could void the us- ers authority to operate the equipment.

Starting and driving 5-5

For Canada:

This device complies with RSS-210 of In- dustry Canada. Operation is subject to the following two conditions:

1. This device may not cause interfer- ence, and

2. This device must accept any interfer- ence, include interference that may cause undesired operation of the de- vice.

3. The term IC: before the radio certifi- cation number only signifies that In- dustry Canada technical specifications were met.

ON-PAVEMENT AND OFF-ROAD DRIVING PRECAUTIONS Utility vehicles have a significantly higher rollover rate than other types of vehicles.

They have higher ground clearance than passen- ger cars to make them capable of performing in a variety of on-pavement and off-road applications. This gives them a higher center of gravity than ordinary cars. An advantage of higher ground clearance is a better view of the road, allowing you to anticipate problems. However, they are not designed for cornering at the same speeds as conventional two-wheel drive vehicles any more

than low-slung sports cars are designed to per- form satisfactorily under off-road conditions. If at all possible, avoid sharp turns at high speeds. As with other vehicles of this type, failure to operate this vehicle correctly may result in loss of control or vehicle rollover. In a rollover crash, an unbelted person is significantly more likely to die than a person wearing a seat belt.

Be sure to read the driving safety precautions later in this section.

AVOIDING COLLISION AND ROLLOVER

WARNING

Failure to operate this vehicle in a safe and prudent manner may result in loss of control or an accident.

Be alert and drive defensively at all times. Obey all traffic regulations. Avoid excessive speed, high speed cornering, or sudden steering ma- neuvers, because these driving practices could cause you to lose control of your vehicle. As with any vehicle, loss of control could result in a collision with other vehicles or objects or cause the vehicle to roll over, particularly if the loss of control causes the vehicle to slide sideways. Be attentive at all times, and avoid driving when tired. Never drive when under

the influence of alcohol or drugs (including pre- scription or over-the-counter drugs which may cause drowsiness). Always wear your seat belt as outlined in the Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system section of this manual, and also instruct your passengers to do so.

Seat belts help reduce the risk of injury in colli- sions and rollovers. In a rollover crash, an unbelted or improperly belted person is significantly more likely to be injured or killed than a person properly wearing a seat belt.

OFF-ROAD RECOVERY If the right side or left side wheels unintentionally leave the road surface, maintain control of the vehicle by following the procedure below. Please note that this procedure is only a general guide. The vehicle must be driven as appropriate based on the conditions of the vehicle, road and traffic.

1. Remain calm and do not overreact.

2. Do not apply the brakes.

3. Maintain a firm grip on the steering wheel with both hands and try to hold a straight course.

4. When appropriate, slowly release the accel- erator pedal to gradually slow the vehicle.

5-6 Starting and driving

5. If there is nothing in the way, steer the ve- hicle to follow the road while vehicle speed is reduced. Do not attempt to drive the ve- hicle back onto the road surface until vehicle speed is reduced.

6. When it is safe to do so, gradually turn the steering wheel until both tires return to the road surface. When all tires are on the road surface, steer the vehicle to stay in the ap- propriate driving lane.

If you decide that it is not safe to return the vehicle to the road surface based on vehicle, road or traffic conditions, gradually slow the vehicle to a stop in a safe place off the road.

RAPID AIR PRESSURE LOSS Rapid air pressure loss or a blow-out can occur if the tire is punctured or is damaged due to hitting a curb or pothole. Rapid air pressure loss can also be caused by driving on under-inflated tires.

Rapid air pressure loss can affect the handling and stability of the vehicle, especially at highway speeds.

Help prevent rapid air pressure loss by maintain- ing the correct air pressure and visually inspect the tires for wear and damage. See Wheels and tires in the Maintenance and do-it-yourself section of this manual. If a tire rapidly loses air

pressure or blows-out while driving, maintain control of the vehicle by following the procedure below. Please note that this procedure is only a general guide. The vehicle must be driven as appropriate based on the conditions of the ve- hicle, road and traffic.

WARNING

The following actions can increase the chance of losing control of the vehicle if there is a sudden loss of tire air pressure. Losing control of the vehicle may cause a collision and result in personal injury.

The vehicle generally moves or pulls in the direction of the flat tire.

Do not rapidly apply the brakes.

Do not rapidly release the accelerator pedal.

Do not rapidly turn the steering wheel.

1. Remain calm and do not over react.

2. Maintain a firm grip on the steering wheel with both hands and try to hold a straight course.

3. When appropriate, slowly release the accel- erator pedal to gradually slow the vehicle.

4. Gradually steer the vehicle to a safe location off the road and away from traffic if possible.

5. Lightly apply the brake pedal to gradually stop the vehicle.

6. Turn on the hazard warning flashers and either contact a roadside emergency service to change the tire or see Changing a flat tire in the In case of emergency section of this manual.

DRINKING ALCOHOL/DRUGS AND DRIVING

WARNING

Never drive under the influence of alcohol or drugs. Alcohol in the bloodstream re- duces coordination, delays reaction time and impairs judgement. Driving after drinking alcohol increases the likelihood of being involved in an accident injuring yourself and others. Additionally, if you are injured in an accident, alcohol can increase the severity of the injury.

Starting and driving 5-7

NISSAN is committed to safe driving. However, you must choose not to drive under the influence of alcohol. Every year thousands of people are injured or killed in alcohol-related accidents. Al- though the local laws vary on what is considered to be legally intoxicated, the fact is that alcohol affects all people differently and most people underestimate the effects of alcohol.

Remember, drinking and driving dont mix! And that is true for drugs, too (over-the-counter, pre- scription, and illegal drugs). Dont drive if your ability to operate your vehicle is impaired by alco- hol, drugs, or some other physical condition.

DRIVING SAFETY PRECAUTIONS Your NISSAN is designed for both normal and off-road use. However, avoid driving in deep wa- ter or mud as your NISSAN is mainly designed for leisure use, unlike a conventional off-road ve- hicle.

Remember that two-wheel drive models are less capable than four-wheel drive models for rough road driving and extrication when stuck in deep snow or mud, or the like.

Please observe the following precautions:

WARNING

Drive carefully when off the road and avoid dangerous areas. Every person who drives or rides in this vehicle should be seated with their seat belt fastened. This will keep you and your passengers in position when driving over rough terrain.

Do not drive across steep slopes. In- stead drive either straight up or straight down the slopes. Off-road vehicles can tip over sideways much more easily than they can forward or backward.

Many hills are too steep for any vehicle. If you drive up them, you may stall. If you drive down them, you may not be able to control your speed. If you drive across them, you may roll over.

Do not shift gears while driving on downhill grades as this could cause loss of control of the vehicle.

Stay alert when driving to the top of a hill. At the top there could be a drop-off or other hazard that could cause an accident.

If your engine stalls or you cannot make it to the top of a steep hill, never at- tempt to turn around. Your vehicle could tip or roll over. Always back straight down in R (Reverse) gear. Never back down in N (Neutral) or with the clutch depressed (manual transmission vehicles), using only the brake, as this could cause loss of control.

Heavy braking going down a hill could cause your brakes to overheat and fade, resulting in loss of control and an acci- dent. Apply brakes lightly and use a low gear to control your speed. Use the hill descent control feature (if so equipped).

Unsecured cargo can be thrown around when driving over rough terrain. Prop- erly secure all cargo so it will not be thrown forward and cause injury to you or your passengers.

5-8 Starting and driving

To avoid raising the center of gravity excessively, do not exceed the rated capacity of the roof rack (if so equipped) and evenly distribute the load. Secure heavy loads in the cargo area as far forward and as low as pos- sible. Do not equip the vehicle with tires larger than specified in this manual. This could cause your vehicle to roll over.

Do not grip the inside or spokes of the steering wheel when driving off-road. The steering wheel could move sud- denly and injure your hands. Instead drive with your fingers and thumbs on the outside of the rim.

Before operating the vehicle, ensure that the driver and all passengers have their seat belts fastened.

Always drive with the floor mats in place as the floor may become hot.

Lower your speed when encountering strong crosswinds. With a higher center of gravity, your NISSAN is more af- fected by strong side winds. Slower speeds ensure better vehicle control.

Do not drive beyond the performance capability of the tires, even with 4WD engaged (if so equipped).

For 4WD equipped vehicles, do not at- tempt to raise two wheels off the ground and shift the transmission to any drive or reverse position with the engine running. Doing so may result in drivetrain damage or unexpected ve- hicle movement which could result in serious vehicle damage or personal injury.

Do not attempt to test a 4WD equipped vehicle on a 2-wheel dynamometer (such as the dynamometers used by some states for emissions testing), or similar equipment even if the other two wheels are raised off the ground. Make sure you inform test facility personnel that your vehicle is equipped with 4WD before it is placed on a dynamometer. Using the wrong test equipment may result in drivetrain damage or unex- pected vehicle movement which could result in serious vehicle damage or per- sonal injury.

Accelerating quickly, sharp steering maneuvers or sudden braking may cause loss of control.

If at all possible, avoid sharp turning ma- neuvers, particularly at high speeds. Your NISSAN four-wheel drive vehicle has a higher center of gravity than a passenger car. The vehicle is not designed for cor- nering at the same speeds as passenger cars. Failure to operate this vehicle cor- rectly could result in loss of control and/or a rollover accident.

Always use tires of the same type, size, brand, construction (bias, bias-belted, or radial), and tread pattern on all four wheels. Install tire chains on the rear wheels when driving on slippery roads and drive carefully.

Be sure to check the brakes immedi- ately after driving in mud or water. See Brake system later in this section for Wet brakes.

Avoid parking your vehicle on steep hills. If you get out of the vehicle and it rolls forward, backward or sideways, you could be injured.

Whenever you drive off-road through sand, mud or water as deep as the wheel hub, more frequent maintenance may be required. See Periodic mainte- nance in the NISSAN Service and Maintenance Guide.

Starting and driving 5-9

WARNING

Never remove the ignition key or place the ignition switch in the LOCK position while driving. The steering wheel will lock (for models with a steering lock mechanism). This may cause the driver to lose control of the vehicle and could result in serious vehicle damage or per- sonal injury.

AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION (if so equipped) The ignition lock is designed so the ignition switch cannot be placed in the LOCK position and the key removed until the shift selector is moved to the P (Park) position.

When removing the key from the ignition, make sure the shift selector is in the P (Park) position.

If the shift selector is not returned to P (Park) position, the ignition switch cannot be moved to the LOCK position.

To remove the key from the ignition switch:

1. Shift the shift selector to the P (Park) posi- tion with the ignition switch in the ON posi- tion.

2. Place the ignition switch to the LOCK posi- tion.

3. Remove the key from the ignition.

If the shift selector is shifted to the P (Park) position after the ignition switch is placed in the OFF position or when the ignition switch cannot be turned to the LOCK position, proceed as follows to remove the key.

1. Move the shift selector into the P (Park) position.

2. Turn the ignition key slightly toward the ON position.

3. Turn the key to the LOCK position.

4. Remove the key.

The shift selector is designed so it cannot moved out of P (Park) and into any of the other gear positions if the ignition key is turned to OFF position or if the key is removed from the switch.

The shift selector can be moved if the igni- tion switch is in the ON position and the foot brake pedal is depressed.

WSD0041

IGNITION SWITCH

5-10 Starting and driving

There is an OFF position between the LOCK and ON positions. The OFF position is indicated by a 1 on the ignition switch. When the ignition is in the OFF position, the steering wheel is not locked (for mod- els with a steering lock mechanism).

In order for the steering wheel to be locked, it must be turned about 1/8 of a turn clockwise from the straight up position.

To lock the steering wheel, turn the key to the LOCK position. Remove the key. To unlock the steering wheel, insert the key and turn it gently while rotating the steer- ing wheel slightly right and left.

If the key will not turn from the LOCK posi- tion, turn the steering wheel to the left or right while turning the key to unlock the key cylinder.

MANUAL TRANSMISSION (if so equipped) The ignition switch includes a device that helps prevent accidental removal of the key while driv- ing.

The key can only be removed when the ignition switch is in the LOCK position.

On manual transmission models, to turn the igni- tion switch to the LOCK position from the ACC or ON position, place the ignition switch in the OFF position, push the key in, then place the ignition switch in LOCK position.

KEY POSITIONS LOCK: Normal parking position (0)

OFF: (Not used) (1)

ACC: (Accessories) (2)

This position activates electrical accessories such as the radio when the engine is not running.

ON: Normal operating position (3)

This position turns on the ignition system and the electrical accessories.

START: (4)

This position starts the engine. As soon as the engine has started, release the key. It automati- cally returns to the ON position.

WSD0052

Starting and driving 5-11

NISSAN VEHICLE IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM (if so equipped) The NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System will not allow the engine to start without the use of the registered key.

If the engine fails to start using a registered key (for example, when interference is caused by another registered key, an automated toll road device or automatic payment device on the key ring), restart the engine using the following pro- cedures:

1. Leave the ignition switch in the ON position for approximately 5 seconds.

2. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF or LOCK position, and wait approximately 10 sec- onds.

3. Repeat steps 1 and 2.

4. Restart the engine while holding the device (which may have caused the interference) separate from the registered key.

If the no start condition re-occurs, NISSAN rec- ommends placing the registered key on a sepa- rate key ring to avoid interference from other devices.

Make sure the area around the vehicle is clear.

Check fluid levels such as engine oil, cool- ant, brake and clutch fluid (if so equipped), and windshield-washer fluid as frequently as possible, or at least whenever you refuel.

Check that all windows and lights are clean.

Visually inspect tires for their appearance and condition. Also check tires for proper inflation.

Check that all doors are closed.

Position seat and adjust head restraints.

Adjust inside and outside mirrors.

Fasten the seat belt and ask all passengers to do likewise.

Check the operation of warning lights when the key is turned to the ON (3) position. See Warning/indicator lights and audible re- minders in the Instruments and controls section of this manual.

1. Apply the parking brake.

2. Automatic transmission:

Move the shift selector to P (Park) or N (Neutral). P (Park) is recommended.

The shift selector cannot be moved out of the P (Park) position and into any of the other gear positions if the ignition switch is placed in the OFF position or if the key is removed from the ignition switch.

The starter is designed not to operate if the shift selector is in any of the driving positions.

Manual transmission:

Move the shift selector to N (Neutral). De- press the clutch pedal to the floor while cranking the engine.

The starter is designed not to operate unless the clutch pedal is fully de- pressed.

BEFORE STARTING THE ENGINE STARTING THE ENGINE

5-12 Starting and driving

3. Crank the engine with your foot off the accelerator pedal by placing the ignition switch in the START position. Release the key when the engine starts. If the engine starts, but fails to run, repeat the above procedure.

If the engine is very hard to start in ex- tremely cold weather or when restarting, depress the accelerator pedal a little (ap- proximately 1/3 to the floor) and hold it and then crank the engine. Release the key and the accelerator pedal when the engine starts.

If the engine is very hard to start because it is flooded, depress the accelerator pedal all the way to the floor and hold it. Crank the engine for 5-6 seconds. After cranking the engine, release the accel- erator pedal. Crank the engine with your foot off the accelerator pedal by plac- ing the ignition in the START position. Release the key when the engine starts. If the engine starts, but fails to run, repeat the above procedure.

CAUTION

Do not operate the starter for more than 15 seconds at a time. If the engine does not start, turn the key off and wait 10 sec- onds before cranking again, otherwise the starter could be damaged.

4. Allow the engine to idle for at least 30 sec- onds after starting. Do not race the engine while warming it up. Drive at moderate speed for a short distance first, especially in cold weather.

NOTE:

Care should be taken to avoid situations that can lead to potential battery discharge and potential no-start conditions such as:

1. Installation or extended use of electronic accessories that consume battery power when the engine is not running (Phone char- gers, GPS, DVD players, etc.)

2. Vehicle is not driven regularly and/or only driven short distances. In these cases, the battery may need to be charged to maintain battery health.

AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION (if so equipped)

WARNING

Do not depress the accelerator pedal while shifting from P (Park) or N (Neu- tral) to R (Reverse), D (Drive), 3, 2 or 1. Always depress the brake pedal until shifting is completed. Failure to do so could cause you to lose control and have an accident.

Cold engine idle speed is high, so use caution when shifting into a forward or reverse gear before the engine has warmed up.

Never shift to P (Park) or R (Reverse) while the vehicle is moving. This could cause an accident.

Except in an emergency, do not shift to the N (Neutral) position while driving. Doing so can cause a loss of engine braking which may result in a collision, serious personal injury or death.

DRIVING THE VEHICLE

Starting and driving 5-13

CAUTION

Except in an emergency, do not shift to the N (Neutral) position while driving. Coasting with the transmission in the N (Neutral) position may cause serious damage to the transmission.

When stopping the vehicle on an uphill grade, do not hold the vehicle by de- pressing the accelerator pedal. The foot brake should be used for this purpose.

Do not downshift abruptly on slippery roads. This may cause a loss of control.

The automatic transmission in your vehicle is electronically controlled to produce maximum power and smooth operation.

The recommended operating procedures for this transmission are shown on the following pages. Follow these procedures for maximum vehicle performance and driving enjoyment.

Starting the vehicle

1. After starting the engine, fully depress the foot brake pedal before moving the shift selector out of the P (Park) position.

2. Keep the foot brake pedal depressed and move the shift selector into a driving gear.

3. Release the foot brake, then gradually start the vehicle in motion.

The automatic transmission is designed so the foot brake pedal MUST be depressed before shifting from P (Park) to any drive position while the ignition switch is in the ON position.

The shift selector cannot be moved out of the P (Park) position and into any of the other gear positions if the ignition switch is placed in the LOCK or OFF position.

To move the shift selector:

: Push the button while depressing the brake pedal

: Push the button to shift

: Shift without depressing brake pedal

Shifting

After starting the engine, fully depress the brake pedal and move the shift selector out of the P (Park) position.

LSD0151

5-14 Starting and driving

WARNING

Apply the parking brake if the shift selec- tor is in any position while the engine is not running. Failure to do so could cause the vehicle to move unexpectedly or roll away and result in serious personal injury or property damage.

If the ignition switch is placed in the OFF position for any reason while the vehicle is in N (Neutral), or any D (Drive) position, the ignition switch can- not be placed in the LOCK position and the key cannot be removed from the ignition switch. Move the shift selector to the P (Park) position, then the ignition switch can be placed in LOCK.

P (Park):

CAUTION

To prevent transmission damage, use the P (Park) or R (Reverse) position only when the vehicle is completely stopped.

Use the P (Park) shift selector position when the vehicle is parked or when starting the engine. Make sure the vehicle is completely stopped. The brake pedal should be depressed to move the shift selector from N (Neutral) or any drive position to P (Park). Apply the parking brake. When parking on a hill, apply the

parking brake first, then move the shift selector into the P (Park) position.

R (Reverse):

CAUTION

To prevent transmission damage, use the P (Park) or R (Reverse) position only when the vehicle is completely stopped.

Use the R (Reverse) position to back up. Make sure the vehicle is completely stopped before selecting the R (Reverse) position. The brake pedal must be depressed to move the shift selector from P (Park), N (Neutral) or any drive position to R (Reverse).

N (Neutral):

Neither forward nor reverse gear is engaged. The engine can be started in this position. You may shift to N (Neutral) and restart a stalled engine while the vehicle is moving.

D (Drive):

Use this position for all normal forward driving.

3 (Third gear):

Use this position for driving up and down long slopes where engine braking would be advanta- geous.

Do not downshift into the 3 position at speeds over the following and do not exceed the follow- ing speeds in the 3 position.

2WD:

99 MPH (160 km/h)

4H:

93 MPH (150 km/h)

4LO:

34 MPH (55 km/h)

2 (Second gear):

Use this position for hill climbing or engine brak- ing on downhill grades.

Do not downshift into the 2 position at speeds over the following and do not exceed the follow- ing speeds in the 2 position.

2WD:

62 MPH (100 km/h)

4H:

59 MPH (95 km/h)

4LO:

21 MPH (35 km/h)

Starting and driving 5-15

1 (Low gear):

Use this position when climbing steep hills slowly or slow driving through deep snow, sand or mud, or for maximum engine braking on steep downhill grades.

Do not downshift into the 1 position at speeds over the following and do not exceed the follow- ing speeds in the 1 position.

2WD:

37 MPH (60 km/h)

4H:

37 MPH (60 km/h)

4LO:

12 MPH (20 km/h)

Shift lock release If the battery is discharged, the shift selector may not be moved from the P (Park) position even with the brake pedal depressed.

To move the shift selector, release the shift lock. The shift selector can be moved to N (Neutral). However, the steering wheel will be locked un- less the ignition switch is placed in the ON posi- tion (for models with a steering lock mechanism). This allows the vehicle to be moved if the battery is discharged.

To push the shift lock release, complete the fol- lowing procedure:

1. Place the ignition switch in the LOCK posi- tion and remove the key.

2. Apply the parking brake.

3. Remove the shift lock release cover as shown.

4. Use a protective cloth on the tip of a small screwdriver before inserting it in the shift lock release slot and pushing down.

5. Move the shift selector to the N (Neutral) position while holding down the shift lock release.

6. Place the ignition switch in the ON position to unlock the steering wheel (for models with a steering lock mechanism).

7. Now the vehicle may be moved to the de- sired location.

If the shift selector cannot be moved out of P (Park), have a NISSAN dealer check the auto- matic transmission system as soon as possible.

LSD0141

5-16 Starting and driving

WARNING

If the shift selector cannot be moved from the P (Park) position while the engine is running and the brake pedal is depressed, the stop lights may not work. Malfunction- ing stop lights could cause an accident injuring yourself and others.

Accelerator downshift in D position For passing or hill climbing, depress the accel- erator pedal to the floor. This shifts the transmis- sion down into a lower gear, depending on the vehicle speed.

Overdrive switch

Each time your vehicle is started, the transmis- sion is automatically reset to overdrive ON.

ON: With the engine running and the shift selector in the D (Drive) position, the transmission upshifts into Overdrive as vehicle speed increases.

Overdrive does not engage until the engine has reached operating temperature.

OFF: For driving up and down long slopes where engine braking is nec- essary push the Overdrive switch once. The O/D OFF indicator light in the instrument panel comes on at this time.

When cruising at a low speed or climbing a gentle slope, you may feel uncomfortable shift shocks as the transmission shifts into and out of Overdrive repeatedly. In this case, depress the Overdrive switch to turn the Overdrive off. The O/D OFF indicator light in the instrument panel comes on at this time.

When driving conditions change, depress the Overdrive switch to turn the Overdrive on.

Remember not to drive at high speeds for ex- tended periods of time with the Overdrive off. This reduces fuel economy.

Each time your vehicle is started, the transmis- sion is automatically reset to overdrive ON.

ON: With the engine running and the shift selector in the D (Drive) position, the transmission upshifts into Overdrive as vehicle speed increases.

Overdrive does not engage until the engine has reached operating temperature.

LSD0142

Starting and driving 5-17

OFF: For driving up and down long slopes where engine braking is nec- essary push the Overdrive switch once. The O/D OFF indicator light in the instrument panel comes on at this time.

When cruising at a low speed or climbing a gentle slope, you may feel uncomfortable shift shocks as the transmission shifts into and out of Overdrive repeatedly. In this case, depress the Overdrive switch to turn the Overdrive off. The O/D OFF indicator light in the instrument panel comes on at this time.

When driving conditions change, depress the Overdrive switch to turn the Overdrive on.

Remember not to drive at high speeds for ex- tended periods of time with the Overdrive off. This reduces fuel economy.

MANUAL TRANSMISSION (if so equipped)

WARNING

Do not downshift abruptly on slippery roads. This may cause a loss of control.

Do not over-rev the engine when shift- ing to a lower gear. This may cause a loss of control or engine damage.

Do not shift to the N (Neutral) position while driving. Doing so may result in an accident due to loss of engine braking.

CAUTION

Do not rest your foot on the clutch pedal while driving. This may cause clutch damage.

Fully depress the clutch pedal before shifting to help prevent transmission damage.

Stop your vehicle completely before shifting into R (Reverse).

When the vehicle is stopped with the engine running (for example, at a stop light), shift to N (Neutral) and release the clutch pedal with the foot brake applied.

Shifting

To change gears, or when upshifting or down- shifting, depress the clutch pedal fully, shift into the appropriate gear, then release the clutch slowly and smoothly.

To ensure smooth gear changes, fully depress the clutch pedal before operating the shift selec- tor. If the clutch pedal is not fully depressed before the transmission is shifted, a gear noise may be heard. Transmission damage could oc- cur.

5 - speed WSD0154

5-18 Starting and driving

Start the vehicle in 1st gear and shift to 2nd, 3rd, 4th, 5th and 6th gear in sequence according to vehicle speed.

To back up depress the shift selector and then move it to the R (Reverse) position after stopping the vehicle completely.

On the 5-speed manual transmission model, you cannot shift directly from the 5th gear into R (Reverse). First shift into N (Neutral), then in to R (Reverse) after stopping the vehicle completely.

If it is difficult to move the shift selector into R (Reverse) or 1 (First), shift into N (Neutral), then release the clutch pedal. Fully depress the clutch pedal again and shift into R (Reverse) or 1 (First).

If your vehicle is equipped with 4-wheel drive, see Transfer case shifting procedures later in this section.

Suggested up-shift speeds

The following are suggested vehicle speeds for shifting into a higher gear. These suggestions relate to fuel economy and vehicle performance. Actual upshift speeds will vary according to road conditions, the weather and individual driving habits.

For QR25DE two-wheel drive models:

GEAR CHANGE MPH (km/h) 1st to 2nd 11 (17) 2nd to 3rd 15 (24) 3rd to 4th 24 (38) 4th to 5th 35 (56)

For VQ40DE two-wheel drive models and four-wheel drive models (2H and 4H posi- tion):

GEAR CHANGE MPH (km/h) 1st to 2nd 11 (17) 2nd to 3rd 17 (27) 3rd to 4th 25 (40) 4th to 5th 32 (51) 5th to 6th 45 (72)

Suggested maximum speed in each gear Downshift to a lower gear if the engine is not running smoothly, or if you need to accelerate.

Do not exceed the maximum suggested speed (shown below) in any gear. For level road driving, use the highest gear suggested for that speed. Always observe posted speed limits, and drive according to the road conditions, which will en- sure safe operation. Do not over-rev the engine when shifting to a lower gear as it may cause engine damage or loss of vehicle control.

Allowable maximum speed in each gear:

2wheel drive models (QR25DE engine)

GEAR MPH (km/h)

1st 34 (54)

2nd 58 (94)

3rd 89 (144)

4th

5th

6 - speed LSD0148

Starting and driving 5-19

2wheel drive models (VQ40DE engine)

GEAR MPH (km/h)

1st 35 (56)

2nd 60 (97)

3rd 87 (141)

4th

5th

4wheel drive models (VQ40DE engine)

2H/4H position

GEAR MPH (km/h) 1st 33 (54) 2nd 58 (93) 3rd 84 (135) 4th 5th 6th

4L position

GEAR MPH (km/h) 1st 12 (20) 2nd 22 (35) 3rd 32 (51) 4th 43 (70) 5th 55 (89) 6th

WARNING

Be sure the parking brake is fully re- leased before driving. Failure to do so can cause brake failure and lead to an accident.

Do not release the parking brake from outside the vehicle.

Do not use the shift selector in place of the parking brake. When parking, be sure the parking brake is fully engaged.

Do not leave children unattended in a vehicle. They could release the parking brake and cause an accident.

To engage: Pull the parking brake lever up A .

To release:

1. Firmly apply the foot brake.

2. Manual transmission models:

Place the shift selector in the N (Neutral) position.

Automatic transmission models:

Move the shift selector to the P (Park) position.

3. While pulling up on the parking brake lever slightly, push the button B and lower the lever completely .

4. Before driving, be sure the brake warning light goes out.

LSD0150

PARKING BRAKE

5-20 Starting and driving

1. ACCEL/RES switch 2. COAST/SET switch 3. ON/OFF switch 4. CANCEL switch

PRECAUTIONS ON CRUISE CONTROL

If the cruise control system malfunctions, it cancels automatically. The SET indicator light in the instrument panel then blinks to warn the driver.

If the SET indicator light blinks, turn the cruise control main switch off and have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer.

The SET indicator light may blink when the cruise control main switch is turned ON while pushing the ACCEL/RES, COAST/SET, or CANCEL switch (located on the steering wheel). To properly set the cruise control system, use the following pro- cedures.

WARNING

Do not use the cruise control when driving under the following conditions:

When it is not possible to keep the vehicle at a set speed.

In heavy traffic or in traffic that varies in speed.

On winding or hilly roads.

On slippery roads (rain, snow, ice, etc.).

In very windy areas.

Doing so could cause a loss of vehicle control and result in an accident.

CAUTION

On manual transmission models, do not shift into N (Neutral) without depressing the clutch pedal when the cruise control is set. Should this occur, depress the clutch pedal and turn the main switch off immediately. Failure to do so may cause engine damage.

CRUISE CONTROL OPERATIONS The cruise control allows driving at a speed be- tween 25 - 89 MPH (40 - 144 km/h) without keeping your foot on the accelerator pedal.

To turn on the cruise control, push the main switch. The CRUISE indicator light in the instru- ment panel comes on.

To set cruising speed, accelerate the vehicle to the desired speed, push the COAST/SET switch and release it. The SET indicator light in the instrument panel comes on. Take your foot off the accelerator pedal. Your vehicle maintains the set speed.

To pass another vehicle, depress the ac- celerator pedal. When you release the pedal, the vehicle returns to the previously set speed.

The vehicle may not maintain the set speed when going up or down steep hills. If this happens, drive without the cruise control.

WSD0153

CRUISE CONTROL (if so equipped)

Starting and driving 5-21

To cancel the preset speed, use one of the following three methods.

Push the CANCEL button; the SET indicator light in the instrument panel goes out.

Tap the brake pedal; the SET indicator light goes out.

Turn the main switch off. Both the CRUISE indicator light and SET indicator light in the instrument panel go out.

The cruise control is automatically canceled and the SET light in the instrument panel goes out if:

you depress the brake or clutch pedal while pushing the ACCEL/RES or COAST/SET switch. The preset speed is deleted from memory.

the vehicle slows down more than 8 MPH (13 km/h) below the set speed.

you depress the clutch pedal (manual trans- mission), or move the shift selector to N (Neutral) (automatic transmission).

To reset at a faster cruising speed, use one of the following three methods.

Depress the accelerator pedal. When the vehicle attains the desired speed, push and release the COAST/SET switch.

Push and hold the ACCEL/RES switch. When the vehicle attains the speed you de- sire, release the switch.

Push and release the ACCEL/RES switch. Each time you do this, the set speed in- creases by about 1 MPH (1.6 km/h).

To reset at a slower cruising speed, use one of the following three methods.

Lightly tap the brake pedal. When the ve- hicle attains the desired speed, push the COAST/SET switch and release it.

Push and hold the COAST/SET switch. Re- lease the switch when the vehicle slows to the desired speed.

Push and release the COAST/SET switch. Each time you do this, the set speed de- creases by about 1 MPH (1.6 km/h).

To resume the preset speed, push and re- lease the ACCEL/RES switch. The vehicle re- turns to the last set cruising speed when the vehicle speed is over 25 MPH (40 km/h).

CAUTION

During the first 1,200 miles (2,000 km), follow these recommendations to obtain maximum engine performance and en- sure the future reliability and economy of your new vehicle. Failure to follow these recommendations may result in short- ened engine life and reduced engine performance.

Avoid driving for long periods at constant speed, either fast or slow, and do not run the engine over 4,000 rpm.

Do not accelerate at full throttle in any gear.

Avoid quick starts.

Avoid hard braking as much as possible.

Do not tow a trailer for the first 500 miles (800 km). Your engine, axle or other parts could be damaged.

BREAK-IN SCHEDULE

5-22 Starting and driving

Follow these easy-to-use Fuel Efficient Driving Tips to help you achieve the most fuel economy from your vehicle.

1. Use Smooth Accelerator and Brake Pedal Application

Avoid rapid starts and stops

Use smooth, gentle accelerator and brake application whenever possible

Maintain constant speed while commut- ing and coast whenever possible

2. Maintain Constant Speed

Look ahead to try and anticipate and mini- mize stops

Synchronizing your speed with traffic lights allows you to reduce your number of stops

Maintaining a steady speed can minimize red light stops and improve fuel efficiency

3. Use Air Conditioning (A/C) at Higher Vehicle Speeds

Below 40 MPH (64 km/h), it is more efficient to open windows to cool the vehicle due to reduced engine load

Above 40 MPH (64 km/h), it is more efficient to use A/C to cool the vehicle due to increased aerodynamic drag

Recirculating the cool air in the cabin when the A/C is on reduces cooling load

4. Drive at Economical Speeds and Dis- tances

Observing the speed limit and not ex- ceeding 60 MPH (97 km/h) (where le- gally allowed) can improve fuel efficiency due to reduced aerodynamic drag

Maintaining a safe following distance be- hind other vehicles reduces unnecessary braking

Safely monitoring traffic to anticipate changes in speed permits reduced brak- ing and smooth acceleration changes

Select a gear range suitable to road con- ditions.

5. Use Cruise Control

Using cruise control during highway driv- ing helps maintain a steady speed

Cruise control is particularly effective in providing fuel savings when driving on flat terrains

6. Plan for the Shortest Route

Utilize a map or navigation system to de- termine the best route to save time

7. Avoid Idling

Shutting off your engine when safe for stops exceeding 3060 seconds saves fuel and reduces emissions

8. Buy an Automated Pass for Toll Roads

Automated passes permit drivers to use special lanes to maintain cruising speed through the toll and avoid stopping and starting

9. Winter Warm Up

Limit idling time to minimize impact to fuel economy

Vehicles typically need no more than 30 seconds of idling at start-up to effec- tively circulate the engine oil before driv- ing

Your vehicle will reach its ideal operating temperature more quickly while driving versus idling

FUEL EFFICIENT DRIVING TIPS

Starting and driving 5-23

10. Keeping your Vehicle Cool

Park your vehicle in a covered parking area or in the shade whenever possible

When entering a hot vehicle, opening the windows will help to reduce the inside temperature faster, resulting in reduced demand on your A/C system

Keep your engine tuned up.

Follow the recommended scheduled main- tenance.

Keep the tires inflated to the correct pres- sure. Low tire pressure increases tire wear and lowers fuel economy.

Keep the front wheels in correct alignment. Improper alignment increases tire wear and lowers fuel economy.

For vehicles equipped with , use 4H or 4L position only when necessary. Four- wheel drive operation lowers fuel economy.

Use the recommended viscosity engine oil. See Engine oil and oil filter recommenda- tions in Technical and consumer informa- tion later in this manual.

WARNING

For 4WD equipped vehicles, do not at- tempt to raise two wheels off the ground and shift the transmission to any drive or reverse position with the engine running. Doing so may result in drivetrain damage or unexpected ve- hicle movement which could result in serious vehicle damage or personal injury.

Do not attempt to test a 4WD equipped vehicle on a 2-wheel dynamometer (such as the dynamometers used by some states for emissions testing), or similar equipment even if the other two wheels are raised off the ground. Make sure you inform test facility personnel that your vehicle is equipped with 4WD before it is placed on a dynamometer. Using the wrong test equipment may result in drivetrain damage or unex- pected vehicle movement which could result in serious vehicle damage or per- sonal injury.

INCREASING FUEL ECONOMY USING FOUR WHEEL DRIVE (4WD) (if so equipped)

5-24 Starting and driving

CAUTION

Do not drive the vehicle in the 4H or 4LO position on dry hard surface roads. Driv- ing on dry, hard surfaces in 4H or 4LO may cause unnecessary noise, tire wear and increased fuel consumption.

If the 4WD warning light turns on when you are driving on dry hard surface roads:

in the 4H position, shift the 4WD shift switch to 2WD.

in the 4LO position for automatic transmission vehicles, stop the ve- hicle and shift the shift selector to the N position with the brake pedal depressed and shift the 4WD shift switch to 2WD.

in the 4LO position for manual trans- mission vehicles, stop the vehicle and shift the shift selector to the N position with the clutch pedal de- pressed and shift the 4WD shift switch to 2WD.

If the warning light is still on after the above operation, have your vehicle checked by a NISSAN dealer as soon as possible.

Starting and driving 5-25

TRANSFER CASE SHIFTING PROCEDURES The part time 4WD system provides 3 positions (2WD, 4H and 4LO), so you can select the desired drive mode according to the driving conditions.

2WD or 4WD shift procedure:

4WD Shift Switch Position Wheels Driven

Indicator Light Use Conditions 4WD Shift Procedure

4WD shift Transfer 4LO position

2WD

Rear wheels For driving on dry, paved roads (Economy drive)

Move the 4WD switch. 2WD <> 4H 4WD shift indicator light will indicate transfer shift position engaged.

4H

4 wheels For driving on rocky, sandy or snow-covered roads

Neutral

*1 May blink

Neutral disengages the auto- matic transmission mechani- cal parking lock, which will allow the vehicle to roll. Do not leave the transfer shift position in Neutral.*2

1. Stop the vehicle. 2. For automatic transmission vehicles: Shift the shift se-

lector to the (N) position with the brake pedal de- pressed. For manual transmission vehicles: Shift the shift selec- tor to the (N) position with the clutch depressed.

3. For automatic transmission vehicles: Depress and turn the 4WD shift switch to 4LO or 4H with the brake pedal depressed. For manual transmission vehicles: Depress and turn the 4WD switch to 4LO or 4H with the clutch pedal de- pressed.

THE TRANSFER CASE DOES NOT ENGAGE BETWEEN 4H AND 4LO (OR 4LO TO 4H) UNLESS YOU HAVE FIRST STOPPED THE VEHICLE, DEPRESSED THE BRAKE PEDAL AND MOVED THE SHIFT SELECTOR TO NEUTRAL FOR AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION VEHICLES. FOR MANUAL TRANSMISSION VEHICLES YOU MUST MOVE THE SHIFT SELECTOR TO NEUTRAL. *3

4LO

4 wheels

Illuminated

For use when maximum power and traction is required (for example: on steep grades or rocky, sandy, muddy roads)

5-26 Starting and driving

*1: Before moving the shift selector from neutral, wait until the 4LO indicator light stays on steady. This indicates that the 4WD shift procedure is completed and the transfer gear is correctly set in the 4LO position. If the vehicle is shifted into gear before the indicator is on steady, the transfer gear may grind, not engage correctly or stay in the neutral position.

- If the 4WD warning light illuminates, perform the following procedure to return the transfer case to correct operating condition.

1. Turn off the engine by turning the ignition switch OFF.

2. Start the engine.

- Check that the 4WD warning light turns off. If the 4WD warning light illuminates, have the system checked by a NISSAN dealer.

3. Apply the parking brake, for automatic transmission vehicles, depress the brake pedal and move the shift selector to Neutral position. For manual transmission vehicles, move the shift selector to Neutral position.

4. With the brake pedal depressed on automatic transmission vehicles or with the clutch pedal depressed on manual transmission vehicles, move the 4WD shift switch to desired mode.

- Be sure to wait until the transfer gear change completes before shifting the shift selector from Neutral position.

*2: While changing in and out of 4LO, the ignition key must be ON and the vehicles engine must be running for a shift to take place and for the indicator lights (4WD shift and 4LO position indicator) to be operable. Otherwise, the shift will not take place and no indicator lights will be on or flashing.

*3: Make sure the transfer 4LO position indicator light turns on when you shift the 4WD shift switch to 4LO. The indicator light will also turn on when 4LO is selected. See Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system later in this section.

Starting and driving 5-27

The transfer case 4WD shift switch is used to select either 2WD or 4WD depending on the driving conditions. There are three types of drive modes available, 2WD, 4H and 4LO.

The 4WD shift switch electronically controls the transfer case operation. Rotate the switch to move between each mode, 2WD, 4H and 4LO.

To change into or out of 4LO, the vehicle MUST be stationary, shift the shift selector to Neutral (N), and for automatic transmis- sion vehicles depress the brake pedal or for manual transmission vehicles depress the clutch pedal. The switch must be de- pressed and turned when changing into or out of 4LO.

WARNING

When parking, apply the parking brake before stopping the engine and make sure that the 4WD shift indicator light is on and the ATP warning light goes off. Otherwise, the vehicle could unexpect- edly move even if the automatic trans- mission is in the P position.

The 4LO indicator light must stop blink- ing and remain illuminated or turn off before shifting the transmission into gear. If the shift selector is shifted from the (N) position to any other gear when the 4LO indicator light is blinking, the vehicle may move unexpectedly.

CAUTION

Never shift the 4WD shift switch be- tween 4LO and 4H while driving.

The 4H position provides greater trac- tion. Avoid excessive speed, as it will cause increased fuel consumption and higher oil temperatures, and could damage drivetrain components. Speeds over 62 MPH (100 km/h) in 4H is not recommended

The 4LO position provides maximum power and traction. Avoid raising ve- hicle speed excessively, as the maxi- mum speed is approximately 31 MPH (50 km/h).

When driving straight, shift the 4WD shift switch to the 2WD or 4H position. Do not move the 4WD shift switch when making a turn or reversing.

Do not shift the 4WD shift switch (be- tween 2WD and 4H) while driving on steep downhill grades. Use the engine brake and low automatic transmission gears (D1 or D2) or manual transmis- sion (1st gear or 2nd gear) for engine braking.

Do not operate the 4WD shift switch (between 2WD and 4H) with the rear wheels spinning.

Do not drive on dry hard surface roads in the 4H or 4LO position. Driving on dry hard surfaces in 4H or 4LO may cause unnecessary noise and tire wear. NISSAN recommends driving in the 2WD position under these conditions.

The 4WD transfer case may not be shifted between 4H and 4LO at low am- bient temperatures and the transfer 4LO position indicator light may blink even when the 4WD shift switch is shifted. After driving for a while you can change the 4WD transfer case between 4H and 4LO.

When driving on rough roads,

Set the 4WD shift switch to 4H or 4LO.

Drive carefully according to the road surface conditions.

5-28 Starting and driving

When the vehicle is stuck,

Set the 4WD shift switch to 4H or 4LO.

Use the Electronic Locking Rear Differential (E-Lock) system (if so equipped). Turn the switch ON while the vehicle is stationary and apply the throttle to try to free the vehicle.

If it is difficult to free the vehicle, rock the vehicle back and forth between reverse and drive gears.

If the vehicle is stuck deep in mud, place stones or wooden blocks under the tires. Then try the recovery procedures above. Tire chains may be effective.

CAUTION

Do not spin the tires excessively. Tires will sink deep into the mud, making it difficult to free the vehicle.

Avoid shifting gears with the engine running at high speeds as this may cause malfunction.

4WD shift switch operations

Shift the 4WD shift switch to either the 2WD, 4H or 4LO position, depending on driving conditions.

If the 4WD shift switch is operated while making a turn, accelerating or decelerating or if the key switch is turned off while in the 4H or 4LO posi- tion, you may feel a jolt. This is not abnormal.

When the vehicle is stopped after mak- ing a turn, you may feel a slight jolt after the shift selector is shifted to N or P. This occurs because the transfer clutch is released and not because of a malfunction.

CAUTION

When driving straight, shift the 4WD shift switch to the 2WD or 4H position. Do not move the 4WD shift switch when making a turn or reversing.

Do not shift the 4WD shift switch while driving on steep downhill grades. Use the engine brake and low automatic transmission gears (D1 or D2) or manual transmission (1st gear or 2nd gear) for engine braking.

Do not operate the 4WD shift switch with the rear wheels spinning.

Before placing the 4WD shift switch in the 4H position from 2WD, ensure the vehicle speed is less than 62 MPH (100 km/h). Failure to do so can dam- age the 4WD system.

Never shift the 4WD shift switch be- tween 4LO and 4H while driving.

LSD0145

Starting and driving 5-29

4WD shift indicator light

The 4WD shift indicator light is located in the odometer display.

The light should turn off within 1 second after turning the ignition switch to the ON position.

While the engine is running, the 4WD shift indi- cator light will illuminate the position selected by the 4WD shift switch.

The 4WD shift indicator light may blink while shifting from one drive mode to the other. When the shifting is com- pleted, the 4WD shift indicator light will come on.

If the 4WD warning light comes on, the 4WD indicator light goes out.

CAUTION

If the 4WD shift indicator light indication changes to 2WD when the 4WD shift switch is shifted to the 4H position at low ambient temperatures, the 2WD mode may be being engaged due to malfunc- tioning drive system. If the indicator does not return to normal and the 4WD warning light comes on, have the system checked by the nearest NISSAN dealer.

4WD warning light

Warning light Comes on or blinks when:

Comes on

There is a mal- function in the 4wheel drive

system

Blinks slowly

The difference in wheel rotation is

large

The 4WD warning light is located in the meter.

The 4WD warning light comes on when the igni- tion switch is turned to ON. It turns off soon after the engine is started.

If any malfunction occurs in the 4WD system when the ignition switch is ON, the warning light will either remain illuminated or blink.

If the 4WD warning light comes on, the 4WD shift indicator light goes out.

A large difference between the diameters of front and rear wheels will make the warning light blink slowly (about once per two seconds). Change the 4WD shift switch into 2WD and do not drive fast.

CAUTION

If the warning light comes on or blinks slowly during operation, have your ve- hicle checked by a NISSAN dealer as soon as possible.

Shifting between 4H and 4LO is not recommended when the 4WD warning light turns on.

LSD0147

5-30 Starting and driving

When the warning light comes on, the 2WD mode may be engaged even if the 4WD shift switch is in 4H. Be especially careful when driving. If corresponding parts are malfunctioning, the 4WD mode will not be engaged even if the 4WD shift switch is shifted.

Do not drive the vehicle in the 4H or 4LO position on dry hard surface roads. Driv- ing on dry, hard surfaces in 4H or 4LO may cause unnecessary noise, tire wear and increased fuel consumption.

If the 4WD warning light turns on when you are driving on dry hard surface roads:

in the 4H position, shift the 4WD shift switch to 2WD.

in the 4LO position for automatic transmission vehicles, stop the ve- hicle and shift the shift selector to the N position with the brake pedal depressed and shift the 4WD shift switch to 2WD.

in the 4LO position for manual trans- mission vehicles, stop the vehicle and shift the shift selector to the N position with the clutch pedal de- pressed and shift the 4WD shift switch to 2WD.

If the warning light is still on after the above operation, have your vehicle checked by a NISSAN dealer as soon as possible.

The transfer case may be damaged if you continue driving with the warning light blinking.

The E-Lock system can provide additional trac- tion and should only be used when a vehicle has become or is becoming stuck. This system oper- ates by electronically locking the two rear drive wheels together, allowing them to turn at the same speed. The system is used when it is not possible to free a stuck vehicle even when using the 4LO position (4 wheel drive vehicles).

When added traction is required, activate the E-Lock system by pushing the switch ON. See Electronic locking rear differential (E-Lock) sys- tem switch in the Instruments and Controls section. Once the system fully engages, the indi- cator light in the instrument panel will remain ON. When the system is activated, both rear wheels will engage, providing added traction.

The rear wheels may momentarily slip or move to engage the system, and the system will only engage up to approximately 4 MPH (7 km/h). Once the vehicle is free, the system should be turned OFF and driving resumed.

The Anti-Lock Brake (ABS) system is disabled and the ABS light illuminates when the E-Lock system is ON. Also, the Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system is disabled and the VDC light illuminates when the E-Lock system is ON.

ELECTRONIC LOCKING REAR DIFFERENTIAL (E-Lock) SYSTEM (if so equipped)

Starting and driving 5-31

WARNING

Never leave the E-Lock system ON when driving on paved or hard-surfaced roads. Turning the vehicle may result in the rear wheels slipping and result in an accident and personal injury. After us- ing the E-Lock system to free the ve- hicle, turn the system OFF.

Use the E-Lock system only when free- ing a stuck vehicle. Try the 4LO position before using the E-Lock system. Never use the E-Lock system on a slippery road surface such as snow or ice sur- face. Using the E-Lock system when driving in these road conditions may cause unexpected movement of the ve- hicle during engine braking, accelerat- ing or turning, which may result in an accident and serious personal injury.

CAUTION

After using the E-Lock system, turn the switch OFF to prevent possible damage to driveline components from extended use.

Do not drive the vehicle at speeds faster than 12 MPH (20 km/h) when the sys- tem is engaged. Doing so could damage drivetrain components.

Do not turn on the E-lock system while the tires are spinning. Doing so could damage drivetrain components.

5-32 Starting and driving

WARNING

Do not stop or park the vehicle over flammable materials such as dry grass, waste paper or rags. They may ignite and cause a fire.

Safe parking procedures require that both the parking brake be set and the transmission placed into P (Park) for automatic transmission models or in an appropriate gear for manual transmis- sion models. Failure to do so could cause the vehicle to move unexpectedly or roll away and result in an accident.

Make sure the shift selector has been pushed as far forward as it can go and cannot be moved without depressing the foot brake pedal.

Never leave the engine running while the vehicle is unattended.

Do not leave children unattended inside the vehicle. They could unknowingly ac- tivate switches or controls. Unattended children could become involved in seri- ous accidents.

1. Firmly apply the parking brake.

2. Manual transmission models:

Place the shift selector in the R (Reverse) position. When parking on an uphill grade, place the shift selector in 1st gear.

Automatic transmission models:

Move the shift selector to the P (Park) posi- tion.

3. To help prevent the vehicle from rolling into traffic when parked on an incline, it is a good practice to turn the wheels as illustrated.

HEADED DOWNHILL WITH CURB: A

Turn the wheels into the curb and move the vehicle forward until the curb side wheel gently touches the curb.

HEADED UPHILL WITH CURB: B

Turn the wheels away from the curb and move the vehicle back until the curb side wheel gently touches the curb.

HEADED UPHILL OR DOWNHILL, NO CURB: C

Turn the wheels toward the side of the road so the vehicle will move away from the cen- ter of the road if it moves.

4. Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK posi- tion and remove the key.

WSD0050

PARKING/PARKING ON HILLS

Starting and driving 5-33

The power assisted steering uses a hydraulic pump, driven by the engine, to assist steering.

If the engine stops or the drive belt breaks, you will still have control of the vehicle. However, much greater steering effort is needed, especially in sharp turns and at low speeds.

WARNING

If the engine is not running or is turned off while driving, the power assist for the steering will not work. Steering will be harder to operate.

The brake system has two separate hydraulic circuits. If one circuit malfunctions, you will still have braking at 2 wheels.

BRAKE PRECAUTIONS

Vacuum assisted brakes

The brake booster aids braking by using engine vacuum. If the engine stops, you can stop the vehicle by depressing the brake pedal. However, greater foot pressure on the brake pedal will be required to stop the vehicle and stopping dis- tance will be longer.

Using the brakes

Avoid resting your foot on the brake pedal while driving. This will overheat the brakes, wear out the brake pads faster, and reduce gas mileage.

To help reduce brake wear and to prevent the brakes from overheating, reduce speed and downshift to a lower gear before going down a slope or long grade. Overheated brakes may reduce braking performance and could result in loss of vehicle control.

WARNING

While driving on a slippery surface, be careful when braking, accelerating or downshifting. Abrupt braking or accel- erating could cause the wheels to skid and result in an accident.

If the engine is not running or is turned off while driving, the power assist for the brakes will not work. Braking will be harder.

Wet brakes

When the vehicle is washed or driven through water, the brakes may get wet. As a result, your braking distance will be longer and the vehicle may pull to one side during braking.

To dry the brakes, drive the vehicle at a safe speed while lightly pressing the brake pedal to heat up the brakes. Do this until the brakes return to normal. Avoid driving the vehicle at high speeds until the brakes function correctly.

Parking brake break-in

Break-in the parking brake shoes whenever the effect of the parking brake is weakened or when- ever the parking brake shoes and/or drum/rotors are replaced, in order to assure the best brake performance.

POWER STEERING BRAKE SYSTEM

5-34 Starting and driving

This procedure is described in the vehicle service manual and can be performed by a NISSAN dealer.

ANTI-LOCK BRAKING SYSTEM (ABS)

WARNING

The Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) is a sophisticated device, but it cannot pre- vent accidents resulting from careless or dangerous driving techniques. It can help maintain vehicle control during braking on slippery surfaces. Remem- ber that stopping distances on slippery surfaces will be longer than on normal surfaces even with ABS. Stopping dis- tances may also be longer on rough, gravel or snow covered roads, or if you are using tire chains. Always maintain a safe distance from the vehicle in front of you. Ultimately, the driver is respon- sible for safety.

Tire type and condition may also affect braking effectiveness.

When replacing tires, install the specified size of tires on all four wheels.

When installing a spare tire, make sure that it is the proper size and type as specified on the Tire and Loading Information label. See Tire and Loading Information label in the Technical and consumer informa- tion section of this manual.

For detailed information, see Wheels and tires in the Mainte- nance and do-it-yourself section of this manual.

The Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) controls the brakes so the wheels do not lock during hard braking or when braking on slippery surfaces. The system detects the rotation speed at each wheel and varies the brake fluid pressure to pre- vent each wheel from locking and sliding. By preventing each wheel from locking, the system helps the driver maintain steering control and helps to minimize swerving and spinning on slip- pery surfaces.

Using the system

Depress the brake pedal and hold it down. De- press the brake pedal with firm steady pressure, but do not pump the brakes. The ABS will oper- ate to prevent the wheels from locking up. Steer the vehicle to avoid obstacles.

WARNING

Do not pump the brake pedal. Doing so may result in increased stopping distances.

Self-test feature

The ABS includes electronic sensors, electric pumps, hydraulic solenoids and a computer. The computer has a built-in diagnostic feature that tests the system each time you start the engine and move the vehicle at a low speed in forward or reverse. When the self-test occurs, you may hear a clunknoise and/or feel a pulsation in the brake pedal. This is normal and does not indicate a malfunction. If the computer senses a malfunc- tion, it switches the ABS off and illuminates the ABS warning light on the instrument panel. The brake system then operates normally, but without anti-lock assistance.

If the ABS warning light illuminates during the self-test or while driving, have the vehicle checked by a NISSAN dealer.

Normal operation

The ABS operates at speeds above 3 - 6 MPH (5 - 10 km/h). The speed varies according to road conditions.

Starting and driving 5-35

When the ABS senses that 1 or more wheels are close to locking up, the actuator rapidly applies and releases hydraulic pressure. This action is similar to pumping the brakes very quickly. You may feel a pulsation in the brake pedal and hear a noise from under the hood or feel a vibration from the actuator when it is operating. This is normal and indicates that the ABS is operating properly. However, the pulsation may indicate that road conditions are hazardous and extra care is re- quired while driving.

ABLS system uses automatic braking to transfer power from a slipping drive wheel to the wheel on the same axle with more trac- tion. The ABLS system applies braking to the slipping wheel, which helps redirect power to the other wheel.

On 4WD models the ABLS system operates in both 4H and 4LO modes. If 4WD mode is engaged, the ABLS system operates for both drive axles. On 2WD vehicles, the ABLS sys- tem operates on the drive axle only.

The ABLS system is always ON. In some conditions, the system may automatically turn the ABLS system off. If the system is automatically turned off, normal brake func- tion will continue. ABLS will function even when the VDC system is turned OFF.

The ABLS does not operate if both wheels on a drive axle are slipping.

WARNING

The ABLS system helps provide in- creased traction, but will not prevent accidents due to abrupt steering opera- tion or by careless driving or dangerous driving practices. Reduce vehicle speed and be especially careful when driving and cornering on slippery surfaces. Al- ways drive carefully.

Do not modify the vehicles suspension. If suspension parts such as shock ab- sorbers, struts, springs, stabilizer bars, bushings and wheels are not NISSAN approved for your vehicle or are ex- tremely deteriorated, the ABLS system may not operate properly. This could adversely affect vehicle handling per- formance, and the slip indicator light may illuminate.

If brake related parts such as brake pads, rotors and calipers are not NISSAN recommended or are extremely deteriorated, the ABLS system may not operate properly and the slip indicator light may illuminate.

If wheels or tires other than the NISSAN recommended ones are used, the ABLS system may not operate properly and the slip indicator light may illuminate.

ACTIVE BRAKE LIMITED SLIP (ABLS) SYSTEM

5-36 Starting and driving

The Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system uses various sensors to monitor driver inputs and ve- hicle motion. Under certain driving conditions, the VDC System helps to perform the following functions:

Controls brake pressure to reduce wheel slip on one slipping drive wheel so power is transferred to a non slipping drive wheel on the same axle.

Controls brake pressure and engine output to reduce drive wheel slip based on vehicle speed (traction control function).

If the 4WD transfer case is shifted into 4LO the indicator light will come on and the VDC system will be turned off. See Us- ing four wheel drive (4WD) earlier in this section.

Controls brake pressure at individual wheels and engine output to help the driver maintain control of the vehicle in the following condi- tions:

understeer (vehicle tends to not follow the steered path despite increased steer- ing input)

oversteer (vehicle tends to spin due to certain road or driving conditions)

The VDC system can help the driver to maintain control of the vehicle, but it can not prevent loss of vehicle control in all driving situations.

When the VDC system operates, the indi- cator in the instrument panel flashes so note the following:

The road may be slippery or the system may determine some action is required to help keep the vehicle on the steered path.

You may feel a pulsation in the brake pedal and hear a noise or vibration from under the hood. This is normal and indicates that the VDC system is working properly.

Adjust your speed and driving to the road conditions.

See Slip indicator light and Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) OFF indicator light in the Instru- ments and controls section.

If a malfunction occurs in the system, the indicator light will come on in the instrument panel. The VDC system automatically turns off when these indicator lights are off.

The VDC OFF switch is used to turn off the VDC system. The indicator illuminates to indi- cate the VDC system is off.

When the VDC switch is used to turn off the system, the VDC system still operates to prevent one drive wheel from slipping by transferring power to a non slipping drive wheel. The indicator flashes if this occurs. All other VDC functions are off and the indicator will not flash.

The VDC system is automatically reset to on when the ignition switch is placed in the off position then back to the on position.

The computer has a built in diagnostic feature that tests the system each time you start the engine and move the vehicle forward or in reverse at a slow speed. When the self-test occurs, you may hear a clunk noise and/or feel a pulsation in the brake pedal. This is normal and is not an indication of a malfunction.

WARNING

The VDC system is designed to help the driver maintain stability but does not prevent accidents due to abrupt steer- ing operation at high speeds or by care- less or dangerous driving techniques. Reduce vehicle speed and be especially careful when driving and cornering on slippery surfaces and always drive carefully.

VEHICLE DYNAMIC CONTROL (VDC) SYSTEM

Starting and driving 5-37

Do not modify the vehicles suspension. If suspension parts such as shock ab- sorbers, struts, springs, stabilizer bars, bushings and wheels are not NISSAN recommended for your vehicle or are extremely deteriorated, the VDC system may not operate properly. This could adversely affect vehicle handling per- formance, and the indicator may flash or the indicator light may illuminate.

If brake related parts such as brake pads, rotors and calipers are not NISSAN recommended or are extremely deteriorated, the VDC system may not operate properly and the indica- tor light may illuminate.

If engine control related parts are not NISSAN recommended or are extremely deteriorated, the indicator light may illuminate.

When driving on extremely inclined sur- faces such as higher banked corners, the VDC system may not operate prop- erly and the indicator may flash or the indicator light may illuminate. Do not drive on these types of roads.

When driving on an unstable surface such as a turntable, ferry, elevator or ramp, the indicator may flash or the indicator light may illuminate. This is not a malfunction. Restart the engine after driving onto a stable surface.

If wheels or tires other than the NISSAN recommended ones are used, the VDC system may not operate properly and the indicator may flash or the indicator light may illuminate.

The VDC system is not a substitute for winter tires or tire chains on a snow covered road.

WARNING

Never rely solely on the hill descent control system to control vehicle speed when driving on steep down hill grades. Always drive carefully and attentively when using the hill descent control sys- tem and decelerate the vehicle speed by depressing the brake pedal if neces- sary. Be especially careful when driving on frozen, muddy or an extremely steep downhill roads. Failure to control ve- hicle speed may result in a loss of con- trol of the vehicle and possible serious injury or death.

The hill descent control may not control the vehicle speed on a hill under all load or road conditions. Always be prepared to depress the brake pedal to control vehicle speed. Failure to do so may re- sult in a collision or serious personal injury.

The hill descent control system helps maintain vehicle speed when driving under 15-21 MPH (25-35 km/h) on steeper downhill grades. Hill descent control is useful when engine braking alone in 4H or 4L cannot control vehicle speed. Hill descent control applies the vehicle brakes to control vehicle speed allowing the driver to con-

HILL DESCENT CONTROL SYSTEM (if so equipped)

5-38 Starting and driving

centrate on steering while reducing the burden of brake and accelerator operation.

When additional braking is required on steep downhill roads activate the hill de- scent control system by pushing the switch ON, see Hill descent control switch in the Instruments and controls section.

Once the system is activated the indicator light will remain on in the instrument panel, see Hill descent control system on indicator light in the Instruments and controls sec- tion.

If the accelerator or brake pedal is depressed while the hill descent control system is on, the system will stop operating temporarily. As soon as the accelerator or brake pedal is released, the hill descent control system begins to function again if the hill descent control operating condi- tions are fulfilled.

For the best results, when descending steep downhill grades, the hill descent control switch should be ON and the shift selector in 2 (Second gear) or 1 (Low gear) for engine braking.

WARNING

Never rely solely on the hill start assist system to prevent the vehicle from mov- ing backward on a hill. Always drive carefully and attentively. Depress the brake pedal when the vehicle is stopped on a steep hill. Be especially careful when stopped on a hill on frozen or muddy roads. Failure to prevent the vehicle from rolling backwards may re- sult in a loss of control of the vehicle and possible serious injury or death.

The hill start assist system is not de- signed to hold the vehicle at a standstill on a hill. Depress the brake pedal when the vehicle is stopped on a steep hill. Failure to do so may cause the vehicle to roll backwards and may result in a collision or serious personal injury.

The hill start assist may not prevent the vehicle from rolling backwards on a hill under all load or road conditions. Al- ways be prepared to depress the brake pedal to prevent the vehicle from rolling backwards. Failure to do so may result in a collision or serious personal injury.

The hill start assist system automatically keeps the brakes applied to help prevent the vehicle from rolling backwards in the time it takes the driver to release the brake pedal and apply the accelerator when the vehicle is stopped on a hill.

Hill start assist will operate automatically under the following conditions:

The shift selector is shifted to a forward or reverse gear.

The vehicle is stopped completely on a hill by applying the brake.

The maximum holding time is 2 seconds. After 2 seconds the vehicle will begin to roll back and hill start assist will stop operating completely.

Hill start assist will not operate when the shift selector is shifted to N or P or on a flat and level road.

HILL START ASSIST SYSTEM (if so equipped)

Starting and driving 5-39

WARNING

Always turn and look back before back- ing up. The RSS is not a substitute for proper backing procedures.

Read and understand the limitations of the rear sonar system as contained in this section. Inclement weather may af- fect the function of the RSS; this may include reduced performance or a false activation.

This system is not designed to prevent contact with small or moving objects.

The system is designed as an aid to the driver in detecting large stationary ob- jects to help avoid damaging the ve- hicle. The system will not detect small objects below the bumper, and may not detect objects close to the bumper or on the ground.

If your vehicle sustains damage to the rear bumper fascia, leaving it mis- aligned or bent, the sensing zone may be altered causing inaccurate measure- ment of obstacles or false alarms.

The Rear Sonar System (RSS) sounds a tone to warn the driver of obstacles near the rear bumper when the shift selector is in R (Reverse). The system may not detect objects at speeds above 3 mph (5 km/h) and may not detect certain angu- lar or moving objects.

The RSS detects obstacles up to 5.9 ft (1.8 m) from the rear bumper with a decreased coverage area at the outer corners of the bumper, (refer to the illustration for approximate zone coverage areas). As you move closer to the obstacle, the rate of the tone increases. When the obstacle is less than 10 in (25.0 cm) away, the tone will sound continuously. If the RSS detects a station- ary or receding object further than 10 in (25.0 cm) from the side of the vehicle, the tone

will sound for only three seconds. Once the sys- tem detects an object approaching, the tone will sound again.

The RSS automatically turns on when the shift selector is placed in R (Reverse) and the ignition is ON. The RSS OFF switch on the instrument panel allows the driver to turn the RSS on and off. To turn the RSS off, the ignition must be ON, and the shift selector in R (Reverse). An indicator light on the switch will illuminate when the system is turned off. If the indicator light illuminates when the RSS is not turned off, it may indicate a mal- function in the RSS.

Keep the RSS sensors (located on the rear bum- per fascia) free from snow, ice and large accumu- lations of dirt (do not clean the sensors with sharp objects). If the sensors are covered, it will affect the accuracy of the RSS.

WSD0103

REAR SONAR SYSTEM (if so equipped)

5-40 Starting and driving

FREEING A FROZEN DOOR LOCK

To prevent a door lock from freezing, apply de-icer through the key hole. If the lock becomes frozen, heat the key before inserting it into the key hole or use the remote keyless entry keyfob (if so equipped).

ANTI-FREEZE

In the winter when it is anticipated that the tem- perature will drop below 32F (0C), check the anti-freeze to assure proper winter protection. For details, see Engine cooling system in the Maintenance and do-it-yourself section of this manual.

BATTERY

If the battery is not fully charged during extremely cold weather conditions, the battery fluid may freeze and damage the battery. To maintain maxi- mum efficiency, the battery should be checked regularly. For details, see Battery in the Mainte- nance and do-it-yourself section of this manual.

DRAINING OF COOLANT WATER If the vehicle is to be left outside without anti-freeze, drain the cooling system, including the engine block. Refill before operating the vehicle. For de- tails, see Changing engine coolant in the Main- tenance and do-it-yourself section of this manual.

TIRE EQUIPMENT 1. SUMMER tires have a tread designed to

provide superior performance on dry pave- ment. However, the performance of these tires will be substantially reduced in snowy and icy conditions. If you operate your ve- hicle on snowy or icy roads, NISSAN recom- mends the use of MUD & SNOW or ALL SEASON TIRES on all four wheels. Please consult a NISSAN dealer for the tire type, size, speed rating and availability informa- tion.

2. For additional traction on icy roads, studded tires may be used. However, some U.S. states and Canadian provinces prohibit their use. Check local, state and provincial laws before installing studded tires.

Skid and traction capabilities of studded snow tires on wet or dry surfaces may be poorer than that of non-studded snow tires.

3. Tire chains may be used. For details see Tire chains in the Maintenance and do-it- yourself section of this manual.

SPECIAL WINTER EQUIPMENT

It is recommended that the following items be carried in the vehicle during winter:

A scraper and stiff-bristled brush to remove ice and snow from the windows and wiper blades.

A sturdy, flat board to be placed under the jack to give it firm support.

A shovel to dig the vehicle out of snowdrifts.

Extra washer fluid to refill the windshield- washer fluid reservoir.

DRIVING ON SNOW OR ICE

WARNING

Wet ice (32F, 0C and freezing rain), very cold snow or ice can be slick and very hard to drive on. The vehicle will have much less traction or grip under these conditions. Try to avoid driving on wet ice until the road is salted or sanded.

Whatever the condition, drive with cau- tion. Accelerate and slow down with care. If accelerating or downshifting too fast, the drive wheels will lose even more traction.

COLD WEATHER DRIVING

Starting and driving 5-41

Allow more stopping distance under these conditions. Braking should be started sooner than on dry pavement.

Allow greater following distances on slippery roads.

Watch for slippery spots (glare ice). These may appear on an otherwise clear road in shaded areas. If a patch of ice is seen ahead, brake before reach- ing it. Try not to brake while on the ice, and avoid any sudden steering maneuvers.

Do not use the cruise control on slip- pery roads.

Snow can trap dangerous exhaust gases under your vehicle. Keep snow clear of the exhaust pipe and from around your vehicle.

ENGINE BLOCK HEATER (if so equipped)

Engine block heaters are used to assist with cold temperature starting.

The engine block heater should be used when the outside temperature is 20F (-7C) or lower.

WARNING

Do not use your engine block heater with an ungrounded electrical system or a 2-pronged adapter. You can be se- riously injured by an electrical shock if you use an ungrounded connection.

Disconnect and properly store the en- gine block heater cord before starting the engine. Damage to the cord could result in an electrical shock and can cause serious injury.

Use a heavy-duty 3-wire, 3-pronged ex- tension cord rated for at least 10 A. Plug the extension cord into a Ground Fault Interrupt (GFI) protected, grounded 110-VAC outlet. Failure to use the proper extension cord or a grounded outlet can result in a fire or electrical shock and cause serious personal injury.

To use the engine block heater:

1. Turn the engine off.

2. Open the hood and unwrap the engine block heater cord.

3. Plug the engine block heater cord into a grounded 3-wire, 3-pronged extension cord.

4. Plug the extension cord into a Ground Fault Interrupt (GFI) protected, grounded 110- volt AC (VAC) outlet.

5. The engine block heater must be plugged in for at least 2 - 4 hours, depending on outside temperatures, to properly warm the engine coolant. Use an appropriate timer to turn the engine block heater on.

6. Before starting the engine, unplug and prop- erly store the cord to keep it away from moving parts.

5-42 Starting and driving

6 In case of emergency

First aid kit (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-2 Hazard warning flasher switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3 Flat tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3

Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS). . . . . . . . . . 6-3 Changing a flat tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4

Jump starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-10

Push starting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12 If your vehicle overheats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12 Towing your vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-13

Towing recommended by NISSAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-14 Vehicle recovery (freeing a stuck vehicle) . . . . . . . . . 6-15

The first aid kit is located in the under-seat stor- age bins.

To access the first aid kit:

For King cab model, lift up the rear jump seat and remove net to remove the first aid kit. Refer to Jump Seats in the Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system section ear- lier in the manual.

For Crew cab model, lift up the rear bench seat and remove the net to remove the first aid kit. Refer to Folding the rear bench seat in the Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system section earlier in the manual.

King cab model LCE0108

Crew cab model LCE0113

FIRST AID KIT (if so equipped)

6-2 In case of emergency

Push the switch on to warn other drivers when you must stop or park under emergency condi- tions. All turn signal lights flash.

WARNING

If stopping for an emergency, be sure to move the vehicle well off the road.

Do not use the hazard warning flashers while moving on the highway unless unusual circumstances force you to drive so slowly that your vehicle might become a hazard to other traffic.

Turn signals do not work when the haz- ard warning flasher lights are on.

The flashers will operate with the ignition switch placed in any position.

Some state laws may prohibit the use of the hazard warning flasher switch while driving.

TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM (TPMS)

This vehicle is equipped with the Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS). It monitors tire pres- sure of all tires except the spare. When the low tire pressure warning light is lit, and the CHECK TIRE PRES (pressure) warning message is dis- played in the odometer, one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated. If the vehicle is being driven with low tire pressure, the TPMS will activate and warn you of it by the low tire pressure warning light. This system will activate only when the vehicle is driven at speeds above 16 MPH (25 km/h). For more details, refer to Warning/indicator lights and audible reminders in the Instruments and controls section, and Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) in the Starting and driving section.

WARNING

Radio waves could adversely affect electric medical equipment. Those who use a pacemaker should contact the electric medical equipment manufac- turer for the possible influences before use.

LIC0394

HAZARD WARNING FLASHER SWITCH

FLAT TIRE

In case of emergency 6-3

If the low tire pressure warning light illuminates while driving, avoid sudden steering maneuvers or abrupt braking, reduce vehicle speed, pull off the road to a safe location and stop the vehicle as soon as possible. Driving with under- inflated tires may permanently damage the tires and increase the likelihood of tire failure. Serious vehicle damage could occur and may lead to an acci- dent and could result in serious per- sonal injury. Check the tire pressure for all four tires. Adjust the tire pressure to the recommended COLD tire pressure shown on the Tire and Loading Informa- tion label to turn the low tire pressure warning light OFF. If you have a flat tire, replace it with a spare tire as soon as possible.

When a spare tire is mounted or a wheel is replaced, the TPMS will not function and the low tire pressure warning light will flash for approximately 1 minute. The light will remain on after 1 minute. Contact your NISSAN dealer as soon as possible for tire replacement and/or system resetting.

Replacing tires with those not originally specified by NISSAN could affect the proper operation of the TPMS.

Do not inject any tire liquid or aerosol tire sealant into the tires, as this may cause a malfunction of the tire pressure sensors.

CHANGING A FLAT TIRE

If you have a flat tire, follow the instructions be- low:

Stopping the vehicle

1. Safely move the vehicle off the road and away from traffic.

2. Turn on the hazard warning flashers.

3. Park on a level surface and apply the parking brake. Shift the manual transmission into R (Reverse), or the automatic transmission into P (Park).

4. Turn off the engine.

5. Raise the hood to warn other traffic and to signal professional road assistance person- nel that you need assistance.

6. Have all passengers get out of the vehicle and stand in a safe place, away from traffic and clear of the vehicle.

WARNING

Make sure the parking brake is securely applied and the manual transmission is shifted into R (Reverse), or the auto- matic transmission into P (Park).

Never change tires when the vehicle is on a slope, ice or slippery areas. This is hazardous.

Never change tires if oncoming traffic is close to your vehicle. Wait for profes- sional road assistance.

6-4 In case of emergency

Blocking wheels Place suitable blocks 1 at both the front and back of the wheel diagonally opposite the flat tire 2 to prevent the vehicle from moving when it is jacked up.

WARNING

Be sure to block the wheel as the vehicle may move and result in personal injury.

Getting the spare tire and tools For King Cab models:

The tool storage compartment is located be- tween the two rear jump seats.

1. Turn the knob from the lock to the unlock position and remove the lid from the tool storage compartment.

2. Release the strap to remove the tool bag.

3. Collapse the jack to remove it from the stor- age location.

4. Remove the jack and jacking tools.

WCE0044 King Cab models

LCE0109

King Cab models LCE0110

In case of emergency 6-5

For Crew Cab models:

The tools and tool case are located behind the rear bench seat.

1. Fold the rear bench seat down. Refer to Folding the rear bench seatdown in the SafetySeats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system section earlier in this manual.

2. Remove the jack 1 and jacking tools 2 .

1. Fit the square end of the jack rod into the square hole of the wheel nut wrench to form a handle.

2. Find the oval-shaped opening under the middle of the tailgate. Pass the T-shaped end of the jack rod through the opening and direct it toward the spare tire winch, located directly above the spare tire.

Crew Cab models LCE0111

WCE0070

6-6 In case of emergency

All models:

3. Seat the T-shaped end of the jack rod into the T-shaped opening of the spare tire winch. Apply pressure to keep the jack rod engaged in the spare tire winch and turn the jack rod counterclockwise to lower the spare tire.

4. Once the spare tire is completely lowered, reach under the vehicle, remove the retainer chain, and carefully slide the tire from under the rear of the vehicle.

5. To reinstall the wheel, insert the tire chain through the wheel. Be sure the rubber spacer is centered on the wheel before lift- ing. Use the assembled jack rod and slowly rotate the winch clockwise to raise the wheel to the vehicle.

NOTE:

Inspect the spacer every six years and re- place as necessary. Contact your NISSAN dealer for replacement parts if necessary.

CAUTION

Be sure to center the spare tire sus- pending plate on the wheel and then lift the spare tire.

Failure to use the spacer may allow the chain to get stuck on the wheel nut holes.

CAUTION

Be sure to center the spare tire suspend- ing plate on the wheel and then lift the spare tire.

Jacking up vehicle and removing the damaged tire

WARNING

Never get under the vehicle while it is supported only by the jack. If it is nec- essary to work under the vehicle, sup- port it with safety stands.

Use only the jack provided with your vehicle to lift the vehicle. Do not use the jack provided with your vehicle on other vehicles. The jack is designed for lifting only your vehicle during a tire change.

LCE2022

In case of emergency 6-7

Use the correct jack-up points. Never use any other part of the vehicle for jack support.

Never jack up the vehicle more than necessary.

Never use blocks on or under the jack.

Do not start or run the engine while vehicle is on the jack. It may cause the vehicle to move. This is especially true for vehicles with limited slip differentials.

Do not allow passengers to stay in the vehicle while it is on the jack.

Never run the engine with a wheel(s) off the ground. It may cause the vehicle to move.

Always refer to the illustration for the correct placement and jack-up points for your specific vehicle model and jack type.

Carefully read the caution label attached to the jack body and the following instruc- tions.

1. Loosen each wheel nut one or two turns by turning counterclockwise with the wheel nut wrench. Do not remove the wheel nuts until the tire is off the ground.

2. Place the jack directly under the jack-up point as illustrated so the top of the jack contacts the vehicle at the jack-up point. The jack-up points are indicated by stamped ar- rows on the side of the frame.

The jack should be used on firm and level ground.

WCE0152

6-8 In case of emergency

3. Install the assembled jack rod into the jack as shown.

4. To lift the vehicle, securely hold the jack lever and rod. Carefully raise the vehicle until the tire clears the ground.

5. Remove the wheel nuts and then remove the tire.

Installing the spare tire

The spare tire is designed for emergency use. See specific instructions under the heading Wheels and tires in the Mainte- nance and do-it-yourself section of this manual.

1. Clean any mud or dirt from the surface be- tween the wheel and hub.

2. Carefully put the spare tire on and tighten the wheel nuts finger tight.

3. With the wheel nut wrench, tighten wheel nuts alternately and evenly as illustrated until they are tight.

4. Lower the vehicle slowly until the tire touches the ground. Then, with the wheel nut wrench, tighten the wheel nuts securely in the sequence illustrated. Lower the ve- hicle completely.

WARNING

Incorrect wheel nuts or improperly tightened wheel nuts can cause the wheel to become loose or come off. This could cause an accident.

Do not use oil or grease on the wheel studs or nuts. This could cause the nuts to become loose.

Retighten the wheel nuts when the ve- hicle has been driven for 600 miles (1,000 km) (also in cases of a flat tire, etc.).

As soon as possible, tighten the wheel nuts to the specified torque with a torque wrench.

Wheel nut tightening torque:

98 ft-lb (133 Nm)

The wheel nuts must be kept tightened to specification at all times. It is recom- mended that wheel nuts be tightened to specifications at each lubrication interval.

LCE0087

WCE0063

In case of emergency 6-9

Adjust tire pressure to the COLD pressure.

COLD pressure: After vehicle has been parked for three hours or more or driven less than 1 mile (1.6 km).

COLD tire pressures are shown on the Tire and Loading Information label located in the drivers door opening.

5. Securely store the flat tire and jacking equip- ment in the vehicle.

WARNING

Always make sure that the spare tire and jacking equipment are properly se- cured after use. Such items can become dangerous projectiles in an accident or sudden stop.

The spare tire is designed for emer- gency use. See specific instructions un- der the heading Wheels and tires in the Maintenance and do-it-yourself section of this manual.

To start your engine with a booster battery, the instructions and precautions below must be fol- lowed.

WARNING

If done incorrectly, jump starting can lead to a battery explosion, resulting in severe injury or death. It could also damage your vehicle.

Explosive hydrogen gas is always pres- ent in the vicinity of the battery. Keep all sparks and flames away from the battery.

Do not allow battery fluid to come into contact with eyes, skin, clothing or painted surfaces. Battery fluid is a cor- rosive sulfuric acid solution which can cause severe burns. If the fluid should come into contact with anything, imme- diately flush the contacted area with water.

Keep battery out of the reach of children.

The booster battery must be rated at 12 volts. Use of an improperly rated battery can damage your vehicle.

Whenever working on or near a battery, always wear suitable eye protectors (for example, goggles or industrial safety spectacles) and remove rings, metal bands, or any other jewelry. Do not lean over the battery when jump starting.

Do not attempt to jump start a frozen battery. It could explode and cause se- rious injury.

Your vehicle has an automatic engine cooling fan. It could come on at any time. Keep hands and other objects away from it.

JUMP STARTING

6-10 In case of emergency

WARNING

Always follow the instructions below. Failure to do so could result in damage to the charging system and cause personal injury.

1. If the booster battery is in another vehicle, position the two vehicles to bring their bat- teries near each other.

Do not allow the two vehicles to touch.

2. Apply the parking brake. Move the shift se- lector to N (Neutral) (manual transmission) or to P (Park) (automatic transmission). Switch off all unnecessary electrical sys- tems (lights, heater, air conditioner, etc.).

3. Remove vent caps on the battery (if so equipped). Cover the battery with an old cloth to reduce explosion hazard.

4. Connect jumper cables in the sequence il- lustrated (A , B , C , D ).

CAUTION

Always connect positive () to positive () and negative () to body ground (for example, strut mounting bolt, engine lift bracket, etc.) not to the battery.

Make sure the jumper cables do not touch moving parts in the engine com- partment and that the cable clamps do not contact any other metal.

5. Start the engine of the booster vehicle and let it run for a few minutes.

6. Keep the engine speed of the booster ve- hicle at about 2,000 rpm, and start the en- gine of the vehicle being jump started.

CAUTION

Do not keep the starter motor engaged for more than 10 seconds. If the engine does not start right away, turn the key off and wait 3 to 4 seconds before trying again.

7. After starting the engine, carefully discon- nect the negative cable and then the positive cable.

8. Replace the vent caps (if so equipped). Be sure to dispose of the cloth used to cover the vent holes as it may be contaminated with corrosive acid.

WCE0066

In case of emergency 6-11

CAUTION

Do not push start this vehicle. The three-way catalyst may be damaged.

Automatic transmission models cannot be push-started or tow-started. At- tempting to do so may cause transmis- sion damage.

For manual transmission models, never try to start the vehicle by towing it. When the engine starts, the forward surge could cause the vehicle to collide with the tow vehicle.

WARNING

Do not continue to drive if your vehicle overheats. Doing so could cause engine damage or a vehicle fire.

To avoid the danger of being scalded, never remove the radiator cap while the engine is still hot. When the radiator cap is removed, pressurized hot water will spurt out, possibly causing serious injury.

Do not open the hood if steam is com- ing out.

If your vehicle is overheating (indicated by an extremely high temperature gauge reading), or if you feel a lack of engine power, detect abnormal noise, etc. take the following steps.

1. Move the vehicle safely off the road, apply the parking brake and move the shift selector to N (Neutral) (manual transmission) or to P (Park) (automatic transmission).

Do not stop the engine.

2. Turn off the air conditioner (if so equipped). Open all the windows, move the heater or air conditioner temperature control to maximum hot and fan control to high speed.

3. Get out of the vehicle. Look and listen for steam or coolant escaping from the radiator before opening the hood. (If steam or cool- ant is escaping, turn off the engine.) Do not open the hood further until no steam or coolant can be seen.

4. Open the engine hood.

WARNING

If steam or water is coming from the en- gine, stand clear to prevent getting burned.

5. Visually check drive belts for damage or looseness. Also check if the cooling fan is running. The radiator hoses and radiator should not leak water. If coolant is leaking, the water pump belt is missing or loose, or the cooling fan does not run, stop the en- gine.

WARNING

Be careful not to allow your hands, hair, jewelry or clothing to come into contact with, or get caught in, engine belts or the engine cooling fan. The engine cooling fan can start at any time.

PUSH STARTING IF YOUR VEHICLE OVERHEATS

6-12 In case of emergency

6. After the engine cools down, check the cool- ant level in the engine coolant reservoir tank with the engine running. Add coolant to the engine coolant reservoir tank if necessary. Have your vehicle repaired at a NISSAN dealer.

When towing your vehicle, all State (Provincial in Canada) and local regulations for towing must be followed. Incorrect towing equipment could dam- age your vehicle. Towing instructions are avail- able from a NISSAN dealer. Local service opera- tors are generally familiar with the applicable laws and procedures for towing. To assure proper towing and to prevent accidental damage to your vehicle, NISSAN recommends having a service operator tow your vehicle. It is advisable to have the service operator carefully read the following precautions:

WARNING

Never ride in a vehicle that is being towed.

Never get under your vehicle after it has been lifted by a tow truck.

CAUTION

When towing, make sure that the trans- mission, axles, steering system and powertrain are in working condition. If any of these conditions apply, dollies or a flatbed tow truck must be used.

Always attach safety chains before towing.

For information about towing your vehicle behind a recreational vehicle (RV), refer to Flat towing in the Technical and consumer information sec- tion of this manual.

TOWING YOUR VEHICLE

In case of emergency 6-13

TOWING RECOMMENDED BY NISSAN

Two-wheel drive models

NISSAN recommends that your vehicle be towed with the driving (rear) wheels off the ground or place the vehicle on a flat bed truck as illustrated.

CAUTION

Never tow automatic transmission models with the rear wheels on the ground or four wheels on the ground (forward or backward), as this may cause serious and expensive damage to the transmission. If it is necessary to tow the vehicle with the front wheels raised always use towing dollies under the rear wheels.

When towing automatic or manual transmission models with the front wheels on the ground or on towing dollies:

Place the ignition switch in the OFF position, and secure the steering wheel in a straight-ahead position with a rope or similar device. Never secure the steering wheel by placing the ignition switch in the LOCK posi- tion. This may damage the steering lock mechanism (for models with a steering lock mechanism).

If you have to tow manual transmission models with the rear wheels on the ground (if you do not use towing dol- lies) or four wheels on the ground:

Always release the parking brake.

Move the transmission shift selector to the N (Neutral) position

Observe the following restricted tow- ing speeds and distances for manual transmission models only:

Speed: Below 60 MPH (97 km/h)

Distance: Less than 500 miles (805 km)

If the speed or distance must necessarily be greater, remove the propeller shaft before towing to prevent damage to the transmission.

A Automatic Transmissions (A/T) B Manual Transmissions (M/T)

WCE0197

6-14 In case of emergency

Four-wheel drive models NISSAN recommends that towing dollies be used when towing your vehicle or place the ve- hicle on a flat bed truck as illustrated.

CAUTION

Never tow 4WD models with any of the wheels on the ground as this may cause serious and expensive damage to the transfer case and transmission.

VEHICLE RECOVERY (freeing a stuck vehicle)

Pulling a stuck vehicle

WARNING

To avoid vehicle damage, serious per- sonal injury or death when recovering a stuck vehicle:

Contact a professional towing service to recover the vehicle if you have any questions regarding the recovery procedure.

WCE0161 Hooks (if so equipped)

LCE0103

In case of emergency 6-15

Attach recovery devices only to main structural members of the vehicle or the recovery hooks.

Do not use the vehicle tie-downs to tow or free a stuck vehicle.

Only use devices specifically designed for vehicle recovery and follow the manufacturers instructions.

Always pull the recovery device straight out from the front of the vehicle. Never pull at an angle.

Route recovery devices so they do not touch any part of the vehicle except the attachment point.

If your vehicle is stuck in sand, snow, mud, etc., use a tow strap or other device designed specifi- cally for vehicle recovery. Always follow the manufacturers instructions for the recovery de- vice.

Do not use the tie-down hooks for towing or vehicle recovery.

Rocking a stuck vehicle

WARNING

Stand clear of a stuck vehicle.

Do not spin your tires at high speed. This could cause them to explode and result in serious injury. Parts of your vehicle could also overheat and be damaged.

If your vehicle is stuck in sand, snow, mud, etc., use the following procedure:

1. Turn off the Vehicle Dynamic Control Sys- tem.

2. Make sure the area in front and behind the vehicle is clear of obstructions.

3. Turn the steering wheel right and left to clear an area around the front tires.

4. Slowly rock the vehicle forward and back- ward.

Shift back and forth between R (reverse) and D (drive) (automatic transmission models) or 1st (low) and R (reverse) (manual transmission models).

Apply the accelerator as little as possible to maintain the rocking motion.

Release the accelerator pedal before shifting between R and D (automatic transmission models) or 1st and R (manual transmission models).

Do not spin the tires above 35 MPH (55 km/h).

5. If the vehicle can not be freed after a few tries, contact a professional towing service to remove the vehicle.

6-16 In case of emergency

7 Appearance and care

Cleaning exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-2 Washing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-2 Waxing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-2 Removing spots . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3 Underbody . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3 Glass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3 Aluminum alloy wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3 Chrome parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3 Tire dressings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3

Cleaning interior. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4

Air fresheners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4 Floor mats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4 Seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-5

Corrosion protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-5 Most common factors contributing to vehicle corrosion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-5 Environmental factors influence the rate of corrosion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-5 To protect your vehicle from corrosion . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6

In order to maintain the appearance of your ve- hicle, it is important to take proper care of it.

To protect the paint surfaces, please wash your vehicle as soon as you can:

after a rainfall to prevent possible damage from acid rain.

after driving on coastal roads.

when contaminants such as soot, bird drop- pings, tree sap, metal particles or bugs get on the paint surface.

when dust or mud builds up on the surface.

Whenever possible, store or park your vehicle inside a garage or in a covered area.

When it is necessary to park outside, park in a shady area or protect the vehicle with a body cover.

Be careful not to scratch the paint surface when putting on or removing the body cover.

WASHING Wash dirt off with a wet sponge and plenty of water. Clean the vehicle thoroughly using a mild soap, a special vehicle soap or general purpose dishwashing liquid mixed with clean, lukewarm (never hot) water.

CAUTION

Do not use car washes that use acid in the detergent. Some car washes, espe- cially brushless ones, use some acid for cleaning. The acid may react with some plastic vehicle components, causing them to crack. This could affect their appearance, and also could cause them not to function properly. Always check with your car wash to confirm that acid is not used.

Do not wash the vehicle with strong household soap, strong chemical deter- gents, gasoline or solvents.

Do not wash the vehicle in direct sun- light or while the vehicle body is hot, as the surface may become water-spotted.

Avoid using tight-napped or rough cloths, such as washing mitts. Care must be taken when removing caked-on dirt or other foreign sub- stances so the paint surface is not scratched or damaged.

Rinse the vehicle thoroughly with plenty of clean water.

Inside flanges, seams and folds on the doors, hatches and hood are particularly vulnerable to the effects of road salt. Therefore, these areas must be cleaned regularly. Take care that the drain holes in the lower edge of the door are open. Spray water under the body and in the wheel wells to loosen the dirt and wash away road salt.

A damp chamois can be used to dry the vehicle to avoid water spots.

WAXING Regular waxing protects the paint surface and helps retain new vehicle appearance. Polishing is recommended to remove built-up wax residue and to avoid a weathered appearance before re-applying wax.

A NISSAN dealer can assist you in choosing the proper product.

Wax your vehicle only after a thorough wash- ing. Follow the instructions supplied with the wax.

Do not use a wax containing any abrasives, cutting compounds or cleaners that may damage the vehicle finish.

Machine compounding or aggressive polishing on a base coat/clear coat paint finish may dull the finish or leave swirl marks.

CLEANING EXTERIOR

7-2 Appearance and care

REMOVING SPOTS

Remove tar and oil spots, industrial dust, insects, and tree sap as quickly as possible from the surface of the paint to avoid lasting damage or staining. Special cleaning products are available at a NISSAN dealer or any automotive accessory store.

UNDERBODY

In areas where road salt is used in winter, it is necessary to clean the underbody regularly in order to prevent dirt and salt from building up and causing the acceleration of corrosion on the un- derbody and suspension. Before the winter pe- riod and again in the spring, the underseal must be checked and, if necessary, retreated.

GLASS

Use glass cleaner to remove smoke and dust film from the glass surfaces. It is normal for glass to become coated with a film after the vehicle is parked in the hot sun. Glass cleaner and a soft cloth will easily remove this film.

CAUTION

When cleaning the inside of the windows, do not use sharp-edged tools, abrasive cleaners or chlorine-based disinfectant cleaners. They could damage the electri- cal conductors, radio antenna elements or rear window defroster elements.

ALUMINUM ALLOY WHEELS

Wash the wheels regularly with a sponge damp- ened in a mild soap solution, especially during winter months in areas where road salt is used. If not removed, road salt can discolor the wheels.

CAUTION

Follow the directions below to avoid staining or discoloring the wheels:

Do not use a cleaner that uses strong acid or alkali contents to clean the wheels.

Do not apply wheel cleaners to the wheels when they are hot. The wheel temperature should be the same as am- bient temperature.

Rinse the wheel to completely remove the cleaner within 15 minutes after the cleaner is applied.

CHROME PARTS Clean all chrome parts regularly with a non- abrasive chrome polish to maintain the finish.

TIRE DRESSINGS NISSAN does not recommend the use of tire dressings. Tire manufacturers apply a coating to the tires to help reduce discoloration of the rub- ber. If a tire dressing is applied to the tires, it may react with the coating and form a compound. This compound may come off the tire while driving and stain the vehicle paint.

If you choose to use a tire dressing, take the following precautions:

Use a water-based tire dressing. The coat- ing on the tire dissolves more easily than with an oil-based tire dressing.

Apply a light coat of tire dressing to help prevent it from entering the tire tread/grooves (where it would be difficult to remove).

Wipe off excess tire dressing using a dry towel. Make sure the tire dressing is com- pletely removed from the tire tread/grooves.

Allow the tire dressing to dry as recom- mended by the tire dressing manufacturer.

Appearance and care 7-3

Occasionally remove loose dust from the interior trim, plastic parts and seats using a vacuum cleaner or soft bristled brush. Wipe the vinyl and leather surfaces with a clean, soft cloth damp- ened in mild soap solution, then wipe clean with a dry, soft cloth.

Regular care and cleaning is required in order to maintain the appearance of the leather.

Before using any fabric protector, read the manu- facturers recommendations. Some fabric pro- tectors contain chemicals that may stain or bleach the seat material.

Use a cloth dampened only with water to clean the meter and gauge lens.

WARNING

Do not use water or acidic cleaners (hot steam cleaners) on the seat. This can damage the seat or occupant classifica- tion sensor. This can also affect the opera- tion of the air bag system and result in serious personal injury.

CAUTION

Never use benzine, thinner or any simi- lar material.

Small dirt particles can be abrasive and damaging to leather surfaces and should be removed promptly. Do not use saddle soap, car waxes, polishes, oils, cleaning fluids, solvents, deter- gents or ammonia-based cleaners as they may damage the leathers natural finish.

Never use fabric protectors unless rec- ommended by the manufacturer.

Do not use glass or plastic cleaner on meter or gauge lens covers. It may dam- age the lens cover.

AIR FRESHENERS

Most air fresheners use a solvent that could affect the vehicle interior. If you use an air freshener, take the following precautions:

Hanging-type air fresheners can cause per- manent discoloration when they contact ve- hicle interior surfaces. Place the air fresh- ener in a location that allows it to hang free and not contact an interior surface.

Liquid-type air fresheners typically clip on the vents. These products can cause imme- diate damage and discoloration when spilled on interior surfaces.

Carefully read and follow the manufacturers in- structions before using the air fresheners.

FLOOR MATS

WARNING

To avoid potential pedal interference that may result in a collision or injury:

NEVER place a floor mat on top of an- other floor mat in the driver front position.

Use only genuine NISSAN floor mats specifically designed for use in your ve- hicle model. See your NISSAN dealer for more information.

Properly position the mats in the floor- well using the floor mat positioning aid. See Floor mat positioning aid in this section.

The use of genuine NISSAN floor mats can ex- tend the life of your vehicle carpet and make it easier to clean the interior. Mats should be main- tained with regular cleaning and replaced if they become excessively worn.

CLEANING INTERIOR

7-4 Appearance and care

Floor mat positioning aid This vehicle includes two drivers side front floor mat brackets and one passengers side front floor mat bracket to help keep your floor mats in place. Genuine NISSAN floor mats have been specially designed for your vehicle model. The drivers side floor mat has two grommet holes incorporated in it and the passengers side has one grommet hole. Position each mat by placing the floor mat bracket hook through the floor mat grommet holes while centering the mat in the floorwell.

Periodically check to make certain the mats are properly positioned.

SEAT BELTS The seat belts can be cleaned by wiping them with a sponge dampened in a mild soap solution. Allow the belts to dry completely in the shade before using them. See Seat belt maintenance in the Safety Seats, seat belts and supplemen- tal restraint system section of this manual.

WARNING

Do not allow wet seat belts to roll up in the retractor. NEVER use bleach, dye or chemical solvents to clean the seat belts, since these materials may severely weaken the seat belt webbing.

MOST COMMON FACTORS CONTRIBUTING TO VEHICLE CORROSION

The accumulation of moisture-retaining dirt and debris in body panel sections, cavities, and other areas.

Damage to paint and other protective coat- ings caused by gravel and stone chips or minor traffic accidents.

ENVIRONMENTAL FACTORS INFLUENCE THE RATE OF CORROSION

Moisture

Accumulation of sand, dirt and water on the ve- hicle body underside can accelerate corrosion. Wet floor coverings will not dry completely inside the vehicle and should be removed for drying to avoid floor panel corrosion.

Relative humidity

Corrosion will be accelerated in areas of high relative humidity, especially those areas where the temperatures stay above freezing and where atmospheric pollution exists and road salt is used.

LAI0009

CORROSION PROTECTION

Appearance and care 7-5

Temperature High temperatures accelerate the rate of corro- sion to those parts which are not well ventilated.

Air pollution Industrial pollution, the presence of salt in the air in coastal areas, or heavy road salt use acceler- ates the corrosion process. Road salt also accel- erates the disintegration of paint surfaces.

TO PROTECT YOUR VEHICLE FROM CORROSION

Wash and wax your vehicle often to keep the vehicle clean.

Always check for minor damage to the paint and repair it as soon as possible.

Keep drain holes at the bottom of the doors open to avoid water accumulation.

Check the underbody for accumulation of sand, dirt or salt. If present, wash with water as soon as possible.

CAUTION

NEVER remove dirt, sand or other de- bris from the passenger compartment by washing it out with a hose. Remove dirt with a vacuum cleaner or broom.

Never allow water or other liquids to come in contact with electronic compo- nents inside the vehicle as this may damage them.

Chemicals used for road surface de-icing are extremely corrosive. They accelerate corrosion and deterioration of underbody components such as the exhaust system, fuel and brake lines, brake cables, floor pan and fenders.

In winter, the underbody must be cleaned periodically.

For additional protection against rust and corro- sion, which may be required in some areas, con- sult a NISSAN dealer.

7-6 Appearance and care

8 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

Maintenance requirements. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2 General maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2

Explanation of general maintenance items . . . . . . . . . 8-2 Maintenance precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-5 Engine compartment check locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-6 Engine cooling system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-8

Checking engine coolant level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-9 Changing engine coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-9

Engine oil. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-10 Checking engine oil level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-10 Changing engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-11 Changing engine oil filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-12

5-speed automatic transmission fluid (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-13 Power steering fluid. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-14 Brake and clutch (if so equipped) fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-14

Brake fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-14 Clutch fluid (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-15

Windshield-washer fluid. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-15 Windshield-washer fluid reservoir . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-15

Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-16 Jump starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-17

Variable voltage control system. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-18

Drive belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-18 Spark plugs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-19

Replacing spark plugs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-19 Air cleaner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-20

In-cabin microfilter (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-21 Windshield wiper blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-22

Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-22 Replacing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-22

Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-23 Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-24

Engine compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-25 Passenger compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-26

Battery replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-28 Keyfob (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-28

Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-29 Headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-29 Exterior and interior lights. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-31

Wheels and tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-33 Tire pressure. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-33 Tire labeling. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-37 Types of tires. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-39 Tire chains. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-40 Changing wheels and tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-40

Your NISSAN has been designed to have mini- mum maintenance requirements with long ser- vice intervals to save you both time and money. However, some day-to-day and regular mainte- nance is essential to maintain your NISSANs good mechanical condition, as well as its emis- sions and engine performance.

It is the owners responsibility to make sure that the scheduled maintenance, as well as general maintenance, is performed.

As the vehicle owner, you are the only one who can ensure that your vehicle receives proper maintenance. You are a vital link in the mainte- nance chain.

Scheduled maintenance

For your convenience, both required and optional scheduled maintenance items are described and listed in your NISSAN Service and Maintenance Guide. You must refer to that guide to ensure that necessary maintenance is performed on your NISSAN at regular intervals.

General maintenance

General maintenance includes those items which should be checked during normal day-to-day op- eration. They are essential for proper vehicle op- eration. It is your responsibility to perform these maintenance procedures regularly as prescribed.

Performing general maintenance checks requires minimal mechanical skill and only a few general automotive tools.

These checks or inspections can be done by you, a qualified technician, or, if you prefer, a NISSAN dealer.

Where to go for service

If maintenance service is required or your vehicle appears to malfunction, have the systems checked and corrected by a NISSAN dealer.

NISSAN technicians are well-trained specialists who are kept up-to-date with the latest service information through technical bulletins, service tips, and in-dealership training programs. They are completely qualified to work on NISSAN ve- hicles before they work on your vehicle, rather than after they have worked on it.

You can be confident that a NISSAN dealers service department performs the best job to meet the maintenance requirements on your vehicle in a reliable and economical way.

During the normal day-to-day operation of the vehicle, general maintenance should be per- formed regularly as prescribed in this section. If you detect any unusual sounds, vibrations or smells, be sure to check for the cause or have a NISSAN dealer do it promptly. In addition, you should notify a NISSAN dealer if you think that repairs are required.

When performing any checks or maintenance work, closely observe the Maintenance precau- tions later in this section.

EXPLANATION OF GENERAL MAINTENANCE ITEMS

Additional information on the following items with * is found later in this section.

Outside the vehicle

The maintenance items listed here should be performed from time to time, unless otherwise specified.

Doors and engine hood Check that the doors and engine hood operate properly. Also ensure that all latches lock securely. Lubricate hinges, latches, latch pins, rollers and links as necessary. Make sure that the secondary latch keeps the hood from opening when the primary latch is released.

MAINTENANCE REQUIREMENTS GENERAL MAINTENANCE

8-2 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

When driving in areas using road salt or other corrosive materials, check lubrication frequently.

Lights* Clean the headlights on a regular basis. Make sure that the headlights, stop lights, tail lights, turn signal lights, and other lights are all operating properly and installed securely. Also check headlight aim.

Road wheel nuts (lug nuts)* When checking the tires, make sure no wheel nuts are missing, and check for any loose wheel nuts. Tighten if necessary.

Tire rotation* Tires should be rotated every 7,500 miles (12,000 km).

Tires* Check the pressure with a gauge often and always prior to long distance trips. If neces- sary, adjust the pressure in all tires, including the spare, to the pressure specified. Check carefully for damage, cuts or excessive wear.

Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) transmitter components Replace the TPMS transmitter grommet seal, valve core and cap when the tires are replaced due to wear or age.

Wheel alignment and balance If the vehicle should pull to either side while driving on a straight and level road, or if you detect uneven or abnormal tire wear, there may be a need for wheel alignment. If the steering wheel or seat vibrates at normal highway speeds, wheel balancing may be needed.

For additional information regarding tires, refer to Important Tire Safety Information (US) or Tire Safety Information (Canada) in the Warranty Information Booklet.

Windshield Clean the windshield on a regular basis. Check the windshield at least every six months for cracks or other damage. Have a dam- aged windshield repaired by a qualified repair facility.

Windshield wiper blades* Check for cracks or wear if they do not wipe properly.

Inside the vehicle

The maintenance items listed here should be checked on a regular basis, such as when per- forming periodic maintenance, cleaning the ve- hicle, etc.

Additional information on the following items with an * is found later in this sec- tion.

Accelerator pedal Check the pedal for smooth operation and make sure the pedal does not bind or require uneven effort. Keep the floor mat away from the pedal.

Automatic transmission P (Park) position mechanism On a fairly steep hill check that your vehicle is held securely with the shift selector in the P (Park) position without applying any brakes.

Brake pedal Check the pedal for smooth opera- tion. If the brake pedal suddenly goes down fur- ther than normal, the pedal feels spongy or the vehicle seems to take longer to stop, see a NISSAN dealer immediately. Keep the floor mat away from the pedal.

Brakes Check that the brakes do not pull the vehicle to one side when applied.

Parking brake Check the parking brake opera- tion regularly. The vehicle should be securely held on a fairly steep hill with only the parking brake applied. If the parking brake needs adjustment, see a NISSAN dealer.

Seats Check seat position controls such as seat adjusters, seatback recliner, etc. to ensure they operate smoothly and all latches lock securely in every position. Check that the head restraints and headrests move up and down smoothly and the locks (if so equipped) hold securely in all latched positions.

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-3

Seat belts Check that all parts of the seat belt system (for example, buckles, anchors, adjusters and retractors) operate properly and smoothly, and are installed securely. Check the belt web- bing for cuts, fraying, wear or damage.

Steering wheel Check for changes in the steer- ing system, such as excessive freeplay, hard steering or strange noises.

Warning lights and chimes Make sure all warning lights and chimes are operating properly.

Windshield wiper and washer* Check that the wipers and washer operate properly and that the wipers do not streak.

Windshield defroster Check that the air comes out of the defroster outlets properly and in sufficient quantity when operating the heater or air conditioner.

Under the hood and vehicle

The maintenance items listed here should be checked periodically (for example, each time you check the engine oil or refuel).

Battery* Check the fluid level in each cell. It should be between the MAX and MIN lines. Ve- hicles operated in high temperatures or under severe conditions require frequent checks of the battery fluid level.

Brake and clutch fluid levels* Make sure that the brake and clutch fluid level is between the MIN and MAX lines on the reservoir.

Engine coolant level* Check the coolant level when the engine is cold.

Engine drive belts* Make sure the drive belts are not frayed, worn, cracked or oily.

Engine oil level* Check the level after parking the vehicle on a level surface with the engine off. Wait more than 10 minutes for the oil to drain back into the oil pan.

Exhaust system Make sure there are no loose supports, cracks or holes. If the sound of the exhaust seems unusual or there is a smell of exhaust fumes, immediately have the exhaust system inspected by a NISSAN dealer. See the carbon monoxide warning in the Starting and driving section of this manual.

Fluid leaks Check under the vehicle for fuel, oil, water or other fluid leaks after the vehicle has been parked for a while. Water dripping from the air conditioner after use is normal. If you should notice any leaks or if gasoline fumes are evident, check for the cause and have it corrected imme- diately.

Power steering fluid level* and lines Check the level when the fluid is cold, with the engine off. Check the lines for proper attachment, leaks, cracks, etc.

Radiator and hoses Check the front of the radiator and clean off any dirt, insects, leaves, etc., that may have accumulated. Make sure the hoses have no cracks, deformation, rot or loose connections.

Underbody The underbody is frequently ex- posed to corrosive substances such as those used on icy roads or to control dust. It is very important to remove these substances from the underbody, otherwise rust may form on the floor pan, frame, fuel lines and exhaust system. At the end of winter, the underbody should be thor- oughly flushed with plain water, in those areas where mud and dirt may have accumulated. See the Appearance and care section of this manual.

Windshield-washer fluid* Check that there is adequate fluid in the reservoir.

8-4 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

When performing any inspection or maintenance work on your vehicle, always take care to prevent serious accidental injury to yourself or damage to the vehicle. The following are general precau- tions which should be closely observed.

WARNING

Park the vehicle on a level surface, ap- ply the parking brake securely and block the wheels to prevent the vehicle from moving. Move the shift selector to P (Park).

Be sure the ignition switch is in the OFF or LOCK position when performing any parts replacement or repairs.

If you must work with the engine run- ning, keep your hands, clothing, hair and tools away from moving fans, belts and any other moving parts.

It is advisable to secure or remove any loose clothing and remove any jewelry, such as rings, watches, etc. before working on your vehicle.

Always wear eye protection whenever you work on your vehicle.

Your vehicle is equipped with an auto- matic engine cooling fan. It may come on at any time without warning, even if the ignition switch is in the OFF posi- tion and the engine is not running. To avoid injury, always disconnect the negative battery cable before working near the fan.

If you must run the engine in an en- closed space such as a garage, be sure there is proper ventilation for exhaust gases to escape.

Never get under the vehicle while it is supported only by a jack. If it is neces- sary to work under the vehicle, support it with safety stands.

Keep smoking materials, flame and sparks away from the fuel tank and battery.

On gasoline engine models, the fuel filter or fuel lines should be serviced by a NISSAN dealer because the fuel lines are under high pressure even when the engine is off.

CAUTION

Do not work under the hood while the engine is hot. Turn the engine off and wait until it cools down.

Avoid contact with used engine oil and coolant. Improperly disposed engine oil, engine coolant and/or other vehicle fluids can damage the environment. Al- ways conform to local regulations for disposal of vehicle fluid.

Never leave the engine or automatic transmission related component har- nesses disconnected while the ignition switch is in the ON position.

Never connect or disconnect the battery or any transistorized component while the ignition switch is in the ON position.

This Maintenance and do-it-yourself section gives instructions regarding only those items which are relatively easy for an owner to perform.

You should be aware that incomplete or improper servicing may result in operating difficulties or excessive emissions, and could affect warranty coverage. If in doubt about any servicing, have it done by a NISSAN dealer.

MAINTENANCE PRECAUTIONS

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-5

QR25DE engine

1. Windshield-washer fluid reservoir 2. Fuse/Fusible link box 3. Fuse and relay box 4. Air cleaner 5. Engine oil filler cap 6. Engine oil dipstick 7. Brake fluid reservoir/Clutch fluid

reservoir (M/T model) 8. Drive belt location 9. Radiator cap 10. Power steering fluid reservoir 11. Battery 12. Engine coolant reservoir

WDI0643

ENGINE COMPARTMENT CHECK LOCATIONS

8-6 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

VQ40DE engine

1. Windshield-washer fluid reservoir 2. Fuse/fusible link box 3. Fuse and relay box 4. Engine oil filler cap 5. Engine oil dipstick 6. Brake fluid reservoir/Clutch fluid

reservoir (M/T model) 7. Air cleaner 8. Drive belt location 9. Radiator cap 10. Power steering fluid reservoir 11. Battery 12. Engine coolant reservoir

LII0167

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-7

The engine cooling system is filled at the factory with a pre-diluted mixture of 50% Genuine NISSAN Long Life Antifreeze/Coolant (blue) and 50% water to provide year-round anti-freeze and coolant protection. The antifreeze solution con- tains rust and corrosion inhibitors. Additional en- gine cooling system additives are not necessary.

WARNING

Never remove the radiator or coolant reservoir cap when the engine is hot. Wait until the engine and radiator cool down. Serious burns could be caused by high pressure fluid escaping from the radiator. See precautions in If your vehicle overheats found in the In case of emergency section of this manual.

The radiator is equipped with a pres- sure type radiator cap. To prevent en- gine damage, use only a genuine NISSAN radiator cap.

CAUTION

Never use any cooling system additives such as radiator sealer. Additives may clog the cooling system and cause damage to the engine, transmission and/or cooling system.

When adding or replacing coolant, be sure to use only Genuine NISSAN Long Life Antifreeze/Coolant (blue) or equivalent. Genuine NISSAN Long Life Antifreeze/Coolant (blue) is pre-diluted to provide antifreeze protection to -34 F (-37 C). If additional freeze protec- tion is needed due to weather where you operate your vehicle, add Genuine NISSAN Long Life Antifreeze/Coolant (blue) concentrate following the direc- tions on the container. If an equivalent coolant other than Genuine NISSAN Long Life Antifreeze/Coolant (blue) is used, follow the coolant manufacturers instructions to maintain minimum anti- freeze protection to -34 F (-37 C). The use of other types of coolant solutions other than Genuine NISSAN Long Life Antifreeze/Coolant (blue) or equivalent may damage the engine cooling system.

The life expectancy of the factory-fill coolant is 105,000 miles (168,000 km) or 7 years. Mixing any other type of cool- ant other than Genuine NISSAN Long Life Antifreeze/Coolant (blue), includ- ing Genuine NISSAN Long Life Antifreeze/Coolant (green), or the use of non-distilled water will reduce the life expectancy of the factory-fill cool- ant. Refer to the Nissan Service and Maintenance Guide for more details.

ENGINE COOLING SYSTEM

8-8 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

CHECKING ENGINE COOLANT LEVEL Check the coolant level in the reservoir when the engine is cold. If the coolant level is below the MIN level, add coolant to the MAX level. If the reservoir is empty, check the coolant level in the radiator when the engine is cold. If there is insufficient coolant in the radiator, fill the radiator with coolant up to the filler opening and also add it to the reservoir up to the MAX level.

This vehicle contains Genuine NISSAN Long Life Antifreeze/Coolant (blue). The life expectancy of the factory-fill coolant is 105,000 miles (168,000 km) or 7 years. Mixing any other type of coolant or the use of non-distilled water will re- duce the life expectancy of the factory-fill coolant. Refer to the NISSAN Service and Maintenance Guide for more details.

The engine coolant reservoir is a pressur- ized tank. When installing the cap, tighten.

If the cooling system frequently requires coolant, have it checked by a NISSAN dealer.

CHANGING ENGINE COOLANT A NISSAN dealer can change the engine coolant. The service procedure can be found in the NISSAN Service Manual.

Improper servicing can result in reduced heater performance and engine overheat- ing.

WARNING

To avoid the danger of being scalded, never change the coolant when the en- gine is hot.

Never remove the radiator or engine coolant reservoir cap when the engine is hot. Serious burns could be caused by high pressure fluid escaping from the radiator.

Avoid direct skin contact with used coolant. If skin contact is made, wash thoroughly with soap or hand cleaner as soon as possible.

Keep coolant out of the reach of chil- dren and pets.

Engine coolant must be disposed of properly. Check your local regulations.

VQ40DE LDI0436

QR25DE LDI0466

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-9

CHECKING ENGINE OIL LEVEL 1. Park the vehicle on a level surface and apply

the parking brake.

2. Start the engine and let it idle until it reaches operating temperature.

3. Turn off the engine. Wait more than 10 minutes for the oil to drain back into the oil pan.

4. Remove the dipstick and wipe it clean. Re- insert it all the way.

5. Remove the dipstick again and check the oil level. It should be between the H (High) and L (Low) marks B . This is the normal oper- ating oil level range. If the oil level is below the L (Low) mark A , remove the oil filler cap and pour recommended oil through the opening. Do not overfill C .

6. Recheck oil level with the dipstick.

It is normal to add some oil between oil maintenance intervals or during the break-in period, depending on the severity of operating conditions.

VQ40DE WDI0672

QR25DE LDI0467 LDI0371

ENGINE OIL

8-10 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

CAUTION

Oil level should be checked regularly. Op- erating the engine with an insufficient amount of oil can damage the engine, and such damage is not covered by warranty.

CHANGING ENGINE OIL 1. Park the vehicle on a level surface and apply

the parking brake.

2. Start the engine and let it idle until it reaches operating temperature, then turn it off.

3. Remove the oil filler cap A by turning it counterclockwise.

4. Place a large drain pan under the drain plug.

5. Remove the drain plug B with a wrench by turning it counterclockwise and completely drain the oil.

If the oil filter is to be changed, remove and replace it at this time. See Changing engine oil filter in this section.

Waste oil must be disposed of prop- erly.

Check your local regulations.

VQ40DE WDI0500

QR25DE WDI0501

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-11

WARNING

Prolonged and repeated contact with used engine oil may cause skin cancer.

Try to avoid direct skin contact with used oil. If skin contact is made, wash thoroughly with soap or hand cleaner as soon as possible.

Keep used engine oil out of reach of children.

CAUTION

Be careful not to burn yourself. The engine oil may be hot.

6. Clean and reinstall the drain plug and a new washer. Securely tighten the drain plug with a wrench. Do not use excessive force.

Drain plug tightening torque: 22 - 29 ft-lb (29 - 39 Nm)

7. Refill engine with recommended oil through the oil filler opening, then install the oil filler cap securely.

See Capacities and recommended fuel/lubricants in the Technical and con- sumer information section of this manual for drain and refill capacity.

The drain and refill capacity depends on the oil temperature and drain time. Use these specifications for reference only. Always use the dipstick to determine when the proper amount of oil is in the engine.

8. Start the engine. Check for leakage around the drain plug and oil filter. Correct as re- quired.

9. Turn the engine off and wait more than 10 minutes. Check the oil level with the dipstick. Add engine oil if necessary.

CHANGING ENGINE OIL FILTER

1. Park the vehicle on a level surface and apply the parking brake.

2. Turn the engine off.

3. Place a large drain pan under the oil filter.

4. Unscrew the plate covering the oil filter ex- posing the filter. (For VQ40DE engine only)

5. Loosen the oil filter A with an oil filter wrench by turning it counterclockwise. Then remove the oil filter by turning it by hand.

VQ40DE WDI0502

8-12 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

CAUTION

Be careful not to burn yourself. The engine oil may be hot.

6. Wipe the engine oil filter sealing surface with a clean rag.

CAUTION

Be sure to remove any old gasket material remaining on the sealing surface of the engine. Failure to do so could lead to engine damage.

7. Coat the gasket on the new filter with clean engine oil.

8. Screw on the oil filter until a slight resistance is felt, then tighten an additional 2/3 turn.

9. Start the engine and check for leakage around the oil filter. Correct as required.

10. Turn the engine off and wait more than 10 minutes. Check the oil level. Add engine oil if necessary.

When checking or replacement is required, we recommend your NISSAN dealer for servicing.

CAUTION

Use Genuine NISSAN Matic S ATF. If Genuine NISSAN Matic S ATF is not available, Genuine NISSAN Matic J ATF may also be used.

Using automatic transmission fluid other than Genuine NISSAN Matic S ATF or Matic J ATF will cause deteriora- tion in driveability and automatic trans- mission durability, and may damage the automatic transmission, which is not covered by the NISSAN new vehicle lim- ited warranty.

The specified automatic transmission fluid is also described on caution labels located in the engine compartment.

QR25DE WDI0503

5-SPEED AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID (if so equipped)

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-13

The fluid level should be checked using the HOT MAX range on the power steering fluid reservoir at fluid temperatures of 122 - 176F (50 - 80C) or using the COLD MAX range on the power steering fluid reservoir at fluid tempera- tures of 32 - 86F (0 - 30C).

If the fluid is at or below the MIN line, add Genu- ine NISSAN PSF. Remove the cap and fill through the opening.

CAUTION

DO NOT OVERFILL.

Recommended fluid is Genuine NISSAN PSF or equivalent.

For further brake and clutch fluid specification information, refer to Capacities and recom- mended fuel/lubricants in the Technical and consumer information section of this manual.

WARNING

Use only new fluid from a sealed con- tainer. Old, inferior or contaminated fluid may damage the brake and clutch (if so equipped) systems. The use of improper fluids can damage the brake and clutch system and affect the vehi- cles stopping ability.

Clean the filler cap before removing.

Brake and clutch fluid is poisonous and should be stored carefully in marked containers out of reach of children.

CAUTION

Do not spill the fluid on any painted sur- faces. This will damage the paint. If fluid is spilled, immediately wash the surface with water.

BRAKE FLUID Check the brake fluid level in the reservoir. If the fluid level is below the MIN line or the brake warning light comes on, add Genuine NISSAN Super Heavy Duty Brake Fluid or equivalent DOT 3 fluid up to the MAX line. If fluid must be added frequently, the system should be checked by a NISSAN dealer.

WDI0256 LDI0463

POWER STEERING FLUID BRAKE AND CLUTCH (if so equipped) FLUID

8-14 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

CLUTCH FLUID (if so equipped) Check the clutch fluid level in the reservoir (manual transmissions only). If the fluid level is below the MIN line, add Genuine NISSAN Super Heavy Duty Brake Fluid or equivalent DOT 3 fluid up to the MAX line. If fluid must be added fre- quently, the system should be checked by a NISSAN dealer.

For further brake and clutch fluid specification information, refer to Capacities and recom- mended fuel/lubricants in the Technical and consumer information section of this manual.

WINDSHIELD-WASHER FLUID RESERVOIR

Fill the windshield-washer fluid reservoir periodi- cally. Add windshield-washer fluid when the low windshield-washer fluid warning light (if so equipped) comes on.

To fill the windshield-washer fluid reservoir, lift the cap off the reservoir and pour the windshield- washer fluid into the reservoir opening.

Add a washer solvent to the washer for better cleaning. In the winter season, add a windshield washer antifreeze. Follow the manufacturers in- structions for the mixture ratio.

Refill the reservoir more frequently when driving conditions require an increased amount of windshield-washer fluid.

Recommended fluid is Genuine NISSAN Wind- shield Washer Concentrate Cleaner & Anti- freeze or equivalent.

CAUTION

Do not substitute engine anti-freeze coolant for windshield-washer solution. This may result in damage to the paint.

Do not fill the windshield-washer reser- voir with washer fluid concentrates at full strength. Some methyl alcohol based washer fluid concentrates may permanently stain the grille if spilled while filling the windshield-washer reservoir.

Pre-mix washer fluid concentrates with water to the manufacturers recom- mended levels before pouring the fluid into the windshield-washer reservoir. Do not use the windshield-washer res- ervoir to mix the washer fluid concen- trate and water.

LDI0463 LDI0441

WINDSHIELD-WASHER FLUID

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-15

Keep the battery surface clean and dry. Clean the battery with a solution of baking soda and water.

Make certain the terminal connections are clean and securely tightened.

If the vehicle is not to be used for 30 days or longer, disconnect the negative (-) battery terminal cable to prevent discharge.

NOTE:

Care should be taken to avoid situations that can lead to potential battery discharge and potential no-start conditions such as:

1. Installation or extended use of electronic accessories that consume battery power when the engine is not running (Phone char- gers, GPS, DVD players, etc.)

2. Vehicle is not driven regularly and/or only driven short distances. In these cases, the battery may need to be charged to maintain battery health.

WARNING

Do not expose the battery to flames, an electrical spark or a cigarette. Hydro- gen gas generated by the battery is ex- plosive. Explosive gases can cause blindness or injury. Do not allow battery fluid to contact your skin, eyes, fabrics or painted surfaces. Sulfuric acid can cause blindness or injury. After touch- ing a battery or battery cap, do not touch or rub your eyes. Thoroughly wash your hands. If the acid contacts your eyes, skin or clothing, immediately flush with water for at least 15 minutes and seek medical attention.

Do not operate the vehicle if the fluid in the battery is low. Low battery fluid can cause a higher load on the battery which can generate heat, reduce bat- tery life, and in some cases lead to an explosion.

When working on or near a battery, al- ways wear suitable eye protection and remove all jewelry.

Battery posts, terminals and related ac- cessories contain lead and lead com- pounds. Wash hands after handling.

Keep battery out of the reach of children.

Do not tip the battery. Keep the vent caps tight and the battery level.

BATTERY

8-16 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

1. Remove the vent caps with a screwdriver as shown. Use a cloth to protect the battery case.

2. Check the fluid level in each cell. If it is necessary to add fluid, add only distilled water to bring the level up to the bottom of the filler opening. Do not overfill. Reinstall the vent caps.

Vehicles operated in high temperatures or under severe conditions require frequent checks of the battery fluid level.

JUMP STARTING If jump starting is necessary, see Jump starting in the In case of emergency section of this manual. If the engine does not start by jump starting, the battery may have to be replaced. Contact a NISSAN dealer.

WDI0224

WDI0529

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-17

CAUTION

Do not ground accessories directly to the battery terminal. Doing so will by- pass the variable voltage control sys- tem and the vehicle battery may not charge completely.

Use electrical accessories with the en- gine running to avoid discharging the vehicle battery.

Your vehicle is equipped with a variable voltage control system. This system measures the amount of electrical discharge from the battery and controls voltage generated by the generator.

The current sensor A is located near the battery along the negative battery cable. If you add elec- trical accessories to your vehicle, be sure to ground them to a suitable body ground such as the frame or engine block area.

1. Power steering fluid pump 2. Automatic belt tensioner 3. Cooling fan 4. Air conditioner compressor 5. Crankshaft pulley 6. Generator

WARNING

Be sure the ignition key is in the OFF or LOCK position before servicing drive belt. The engine could rotate unexpectedly.

LDI0454 VQ40DE

WDI0639

VARIABLE VOLTAGE CONTROL SYSTEM

DRIVE BELT

8-18 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

1. Visually inspect the belt for signs of unusual wear, cuts, fraying or looseness. If the belt is in poor condition or is loose, have it replaced or adjusted by a NISSAN dealer.

2. Have the belt checked regularly for condi- tion and tension in accordance with the maintenance schedule found in the NISSAN Service and Maintenance Guide.

1. Power steering fluid pump 2. Water pump 3. Air conditioner compressor (if so

equipped) 4. Crankshaft pulley 5. Generator

REPLACING SPARK PLUGS

Platinum-tipped spark plugs (QR25DE models)

It is not necessary to replace platinum-tipped A spark plugs as frequently as conventional type spark plugs because they last much longer. Fol- low the maintenance log shown in the NISSAN Service and Maintenance Guide. Do not service platinum-tipped spark plugs by cleaning or re- gapping.

Always replace spark plugs with rec- ommended or equivalent ones.

QR25DE LDI0461 SDI1895

SPARK PLUGS

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-19

If replacement is required, see your NISSAN dealer for assistance.

Iridium-tipped spark plugs (VQ40DE models) It is not necessary to replace iridium-tipped A spark plugs as frequently as conventional type spark plugs because they last much longer. Fol- low the maintenance log shown in the NISSAN Service and Maintenance Guide. Do not service iridium-tipped spark plugs by cleaning or regap- ping.

Always replace spark plugs with rec- ommended or equivalent ones.

If replacement is required, see your NISSAN dealer for assistance. The air cleaner filter should not be cleaned and

reused. Replace it according to the maintenance log shown in the NISSAN Service and Mainte- nance Guide. When replacing the filter, wipe the inside of the air cleaner filter housing and the cover with a damp cloth.

To remove the VQ40DE air cleaner filter:

1 Push down on the clips and remove the air cleaner cover. Remove the air cleaner filter.

To remove the QR25DE air cleaner filter:

1. Unlatch the clips A , B , C .

2. Push down half of air cleaner to clear the bottom retainers.

3. Lift up on half of air cleaner to remove the air cleaner filter

VQ40DE WDI0686

QR25DE LDI0465

AIR CLEANER

8-20 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

WARNING

Operating the engine with the air cleaner removed can cause you or oth- ers to be burned. The air cleaner not only cleans the air, it stops the flame if the engine backfires. If it isnt there, and the engine backfires, you could be burned. Do not drive with the air cleaner removed, and be careful when working on the engine with the air cleaner removed.

Never pour fuel into the throttle body or attempt to start the engine with the air cleaner removed. Doing so could result in serious injury.

IN-CABIN MICROFILTER (if so equipped) The in-cabin microfilter restricts the entry of air- borne dust and pollen particles and reduces some objectionable outside odors. The filter is located behind the glove box. Refer to the NISSAN Service and Maintenance Guide for change intervals.

To replace the filter, perform the following proce- dure:

1. Open the glove box and press in on the sides so that it will open completely allowing it to hang by the cord.

2. Gently lift up on the tab 1 .

3. Pull the filter cover toward you and then down 2 .

4. Remove the old filters 3 .

NOTE:

The filters are marked with air flow arrows. The end of the filter with the arrow should face the rear of the vehicle. The arrows should face downward.

5. Insert the first new filter into the housing and slide it over to the right. Insert the second new filter into the housing.

LDI0442 LDI2047

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-21

6. Replace the filter cover. The cover will click into place under the tab.

7. Install the glove box door.

CLEANING If your windshield is not clear after using the windshield washer or if a wiper blade chatters when running, wax or other material may be on the blade or windshield.

Clean the outside of the windshield with a washer solution or a mild detergent. Your windshield is clean if beads do not form when rinsing with clear water.

Clean each blade by wiping it with a cloth soaked in a washer solution or a mild detergent. Then rinse the blades with clear water. If your wind- shield is still not clear after cleaning the blades and using the wiper, replace the blades.

CAUTION

Worn windshield wiper blades can dam- age the windshield and impair driver vision.

REPLACING

Replace the wiper blades if they are worn.

1. Lift the wiper arm away from the windshield.

2 Push the release tab, then move the wiper blade down the wiper arm to remove.

3 Remove the wiper blade.

4. Insert the new wiper blade onto the wiper arm until it clicks into place.

5. Rotate the wiper blade so the dimple is in the groove.

WDI0408

WINDSHIELD WIPER BLADES

8-22 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

6. Return the wiper to its original position and release it until it has made contact with the windshield.

CAUTION

After wiper blade replacement, return the wiper arm to its original position; otherwise it may be damaged when the hood is opened.

Make sure the wiper blades contact the glass; otherwise the arms may be dam- aged from wind pressure.

If you wax the surface of the hood, be careful not to let wax get into the windshield washer nozzle A . This may cause clogging or improper wind- shield washer operation. If wax gets into the nozzle, remove it with a needle or small pin B .

If the brakes do not operate properly, have the brakes checked by a NISSAN dealer.

Self-adjusting brakes

Your vehicle is equipped with self-adjusting brakes.

The front and rear disc-type brakes self-adjust every time the brake pedal is applied.

WARNING

See a NISSAN dealer for a brake system check if the brake pedal height does not return to normal.

Brake pad wear indicators

The disc brake pads on your vehicle have audible wear indicators. When a brake pad requires re- placement, a high pitched scraping or screech- ing sound will be heard when the vehicle is in motion. The noise will be heard whether or not the brake pedal is depressed. Have the brakes checked as soon as possible if the wear indicator sound is heard.

Under some driving or climate conditions, occa- sional brake squeak, squeal or other noise may be heard. Occasional brake noise during light to moderate stops is normal and does not affect the function or performance of the brake system.

LDI2142

BRAKES

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-23

Proper brake inspection intervals should be followed. For more information regarding brake inspections, see the appropriate mainte- nance schedule information in the NISSAN Ser- vice and Maintenance Guide.

Two types of fuses are used. Type A is used in the fuse boxes in the engine compartment. Type B is used in the passenger compartment fuse box.

Type A fuses are provided as spare fuses. They are stored in the passenger compartment fuse box.

Type A fuses can be installed in the engine com- partment and passenger compartment fuse boxes.

If a type A fuse is used to replace a type B fuse, the type A fuse will not be level with the fuse pocket as shown in the illustration. This will not affect the performance of the fuse. Make sure the fuse is installed in the fuse box securely.

Type B fuses cannot be installed in the under- hood fuse boxes. Only use type A fuses in the underhood fuse boxes.

LDI0455 LDI0457

FUSES

8-24 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

ENGINE COMPARTMENT

CAUTION

Never use a fuse of a higher or lower amperage rating than specified on the fuse box cover. This could damage the electrical system or cause a fire.

If any electrical equipment does not come on, check for an open fuse.

1. Be sure the ignition switch and the headlight switch are OFF.

2. Open the engine hood.

3. Remove the fuse box cover by pushing the tab and lifting the cover up.

4. Remove the fuse with the fuse puller. The fuse puller is located in the center of the fuse block in the passenger compartment.

5. If the fuse is open A , replace it with a new fuse B .

6. If a new fuse also opens, have the electrical system checked and repaired by a NISSAN dealer.

LDI0444 WDI0452

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-25

Fusible links

If the electrical equipment does not operate and fuses are in good condition, check the fusible links. If any of these fusible links are melted, replace with only Genuine NISSAN parts.

PASSENGER COMPARTMENT

CAUTION

Never use a fuse of a higher or lower amperage rating than specified on the fuse box cover. This could damage the electrical system or cause a fire.

If any electrical equipment does not operate, check for an open fuse.

1. Be sure the ignition switch and the headlight switch are OFF.

2. Pull the fuse box cover to remove.

3. Remove the fuse with the fuse puller.

4. If the fuse is open A , replace it with an equivalent good fuse B .

5. Push the fuse box cover to install.

6. If a new fuse also opens, have the electrical system checked and repaired by a NISSAN dealer.

LDI0445 Type A

WDI0452

8-26 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

Extended storage switch If any electrical equipment does not operate, remove the extended storage switch and check for an open fuse.

NOTE:

The extended storage switch is used for long term vehicle storage. Even if the ex- tended storage switch is broken it is not necessary to replace it. Replace only the open fuse in the switch with a new fuse.

How to replace the extended storage switch:

1. To remove the extended storage switch, be sure the ignition switch is in the OFF or LOCK position.

2. Be sure the headlight switch is in the OFF position.

3. Remove the fuse box cover.

4. Pinch the locking tabs 1 found on each side of the storage switch.

5. Pull the storage switch straight out from the fuse box 2 .

Type B LDI0456 LDI2035

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-27

CAUTION

Be careful not to allow children to swallow the battery or removed parts.

KEYFOB (if so equipped)

Replace the battery in the keyfob as follows:

1 Open the lid using a coin A .

2 Remove the battery B .

3 Install a new battery C with the + facing down.

Hold the battery by the edges. Holding the battery across the contact points will seri- ously deplete the storage capacity.

LDI2026

BATTERY REPLACEMENT

8-28 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

Do not touch the internal circuit and electric terminals as it could cause a malfunction.

When changing the battery, do not let dust or oil get on the keyfob.

There is danger of explosion if a lithium bat- tery is incorrectly replaced. Replace only with the same or equivalent type.

Recommended battery: CR2025 or equivalent.

4 Close the lid securely.

5. Press the button, then the button two or three times to check the key- fob operation.

If the battery is removed for any reason other than replacement, perform step 5.

An improperly disposed battery can hurt the environment. Always confirm local regulations for battery disposal.

The keyfob is water-resistant; how- ever, if it does get wet, immediately wipe completely dry.

The operational range of the keyfob extends to approximately 33 ft (10 m) from the vehicle. This range may vary with conditions.

FCC Notice:

For USA: This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the fol- lowing two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference re- ceived, including interference that may cause undesired operation. Note: Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the users authority to operate the equipment.

For Canada: This device complies with RSS-210 of In- dustry Canada. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference, in- cluding interference that may cause unde- sired operation of the device.

HEADLIGHTS

The headlight is a semi-sealed beam type which uses a replaceable headlight (halogen) bulb. A bulb can be replaced from inside the engine compartment without removing the headlight as- sembly.

CAUTION

High pressure halogen gas is sealed inside the halogen bulb. The bulb may break if the glass envelope is scratched or the bulb is dropped.

When handling the bulb, do not touch the glass envelope.

DO NOT TOUCH THE BULB WITH BARE HANDS.

Use the same number and wattage as shown in the chart.

Do not leave the bulb out of the head- light reflector for a long period of time as dust, moisture and smoke may enter the headlight body and affect the per- formance of the headlight.

Aiming is not necessary after replacing the bulb. When aiming adjustment is necessary, contact a NISSAN dealer.

LIGHTS

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-29

Fog may temporarily form inside the lens of the exterior lights in the rain or in a car wash. A temperature difference between the inside and the outside of the lens causes the fog. This is not a malfunction. If large drops of water collect inside the lens, contact a NISSAN dealer.

Removing the headlight bulb

1. Open the hood.

2. Disconnect the negative (-) battery cable.

3. Disconnect the electrical connector from the rear end of the bulb.

4. Turn the bulb retaining ring counterclock- wise until it is free from the headlight reflec- tor and then remove it A .

5. Carefully remove the headlight bulb. Do not shake or rotate the bulb when removing it B .

Replacing the headlight bulb 1. Insert the bulb.

DO NOT TOUCH THE BULB WITH BARE HANDS.

2. Install and tighten the bulb retainer.

Be sure the lip of the bulb socket con- tacts the headlight body.

3. Push the electrical connector into the bulb plastic base until it snaps and stops.

4. Connect the negative (-) battery cable.

5. Close the hood.

LDI0446

8-30 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

EXTERIOR AND INTERIOR LIGHTS

Item Wattage (W) Bulb No.*1

Headlight 60/55 9007 (HB5) Turn signal light/Parking light 28/8 HT7444NA Side marker 5 168 Rear combination light

Turn signal 27 3156AK Stop/Tail 27/8 3157K Back-up 18 921

License plate light 5 W5W Fog light*2 (if so equipped) 55 H11 Map lights (if so equipped) 8 AL12 Interior light 8 AL25 High-mounted stop light/cargo light*2 12.8 912LF Always check with the Parts Department at a NISSAN dealer for the latest parts information. * The bulb is not serviceable in-vehicle. See a NISSAN dealer for assistance.

1. Map lights (if so equipped) 2. Interior light 3. High-mounted stop light/cargo light 4. License plate light 5. Rear combination light 6. Fog light (if so equipped) 7. Headlight assembly

LDI0713

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-31

Replacement procedures All other lights are either type A, B, C or D. When replacing a bulb, first remove the lens and/or cover.

: Indicates bulb removal : Indicates bulb installation

Use a cloth 1 to protect the housing.

WDI0306

Map lights/personal lights LDI0478

Interior light WDI0206

8-32 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

If you have a flat tire, see Flat tire in the In case of emergency section of this manual.

TIRE PRESSURE

Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)

This vehicle is equipped with the Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS). It monitors tire pressure of all tires except the spare. When the low tire pressure warning light is lit and the CHECK TIRE PRES (pressure) warning message is dis- played in the odometer, one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated.

The TPMS will activate only when the vehicle is driven at speeds above 16 MPH (25 km/h). Also, this system may not de- tect a sudden drop in tire pressure (for example a flat tire while driving).

For more details, refer to Low tire pres- sure warning light in the Instruments and controls section, Tire Pressure Monitor- ing System (TPMS) in the Starting and driving section, and Flat tire in the In case of emergency section.

Rear combination light WDI0300

License plate light WDI0411

WHEELS AND TIRES

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-33

Tire inflation pressure

Check the tire pressures (including the spare) often and always prior to long dis- tance trips. The recommended tire pres- sure specifications are shown on the F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label or the Tire and Loading Information label under the Cold Tire Pressure heading. The Tire and Loading Information label is affixed to the driver side center pillar. Tire pressures should be checked regularly because:

Most tires naturally lose air over time.

Tires can lose air suddenly when driven over potholes or other objects or if the vehicle strikes a curb while parking.

The tire pressures should be checked when the tires are cold. The tires are considered COLD after the vehicle has been parked for 3 or more hours, or driven less than 1 mile (1.6 km) at moderate speeds.

Incorrect tire pressure, including un- der inflation, may adversely affect tire life and vehicle handling.

WARNING

Improperly inflated tires can fail suddenly and cause an accident.

The Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) is located on the F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certifica- tion label. The vehicle weight ca- pacity is indicated on the Tire and Loading Information label. Do not load your vehicle beyond this capacity. Overloading your ve- hicle may result in reduced tire life, unsafe operating conditions due to premature tire failure, or unfavorable handling character- istics and could also lead to a serious accident. Loading be- yond the specified capacity may also result in failure of other ve- hicle components.

Before taking a long trip, or whenever you heavily load your vehicle, use a tire pressure gauge to ensure that the tire pressures are at the specified level.

For additional information re- garding tires, refer to Important Tire Safety Information (US) or Tire Safety Information (Canada) in the Warranty Infor- mation Booklet.

8-34 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

Tire and loading information label

1 Seating capacity: The maximum num- ber of occupants that can be seated in the vehicle.

2 Vehicle load limit: See loading infor- mation in the Technical and con- sumer information section.

3 Original tire size: The size of the tires originally installed on the vehicle at the factory.

4 Cold tire pressure: Inflate the tires to this pressure when the tires are cold. Tires are considered COLD after the vehicle has been parked for 3 or more hours, or driven less than 1 mile (1.6 km) at moderate speeds. The recommended cold tire inflation is set by the manufacturer to provide the best balance of tire wear, vehicle handling, driveability, tire noise, etc., up to the vehicles GVWR.

5 Tire size - refer to Tire labeling later in this section.

6 Spare tire size.

LDI2007

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-35

Checking tire pressure

1. Remove the valve stem cap from the tire.

2. Press the pressure gauge squarely onto the valve stem. Do not press too hard or force the valve stem side- ways, or air will escape. If the hissing sound of air escaping from the tire is heard while checking the pressure, reposition the gauge to eliminate this leakage.

3. Remove the gauge.

4. Read the tire pressure on the gauge stem and compare to the specifica- tion shown on the F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. label or the Tire and Loading Information label.

5. Add air to the tire as needed. If too much air is added, press the core of the valve stem briefly with the tip of the gauge stem to release pressure. Recheck the pressure and add or release air as needed.

6. Install the valve stem cap.

7. Check the pressure of all other tires, including the spare.

Size Cold Tire Inflation Pressure

Front Original Tire: P235/75R15 P265/70R16 P265/75R16 P265/60R18

240 kPa, 35 PSI

Rear Original Tire: P235/75R15 P265/70R16 P265/75R16 P265/60R18

240 kPa, 35 PSI

Spare Tire: P235/75R15 P265/70R16 P265/75R16 P265/60R18

240 kPa, 35 PSI

LDI0393

8-36 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

TIRE LABELING

Federal law requires tire manufacturers to place standardized information on the sidewall of all tires. This information iden- tifies and describes the fundamental characteristics of the tire and also pro- vides the tire identification number (TIN) for safety standard certification. The TIN can be used to identify the tire in case of a recall.

1 Tire size (example: P215/65R15 95H)

1. P: The P indicates the tire is de- signed for passenger vehicles (not all tires have this information).

2. Three-digit number (215): This num- ber gives the width in millimeters of the tire from sidewall edge to side- wall edge.

3. Two-digit number (65): This number, known as the aspect ratio, gives the tires ratio of height to width.

4. R: The R stands for radial. 5. Two-digit number (15): This number

is the wheel or rim diameter in inches. 6. Two- or three-digit number (95): This

number is the tires load index. It is a measurement of how much weight each tire can support. You may not find this information on all tires be- cause it is not required by law.

7. H: Tire speed rating. You should not drive the vehicle faster than the tire speed rating.

Example WDI0394

Example WDI0395

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-37

2 TIN (Tire Identification Number) for a new tire (example: DOT XX XX XXX XXXX)

1. DOT: Abbreviation for the Depart- ment Of Transportation. The symbol can be placed above, below or to the left or right of the Tire Identification Number.

2. Two-digit code: Manufacturers identification mark.

3. Two-digit code: Tire size.

4. Three-digit code: Tire type code (Optional).

5. Three-digit code: Date of Manufac- ture.

6. Four numbers represent the week and year the tire was built. For ex- ample, the numbers 3103 means the 31st week of 2003. If these numbers are missing, then look on the other sidewall of the tire.

3 Tire ply composition and material

The number of layers or plies of rubber- coated fabric in the tire. Tire manufactur- ers also must indicate the materials in the tire, which include steel, nylon, polyester, and others.

4 Maximum permissible inflation pres- sure

This number is the greatest amount of air pressure that should be put in the tire. Do not exceed the maximum permissible in- flation pressure.

5 Maximum load rating

This number indicates the maximum load in kilograms and pounds that can be car- ried by the tire. When replacing the tires on the vehicle, always use a tire that has the same load rating as the factory in- stalled tire.

6 Term of tubeless or tube type

Indicates whether the tire requires an in- ner tube (tube type) or not (tubeless).

Example WDI0396

8-38 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

7 The word radial

The word radial is shown if the tire has radial structure.

8 Manufacturer or brand name

Manufacturer or brand name is shown.

Other Tire-related Terminology

In addition to the many terms that are defined throughout this section, Intended Outboard Sidewall is (1) the sidewall that contains a whitewall, bears white lettering or bears manufacturer, brand, and/or model name molding that is higher or deeper than the same molding on the other sidewall of the tire, or (2) the out- ward facing sidewall of an asymmetrical tire that has a particular side that must always face outward when mounted on a vehicle.

TYPES OF TIRES

WARNING

When changing or replacing tires, be sure all four tires are of the same type (i.e., Summer, All Season or Snow) and construction. A NISSAN dealer may be able to help you with information about tire type, size, speed rating and availability.

Replacement tires may have a lower speed rating than the factory equipped tires, and may not match the potential maximum vehicle speed. Never exceed the maximum speed rating of the tire.

For additional information regarding tires, refer to Important Tire Safety In- formation (US) or Tire Safety Informa- tion (Canada) in the Warranty Informa- tion Booklet.

All season tires

NISSAN specifies All Season tires on some mod- els to provide good performance all year, includ- ing snowy and icy road conditions. All Season tires are identified by ALL SEASON and/or M&S on the tire sidewall. Snow tires have better snow traction than All Season tires and may be more appropriate in some areas.

Summer tires

NISSAN specifies summer tires on some models to provide superior performance on dry roads. Summer tire performance is substantially re- duced in snow and ice. Summer tires do not have the tire traction rating M&S on the tire sidewall.

If you plan to operate your vehicle in snowy or icy conditions, NISSAN recommends the use of SNOW tires or ALL SEASON tires on all four wheels.

Snow tires If snow tires are needed, it is necessary to select tires equivalent in size and load rating to the original equipment tires. If you do not, it can adversely affect the safety and handling of your vehicle.

Generally, snow tires have lower speed ratings than factory equipped tires and may not match the potential maximum vehicle speed. Never ex- ceed the maximum speed rating of the tire.

If you install snow tires, they must be the same size, brand, construction and tread pattern on all four wheels.

For additional traction on icy roads, studded tires may be used. However, some U.S. states and Canadian provinces prohibit their use. Check local, state and provincial laws before installing

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-39

studded tires. Skid and traction capabilities of studded snow tires on wet or dry surfaces may be poorer than that of non-studded snow tires.

TIRE CHAINS

Use of tire chains may be prohibited according to location. Check the local laws before installing tire chains. When installing tire chains, make sure they are the proper size for the tires on your vehicle and are installed according to the chain manufacturers suggestions. Use only SAE class S chains. Class S chains are used on vehicles with restricted tire to vehicle clearance. Vehicles that can use Class S chains are de- signed to meet the minimum clearances between the tire and the closest vehicle suspension or body component required to accommodate the use of a winter traction device (tire chains or cables). The minimum clearances are determined using the factory equipped tire size. Other types may damage your vehicle. Use chain tensioners when recommended by the tire chain manufac- turer to ensure a tight fit. Loose end links of the tire chain must be secured or removed to prevent the possibility of whipping action damage to the fenders or underbody. If possible, avoid fully load- ing your vehicle when using tire chains. In addi- tion, drive at a reduced speed. Otherwise, your vehicle may be damaged and/or vehicle handling and performance may be adversely affected.

Tire chains must be installed only on the rear wheels and not on the front wheels.

Do not use tire chains on dry roads. Driving with chains in such conditions can cause damage to the various mechanisms of the vehicle due to some overstress.

Use only the 2WD range when driving on clear paved roads.

CHANGING WHEELS AND TIRES

Tire rotation

NISSAN recommends rotating the tires every 7,500 miles (12,000 km).

See Flat tire in the In case of emer- gency section in this manual for tire re- placing procedures.

As soon as possible, tighten the wheel nuts to the specified torque with a torque wrench.

WDI0258

8-40 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

Wheel nut tightening torque:

98 ft-lb (133 Nm)

The wheel nuts must be kept tight- ened to specifications at all times. It is recommended that wheel nuts be tightened to specification at each tire rotation interval.

WARNING

After rotating the tires, check and adjust the tire pressure.

Retighten the wheel nuts when the vehicle has been driven for 600 miles (1,000 km) (also in cases of a flat tire, etc.).

Do not include the spare tire in the tire rotation.

For additional information re- garding tires, refer to Important Tire Safety Information (US) or Tire Safety Information (Canada) in the Warranty Infor- mation Booklet.

1. Wear indicator 2. Location mark

Tire wear and damage

WARNING

Tires should be periodically in- spected for wear, cracking, bulg- ing or objects caught in the tread. If excessive wear, cracks, bulging or deep cuts are found, the tire(s) should be replaced.

The original tires have built-in tread wear indicators. When the wear indicators are visible, the tire(s) should be replaced.

Tires degrade with age and use. Have tires, including the spare, over 6 years old checked by a qualified technician because some tire damage may not be ob- vious. Replace the tires as neces- sary to prevent tire failure and possible personal injury.

Improper service of the spare tire may result in serious personal in- jury. If it is necessary to repair the spare tire, contact a NISSAN dealer.

For additional information re- garding tires, refer to Important Tire Safety Information (US) or Tire Safety Information (Canada) in the Warranty Infor- mation Booklet.

WDI0259

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-41

Replacing wheels and tires

When replacing a tire, use the same size, tread design, speed rating and load carrying capacity as originally equipped. Recommended types and sizes are shown in Wheels and tires in the Technical and consumer information section of this manual.

WARNING

The use of tires other than those recom- mended or the mixed use of tires of different brands, construction (bias, bias-belted or radial), or tread patterns can adversely affect the ride, braking, handling, VDC system, ground clear- ance, body-to-tire clearance, tire chain clearance, speedometer calibration, headlight aim and bumper height. Some of these effects may lead to acci- dents and could result in serious per- sonal injury.

If your vehicle was originally equipped with 4 tires that were the same size and you are only replacing 2 of the 4 tires, install the new tires on the rear axle. Placing new tires on the front axle may cause loss of vehicle control in some driving conditions and cause an acci- dent and personal injury.

If the wheels are changed for any reason, always replace with wheels which have the same off-set dimension. Wheels of a different off-set could cause premature tire wear, degrade vehicle handling char- acteristics, affect the VDC system and/or interference with the brake discs/drums. Such interference can lead to decreased braking efficiency and/or early brake pad/shoe wear. Refer to Wheels and tires in the Technical and consumer in- formation section of this manual for wheel off-set dimensions.

When a spare tire is mounted or a wheel is replaced, tire pressure will not be indi- cated, the TPMS will not function and the low tire pressure warning light will flash for approximately 1 minute. The light will remain on after 1 minute. Contact your NISSAN dealer as soon as possible for tire replacement and/or system resetting.

Replacing tires with those not originally specified by NISSAN could affect the proper operation of the TPMS.

Do not install a damaged or deformed wheel or tire even if it has been repaired. Such wheels or tires could have structural damage and could fail without warning.

The use of retread tires is not recommended.

For additional information regarding tires, refer to Important Tire Safety In- formation (US) or Tire Safety Informa- tion (Canada) in the Warranty Informa- tion Booklet.

Four-wheel drive models

CAUTION

Always use tires of the same type, size, brand, construction (bias, bias-belted or ra- dial), and tread pattern on all four wheels. Failure to do so may result in a circumfer- ence difference between tires on the front and rear axles which will cause excessive tire wear and may damage the transmis- sion, transfer case and differential gears.

If excessive tire wear is found, it is recommended that all four tires be replaced with tires of the same size, brand, construction and tread pattern. The tire pressure and wheel alignment should also be checked and corrected as necessary. Contact a NISSAN dealer.

Wheel balance

Unbalanced wheels may affect vehicle handling and tire life. Even with regular use, wheels can get out of balance. Therefore, they should be bal- anced as required.

8-42 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

Wheel balance service should be per- formed with the wheels off the vehicle. Spin balancing the wheels on the vehicle could lead to mechanical damage.

For additional information regarding tires, refer to Important Tire Safety Information (US) or Tire Safety Infor- mation (Canada) in the Warranty In- formation Booklet.

Care of wheels Wash the wheels when washing the vehicle

to maintain their appearance.

Clean the inner side of the wheels when the wheel is changed or the underside of the vehicle is washed.

Do not use abrasive cleaners when washing the wheels.

Inspect wheel rims regularly for dents or corrosion. Such damage may cause loss of pressure or poor seal at the tire bead.

NISSAN recommends waxing the road wheels to protect against road salt in areas where it is used during winter.

Spare tire (FULL SIZE TEMPORARY USE ONLY spare tire)

Your vehicle may be equipped with a full size spare that is a different size or brand than the tires originally installed on the vehicle. This full size spare tire is intended for temporary use only and should be replaced at the first opportunity.

Observe the following precautions if the full size temporary use only spare tire must be used. Otherwise, your vehicle could be damaged or involved in an accident:

WARNING

The spare tire should be used for emer- gency use only. It should be replaced with the standard tire at the first oppor- tunity to avoid possible tire or differen- tial damage.

Drive carefully while the spare tire is installed. Avoid sharp turns and abrupt braking while driving. The vehicle driv- ing performance may be affected when driving on wet or snow covered roads.

When the temporary full size spare is installed, the following systems may not work correctly:

Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS).

Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) System.

Periodically check spare tire inflation pressure. Always keep the spare tire inflated to the pressure specification shown on the tire and loading informa- tion label.

With the spare tire installed do not drive the vehicle at speeds faster than 50 MPH (80 km/h).

When driving on roads covered with snow or ice, the temporary spare tire should be used on the front wheels and the original tire used on the rear wheels. Use tire chains only on the drive wheels.

Do not use the spare tire on other vehicles.

Do not use more than one spare tire at the same time.

CAUTION

Do not use tire chains on a spare tire. Tire chains will not fit properly and may cause damage to the vehicle.

Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-43

MEMO

8-44 Maintenance and do-it-yourself

9 Technical and consumer information

Capacities and recommended fuel/lubricants . . . . . . . . . 9-2 Fuel recommendation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-4 Engine oil and oil filter recommendations . . . . . . . . . . 9-6 Air conditioner system (if so equipped) refrigerant and oil recommendations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-7

Specifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-8 Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-8 Wheels and tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-9 Dimensions and weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-9

When traveling or registering your vehicle in another country . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-10 Vehicle identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-10

Vehicle identification number (VIN) plate . . . . . . . . . 9-10 Engine serial number. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-11 F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label . . . . . . . . . . 9-11 Emission control information label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-11 Tire and loading information label. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-12 Air conditioner specification label (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-12

Installing front license plate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-12 Installing front license plate with grommets . . . . . . . 9-12 Installing front license plate without grommets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-13

Vehicle loading information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-13

Terms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-13 Vehicle load capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-14 Securing the load. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-16 Utili-track channel system (if so equipped) . . . . . . 9-17 Loading tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-22

Truck-camper loading information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-23 Crew Cab Models . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-23 King Cab models . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-23 Special Body vehicles. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-23 Location for center of gravity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-23 Vehicle load weight capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-24 Measurement of weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-24

Towing a trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-24 Maximum load limits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-25 Towing load/specification. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-28 Towing safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-29 Flat towing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-35

Uniform tire quality grading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-36 Emission control system warranty . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-37 Reporting safety defects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-37 Readiness for inspection/maintenance (I/M) test . . . . . 9-38 Event Data Recorders (EDR). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-39 Owners Manual/Service Manual order information . . . 9-39

The following are approximate capacities. The actual refill capacities may be a little different. When refilling, follow the procedure described in the Maintenance and do-it-yourself section to determine the proper refill capacity.

Capacity (Approximate) Recommended Fluids and Lubricants

US measure Imp measure Liter

Fuel 21-1/8gal 17-5/8 gal 80 See Fuel recommendation later in this section.

Engine oil *7 Drain and Refill

With oil filter change QR25DE

4-7/8 qt 4 qt 4.6

Engine oil with API Certification Mark *1 *10 Viscosity SAE 5W-30 *1 *10

Without oil filter change

4-1/2 qt 3-3/4 qt 4.3

With oil filter change VQ40DE

5-3/8 qt 4-1/2 qt 5.1

Without oil filter change

5-1/8 qt 4-1/4 qt 4.8

Cooling system With reservoir

QR25DE 2-1/2 gal 2-1/8 gal 9.4 Pre-diluted Genuine NISSAN Long Life Antifreeze/Coolant (blue) or equivalentVQ40DE 2-3/4 gal 2-1/4 gal 10.2

Manual transmission gear oil

5M/T 3-1/8 qt 2-1/2 qt 2.9 Genuine NISSAN Manual Transmission Fluid (MTF) HQ Multi 75W-85 or API GL-4, Viscosity SAE 75W-85

6 M/T 4X2 4-1/4 qt 3-1/2 qt 4.0 6 M/T 4X4 4-1/2 qt 3-3/4 qt 4.2

Automatic transmission fluid Refill to the proper level according to the instruc- tions in the Maintenance and do-it-yourself section.

Genuine NISSAN Matic S ATF *2

Power steering fluid (PSF) Genuine NISSAN PSF or equivalent.*3

Brake and clutch fluid Genuine NISSAN Super Heavy Duty Brake Fluid *4 or equivalent DOT 3

Multi-purpose grease NLGI No. 2 (Lithium Soap base)

CAPACITIES AND RECOMMENDED FUEL/LUBRICANTS

9-2 Technical and consumer information

Capacity (Approximate) Recommended Fluids and Lubricants

US measure Imp measure Liter

Air conditioning system refrigerant HFC-134a (R-134a) *5

Air conditioning system oil Genuine NISSAN A/C System Oil Type R or equivalent *5

Transfer fluid 2-1/8 qt 1-3/4 qt 2.0 Genuine NISSAN Matic D ATF recommended *6

Front final drive oil 1-3/4 pt 1-1/2 pt 0.85 Genuine NISSAN Differential Oil Hypoid Super GL-5 80W-90 or API GL-5, Viscosity SAE 80W-90 *8

Rear final drive oil (except 6 speed M/T and O/R vehicles) 3-3/8 pt 2-7/8 pt 1.6 API GL-5 synthetic gear oil, Viscosity SAE 75W-90 *9 Rear final drive oil (6 speed M/T and O/R vehicles only) 4-1/4 pt 3-1/2 pt 2.0 Genuine NISSAN differential oil synthetic 75W-140 or API GL-5

synthetic gear oil, Viscosity SAE 75W-140 *9

Windshield-washer fluid 1-1/4 gal 1 gal 4.5 Genuine NISSAN Windshield Washer Concentrate Cleaner & Anti- freeze or equivalent

*1: For further details, see Engine oil and oil filter recommendations in this section. *2: If Genuine NISSAN Matic S ATF is not available, Genuine NISSAN Matic J ATF may also be used. Using automatic transmission fluid other than Genuine NISSAN Matic S ATF or

Genuine NISSAN Matic J ATF will cause deterioration in driveability and automatic transmission durability, and may damage the automatic transmission, which is not covered by the NISSAN new vehicle limited warranty.

*3: DEXRON VI type ATF may also be used. *4: Available in mainland USA through a NISSAN dealer. *5: For further details, see Air conditioner specification label in this section. *6: Using fluid other than Genuine NISSAN Matic D ATF will cause deterioration in driveability and transfer durability, and may damage the transfer, which is not covered by the NISSAN

new vehicle limited warranty. *7: For further details, see Changing engine oil in the Maintenance and do-it-yourself section. *8: For hot climates, Viscosity SAE 90 is suitable for ambient temperatures above 0 (32F) *9: See a NISSAN dealer for service for synthetic oil. *10: NISSAN recommends the use of Genuine NISSAN Ester Oil, available at a NISSAN dealer.

Technical and consumer information 9-3

FUEL RECOMMENDATION

Use unleaded regular gasoline with an octane rating of at least 87 AKI (Anti-Knock Index) num- ber (Research octane number 91).

CAUTION

Only vehicles with the E-85 filler door label can operate on E-85. Fuel system or other damage can occur if E-85 is used in vehicles that are not designed to run on E-85.

Using a fuel other than that specified could adversely affect the emission control system, and may also affect the warranty coverage.

Under no circumstances should a leaded gasoline be used, because this will damage the three-way catalyst.

Do not use E-15 or E-85 fuel in your vehicle. Your vehicle is not designed to run on E-15 or E-85 fuel. Using E-15 or E-85 fuel in a vehicle not specifically designed for E-15 or E-85 fuel can ad- versely affect the emission control de- vices and systems of the vehicle. Dam- age caused by such fuel is not covered by the NISSAN new vehicle limited warranty.

U.S. government regulations require ethanol dispensing pumps to be identi- fied by a small, square, orange and black label with the common abbrevia- tion or the appropriate percentage for that region.

Gasoline specifications

NISSAN recommends using gasoline that meets the World-Wide Fuel Charter (WWFC) specifi- cations where it is available. Many of the automo- bile manufacturers developed this specification to improve emission control system and vehicle performance. Ask your service station manager if the gasoline meets the WWFC specifications.

Reformulated gasoline Some fuel suppliers are now producing reformu- lated gasolines. These gasolines are specially designed to reduce vehicle emissions. NISSAN supports efforts towards cleaner air and sug- gests that you use reformulated gasoline when available.

Gasoline containing oxygenates Some fuel suppliers sell gasoline containing oxy- genates such as ethanol, MTBE and methanol with or without advertising their presence. NISSAN does not recommend the use of fuels of which the oxygenate content and the fuel com-

patibility for your NISSAN cannot be readily de- termined. If in doubt, ask your service station manager.

If you use oxygenate-blend gasoline, please take the following precautions as the usage of such fuels may cause vehicle performance problems and/or fuel system damage.

The fuel should be unleaded and have an octane rating no lower than that recommended for unleaded gasoline.

If an oxygenate-blend other than methanol blend is used, it should con- tain no more than 10% oxygenate. (MTBE may, however, be added up to 15%.)

E-15 fuel contains more than 10% oxy- genate. E-15 fuel will adversely affect the emission control devices and sys- tems of the vehicle and should not be used. Damage caused by such fuel is not covered by the NISSAN new ve- hicle limited warranty.

9-4 Technical and consumer information

If a methanol blend is used, it should contain no more than 5% methanol (methyl alcohol, wood alcohol). It should also contain a suitable amount of appropriate cosolvents and corro- sion inhibitors. If not properly formu- lated with appropriate cosolvents and corrosion inhibitors, such methanol blends may cause fuel system damage and/or vehicle performance problems. At this time, sufficient data is not avail- able to ensure that all methanol blends are suitable for use in NISSAN ve- hicles.

If any driveability problems such as engine stall- ing and difficult hot-starting are experienced after using oxygenate-blend fuels, immediately change to a non-oxygenate fuel or a fuel with a low blend of MTBE.

Take care not to spill gasoline during refu- eling. Gasoline containing oxygenates can cause paint damage.

E15 fuel E-15 fuel is a mixture of approximately 15% fuel ethanol and 85% unleaded gasoline. E-15 can only be used in vehicles designed to run on E-15 fuel. Do not use E-15 in your vehicle. U.S. gov- ernment regulations require fuel ethanol dispens- ing pumps to be identified with small, square,

orange and black label with the common abbre- viation or the appropriate percentage for that region.

E85 fuel

E-85 fuel is a mixture of approximately 85% fuel ethanol and 15% unleaded gasoline. E-85 can only be used in a Flexible Fuel Vehicle (FFV). Do not use E-85 in your vehicle. U.S. government regulations require fuel ethanol dispensing pumps to be identified by a small, square, orange and black label with the common abbreviation or the appropriate percentage for that region.

Aftermarket fuel additives NISSAN does not recommend the use of any aftermarket fuel additives (for example, fuel injec- tor cleaner, octane booster, intake valve deposit removers, etc.) which are sold commercially. Many of these additives intended for gum, varnish or deposit removal may contain active solvents or similar ingredients that can be harmful to the fuel system and engine.

Octane rating tips Using unleaded gasoline with an octane rating lower than recommended can cause persistent, heavy spark knock. (Spark knock is a metallic rapping noise.) If se- vere, this can lead to engine damage. If you

detect a persistent heavy spark knock even when using gasoline of the stated octane rating, or if you hear steady spark knock while holding a steady speed on level roads, have a NISSAN dealer correct the condition. Failure to correct the condition is misuse of the vehicle, for which NISSAN is not responsible.

Incorrect ignition timing may result in spark knock, after-run and/or overheating, which may cause excessive fuel consumption or engine damage. If any of the above symptoms are en- countered, have your vehicle checked at a NISSAN dealer.

However, now and then you may notice light spark knock for a short time while accelerating or driving up hills. This is not a cause for concern, because you get the greatest fuel benefit when there is light spark knock for a short time under heavy engine load.

Technical and consumer information 9-5

ENGINE OIL AND OIL FILTER RECOMMENDATIONS

Selecting the correct oil

It is essential to choose the correct grade, quality and viscosity engine oil to ensure satisfactory engine life and performance. See Capacities and recommended fuel/lubricants earlier in this section. NISSAN recommends the use of an energy conserving oil in order to improve fuel economy.

Select only engine oils that meet the American Petroleum Institute (API) certification or Interna- tional Lubricant Standardization and Approval

Committee (ILSAC) certification and SAE vis- cosity standard. These oils have the API certifica- tion mark on the front of the container. Oils which do not have the specified quality label should not be used as they could cause engine damage.

Oil additives

NISSAN does not recommend the use of oil additives. The use of an oil additive is not neces- sary when the proper oil type is used and main- tenance intervals are followed.

Oil which may contain foreign matter or has been previously used should not be used.

Oil viscosity The engine oil viscosity or thickness changes with temperature. Because of this, it is important to select the engine oil viscosity based on the temperatures at which the vehicle will be oper- ated before the next oil change. Choosing an oil viscosity other than that recommended could cause serious engine damage.

Selecting the correct oil filter Your new NISSAN vehicle is equipped with a high-quality genuine NISSAN oil filter. When re- placing, use a genuine NISSAN oil filter or its equivalent for the reason described in Change intervals.

Change intervals The oil and oil filter change intervals for your engine are based on the use of the specified quality oils and filters. Using engine oil and filters that are not of the specified quality, or exceeding recommended oil and filter change intervals could reduce engine life. Damage to the engine caused by improper maintenance or use of incor- rect oil and filter quality and/or viscosity is not covered by the NISSAN new vehicle limited war- ranty.

LTI2061

9-6 Technical and consumer information

Your engine was filled with a high-quality engine oil when it was built. You do not have to change the oil before the first recommended change interval. Oil and filter change intervals depend upon how you use your vehicle.

Operation under the following conditions may require more frequent oil and filter changes:

repeated short distance driving at cold out- side temperatures

driving in dusty conditions

extensive idling

towing a trailer

stop and go commuting

Refer to the NISSAN Service and Maintenance Guide for the maintenance schedule.

AIR CONDITIONER SYSTEM (if so equipped) REFRIGERANT AND OIL RECOMMENDATIONS

The air conditioner system in your NISSAN vehicle must be charged with the refriger- ant HFC-134a (R-134a) and the oil, NISSAN A/C system oil Type R or the exact equiva- lents.

CAUTION

The use of any other refrigerant or oil will cause severe damage to the air condition- ing system and will require the replace- ment of all air conditioner system components.

The refrigerant HFC-134a (R-134a) in your NISSAN vehicle does not harm the earths ozone layer. Although this refrigerant does not affect the earths atmosphere, certain government regula- tions require the recovery and recycling of any refrigerant during automotive air conditioner sys- tem service. A NISSAN dealer has the trained technicians and equipment needed to recover and recycle your air conditioner system refriger- ant.

Contact a NISSAN dealer when servicing your air conditioner system.

Technical and consumer information 9-7

ENGINE

Model QR25DE VQ40DE

Type Gasoline, 4-cycle, DOHC Gasoline, 4-cycle, DOHC Cylinder arrangement 4-cylinder in-line 6-cylinder, V-block, Slanted at 60 Bore x Stroke in (mm) 3.5 x 3.9 (89.0 x 100.0) 3.760 x 3.622 (95.5 x 92) Displacement cu in (cm3) 151.82 (2,488) 241.30 (3,954) Firing order 1342 123456

Idle speed M/T A/T (in N position) See the Emission control information label on the underside of the hood. Ignition timing (degree B.T.D.C. at idle speed) CO % at idle

Spark plug Standard PLZKAR6A-11 DILFR5A-11

Spark plug gap (Nominal) in (mm) 0.043 (1.1) 0.043 (1.1)

Camshaft operation Timing chain Timing chain This spark ignition system complies with the Canadian standard ICES-002.

SPECIFICATIONS

9-8 Technical and consumer information

WHEELS AND TIRES

Wheels

15 x 6.5JJ

16 x 7.0JJ

18 x 7.5JJ

Tires

P235/75R15

P265/70R16

P265/75R16

P265/60R18

Spare tire Full size

DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS

Overall length

Short wheel base in (mm) 205.5 (5,220)

Long wheel base in (mm) 219.4 (5,574)

Overall width in (mm) 72.8 (1,850)

Overall height

With roof rack in (mm) 73.9 (1,878)

Without roof rack

S and SV I-4 King cab mod- els (4x2)

in (mm) 68.7 (1,745)

SV (4x2 and 4x4) and Pro-4X (4x4) King cab models

in (mm) 69.7 (1,770)

Crew cab models in (mm) 70.1 (1,780)

Front Track in (mm) 61.8 (1,570)

Rear Track in (mm) 61.8 (1,570)

Wheelbase

Short wheel base in (mm) 125.9 (3,200)

Long wheel base in (mm) 139.9 (3,554)

Gross vehicle weight rating lb (kg) See the F.M.V.S.S./C.M. V.S.S. certification label on the center pillar be- tween the drivers side front and rear doors.

Gross axle weight rating

Front lb (kg)

Rear lb (kg)

Technical and consumer information 9-9

When planning to drive your NISSAN ve- hicle in another country, you should first find out if the fuel available is suitable for your vehi- cles engine.

Using fuel with an octane rating that is too low may cause engine damage. All gasoline vehicles must be operated with unleaded gasoline. There- fore, avoid taking your vehicle to areas where appropriate fuel is not available.

When transferring the registration of your vehicle to another country, state, province or district, it may be necessary to modify the vehicle to meet local laws and regulations.

The laws and regulations for motor vehicle emis- sion control and safety standards vary according to the country, state, province or district; there- fore, vehicle specifications may differ.

When any vehicle is to be taken into an- other country, state, province or district and registered, its modifications, transpor- tation, and registration are the responsibil- ity of the user. NISSAN is not responsible for any inconvenience that may result.

VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER (VIN) PLATE The vehicle identification number (VIN) plate is attached as shown. This number is the identifica- tion for your vehicle and is used in the vehicle registration.

LTI0085 QR25DE engine

LTI0130

WHEN TRAVELING OR REGISTERING YOUR VEHICLE IN ANOTHER COUNTRY

VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION

9-10 Technical and consumer information

ENGINE SERIAL NUMBER The number is stamped on the engine as shown.

F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. CERTIFICATION LABEL The Federal/Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standard (F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S.) certification la- bel is affixed as shown. This label contains valu- able vehicle information, such as: Gross Vehicle Weight Ratings (GVWR), Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR), month and year of manufacture, Vehicle Identification Number (VIN), etc. Review it carefully.

EMISSION CONTROL INFORMATION LABEL The emission control information label is at- tached to the underside of the hood as shown.

VQ40DE engine LTI0127 LTI0136 LTI0133

Technical and consumer information 9-11

TIRE AND LOADING INFORMATION LABEL The cold tire pressure is shown on the Tire and Loading Information label. The label is located as shown.

AIR CONDITIONER SPECIFICATION LABEL (if so equipped) The air conditioner specification label is affixed as shown.

INSTALLING FRONT LICENSE PLATE WITH GROMMETS Use the following steps to mount the front license plate with grommets:

1. Make holes on the plastic finisher at the location mark (small dimple) using a 0.37 in (9.5 mm) drill. Apply light pressure to the drill. Insert two plastic grommets provided. Install the license plate holder using the two bolts (and washers) provided.

2. Mount the license plate using two M6- 14 mm bolts. License plate bolt tightening torque:

3.8 - 4.7 ft-lb (5.10 - 6.37 Nm)

LTI0135 LTI0206 LTI0137

INSTALLING FRONT LICENSE PLATE

9-12 Technical and consumer information

INSTALLING FRONT LICENSE PLATE WITHOUT GROMMETS Use the following steps to mount the front license plate without grommets:

1. Make a shallow hole in each plastic finisher at the location mark (small dimple) using a 0.31 in (8 mm) drill. To avoid damaging the threads behind the finisher, apply only light pressure to the drill.

2. Mount the license plate bracket using two 8 mm slotted hex head screws.

WARNING

It is extremely dangerous to ride in a cargo area inside a vehicle. In a collision, people riding in these areas are more likely to be seri- ously injured or killed.

Do not allow people to ride in any area of your vehicle that is not equipped with seats and seat belts.

Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and using a seat belt properly.

TERMS

It is important to familiarize yourself with the following terms before loading your vehicle:

Curb Weight (actual weight of your vehicle) - vehicle weight including: standard and optional equipment, flu- ids, emergency tools, and spare tire assembly. This weight does not in- clude passengers and cargo.

GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight) - curb weight plus the combined weight of passengers and cargo.

GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rat- ing) - maximum total combined weight of the unloaded vehicle, pas- sengers, luggage, hitch, trailer tongue load and any other optional equipment. This information is lo- cated on the F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label.

GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating) - maximum weight (load) limit specified for the front or rear axle. This informa- tion is located on the F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label.

GCWR (Gross Combined Weight rating) - The maximum total weight rating of the vehicle, passengers, cargo, and trailer.

VEHICLE LOADING INFORMATION

Technical and consumer information 9-13

Vehicle Capacity Weight, Load limit, Total load capacity - maximum total weight limit specified of the load (passengers and cargo) for the ve- hicle. This is the maximum combined weight of occupants and cargo that can be loaded into the vehicle. If the vehicle is used to tow a trailer, the trailer tongue weight must be in- cluded as part of the cargo load. This information is located on the Tire and Loading Information label.

Cargo capacity - permissible weight of cargo, the subtracted weight of occupants from the load limit.

VEHICLE LOAD CAPACITY

Before driving a loaded vehicle, confirm that you do not exceed the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) or the Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) for your vehicle. Both the GVWR and GAWR are located on the F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label. See Measurement of weights later in this section.

Do not exceed the load limit of your ve- hicle shown as The combined weight of occupants and cargo on the Tire and Loading Information label. Do not exceed the number of occupants shown as Seating Capacity on the Tire and Load- ing Information label.

To get the combined weight of occu- pants and cargo, add the weight of all occupants, then add the total luggage weight. Examples are shown in the follow- ing illustration.

9-14 Technical and consumer information

Steps for determining correct load limit

1. Locate the statement The combined weight of occupants and cargo should never exceed XXX lbs or XXX kg on your vehicles placard.

2. Determine the combined weight of the driver and passengers that will be riding in your vehicle.

3. Subtract the combined weight of the driver and passengers from XXX lbs or XXX kg.

4. The resulting figure equals the avail- able amount of cargo and luggage load capacity. For example, if the XXX amount equals 1,400 lbs. and there will be five 150 lb. passengers in your vehicle, the amount of avail- able cargo and luggage load capac- ity is 650 lbs. (1,400-750 (5 X 150) = 650 lbs) or (640-340 (5 X 70) = 300 kg.)

Example LTI0152

Technical and consumer information 9-15

5. Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo being loaded on the vehicle. That weight may not safely exceed the available cargo and luggage load capacity calculated in Step 4.

6. If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, load from your trailer will be trans- ferred to your vehicle. Consult this manual to determine how this re- duces the available cargo and lug- gage load capacity of your vehicle.

Before driving a loaded vehicle, confirm that you do not exceed the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) or the Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) for your vehicle. See Measurement of weights later in this section.

Also check tires for proper inflation pres- sures. See the Tire and Loading Informa- tion label.

SECURING THE LOAD

For your convenience, tie down hooks (if so equipped) are placed at each corner of the truck box. These may be used to help secure cargo loaded into the truck box.

WARNING

Properly secure all cargo with ropes or straps to help prevent it from sliding or shifting. Do not place cargo higher than the seatbacks. In a sudden stop or col- lision, unsecured cargo could cause personal injury.

Do not load your vehicle any heavier than the GVWR or the maximum front and rear GAWRs. If you do, parts of your vehicle can break, tire damage could occur, or it can change the way your vehicle handles. This could result in loss of control and cause personal injury.

LTI0102

9-16 Technical and consumer information

1. Side channels 2. Header channel 3. Channel sections 4. Floor channels

UTILI-TRACK CHANNEL SYSTEM (if so equipped)

WARNING

Properly install and tighten the tie- down cleats into the Utili-track chan- nel system. Also, do not attach any rope or straps directly to the channel. Failure to properly install the tie-down cleats or attaching ropes or straps directly to the channel can cause the cargo to become unsecured. In a sudden stop or colli- sion, unsecured cargo could cause per- sonal injury.

Properly secure all cargo with ropes or straps to help prevent it from sliding or shifting. In a sudden stop or collision, unsecured cargo could cause personal injury.

The Utili-track channel system allows you to move tie-down clamps in the bed to the best location to secure a load.

The tie-down cleats must be installed so the clamp is properly seated in the notches in the rail. If the tie-down cleat is not seated in the notches, it will not be flush with the rail and cannot be properly tightened. The bolt in the center of the cleat must be tightened hand tight (20 40 in- lbs)

Check the tightness of the tie-down cleat peri- odically during a trip to make sure the center bolt has not become loose.

Install the tie-down cleat as follows:

1. Remove the channel protectors by sliding them out the back of the truck bed. Properly store the channel protectors.

2. Loosen the center bolt completely.

LTI0107

Technical and consumer information 9-17

3. Insert the cleat into the channel perpendicu- lar to the channel as shown. Then rotate the cleat clockwise 90 and slide it to the de- sired location.

4. Position the cleat so the nubs on the bottom fully seat into the channel detents.

LTI0103

LTI0104

9-18 Technical and consumer information

5. There should be no gap between the bottom of the cleat and the top of the channel. Tighten the center bolt hand tight (20-40 in- lbs ).

WTI0124

Technical and consumer information 9-19

CAUTION

Install only one cleat per section of channel.

Applying loads at angles to the cleats greater then 45 or loads greater than 150 lbs. (header and floor channels) or 200 lbs. (side channels) may cause damage to the channel or bed.

LTI0106

9-20 Technical and consumer information

WARNING

Do not install accessories over the gap between the front and rear side channels. Doing this could affect the rear structure in certain rear impacts, which could result in serious injury.

CAUTION

Properly secure all cargo with ropes or straps to prevent it from sliding or shifting. Use the channel end stoppers to help se- cure items in the channels from sliding off the end of the truck bed.

Channel end stoppers (if so equipped) The channel end stoppers should be used to help prevent accessories installed in the channels from sliding or shifting off the end of the truck bed.

They must be installed so they are properly seated in the detents in the channel.

1 correct installation, 2 incorrect installation LTI0123 WTI0119

Technical and consumer information 9-21

Install the channels end stoppers as follows:

1. Remove the channel protectors by sliding them out the back of the truck bed. Properly store the channel protectors.

2. Loosen the bolt on the center of the end stopper with the provided wrench and insert it into the channel.

3. Position the end stopper to the desired lo- cation on the channel so the nubs on the bottom of the end stopper fully seat into the channel detents.

4. Tighten the bolt on the center of the end stopper with the provided wrench.

LOADING TIPS

The GVW must not exceed GVWR or GAWR as specified on the F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label.

Do not load the front and rear axle to the GAWR. Doing so will exceed the GVWR.

WARNING

Properly secure all cargo with ropes or straps to help prevent it from sliding or shifting. Do not place cargo higher than the seat- backs. In a sudden stop or colli- sion, unsecured cargo could cause personal injury.

Do not load your vehicle any heavier than the GVWR or the maximum front and rear GAWRs. If you do, parts of your vehicle can break, tire damage could oc- cur, or it can change the way your vehicle handles. This could result in loss of control and cause per- sonal injury.

Overloading not only can shorten the life of your vehicle and the tire, but can also cause unsafe vehicle handling and longer brak- ing distances. This may cause a premature tire failure which could result in a serious accident and personal injury. Failures caused by overloading are not covered by the vehicles warranty.

9-22 Technical and consumer information

CREW CAB MODELS Crew Cab short wheel base models should not be used to carry a slide-in camper.

KING CAB MODELS This information is provided for you to properly install a slide-in camper and is based on the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration regulations. It is recommended that, before in- stalling the camper, you carefully read the follow- ing information and ensure that the camper meets the specifications.

This information may not apply to some Canada model vehicles.

SPECIAL BODY VEHICLES Some vehicles are equipped with commercial or camper bodies. However, this Owners Manual does not cover these options. For further infor- mation, please refer to the body manufacturers instruction manual.

LOCATION FOR CENTER OF GRAVITY The illustration indicates the recommended cargo center of gravity location.

King Cab:

L1 = 41.5 in (1,054 mm)

WARNING

Improper loading may be dangerous. If a load is too far back, it can affect handling characteristics. If a load is too far forward, the front axle may be overloaded.

When the truck is used to carry a slide-in camper, the total cargo load of the truck consists of the camper manufacturers weight figure, plus:

the weight of installed additional camper equipment not included in the camper manufacturers weight figure,

the weight of camper cargo,

and the weight of occupants in the camper.

The total cargo load should not exceed the trucks pay load weight rating and the campers center of gravity should fall within the trucks recommended center of gravity location when installed.

LTI0128 LTI0129

TRUCK-CAMPER LOADING INFORMATION

Technical and consumer information 9-23

WARNING

Overloading or improper loading can ad- versely affect vehicle handling, braking and performance and may lead to accidents.

VEHICLE LOAD WEIGHT CAPACITY The vehicle payload weight capacity shown on the Tire and Loading Information label, see Tire and Loading Information label in this section, indicates the maximum total weight of passen- gers, optional equipment (air conditioning, trailer hitch, etc) and cargo that your vehicle is designed to carry.

Before driving a loaded vehicle, confirm that you do not exceed the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) or the Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) for your vehicle. See Vehicle Loading Information earlier in this section for details.

Also check tires for proper inflation pressures. See the Tire and Loading Information label.

MEASUREMENT OF WEIGHTS

Secure loose items to prevent weight shifts that could affect the balance of your vehicle. When the vehicle is loaded, drive to a scale and weigh the front and the rear wheels separately to determine axle

loads. Individual axle loads should not ex- ceed either of the gross axle weight rat- ings (GAWR). The total of the axle loads should not exceed the gross vehicle weight rating (GVWR). These ratings are given on the vehicle certification label. If weight ratings are exceeded, move or re- move items to bring all weights below the ratings.

WARNING

Overloading or improper loading of a trailer and its cargo can adversely affect vehicle handling, braking and perfor- mance and may lead to accidents.

CAUTION

Do not tow a trailer or haul a heavy load for the first 500 miles (800 km). Your engine, axle or other parts could be damaged.

For the first 500 miles (800 km) that you tow a trailer, do not drive over 50 mph (80 km/h) and do not make starts at full throttle. This helps the engine and other parts of your vehicle wear in at the heavier loads.

Your new vehicle was designed to be used pri- marily to carry passengers and cargo. Remember that towing a trailer places additional loads on your vehicles engine, drive train, steering, brak- ing and other systems.

A NISSAN Towing Guide (U.S. only) is available on the website at www.nissanusa.com. This guide includes information on trailer towing ca- pability and the special equipment required for proper towing.

TOWING A TRAILER

9-24 Technical and consumer information

MAXIMUM LOAD LIMITS Maximum trailer loads Never allow the total trailer load to exceed the value specified in the Towing Load/Specification chart found later in this sec- tion. The total trailer load equals trailer weight plus its cargo weight.

When towing a trailer load of 3,500 lbs. (1,587 kg) or more, trailers with a brake system MUST be used.

The maximum Gross Combined Weight Rating (GCWR) should not exceed the value specified in the following Towing Load/Specification chart. The GCWR equals the combined weight of the

towing vehicle (including passengers and cargo) plus the total trailer load. Towing loads greater than these or using improper towing equipment could adversely affect vehicle handling, braking and performance.

The ability of your vehicle to tow a trailer is not only related to the maximum trailer loads, but also the places you plan to tow. Tow weights appro- priate for level highway driving may have to be reduced for low traction situations (for example, on slippery boat ramps).

Temperature conditions can also affect towing. For example, towing a heavy trailer in high outside temperatures on graded roads can affect engine performance and cause overheating. The engine protection mode, which helps reduce the chance of engine damage, could activate and automati- cally decrease engine power. Vehicle speed may decrease under high load. Plan your trip carefully to account for trailer and vehicle load, weather and road conditions.

WARNING

Overheating can result in reduced engine power and vehicle speed. The reduced speed may be lower than other traffic, which could increase the chance of a col- lision. Be especially careful when driving. If the vehicle cannot maintain a safe driv- ing speed, pull to the side of the road in a safe area. Allow the engine to cool and return to normal operation. See If your vehicle overheats in the In case of emer- gency section of this manual.

CAUTION

Vehicle damage resulting from improper towing procedures is not covered by NISSAN warranties.

LTI0161

Technical and consumer information 9-25

Tongue load When using a weight carrying or a weight distrib- uting hitch, keep the tongue load between 10 - 15 percent of the total trailer load or use the trailer tongue load specified by the trailer manu- facturer. The tongue load must be within the maximum tongue load limits shown in the follow- ing Towing Load/Specification chart. If the tongue load becomes excessive, rearrange cargo to allow for proper tongue load.

Maximum Gross Vehicle Weight (GVW)/maximum Gross Axle Weight (GAW)

The GVW of the towing vehicle must not exceed the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) shown on the F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label. The GVW equals the combined weight of the unloaded vehicle, passengers, luggage, hitch, trailer tongue load and any other optional equipment. In addition, front or rear GAW must not exceed the Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) shown on the F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label.

Towing capacities are calculated assuming a base vehicle with driver and any options required to achieve the rating. Additional passengers, cargo and/or optional equipment, such as the trailer hitch, will add weight to the vehicle and reduce your vehicles maximum towing capacity and trailer tongue load.

The vehicle and trailer need to be weighed to confirm the vehicle is within the GVWR, Front GAWR, Rear GAWR, Gross Combined Weight Rating (GCWR) and Towing capacity.

All vehicle and trailer weights can be measured using platform type scales commonly found at truck stops, highway weigh stations, building supply centers or salvage yards.

To determine the available payload capacity for tongue load, use the following procedure.

1. Locate the GVWR on the F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label.

2. Weigh your vehicle on the scale with all of the passengers and cargo that are normally in the vehicle when towing a trailer.

3. Subtract the actual vehicle weight from the GVWR. The remaining amount is the avail- able maximum tongue load.

To determine the available towing capacity, use the following procedure.

WTI0160 CA0036

9-26 Technical and consumer information

1. Find the GCWR for your vehicle on the Towing Load/Specification chart found later in this section.

2. Subtract the actual vehicle weight from the GCWR. The remaining amount is the avail- able maximum towing capacity.

To determine the Gross Trailer Weight, weigh your trailer on a scale with all equipment and cargo, that are normally in the trailer when it is towed. Make sure the Gross Trailer Weight is not more than the Gross Trailer Weight Rating shown on the trailer and is not more than the calculated available maximum towing capacity.

Also weigh the front and rear axles on the scale to make sure the Front Gross Axle Weight and Rear Gross Axle Weight are not more than Front Gross Axle Weight and Rear Gross Axle Weight on the F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label. The cargo in the trailer and vehicle may need to be moved or removed to meet the specified ratings.

Example:

Gross Vehicle Weight (GVW) as weighed on a scale- including passengers, cargo and hitch - 5,185 lb. (2352 kg).

Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) from F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label - 5,815 lb. (2638 kg).

Gross Combined Weight Rating (GCWR) from Towing Load/Specification chart - 11,133 lb. (5050 kg).

Maximum Trailer towing capacity from Tow- ing Load/Specification chart - 6,100 lb. (2767 kg).

5,815 lb. (2638 kg) GVWR

5,185 lb. (2352 kg) GVW

= 630 lb. (286 kg) Available for tongue weight

11,133 lb. (5050 kg) GCWR

5,185 lb. (2352 kg) GVW

= 5,948 lb. (2698 kg) Capacity available for towing

630 lb. (286 kg) Available tongue weight

/ 5,948 lb. (2698 kg) Available capacity

= 10 % tongue weight

The available towing capacity may be less than the maximum towing capacity due to the passen- ger and cargo load in the vehicle.

Remember to keep trailer tongue weight be- tween 10 - 15% of the trailer weight or within the

trailer tongue load specification recommended by the trailer manufacturer. If the tongue load becomes excessive, rearrange the cargo to ob- tain the proper tongue load. Do not exceed the maximum tongue weight specification shown in the Towing load/specification chart even if the calculated available tongue weight is greater than 15%. If the calculated tongue weight is less than 10% , reduce the total trailer weight to match the available tongue weight.

Always verify that available capacities are within the required ratings.

Trailer frontal area

CAUTION

Exceeding the maximum trailer frontal area specification may exceed the towing capac- ity of the vehicle. This may affect the towing performance and lead to vehicle damage.

The trailer frontal area affects the towing load of a trailer. The frontal area is the total area of the vehicle and trailer that is affected by air resis- tance while towing. Do not exceed the maximum trailer frontal area specification shown in the Towing Load/Specification chart. The frontal area can be determined by multiplying the width of the trailer by the height of the trailer. For example, a trailer that is 8 feet wide by 6 feet tall has a trailer frontal area of 48 square feet.

Technical and consumer information 9-27

TOWING LOAD/SPECIFICATION

King Cab 2WD (4 cyl) King Cab 2WD (6 cyl) King Cab 4WD (6 cyl) Crew Cab 2WD Crew Cab 4WD Maximum Towing Capacity*1, *2, *3

3,500 lb. (1,588 kg) 6,505 lb. (2,949 kg) 6,300 lb. (2,858 kg) 6,300 lb. (2,858 kg) 6,100 lb. (2,767 kg)

Maximum Tongue Load*2, *3 350 lb. (158 kg) 650 lb. (295 kg) 630 lb. (285 kg) 630 lb. (285 kg) 610 lb. (276 kg) Maximum Gross Combined Weight Rating

7,940 lb. (3,600 kg) 11,135 lb. (5,050 kg) 11,135 lb. (5,050 kg) 11,135 lb. (5,050 kg) 11,135 lb. (5,050 kg)

Maximum trailer frontal area 60 sq feet (5.52 sq meters)

*1:

The towing capacity values are calculated assuming a base vehicle with driver and any options required to achieve the rating. Additional passengers, cargo and/or optional equipment will add weight to the vehicle and reduce your vehicles maximum towing capacity.

All towing above 1,000 lb (454 kg) requires the use of trailer brakes. NISSAN recommends the use of a tandem axle trailer whenever towing above 3,000 lb (1,361 kg).

*2: The maximum towing capacity when using the genuine NISSAN step bumper as a ball mount is 3,500 lb. (1,588 kg) and 350 lb. (158 kg) tongue load.

*3: Use of a weight-distributing hitch system is recommended when towing over 5,000 lbs.

9-28 Technical and consumer information

TOWING SAFETY Trailer hitch

Your vehicle may be equipped with an optional trailer tow package. The trailer tow package in- cludes a receiver-type frame mounted hitch. This hitch is rated for the maximum towing capacity of this vehicle when the proper towing equipment is used. Choose a proper ball mount and hitch ball that is rated for the trailer to be towed. Genuine NISSAN ball mounts and hitch balls are available from your NISSAN dealer.

If your vehicle is not equipped with the optional trailer tow package, check the towing capacity of your bumper hitch or receiver-type frame mounted hitch. Choose a proper hitch for your vehicle and trailer. A genuine NISSAN trailer hitch is available from your NISSAN dealer. Make sure the trailer hitch is securely attached to the vehicle to help avoid personal injury or property damage due to sway caused by crosswinds, rough road surfaces or passing trucks.

WARNING

Trailer hitch components have specific weight ratings. Your vehicle may be ca- pable of towing a trailer heavier than the weight rating of the hitch components. Never exceed the weight rating of the hitch components. Doing so can cause serious personal injury or property damage.

Hitch ball

Choose a hitch ball of the proper size and weight rating for your trailer:

The required hitch ball size is stamped on most trailer couplers. Most hitch balls also have the size printed on the top of the ball.

Choose the proper class hitch ball based on the trailer weight.

The diameter of the threaded shank of the hitch ball must be matched to the ball mount hole diameter. The hitch ball shank should be no more than 1/16 smaller than the hole in the ball mount.

The threaded shank of the hitch ball must be long enough to be properly secured to the ball mount. There should be at least 2 threads showing beyond the lock washer and nut.

Ball mount The hitch ball is attached to the ball mount and the ball mount is inserted into the hitch receiver. Choose a proper class ball mount based on the trailer weight. Additionally, the ball mount should be chosen to keep the trailer tongue level with the ground.

Technical and consumer information 9-29

Bumper towing

The genuine NISSAN step bumper has provi- sions to install a trailer hitch ball and is designed to tow trailers of a maximum weight of 3,500 lb (1,588 kg).

To install a trailer hitch ball cut out the circle in the center of the step bumper A , then remove it to install the trailer hitch ball.

Weight carrying hitches A weight carrying or dead weight ball mount is one that is designed to carry the whole amount of tongue weight and gross weight directly on the ball mount and on the receiver.

Weight distribution hitch

This type of hitch is also called a load-levelingor equalizing hitch. A set of bars attach to the ball mount and to the trailer to distribute the tongue weight (hitch weight) of your trailer. Many ve- hicles cant carry the full tongue weight of a given trailer, and need some of the tongue weight transferred through the frame and pushing down on the front wheels. This gives stability to the tow vehicle.

A weight-distributing hitch system (Class IV) is recommended if you plan to tow trailers with a maximum weight over 5,000 lbs (2,268 kg) . Check with the trailer and towing equipment manufacturers to determine if they recommend the use of a weight-distributing hitch system.

NOTE:

A weight-distributing hitch system may af- fect the operation of trailer surge brakes. If you are considering use of a weight- distributing hitch system with a surge brake-equipped trailer, check with the surge brake, hitch or trailer manufacturer to determine if and how this can be done.

Follow the instructions provided by the manufac- turer for installing and using the weight- distributing hitch system.

General set-up instructions are as follows:

1. Park unloaded vehicle on a level surface. With the ignition on and the doors closed, allow the vehicle to stand for several minutes so that it can level.

2. Measure the height of a reference point on the front and rear bumpers at the center of the vehicle.

3. Attach the trailer to the vehicle and adjust the hitch equalizers so that the front bumper height is within 0 - .5 inches (0 13 mm) of the reference height measured in step 2. The rear bumper should be no higher than the reference height measured in step 2.

WARNING

Properly adjust the weight distributing hitch so the rear of the bumper is no higher than the measured reference height when the trailer is attached. If the rear bumper is higher than the measured reference height when loaded, the vehicle may handle unpredictably which could cause a loss of vehicle control and cause serious personal injury or property damage.

LTI0132

9-30 Technical and consumer information

Sway control device

Sudden maneuvers, wind gusts, and buffeting caused by other vehicles can affect trailer han- dling. Sway control devices may be used to help control these affects. If you choose to use one, contact a reputable trailer hitch supplier to make sure the sway control device will work with the vehicle, hitch, trailer and the trailers brake sys- tem. Follow the instructions provided by the manufacturer for installing and using the sway control device.

Class I hitch

Class I trailer hitch equipment (receiver, ball mount and hitch ball) can be used to tow trailers of a maximum weight of 2,000 lb (907 kg).

Class II hitch

Class II trailer hitch equipment (receiver, ball mount and hitch ball) can be used to tow trailers of a maximum weight of 3,500 lb (1,587 kg).

The genuine NISSAN step bumper is considered a Class II ball mount.

Class III hitch

Class III trailer hitch equipment (receiver, ball mount and hitch ball) can be used to tow trailers of a maximum weight of 5,000 lb (2,268 kg).

Class IV hitch

Class IV trailer hitch equipment (receiver, ball mount and hitch ball) can be used to tow trailers of a maximum weight of 10,000 lb (4,535 kg). A weight distributing hitch should be used to tow trailers that weigh over 5,000 lb (2,268 kg).

Your vehicle may be equipped with Class IV trailer hitch equipment that has a 10,000 lb (4,535 kg) maximum weight rating, but your ve- hicle is only capable of towing the maximum trailer weights shown in the Towing Load/Specification chart earlier in this section.

CAUTION

Special hitches which include frame re- inforcements are required for towing above 2,000 lb (907 kg). Suitable genu- ine NISSAN hitches, ball mounts and hitch balls for pickup trucks and sport utility vehicles are available at a NISSAN dealer.

The hitch should not be attached to or affect the operation of the impact- absorbing bumper.

Do not use axle-mounted hitches.

Do not modify the vehicle exhaust sys- tem, brake system, etc. to install a trailer hitch.

To reduce the possibility of additional damage if your vehicle is struck from the rear, where practical, remove the receiver when not in use.

Regularly check that all trailer hitch mounting bolts are securely mounted.

Tire pressures

When towing a trailer, inflate the ve- hicle tires to the recommended cold tire pressure indicated on the Tire and Loading Information label.

Trailer tire condition, size, load rating and proper inflation pressure should be in accordance with the trailer and tire manufacturers specifications.

Technical and consumer information 9-31

Safety chains

Always use suitable safety chains between your vehicle and the trailer. The safety chains should be crossed and should be attached to the hitch, not to the vehicle bumper or axle. The safety chains can be attached to the bumper if the hitch ball is mounted to the bumper. Be sure to leave enough slack in the chains to permit turning corners.

Trailer lights

CAUTION

When splicing into the vehicle electrical system, a commercially available power- type module/converter must be used to provide power for all trailer lighting. This unit uses the vehicle battery as a direct power source for all trailer lights while using the vehicle tail light, stoplight and turn signal circuits as a signal source. The module/converter must draw no more that 15 milliamps from the stop and tail lamp circuits. Using a module/converter that exceeds these power requirements may damage the vehicles electrical sys- tem. See a reputable trailer dealer to ob- tain the proper equipment and to have it installed.

Trailer lights should comply with federal and/or local regulations. For assistance in hooking up trailer lights, contact a NISSAN dealer or repu- table trailer dealer. Vehicles equipped with the optional trailer tow package are equipped with a 7-pin trailer harness connector. A flat 4pin har- ness is available from your dealer for vehicles without a tow package. If your trailer is equipped with a flat 4-pin connector, an adapter will be needed to connect the trailer lights to the vehicle. Adapters are available at auto parts stores and hitch retailers.

Trailer brakes If your trailer is equipped with a braking system, make sure it conforms to federal and/or local regulations and that it is properly installed.

Vehicles equipped with a 7pin trailer harness connector are pre-wired for a trailer brake con- troller. See a NISSAN dealer for a trailer brake adapter harness.

WARNING

Never connect a trailer brake system di- rectly to the vehicle brake system.

When towing a trailer load of 3,500 lbs. (1587 kg) or more, trailers with a brake system MUST be used. However, most states require a separate braking system on trailers with

a loaded weight above a specific amount. Make sure the trailer meets the local regulations and the regulations where you plan to tow.

Several types of braking systems are available.

Surge Brakes -The surge brake actuator is mounted on the trailer tongue with a hydraulic line running to each trailer wheel. Surge brakes are activated by the trailer pushing against the hitch ball when the tow vehicle is braking. Hydraulic surge brakes are common on rental trailers and some boat trailers. In this type of system, there is no hydraulic or electric connection for brake op- eration between the tow vehicle and the trailer.

Electric Trailer Brakes -Electric braking sys- tems are activated by an electronic signal sent from a trailer brake controller (special brake- sensing module). If electric trailer brakes are used, see Electric trailer brake controller in this section.

Have a professional supplier of towing equip- ment make sure the trailer brakes are properly installed and demonstrate proper brake function testing.

Electric trailer brake controller Trailers equipped with electric brakes may re- quire the installation of an aftermarket trailer brake controller.

9-32 Technical and consumer information

A Genuine NISSAN jumper harness is available that is specifically designed to be used when installing an aftermarket brake controller.

Install the aftermarket electric trailer brake con- troller according to the manufacturers instruc- tions.

Pre-towing tips

Be certain your vehicle maintains a level position when a loaded and/or unloaded trailer is hitched. Do not drive the vehicle if it has an abnormal nose-up or nose-down condition; check for improper tongue load, overload, worn suspension or other possible causes of either condition.

Always secure items in the trailer to prevent load shift while driving.

Keep the cargo load as low as possible in the trailer to keep the trailer center of gravity low.

Load the trailer so approximately 60% of the trailer load is in the front half and 40% is in the back half. Also make sure the load is balanced side to side.

Check your hitch, trailer tire pressure, ve- hicle tire pressure, trailer light operation, and trailer wheel lug nuts every time you attach a trailer to the vehicle.

Be certain your rearview mirrors conform to all federal, state or local regulations. If not, install any mirrors required for towing before driving the vehicle.

Determine the overall height of the vehicle and trailer so the required clearance is known.

Trailer towing tips

In order to gain skill and an understanding of the vehicles behavior, you should practice turning, stopping and backing up in an area which is free from traffic. Steering stability and braking perfor- mance will be somewhat different than under normal driving conditions.

Always secure items in the trailer to prevent load shift while driving.

Lock the trailer hitch coupler with a pin or lock to prevent the coupler from inadver- tently becoming unlatched.

Avoid abrupt starts, acceleration or stops.

Avoid sharp turns or lane changes.

Always drive your vehicle at a moderate speed.

When backing up, hold the bottom of the steering wheel with one hand. Move your hand in the direction in which you want the trailer to go. Make small corrections and back up slowly. If possible, have someone guide you when you are backing up.

Always block the wheels on both vehicle and trailer when parking. Parking on a slope is not recommended; however, if you must do so:

CAUTION

If you move the shift selector to the P (Park) position before blocking the wheels and applying the parking brake, transmission damage could occur.

1. Apply and hold the brake pedal.

2. Have someone place blocks on the downhill side of the vehicle and trailer wheels.

3. After the wheel blocks are in place, slowly release the brake pedal until the blocks ab- sorb the vehicle load.

4. Apply the parking brake.

5. Shift the transmission into P (Park).

Technical and consumer information 9-33

6. Make sure the indicator light (if so equipped) indicates the transfer case is in 4H, 4L, or 2H and that the ATP light is off. If the indicator light is flashing, or the ATP light is ON, make sure the transmission is in P (Park) (A/T) and turn the 4WD switch to 2WD or 4H. See Automatic transmission park warning light in the Instruments and controls section and Using four wheel drive (4WD) in the Starting and driving section.

7. Turn off the engine.

To drive away:

1. Start the vehicle.

2. Apply and hold the brake pedal.

3. Shift the transmission into gear.

4. Release the parking brake.

5. Drive slowly until the vehicle and trailer are clear from the blocks.

6. Apply and hold the brake pedal.

7. Have someone retrieve and store the blocks.

While going downhill, the weight of the trailer pushing on the tow vehicle may decrease overall stability. Therefore, to maintain ad- equate control, reduce your speed and shift to a lower gear. Avoid long or repeated use of the brakes when descending a hill, as this re- duces their effectiveness and could cause overheating. Shifting to a lower gear instead provides engine braking and reduces the need to brake as frequently.

If the engine coolant temperature rises to a high temperature, refer to If your vehicle overheats in the In case of emergency section of this owners manual.

Trailer towing requires more fuel than normal circumstances.

Avoid towing a trailer for your vehicles first 500 miles (805 km).

For the first 500 miles (805 km) that you do tow, do not drive over 50 MPH (80 km/h).

Have your vehicle serviced more often than at intervals specified in the recommended Maintenance Schedule in the NISSAN Ser- vice and Maintenance Guide.

When making a turn, your trailer wheels will be closer to the inside of the turn than your vehicle wheels. To compensate for this, make a larger than normal turning radius during the turn.

Crosswinds and rough roads will adversely affect vehicle/trailer handling, possibly caus- ing vehicle sway. When being passed by larger vehicles, be prepared for possible changes in crosswinds that could affect ve- hicle handling.

Do the following if the trailer begins to sway:

1. Take your foot off the accelerator pedal to allow the vehicle to coast and steer as straight ahead as the road conditions allow. This combination will help stabilize the vehicle

Do not correct trailer sway by steering or applying the brakes.

2. When the trailer sway stops, gently apply the brakes and pull to the side of the road in a safe area.

3. Try to rearrange the trailer load so it is bal- anced as described earlier in this section.

Be careful when passing other vehicles. Passing while towing a trailer requires con- siderably more distance than normal pass- ing. Remember, the length of the trailer must also pass the other vehicle before you can safely change lanes.

9-34 Technical and consumer information

Downshift the transmission to a lower gear for engine braking when driving down steep or long hills. This will help slow the vehicle without applying the brakes.

Avoid holding the brake pedal down too long or too frequently. This could cause the brakes to overheat, resulting in reduced braking efficiency.

Increase your following distance to allow for greater stopping distances while towing a trailer. Anticipate stops and brake gradually.

NISSAN recommends that the cruise con- trol not be used while towing a trailer.

Some states or provinces have specific regulations and speed limits for vehicles that are towing trailers. Obey the local speed limits.

Check your hitch, trailer wiring harness con- nections, and trailer wheel lug nuts after 50 miles (80 km) of travel and at every break.

When launching a boat, dont allow the wa- ter level to go over the exhaust tail pipe or rear bumper.

Make sure you disconnect the trailer lights before backing the trailer into the water or the trailer lights may burn out.

When towing a trailer, final drive gear oil should be replaced and transmission oil/fluid should be changed more fre- quently. For additional information, see the Maintenance and do-it-yourself section earlier in this manual.

FLAT TOWING

Towing your vehicle with all four wheels on the ground is sometimes called flat towing. This method is sometimes used when towing a vehicle behind a recreational vehicle, such as a motor home.

CAUTION

Failure to follow these guidelines can result in severe transmission damage.

Whenever flat towing your vehicle, al- ways tow forward, never backward.

DO NOT tow any automatic transmis- sion vehicle with all four wheels on the ground (flat towing). Doing so WILL DAMAGE internal transmission parts due to lack of transmission lubrication.

For emergency towing procedures refer to Towing recommended by NISSAN in the In case of emergency section of this manual.

Manual Transmission (if so equipped) Always tow with the manual transmission in

Neutral.

On 4-wheel drive vehicles, place the transfer case in the 2H range. Failure to do so will cause the powertrain to bind up.

After towing 500 miles (805 km), start and idle the engine with the transmission in Neu- tral for two minutes. Failure to idle the engine after every 500 miles (805 km) of towing may cause damage to internal transmission parts.

Automatic Transmission (if so equipped) To tow a vehicle equipped with an automatic transmission, an appropriate vehicle dolly MUST be placed under the towed vehicles drive wheels. Always follow the dolly manufacturers recommendations when using their product.

Technical and consumer information 9-35

DOT (Department of Transportation) Quality Grades: All passenger car tires must conform to federal safety requirements in addition to these grades.

Quality grades can be found where applicable on the tire sidewall between tread shoulder and maximum section width. For example:

Treadwear 200 Traction AA Temperature A

Treadwear

The treadwear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear rate of the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a specified gov- ernment test course. For example, a tire graded 150 would wear one and one-half (1 1/2) times as well on the government course as a tire graded 100. The relative performance of tires depends upon the actual conditions of their use, however, and may depart significantly from the norm due to variations in driving habits, service practices and differences in road characteristics and climate.

Traction AA, A, B and C

The traction grades, from highest to lowest, are AA, A, B, and C. Those grades represent the tires ability to stop on wet pavement as mea- sured under controlled conditions on specified government test surfaces of asphalt and con- crete. A tire marked C may have poor traction performance.

WARNING

The traction grade assigned to this tire is based on straight-ahead braking traction tests, and does not include acceleration, cornering, hydroplaning, or peak traction characteristics.

Temperature A, B and C

The temperature grades are A (the highest), B, and C, representing the tires resistance to the generation of heat, and its ability to dissipate heat when tested under controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory test wheel. Sustained high temperature can cause the material of the tire to degenerate and reduce tire life, and exces- sive temperature can lead to sudden tire failure. The grade C corresponds to a level of perfor- mance which all passenger car tires must meet under the Federal Motor Safety Standard No. 109. Grades B and A represent higher levels of performance on the laboratory test wheel than the minimum required by law.

WARNING

The temperature grade for this tire is es- tablished for a tire that is properly inflated and not overloaded. Excessive speed, under-inflation, or excessive loading, ei- ther separately or in combination, can cause heat build-up and possible tire failure.

UNIFORM TIRE QUALITY GRADING

9-36 Technical and consumer information

Your NISSAN vehicle is covered by the following emission warranties:

For USA

1. Emission Defects Warranty

2. Emissions Performance Warranty

Details of this warranty may be found with other vehicle warranties in your Warranty Information Booklet which comes with your NISSAN vehicle. If you did not receive a Warranty Information Booklet, or it is lost, you may obtain a replace- ment by writing to:

Nissan North America, Inc. Consumer Affairs Department P.O. Box 685003 Franklin, TN 37068-5003

For Canada

Emission Control System Warranty

Details of this warranty may be found with other vehicle warranties in your Warranty Information Booklet which comes with your NISSAN vehicle. If you did not receive a Warranty Information Booklet, or it is lost, you may obtain a replace- ment by writing to:

Nissan Canada Inc. 5290 Orbitor Drive Mississauga, Ontario, L4W 4Z5

For USA

If you believe that your vehicle has a de- fect which could cause a crash or could cause injury or death, you should immedi- ately inform the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) in addi- tion to notifying NISSAN.

If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy campaign. However, NHTSA cannot be- come involved in individual problems be- tween you, your dealer, or NISSAN.

To contact NHTSA, you may call the Ve- hicle Safety Hotline toll-free at 1-888- 327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-424-9153); go to http://www.safercar.gov; or write to: Administrator, NHTSA, 400 Seventh Street, SW., Washington, D.C. 20590. You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from http://www.safercar.gov.

You may notify NISSAN by contacting our Consumer Affairs Department, toll-free, at 1-800-NISSAN-1.

For Canada

If you believe that your vehicle has a de- fect which could cause a crash or could cause injury or death, you should immedi- ately inform Transport Canada in addition to notifying NISSAN.

If Transport Canada receives complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may request that NISSAN con- duct a recall campaign. However, Trans- port Canada cannot become involved in individual problems between you, your dealer, or NISSAN.

You may contact Transport Canadas De- fect Investigations and Recalls Division toll free at 1-800-333-0510. You may also report safety defects online at: https://wwwapps.tc.gc.ca/Saf-Sec-Sur/ 7/PCDB-BDPP/Index.aspx.

EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM WARRANTY

REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS

Technical and consumer information 9-37

Additional information concerning motor vehicle safety may be obtained from Trans- port Canadas Road Safety Information Centre at 1-800-333-0371 or online at www.tc.gc.ca/roadsafety (English speak- ers) or www.tc.gc.ca/securiteroutiere (French speakers).

To notify NISSAN of any safety concerns please contact our Consumer Information Centre toll free at 1-800-387-0122.

WARNING

A vehicle equipped with Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) should never be tested using a two wheel dynamometer (such as the dyna- mometers used by some states for emis- sions testing), or similar equipment. Make sure you inform the test facility personnel that your vehicle is equipped with 4WD before it is placed on a dynamometer. Using the wrong test equipment may re- sult in transmission damage or unex- pected vehicle movement which could re- sult in serious vehicle damage or personal injury.

Due to legal requirements in some states and Canadian Provinces, your vehicle may be re- quired to be in what is called the ready condi- tion for an Inspection/Maintenance (I/M) test of the emission control system.

The vehicle is set to the ready condition when it is driven through certain driving patterns. Usually, the ready condition can be obtained by ordinary usage of the vehicle.

If a powertrain system component is repaired or the battery is disconnected, the vehicle may be reset to a not ready condition. Before taking the I/M test, check the vehicles inspection/maintenance test readiness condi- tion. Place the ignition switch in the ON position without starting the engine. If the Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) comes on steady for 20 sec- onds and then blinks for 10 seconds , the I/M test condition is not ready. If the MIL does not blink after 20 seconds, the I/M test condition is ready. Contact a NISSAN dealer to set the ready condition or to prepare the vehicle for testing.

READINESS FOR INSPECTION/ MAINTENANCE (I/M) TEST

9-38 Technical and consumer information

This vehicle is equipped with an Event Data Re- corder (EDR). The main purpose of an EDR is to record, in certain crash or near crash-like situa- tions, such as an air bag deployment or hitting a road obstacle, data that will assist in understand- ing how a vehicles systems performed. The EDR is designed to record data related to vehicle dynamics and safety systems for a short period of time, typically 30 seconds or less. The EDR in this vehicle is designed to record such data as:

How various systems in your vehicle were operating;

Whether or not the driver and passenger safety belts were buckled/fastened;

How far (if at all) the driver was depressing the accelerator and/or brake pedal; and,

How fast the vehicle was traveling.

Sounds are not recorded.

These data can help provide a better understand- ing of the circumstances in which crashes and injuries occur. NOTE: EDR data are recorded by your vehicle only if a nontrivial crash situation occurs; no data are recorded by the EDR under normal driving conditions and no personal data (e.g. name, gender, age and crash location) are recorded. However, other parties, such as law enforcement, could combine the EDR data with

the type of personally identifying data routinely acquired during a crash investigation.

To read data recorded by an EDR, special equip- ment is required and access to the vehicle or the EDR is needed. In addition to the vehicle manu- facturer and NISSAN dealer, other parties, such as law enforcement, that have the special equip- ment, can read the information if they have ac- cess to the vehicle or the EDR. EDR data will only be accessed with the consent of the vehicle owner or lessee or as otherwise required or per- mitted by law.

Genuine NISSAN Service Manuals for this model year and prior can be purchased. A genuine NISSAN Service Manual is the best source of service and repair information for your vehicle. This manual is the same one used by the factory- trained technicians working at NISSAN dealer- ships. Genuine NISSAN Owners Manuals can also be purchased.

For USA

For current pricing and availability of genuine NISSAN Service Manuals, contact:

1-800-450-9491 www.nissan-techinfo.com

For current pricing and availability of genuine NISSAN Owners Manuals, contact:

1-800-247-5321

For Canada

To purchase a copy of a genuine NISSAN Ser- vice Manual or Owners Manual, for this model year and prior, please contact your nearest NISSAN dealer. For the phone number and loca- tion of a NISSAN dealer in your area, call the NISSAN Information Center at 1-800-387-0122 and a bilingual NISSAN representative will assist you.

EVENT DATA RECORDERS (EDR) OWNERS MANUAL/SERVICE MANUAL ORDER INFORMATION

Technical and consumer information 9-39

MEMO

9-40 Technical and consumer information

10 Index 4WD warning light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-17

A

Active brake limited slip (ABLS) system . . .5-36 Air bag (See supplemental restraint system) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-63 Air bag system

Front (See supplemental front impact air bag system) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-70

Air bag warning labels . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-77 Air bag warning light. . . . . . . . . . .1-78, 2-20 Air cleaner housing filter . . . . . . . . . . . .8-20 Air conditioner

Air conditioner operation . . . . . .4-20, 4-28 Air conditioner service . . . . . . . . . . .4-35 Air conditioner specification label . . . . .9-12 Air conditioner system refrigerant and oil recommendations . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-7 Heater and air conditioner controls . . . .4-17, 4-25, 4-33 Servicing air conditioner . . . . . . . . . .4-35

Air flow charts . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-22, 4-29 Alarm system (See vehicle security system) . . . . . . . . .2-24 Anchor point locations . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-29 Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-76 Anti-lock brake warning light. . . . . . . . . .2-15 Anti-lock Braking System (ABS). . . . . . . .5-35 Audible reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-24 Audio system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-35

Bluetooth audio . . . . . . . . . .4-70, 4-71

Compact disc (CD) player . .4-46, 4-51, 4-58 FM/AM radio with compact disc (CD) player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-45 FM/AM/SAT radio with compact disc (CD) player . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-49, 4-54

Audio System iPod Player . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-64, 4-66

Audio system Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-35 Steering wheel audio control switch . . .4-75 USB interface . . . . . . . . . . . .4-61, 4-62

Autolight switch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-29 Automatic

Automatic power window switch . . . . .2-49 Automatic transmission position indicator light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-20 Driving with automatic transmission . . . .5-13

Automatic anti-glare inside mirror . . . . . . .3-15 Automatic door locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-5 AUX jack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-52, 4-60

B

Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-16 Charge warning light . . . . . . . . . . . .2-16

Before starting the engine . . . . . . . . . . .5-12 Belt (See drive belt) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-18 Block heater

Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-42 Bluetooth audio . . . . . . . . . . . .4-70, 4-71 Bluetooth hands-free phone system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-77, 4-91

Booster seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-58 Brake

Anti-lock Braking System (ABS). . . . . .5-35 Brake fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-14 Brake light (See stop light). . . . . . . . .8-31 Brake system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-34 Brake warning light . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-16 Brake wear indicators . . . . . . . .2-24, 8-23 Parking brake operation . . . . . . . . . .5-20 Self-adjusting brakes . . . . . . . . . . . .8-23

Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-23 Break-in schedule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-22 Brightness/contrast button. . . . . . . . . . .4-11 Brightness control

Instrument panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-31 Bulb check/instrument panel. . . . . . . . . .2-15 Bulb replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-31

C

Capacities and recommended fuel/lubricants. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-2 Cargo light switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-32 Cargo (See vehicle loading information) . . .9-13 Car phone or CB radio . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-77 CD care and cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-74 CD player (See audio system) . .4-46, 4-51, 4-58 Check tire press . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-5 Child restraints . . . . . . .1-23, 1-24, 1-25, 1-27

Precautions on child restraints . . . . . . . .1-25, 1-36, 1-48, 1-58 Top tether strap anchor point locations . .1-29

Child restraint with top tether strap. . . . . . .1-29 Child safety rear door lock . . . . . . . . . . . .3-6 Chimes, audible reminders . . . . . . . . . . .2-24 Cleaning exterior and interior . . . . . . . . . . .7-2 Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-45 Clutch

Clutch fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-15 Clutch interlock (clutch start) switch . . . . . .2-36 C.M.V.S.S. certification label . . . . . . . . . .9-11 Cold weather driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-41 Compact disc (CD) player . . . .4-46, 4-51, 4-58 Compass display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-10 Console box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-41 Control panel buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-4

Brightness/contrast button . . . . . . . . .4-11 Enter button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-4 Setting button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-7

Controls Audio controls (steering wheel). . . . . . .4-75 Heater and air conditioner controls . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-17, 4-25, 4-33

Coolant Capacities and recommended fuel/lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-2 Changing engine coolant . . . . . . . . . . .8-9 Checking engine coolant level . . . . . . . .8-9 Engine coolant temperature gauge . . . . .2-6

Corrosion protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-5 Cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-21 Cup holders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-44 Curtain side-impact and rollover air bag . . . .1-75

D

Daytime running light system (Canada only) . .2-30

Defroster switch Rear window defroster switch . . . . . . .2-27

Dimensions and weights . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-9 Dimmer switch for instrument panel . . . . . .2-31 Display controls (see control panel buttons) . .4-4 Door locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-3 Door open warning light . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-17 Drive belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-18 Driving

Cold weather driving . . . . . . . . . . . .5-41 Driving with automatic transmission . . . .5-13 Driving with manual transmission . . . . . .5-18 Precautions when starting and driving . . . .5-2

E

Economy - fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-24 Electronic locking rear differential (E-Lock) system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-31 Electronic locking rear differential (E-Lock) system switch . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-35 Emission control information label . . . . . . .9-11 Emission control system warranty . . . . . . .9-37 Engine

Before starting the engine. . . . . . . . . .5-12 Block heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-42 Capacities and recommended fuel/lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-2 Changing engine coolant . . . . . . . . . . .8-9 Changing engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-11 Changing engine oil filter . . . . . . . . . .8-12 Checking engine coolant level . . . . . . . .8-9 Checking engine oil level . . . . . . . . . .8-10 Engine compartment check locations . . . .8-6 Engine coolant temperature gauge . . . . .2-6

Engine cooling system . . . . . . . . . . . .8-8 Engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-10 Engine oil and oil filter recommendation . . .9-6 Engine oil pressure warning light . . . . . .2-17 Engine oil viscosity . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-6 Engine serial number . . . . . . . . . . . .9-11 Engine specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-8 Starting the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-12

Engine oil pressure gauge . . . . . . . . . . . .2-8 Enter button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-4 Event data recorders . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-39 Exhaust gas (Carbon monoxide) . . . . . . . . .5-2 Extended storage switch . . . . . . . . . . . .8-27

F

First aid kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-2 Flashers (See hazard warning flasher switch) . .6-3 Flat tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-3 Floor mat positioning aid . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-5 Fluid

Brake fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-14 Capacities and recommended fuel/lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-2 Clutch fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-15 Engine coolant. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-8 Engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-10 Power steering fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-14 Windshield-washer fluid. . . . . . . . . . .8-15

F.M.V.S.S. certification label. . . . . . . . . . .9-11 Fog light switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-32 Front air bag system (See supplemental restraint system) . . . . . .1-70 Front seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-2

10-2

Fuel Capacities and recommended fuel/lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-2 Fuel economy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-24 Fuel-filler door and cap . . . . . . . . . . .3-11 Fuel gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-7 Fuel octane rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-5 Fuel recommendation . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-4 Loose fuel cap warning . . . . . . . .2-5, 3-11

Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-24 Fusible links . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-26

G

Garage door opener, HomeLink Universal Transceiver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-54 Gas cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-11 Gauge

Engine coolant temperature gauge . . . . .2-6 Engine oil pressure gauge . . . . . . . . . .2-8 Fuel gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-7 Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-4 Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-4 Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-6 Trip computer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-9 Trip odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-4 Voltmeter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-8

General maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-2 Glove box. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-42

H

Hands-free phone system, Bluetooth . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-77, 4-91

Hazard warning flasher switch . . . . . . . . . .6-3 Headlight and turn signal switch . . . . . . . .2-28 Headlight control switch . . . . . . . . . . . .2-28 Headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-29 Heated seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-33 Heater

Heater and air conditioner controls . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-17, 4-25, 4-33 Heater operation . . . . . . . .4-19, 4-26, 4-34

Hill descent control switch . . . . . . . . . . .2-34 Hill descent control system . . . . . . . . . . .5-38 Hill start assist system. . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-39 HomeLink Universal Transceiver . . . . . . .2-54 Hood release. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-10 Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-32

I

Ignition switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-10 Immobilizer system . . . . . . . . .2-25, 3-2, 5-12 Important vehicle information label . . . . . . .9-11 In-cabin microfilter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-21 Increasing fuel economy. . . . . . . . . . . . .5-24 Indicator lights and audible reminders (See warning/indicator lights and audible reminders) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-14 Inside automatic anti-glare mirror . . . . . . . .3-15 Inside mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-15 Instrument brightness control . . . . . . . . . .2-31 Instrument panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .0-6, 2-2 Instrument panel dimmer switch . . . . . . . .2-31 Interior light. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-53 iPod Player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-64, 4-66 ISOFIX child restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-27

J

Jump seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-6 Jump starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-10

K

Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-2 Keyfob battery replacement . . . . . . . . . . .8-28 Keyless entry system (See remote keyless entry system). . . . . . . .3-6

L

Labels Air conditioner specification label . . . . .9-12 C.M.V.S.S. certification label . . . . . . . .9-11 Emission control information label . . . . .9-11 Engine serial number . . . . . . . . . . . .9-11 F.M.V.S.S. certification label. . . . . . . . .9-11 Tire and Loading Information label . . . . .9-12 Vehicle identification number (VIN) plate. .9-10 Warning labels (for SRS) . . . . . . . . . .1-77

LATCH (Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren) System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-27 License plate

Installing the license plate . . . . . . . . . .9-12 Light

Air bag warning light . . . . . . . . .1-78, 2-20 Brake light (See stop light) . . . . . . . . .8-31 Bulb check/instrument panel . . . . . . . .2-15 Bulb replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-31 Charge warning light . . . . . . . . . . . .2-16 Fog light switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-32

10-3

Headlight and turn signal switch . . . . . .2-28 Headlight control switch . . . . . . . . . .2-28 Headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-29 Interior light. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-53 Light bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-29 Low tire pressure warning light . . . . . . .2-18 Low windshield-washer fluid warning light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-19 Passenger air bag and status light . . . . .1-72 Security indicator light. . . . . . . . . . . .2-22 Warning/indicator lights and audible reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-14

Lights Map lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-53

Lock Child safety rear door lock . . . . . . . . . .3-6 Door locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-3 Power door locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-4

Loose fuel cap warning . . . . . . . . . .2-5, 3-11 Low fuel warning light . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-18 Low tire pressure warning light . . . . . . . . .2-18 Low windshield-washer fluid warning light. . .2-19 Luggage rack (see roof rack) . . . . . . . . . .2-46 Luggage (See vehicle loading information) . .9-13

M

Maintenance General maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-2 Inside the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-3 Maintenance precautions . . . . . . . . . . .8-5 Outside the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-2 Seat belt maintenance. . . . . . . . . . . .1-23 Under the hood and vehicle . . . . . . . . .8-4

Malfunction indicator light . . . . . . . . . . . .2-21

Manual front seat adjustment . . . . . . . . . . .1-2 Manual windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-49 Map lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-53 Map pocket. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-43 Meters and gauges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-3

Instrument brightness control . . . . . . . .2-31 Mirror

Automatic anti-glare inside mirror. . . . . .3-15 Inside mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-15 Outside mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-16 Vanity mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-14

Moonroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-50 Multi-remote control system (See remote keyless entry system). . . . . . . .3-6

N

NISSAN vehicle immobilizer system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-25, 3-2, 5-12 NISSAN voice recognition system . . . . . .4-101

O

Octane rating (See fuel octane rating). . . . . .9-5 Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-4 Oil

Capacities and recommended fuel/lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-2 Changing engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-11 Changing engine oil filter . . . . . . . . . .8-12 Checking engine oil level . . . . . . . . . .8-10 Engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-10 Engine oil and oil filter recommendation . . .9-6 Engine oil viscosity . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-6

Outside mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-16 Overdrive switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-17 Overheat

If your vehicle overheats . . . . . . . . . . .6-12 Owners manual order form . . . . . . . . . . .9-39 Owners manual/service manual order information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-39

P

Parking Parking brake operation . . . . . . . . . . .5-20 Parking/parking on hills . . . . . . . . . . .5-33

Phone, Bluetooth hands-free system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-77, 4-91 Power

Front seat adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-4 Power door locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-4 Power outlet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-37 Power steering fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-14 Power steering system . . . . . . . . . . .5-34 Power windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-47 Rear power windows . . . . . . . . . . . .2-49

Precautions Maintenance precautions . . . . . . . . . . .8-5 On-pavement and off-road driving precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-6 Precautions on child restraints. . . . . . . . .1-25, 1-36, 1-48, 1-58 Precautions on seat belt usage . . . . . . .1-15 Precautions on supplemental restraint system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-63 Precautions when starting and driving . . . .5-2

Pre-tensioner seat belt system . . . . . . . . .1-76 Programmable features . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-7

10-4

Push starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-12

R

Radio Car phone or CB radio . . . . . . . . . . .4-77 FM/AM radio with compact disc (CD) player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-45 FM/AM/SAT radio with compact disc (CD) player . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-49, 4-54 Steering wheel audio control switch . . . .4-75

Readiness for inspection maintenance (I/M) test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-38 Rear power windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-49 Rear sliding window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-50 Rear sonar system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-40 Rear sonar system off switch . . . . . . . . . .2-37 RearView Monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-11 Rear window defroster switch . . . . . . . . .2-27 Recorders

Event data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-39 Refrigerant recommendation . . . . . . . . . . .9-7 Registering your vehicle in another country . .9-10 Remote keyless entry system. . . . . . . . . . .3-6 Reporting safety defects (US only) . . . . . . .9-37 Roof rack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-46

S

Safety Child safety rear door lock . . . . . . . . . .3-6 Child seat belts . . . . .1-25, 1-36, 1-48, 1-58 Reporting safety defects (US only) . . . . .9-37

Seat Jump seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-6

Seat adjustment Front manual seat adjustment . . . . . . . .1-2 Front power seat adjustment . . . . . . . . .1-4

Seatback pockets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-44 Seat belt

Child safety. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-23 Infants and small children . . . . . . . . . .1-24 Injured Person . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-18 Larger children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-24 Precautions on seat belt usage . . . . . . .1-15 Pregnant women. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-18 Pre-tensioner seat belt system . . . . . . .1-76 Seat belt extenders . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-22 Seat belt maintenance. . . . . . . . . . . .1-23 Seat belts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-15 Shoulder belt height adjustment . . . . . .1-22 Three-point type with retractor . . . . . . .1-18

Seat belt warning light. . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-19 Seats

Adjustment. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-2 Front seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-2 Heated seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-33 Manual front seat adjustment . . . . . . . . .1-2

Security indicator light. . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-22 Security system (NISSAN vehicle immobilizer system), engine start . . . . . . . .2-25, 3-2, 5-12 Self-adjusting brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-23 Service manual order form . . . . . . . . . . .9-39 Servicing air conditioner. . . . . . . . . . . . .4-35 Setting button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-7 Shifting

Automatic transmission . . . . . . . . . . .5-14 Manual transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-18

Shift lock release. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-16

Shoulder belt height adjustment . . . . . . . .1-22 Side air bag system (See supplemental side air bag, curtain and rollover air bag systems) . . .1-75 Sonar

Rear system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-40 Spark plug replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-19 Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-4 SRS warning label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-77 Starting

Before starting the engine. . . . . . . . . .5-12 Jump starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-10 Precautions when starting and driving . . . .5-2 Push starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-12 Starting the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-12

Steering Power steering fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-14 Power steering system . . . . . . . . . . .5-34 Tilting steering wheel . . . . . . . . . . . .3-13

Steering wheel audio control switch . . . . . .4-75 Stop light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-31 Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-38 Storage tray . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-38, 2-40 Sunglasses case. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-42 Sunroof (see Moonroof) . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-50 Sun visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-14 Supplemental air bag warning labels . . . . . .1-77 Supplemental air bag warning light . . .1-78, 2-20 Supplemental front impact air bag system . . .1-70 Supplemental restraint system

Information and warning labels . . . . . . .1-77 Precautions on supplemental restraint system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-63

Supplemental restraint system (Supplemental air bag system) . . . . . . . . .1-63 Switch

Autolight switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-29

10-5

Automatic power window switch . . . . . .2-49 Clutch interlock (clutch start) switch . . . .2-36 Electronic locking rear differential (E-Lock) system switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-35 Fog light switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-32 Hazard warning flasher switch . . . . . . . .6-3 Headlight and turn signal switch . . . . . .2-28 Headlight control switch . . . . . . . . . .2-28 Hill descent control switch . . . . . . . . .2-34 Ignition switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-10 Overdrive switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-17 Power door lock switch . . . . . . . . . . . .3-4 Rear sonar system off switch . . . . . . . .2-37 Rear window defroster switch . . . . . . .2-27 Turn signal switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-31 Vehicle dynamic control (VDC) off switch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-34 Windshield wiper and washer switch . . .2-26

T

Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-6 Tailgate latch . . . . . . . . . . . .3-17, 3-21, 3-22 Temperature gauge

Engine coolant temperature gauge . . . . .2-6 Theft (NISSAN vehicle immobilizer system), engine start . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-25, 3-2, 5-12 Three-way catalyst . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-3 Tie down hooks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-22 Tilting steering wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-13 Tire

Flat tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-3 Spare tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-5, 8-43 Tire and Loading Information label . . . . .9-12 Tire chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-40

Tire placard. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-12 Tire pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-33 Tire rotation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-40 Tires of 4-wheel drive . . . . . . . . . . . .8-42 Types of tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-39 Uniform tire quality grading . . . . . . . . .9-36 Wheels and tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-33 Wheel/tire size. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-9

Tire pressure Low tire pressure warning light . . . . . . .2-18

Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) . . . .5-3 Top tether strap child restraint . . . . . . . . .1-29 Towing

2-wheel drive models . . . . . . . . . . . .6-14 4-wheel drive models . . . . . . . . . . . .6-15 Flat towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-35 Towing load/specification . . . . . . . . . .9-28 Tow truck towing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-13 Trailer towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-24

Transceiver HomeLink Universal Transceiver . . . . .2-54

Transmission Driving with automatic transmission . . . .5-13 Driving with manual transmission . . . . . .5-18

Travel (See registering your vehicle in another country) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-10 Trip computer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-9 Trip odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-4 Truck - camper loading . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-23 Turn signal switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-31

U

Uniform tire quality grading . . . . . . . . . . .9-36

USB interface Audio file operation . . . . . . . . . .4-61, 4-63

V

Vanity mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-14 Variable voltage control system . . . . . . . . .8-18 Vehicle dimensions and weights . . . . . . . . .9-9 Vehicle dynamic control (VDC) off switch . . .2-34 Vehicle dynamic control (VDC) system. . . . .5-37 Vehicle identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-10 Vehicle identification number (VIN) plate. . . .9-10 Vehicle loading information . . . . . . . . . . .9-13 Vehicle recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-15 Vehicle security system . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-24 Vehicle security system (NISSAN vehicle immobi- lizer system), engine start . . . . . .2-25, 3-2, 5-12 Ventilators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-17 Visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-14 Voice recognition system . . . . . . . . . . .4-101 Voltmeter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-8

W

Warning 4WD warning light. . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-17 Air bag warning light . . . . . . . . .1-78, 2-20 Anti-lock brake warning light . . . . . . . .2-15 Battery charge warning light . . . . . . . .2-16 Brake warning light . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-16 Door open warning light . . . . . . . . . . .2-17 Engine oil pressure warning light . . . . . .2-17 Hazard warning flasher switch . . . . . . . .6-3 Low fuel warning light . . . . . . . . . . . .2-18

10-6

Low tire pressure warning light . . . . . . .2-18 Low windshield-washer fluid warning light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-19 Passenger air bag and status light . . . . .1-72 Seat belt warning light. . . . . . . . . . . .2-19 Vehicle security system . . . . . . . . . . .2-24 Warning/indicator lights and audible reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-14 Warning labels (for SRS) . . . . . . . . . .1-77

Warning lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-14 Washer switch

Windshield wiper and washer switch . . .2-26 Weights (See dimensions and weights) . . . . .9-9 Wheels and tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-33 Wheel/tire size. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-9 When traveling or registering your vehicle in another country . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-10 Windows

Locking passengers windows . . . . . . .2-49 Manual windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-49 Power windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-47 Rear power windows . . . . . . . . . . . .2-49 Rear sliding window . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-50

Windshield-washer fluid. . . . . . . . . . . . .8-15 Windshield wiper and washer switch . . . . .2-26 Wiper

Windshield wiper and washer switch . . .2-26 Wiper blades. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-22

10-7

RECOMMENDED FUEL:

Use unleaded regular gasoline with an octane rating of at least 87 AKI (Anti-Knock Index) num- ber (Research octane number 91).

CAUTION

Using a fuel other than that specified could adversely affect the emission control system, and may also affect the warranty coverage.

Under no circumstances should a leaded gasoline be used, because this will damage the three-way catalyst.

Do not use E-15 or E-85 fuel in your ve- hicle. Your vehicle is not designed to run on E-15 or E-85 fuel. Using E-15 or E-85 fuel in a vehicle not specifically designed for E-15 or E-85 fuel can adversely affect the emission control devices and sys- tems of the vehicle. Damage caused by such fuel is not covered by the NISSAN new vehicle limited warranty.

U.S. government regulations require ethanol dispensing pumps to be identi- fied by a small, square, orange and black label with the common abbrevia- tion or the appropriate percentage for that region.

For additional information, see Capacities and recommended fuel/lubricants in the Technical and consumer information section.

RECOMMENDED ENGINE OIL: Engine oil with API Certification Mark

Viscosity SAE 5W-30

See Engine oil and oil filter recommendations in the Technical and consumer information sec- tion of this manual.

COLD TIRE PRESSURE: See Tire and Loading Information label.

The label is typically located on the driver side center pillar or on the drivers door. For additional information, see Wheels and tires in the Main- tenance and do-it-yourself section of this manual.

RECOMMENDED NEW VEHICLE BREAK-IN PROCEDURE: During the first 1,200 mi (2,000 km) of vehicle use, follow the recommendations outlined in the Break-in schedule information found in the Starting and driving section of this manual. Fol- low these recommendations for the future reli- ability and economy of your new vehicle. Failure to follow these recommendations may result in vehicle damage or shortened engine life.

GAS STATION INFORMATION

Manualsnet FAQs

If you want to find out how the Frontier Nissan works, you can view and download the Nissan Frontier Owner's Manual on the Manualsnet website.

Yes, we have the Owner's Manual for Nissan Frontier as well as other Nissan manuals. All you need to do is to use our search bar and find the user manual that you are looking for.

The Owner's Manual should include all the details that are needed to use a Nissan Frontier. Full manuals and user guide PDFs can be downloaded from Manualsnet.com.

The best way to navigate the Nissan Frontier Owner's Manual is by checking the Table of Contents at the top of the page where available. This allows you to navigate a manual by jumping to the section you are looking for.

This Nissan Frontier Owner's Manual consists of sections like Table of Contents, to name a few. For easier navigation, use the Table of Contents in the upper left corner.

You can download Nissan Frontier Owner's Manual free of charge simply by clicking the “download” button in the upper right corner of any manuals page. This feature allows you to download any manual in a couple of seconds and is generally in PDF format. You can also save a manual for later by adding it to your saved documents in the user profile.

To be able to print Nissan Frontier Owner's Manual, simply download the document to your computer. Once downloaded, open the PDF file and print the Nissan Frontier Owner's Manual as you would any other document. This can usually be achieved by clicking on “File” and then “Print” from the menu bar.